1 //===- ScalarEvolution.cpp - Scalar Evolution Analysis --------------------===//
2 //
3 //                     The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4 //
5 // This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6 // License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
7 //
8 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9 //
10 // This file contains the implementation of the scalar evolution analysis
11 // engine, which is used primarily to analyze expressions involving induction
12 // variables in loops.
13 //
14 // There are several aspects to this library.  First is the representation of
15 // scalar expressions, which are represented as subclasses of the SCEV class.
16 // These classes are used to represent certain types of subexpressions that we
17 // can handle. We only create one SCEV of a particular shape, so
18 // pointer-comparisons for equality are legal.
19 //
20 // One important aspect of the SCEV objects is that they are never cyclic, even
21 // if there is a cycle in the dataflow for an expression (ie, a PHI node).  If
22 // the PHI node is one of the idioms that we can represent (e.g., a polynomial
23 // recurrence) then we represent it directly as a recurrence node, otherwise we
24 // represent it as a SCEVUnknown node.
25 //
26 // In addition to being able to represent expressions of various types, we also
27 // have folders that are used to build the *canonical* representation for a
28 // particular expression.  These folders are capable of using a variety of
29 // rewrite rules to simplify the expressions.
30 //
31 // Once the folders are defined, we can implement the more interesting
32 // higher-level code, such as the code that recognizes PHI nodes of various
33 // types, computes the execution count of a loop, etc.
34 //
35 // TODO: We should use these routines and value representations to implement
36 // dependence analysis!
37 //
38 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
39 //
40 // There are several good references for the techniques used in this analysis.
41 //
42 //  Chains of recurrences -- a method to expedite the evaluation
43 //  of closed-form functions
44 //  Olaf Bachmann, Paul S. Wang, Eugene V. Zima
45 //
46 //  On computational properties of chains of recurrences
47 //  Eugene V. Zima
48 //
49 //  Symbolic Evaluation of Chains of Recurrences for Loop Optimization
50 //  Robert A. van Engelen
51 //
52 //  Efficient Symbolic Analysis for Optimizing Compilers
53 //  Robert A. van Engelen
54 //
55 //  Using the chains of recurrences algebra for data dependence testing and
56 //  induction variable substitution
57 //  MS Thesis, Johnie Birch
58 //
59 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
60 
61 #include "llvm/Analysis/ScalarEvolution.h"
62 #include "llvm/ADT/APInt.h"
63 #include "llvm/ADT/ArrayRef.h"
64 #include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
65 #include "llvm/ADT/DepthFirstIterator.h"
66 #include "llvm/ADT/EquivalenceClasses.h"
67 #include "llvm/ADT/FoldingSet.h"
68 #include "llvm/ADT/None.h"
69 #include "llvm/ADT/Optional.h"
70 #include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
71 #include "llvm/ADT/ScopeExit.h"
72 #include "llvm/ADT/Sequence.h"
73 #include "llvm/ADT/SetVector.h"
74 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
75 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallSet.h"
76 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
77 #include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
78 #include "llvm/ADT/StringRef.h"
79 #include "llvm/Analysis/AssumptionCache.h"
80 #include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h"
81 #include "llvm/Analysis/InstructionSimplify.h"
82 #include "llvm/Analysis/LoopInfo.h"
83 #include "llvm/Analysis/ScalarEvolutionExpressions.h"
84 #include "llvm/Analysis/TargetLibraryInfo.h"
85 #include "llvm/Analysis/ValueTracking.h"
86 #include "llvm/Config/llvm-config.h"
87 #include "llvm/IR/Argument.h"
88 #include "llvm/IR/BasicBlock.h"
89 #include "llvm/IR/CFG.h"
90 #include "llvm/IR/CallSite.h"
91 #include "llvm/IR/Constant.h"
92 #include "llvm/IR/ConstantRange.h"
93 #include "llvm/IR/Constants.h"
94 #include "llvm/IR/DataLayout.h"
95 #include "llvm/IR/DerivedTypes.h"
96 #include "llvm/IR/Dominators.h"
97 #include "llvm/IR/Function.h"
98 #include "llvm/IR/GlobalAlias.h"
99 #include "llvm/IR/GlobalValue.h"
100 #include "llvm/IR/GlobalVariable.h"
101 #include "llvm/IR/InstIterator.h"
102 #include "llvm/IR/InstrTypes.h"
103 #include "llvm/IR/Instruction.h"
104 #include "llvm/IR/Instructions.h"
105 #include "llvm/IR/IntrinsicInst.h"
106 #include "llvm/IR/Intrinsics.h"
107 #include "llvm/IR/LLVMContext.h"
108 #include "llvm/IR/Metadata.h"
109 #include "llvm/IR/Operator.h"
110 #include "llvm/IR/PatternMatch.h"
111 #include "llvm/IR/Type.h"
112 #include "llvm/IR/Use.h"
113 #include "llvm/IR/User.h"
114 #include "llvm/IR/Value.h"
115 #include "llvm/Pass.h"
116 #include "llvm/Support/Casting.h"
117 #include "llvm/Support/CommandLine.h"
118 #include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
119 #include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
120 #include "llvm/Support/ErrorHandling.h"
121 #include "llvm/Support/KnownBits.h"
122 #include "llvm/Support/SaveAndRestore.h"
123 #include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
124 #include <algorithm>
125 #include <cassert>
126 #include <climits>
127 #include <cstddef>
128 #include <cstdint>
129 #include <cstdlib>
130 #include <map>
131 #include <memory>
132 #include <tuple>
133 #include <utility>
134 #include <vector>
135 
136 using namespace llvm;
137 
138 #define DEBUG_TYPE "scalar-evolution"
139 
140 STATISTIC(NumArrayLenItCounts,
141           "Number of trip counts computed with array length");
142 STATISTIC(NumTripCountsComputed,
143           "Number of loops with predictable loop counts");
144 STATISTIC(NumTripCountsNotComputed,
145           "Number of loops without predictable loop counts");
146 STATISTIC(NumBruteForceTripCountsComputed,
147           "Number of loops with trip counts computed by force");
148 
149 static cl::opt<unsigned>
150 MaxBruteForceIterations("scalar-evolution-max-iterations", cl::ReallyHidden,
151                         cl::desc("Maximum number of iterations SCEV will "
152                                  "symbolically execute a constant "
153                                  "derived loop"),
154                         cl::init(100));
155 
156 // FIXME: Enable this with EXPENSIVE_CHECKS when the test suite is clean.
157 static cl::opt<bool> VerifySCEV(
158     "verify-scev", cl::Hidden,
159     cl::desc("Verify ScalarEvolution's backedge taken counts (slow)"));
160 static cl::opt<bool>
161     VerifySCEVMap("verify-scev-maps", cl::Hidden,
162                   cl::desc("Verify no dangling value in ScalarEvolution's "
163                            "ExprValueMap (slow)"));
164 
165 static cl::opt<unsigned> MulOpsInlineThreshold(
166     "scev-mulops-inline-threshold", cl::Hidden,
167     cl::desc("Threshold for inlining multiplication operands into a SCEV"),
168     cl::init(32));
169 
170 static cl::opt<unsigned> AddOpsInlineThreshold(
171     "scev-addops-inline-threshold", cl::Hidden,
172     cl::desc("Threshold for inlining addition operands into a SCEV"),
173     cl::init(500));
174 
175 static cl::opt<unsigned> MaxSCEVCompareDepth(
176     "scalar-evolution-max-scev-compare-depth", cl::Hidden,
177     cl::desc("Maximum depth of recursive SCEV complexity comparisons"),
178     cl::init(32));
179 
180 static cl::opt<unsigned> MaxSCEVOperationsImplicationDepth(
181     "scalar-evolution-max-scev-operations-implication-depth", cl::Hidden,
182     cl::desc("Maximum depth of recursive SCEV operations implication analysis"),
183     cl::init(2));
184 
185 static cl::opt<unsigned> MaxValueCompareDepth(
186     "scalar-evolution-max-value-compare-depth", cl::Hidden,
187     cl::desc("Maximum depth of recursive value complexity comparisons"),
188     cl::init(2));
189 
190 static cl::opt<unsigned>
191     MaxArithDepth("scalar-evolution-max-arith-depth", cl::Hidden,
192                   cl::desc("Maximum depth of recursive arithmetics"),
193                   cl::init(32));
194 
195 static cl::opt<unsigned> MaxConstantEvolvingDepth(
196     "scalar-evolution-max-constant-evolving-depth", cl::Hidden,
197     cl::desc("Maximum depth of recursive constant evolving"), cl::init(32));
198 
199 static cl::opt<unsigned>
200     MaxExtDepth("scalar-evolution-max-ext-depth", cl::Hidden,
201                 cl::desc("Maximum depth of recursive SExt/ZExt"),
202                 cl::init(8));
203 
204 static cl::opt<unsigned>
205     MaxAddRecSize("scalar-evolution-max-add-rec-size", cl::Hidden,
206                   cl::desc("Max coefficients in AddRec during evolving"),
207                   cl::init(8));
208 
209 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
210 //                           SCEV class definitions
211 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
212 
213 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
214 // Implementation of the SCEV class.
215 //
216 
217 #if !defined(NDEBUG) || defined(LLVM_ENABLE_DUMP)
218 LLVM_DUMP_METHOD void SCEV::dump() const {
219   print(dbgs());
220   dbgs() << '\n';
221 }
222 #endif
223 
224 void SCEV::print(raw_ostream &OS) const {
225   switch (static_cast<SCEVTypes>(getSCEVType())) {
226   case scConstant:
227     cast<SCEVConstant>(this)->getValue()->printAsOperand(OS, false);
228     return;
229   case scTruncate: {
230     const SCEVTruncateExpr *Trunc = cast<SCEVTruncateExpr>(this);
231     const SCEV *Op = Trunc->getOperand();
232     OS << "(trunc " << *Op->getType() << " " << *Op << " to "
233        << *Trunc->getType() << ")";
234     return;
235   }
236   case scZeroExtend: {
237     const SCEVZeroExtendExpr *ZExt = cast<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(this);
238     const SCEV *Op = ZExt->getOperand();
239     OS << "(zext " << *Op->getType() << " " << *Op << " to "
240        << *ZExt->getType() << ")";
241     return;
242   }
243   case scSignExtend: {
244     const SCEVSignExtendExpr *SExt = cast<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(this);
245     const SCEV *Op = SExt->getOperand();
246     OS << "(sext " << *Op->getType() << " " << *Op << " to "
247        << *SExt->getType() << ")";
248     return;
249   }
250   case scAddRecExpr: {
251     const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR = cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(this);
252     OS << "{" << *AR->getOperand(0);
253     for (unsigned i = 1, e = AR->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
254       OS << ",+," << *AR->getOperand(i);
255     OS << "}<";
256     if (AR->hasNoUnsignedWrap())
257       OS << "nuw><";
258     if (AR->hasNoSignedWrap())
259       OS << "nsw><";
260     if (AR->hasNoSelfWrap() &&
261         !AR->getNoWrapFlags((NoWrapFlags)(FlagNUW | FlagNSW)))
262       OS << "nw><";
263     AR->getLoop()->getHeader()->printAsOperand(OS, /*PrintType=*/false);
264     OS << ">";
265     return;
266   }
267   case scAddExpr:
268   case scMulExpr:
269   case scUMaxExpr:
270   case scSMaxExpr: {
271     const SCEVNAryExpr *NAry = cast<SCEVNAryExpr>(this);
272     const char *OpStr = nullptr;
273     switch (NAry->getSCEVType()) {
274     case scAddExpr: OpStr = " + "; break;
275     case scMulExpr: OpStr = " * "; break;
276     case scUMaxExpr: OpStr = " umax "; break;
277     case scSMaxExpr: OpStr = " smax "; break;
278     }
279     OS << "(";
280     for (SCEVNAryExpr::op_iterator I = NAry->op_begin(), E = NAry->op_end();
281          I != E; ++I) {
282       OS << **I;
283       if (std::next(I) != E)
284         OS << OpStr;
285     }
286     OS << ")";
287     switch (NAry->getSCEVType()) {
288     case scAddExpr:
289     case scMulExpr:
290       if (NAry->hasNoUnsignedWrap())
291         OS << "<nuw>";
292       if (NAry->hasNoSignedWrap())
293         OS << "<nsw>";
294     }
295     return;
296   }
297   case scUDivExpr: {
298     const SCEVUDivExpr *UDiv = cast<SCEVUDivExpr>(this);
299     OS << "(" << *UDiv->getLHS() << " /u " << *UDiv->getRHS() << ")";
300     return;
301   }
302   case scUnknown: {
303     const SCEVUnknown *U = cast<SCEVUnknown>(this);
304     Type *AllocTy;
305     if (U->isSizeOf(AllocTy)) {
306       OS << "sizeof(" << *AllocTy << ")";
307       return;
308     }
309     if (U->isAlignOf(AllocTy)) {
310       OS << "alignof(" << *AllocTy << ")";
311       return;
312     }
313 
314     Type *CTy;
315     Constant *FieldNo;
316     if (U->isOffsetOf(CTy, FieldNo)) {
317       OS << "offsetof(" << *CTy << ", ";
318       FieldNo->printAsOperand(OS, false);
319       OS << ")";
320       return;
321     }
322 
323     // Otherwise just print it normally.
324     U->getValue()->printAsOperand(OS, false);
325     return;
326   }
327   case scCouldNotCompute:
328     OS << "***COULDNOTCOMPUTE***";
329     return;
330   }
331   llvm_unreachable("Unknown SCEV kind!");
332 }
333 
334 Type *SCEV::getType() const {
335   switch (static_cast<SCEVTypes>(getSCEVType())) {
336   case scConstant:
337     return cast<SCEVConstant>(this)->getType();
338   case scTruncate:
339   case scZeroExtend:
340   case scSignExtend:
341     return cast<SCEVCastExpr>(this)->getType();
342   case scAddRecExpr:
343   case scMulExpr:
344   case scUMaxExpr:
345   case scSMaxExpr:
346     return cast<SCEVNAryExpr>(this)->getType();
347   case scAddExpr:
348     return cast<SCEVAddExpr>(this)->getType();
349   case scUDivExpr:
350     return cast<SCEVUDivExpr>(this)->getType();
351   case scUnknown:
352     return cast<SCEVUnknown>(this)->getType();
353   case scCouldNotCompute:
354     llvm_unreachable("Attempt to use a SCEVCouldNotCompute object!");
355   }
356   llvm_unreachable("Unknown SCEV kind!");
357 }
358 
359 bool SCEV::isZero() const {
360   if (const SCEVConstant *SC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(this))
361     return SC->getValue()->isZero();
362   return false;
363 }
364 
365 bool SCEV::isOne() const {
366   if (const SCEVConstant *SC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(this))
367     return SC->getValue()->isOne();
368   return false;
369 }
370 
371 bool SCEV::isAllOnesValue() const {
372   if (const SCEVConstant *SC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(this))
373     return SC->getValue()->isMinusOne();
374   return false;
375 }
376 
377 bool SCEV::isNonConstantNegative() const {
378   const SCEVMulExpr *Mul = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(this);
379   if (!Mul) return false;
380 
381   // If there is a constant factor, it will be first.
382   const SCEVConstant *SC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Mul->getOperand(0));
383   if (!SC) return false;
384 
385   // Return true if the value is negative, this matches things like (-42 * V).
386   return SC->getAPInt().isNegative();
387 }
388 
389 SCEVCouldNotCompute::SCEVCouldNotCompute() :
390   SCEV(FoldingSetNodeIDRef(), scCouldNotCompute) {}
391 
392 bool SCEVCouldNotCompute::classof(const SCEV *S) {
393   return S->getSCEVType() == scCouldNotCompute;
394 }
395 
396 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getConstant(ConstantInt *V) {
397   FoldingSetNodeID ID;
398   ID.AddInteger(scConstant);
399   ID.AddPointer(V);
400   void *IP = nullptr;
401   if (const SCEV *S = UniqueSCEVs.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP)) return S;
402   SCEV *S = new (SCEVAllocator) SCEVConstant(ID.Intern(SCEVAllocator), V);
403   UniqueSCEVs.InsertNode(S, IP);
404   return S;
405 }
406 
407 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getConstant(const APInt &Val) {
408   return getConstant(ConstantInt::get(getContext(), Val));
409 }
410 
411 const SCEV *
412 ScalarEvolution::getConstant(Type *Ty, uint64_t V, bool isSigned) {
413   IntegerType *ITy = cast<IntegerType>(getEffectiveSCEVType(Ty));
414   return getConstant(ConstantInt::get(ITy, V, isSigned));
415 }
416 
417 SCEVCastExpr::SCEVCastExpr(const FoldingSetNodeIDRef ID,
418                            unsigned SCEVTy, const SCEV *op, Type *ty)
419   : SCEV(ID, SCEVTy), Op(op), Ty(ty) {}
420 
421 SCEVTruncateExpr::SCEVTruncateExpr(const FoldingSetNodeIDRef ID,
422                                    const SCEV *op, Type *ty)
423   : SCEVCastExpr(ID, scTruncate, op, ty) {
424   assert(Op->getType()->isIntOrPtrTy() && Ty->isIntOrPtrTy() &&
425          "Cannot truncate non-integer value!");
426 }
427 
428 SCEVZeroExtendExpr::SCEVZeroExtendExpr(const FoldingSetNodeIDRef ID,
429                                        const SCEV *op, Type *ty)
430   : SCEVCastExpr(ID, scZeroExtend, op, ty) {
431   assert(Op->getType()->isIntOrPtrTy() && Ty->isIntOrPtrTy() &&
432          "Cannot zero extend non-integer value!");
433 }
434 
435 SCEVSignExtendExpr::SCEVSignExtendExpr(const FoldingSetNodeIDRef ID,
436                                        const SCEV *op, Type *ty)
437   : SCEVCastExpr(ID, scSignExtend, op, ty) {
438   assert(Op->getType()->isIntOrPtrTy() && Ty->isIntOrPtrTy() &&
439          "Cannot sign extend non-integer value!");
440 }
441 
442 void SCEVUnknown::deleted() {
443   // Clear this SCEVUnknown from various maps.
444   SE->forgetMemoizedResults(this);
445 
446   // Remove this SCEVUnknown from the uniquing map.
447   SE->UniqueSCEVs.RemoveNode(this);
448 
449   // Release the value.
450   setValPtr(nullptr);
451 }
452 
453 void SCEVUnknown::allUsesReplacedWith(Value *New) {
454   // Remove this SCEVUnknown from the uniquing map.
455   SE->UniqueSCEVs.RemoveNode(this);
456 
457   // Update this SCEVUnknown to point to the new value. This is needed
458   // because there may still be outstanding SCEVs which still point to
459   // this SCEVUnknown.
460   setValPtr(New);
461 }
462 
463 bool SCEVUnknown::isSizeOf(Type *&AllocTy) const {
464   if (ConstantExpr *VCE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(getValue()))
465     if (VCE->getOpcode() == Instruction::PtrToInt)
466       if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(VCE->getOperand(0)))
467         if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr &&
468             CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue() &&
469             CE->getNumOperands() == 2)
470           if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CE->getOperand(1)))
471             if (CI->isOne()) {
472               AllocTy = cast<PointerType>(CE->getOperand(0)->getType())
473                                  ->getElementType();
474               return true;
475             }
476 
477   return false;
478 }
479 
480 bool SCEVUnknown::isAlignOf(Type *&AllocTy) const {
481   if (ConstantExpr *VCE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(getValue()))
482     if (VCE->getOpcode() == Instruction::PtrToInt)
483       if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(VCE->getOperand(0)))
484         if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr &&
485             CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue()) {
486           Type *Ty =
487             cast<PointerType>(CE->getOperand(0)->getType())->getElementType();
488           if (StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(Ty))
489             if (!STy->isPacked() &&
490                 CE->getNumOperands() == 3 &&
491                 CE->getOperand(1)->isNullValue()) {
492               if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CE->getOperand(2)))
493                 if (CI->isOne() &&
494                     STy->getNumElements() == 2 &&
495                     STy->getElementType(0)->isIntegerTy(1)) {
496                   AllocTy = STy->getElementType(1);
497                   return true;
498                 }
499             }
500         }
501 
502   return false;
503 }
504 
505 bool SCEVUnknown::isOffsetOf(Type *&CTy, Constant *&FieldNo) const {
506   if (ConstantExpr *VCE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(getValue()))
507     if (VCE->getOpcode() == Instruction::PtrToInt)
508       if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(VCE->getOperand(0)))
509         if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr &&
510             CE->getNumOperands() == 3 &&
511             CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue() &&
512             CE->getOperand(1)->isNullValue()) {
513           Type *Ty =
514             cast<PointerType>(CE->getOperand(0)->getType())->getElementType();
515           // Ignore vector types here so that ScalarEvolutionExpander doesn't
516           // emit getelementptrs that index into vectors.
517           if (Ty->isStructTy() || Ty->isArrayTy()) {
518             CTy = Ty;
519             FieldNo = CE->getOperand(2);
520             return true;
521           }
522         }
523 
524   return false;
525 }
526 
527 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
528 //                               SCEV Utilities
529 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
530 
531 /// Compare the two values \p LV and \p RV in terms of their "complexity" where
532 /// "complexity" is a partial (and somewhat ad-hoc) relation used to order
533 /// operands in SCEV expressions.  \p EqCache is a set of pairs of values that
534 /// have been previously deemed to be "equally complex" by this routine.  It is
535 /// intended to avoid exponential time complexity in cases like:
536 ///
537 ///   %a = f(%x, %y)
538 ///   %b = f(%a, %a)
539 ///   %c = f(%b, %b)
540 ///
541 ///   %d = f(%x, %y)
542 ///   %e = f(%d, %d)
543 ///   %f = f(%e, %e)
544 ///
545 ///   CompareValueComplexity(%f, %c)
546 ///
547 /// Since we do not continue running this routine on expression trees once we
548 /// have seen unequal values, there is no need to track them in the cache.
549 static int
550 CompareValueComplexity(EquivalenceClasses<const Value *> &EqCacheValue,
551                        const LoopInfo *const LI, Value *LV, Value *RV,
552                        unsigned Depth) {
553   if (Depth > MaxValueCompareDepth || EqCacheValue.isEquivalent(LV, RV))
554     return 0;
555 
556   // Order pointer values after integer values. This helps SCEVExpander form
557   // GEPs.
558   bool LIsPointer = LV->getType()->isPointerTy(),
559        RIsPointer = RV->getType()->isPointerTy();
560   if (LIsPointer != RIsPointer)
561     return (int)LIsPointer - (int)RIsPointer;
562 
563   // Compare getValueID values.
564   unsigned LID = LV->getValueID(), RID = RV->getValueID();
565   if (LID != RID)
566     return (int)LID - (int)RID;
567 
568   // Sort arguments by their position.
569   if (const auto *LA = dyn_cast<Argument>(LV)) {
570     const auto *RA = cast<Argument>(RV);
571     unsigned LArgNo = LA->getArgNo(), RArgNo = RA->getArgNo();
572     return (int)LArgNo - (int)RArgNo;
573   }
574 
575   if (const auto *LGV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(LV)) {
576     const auto *RGV = cast<GlobalValue>(RV);
577 
578     const auto IsGVNameSemantic = [&](const GlobalValue *GV) {
579       auto LT = GV->getLinkage();
580       return !(GlobalValue::isPrivateLinkage(LT) ||
581                GlobalValue::isInternalLinkage(LT));
582     };
583 
584     // Use the names to distinguish the two values, but only if the
585     // names are semantically important.
586     if (IsGVNameSemantic(LGV) && IsGVNameSemantic(RGV))
587       return LGV->getName().compare(RGV->getName());
588   }
589 
590   // For instructions, compare their loop depth, and their operand count.  This
591   // is pretty loose.
592   if (const auto *LInst = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LV)) {
593     const auto *RInst = cast<Instruction>(RV);
594 
595     // Compare loop depths.
596     const BasicBlock *LParent = LInst->getParent(),
597                      *RParent = RInst->getParent();
598     if (LParent != RParent) {
599       unsigned LDepth = LI->getLoopDepth(LParent),
600                RDepth = LI->getLoopDepth(RParent);
601       if (LDepth != RDepth)
602         return (int)LDepth - (int)RDepth;
603     }
604 
605     // Compare the number of operands.
606     unsigned LNumOps = LInst->getNumOperands(),
607              RNumOps = RInst->getNumOperands();
608     if (LNumOps != RNumOps)
609       return (int)LNumOps - (int)RNumOps;
610 
611     for (unsigned Idx : seq(0u, LNumOps)) {
612       int Result =
613           CompareValueComplexity(EqCacheValue, LI, LInst->getOperand(Idx),
614                                  RInst->getOperand(Idx), Depth + 1);
615       if (Result != 0)
616         return Result;
617     }
618   }
619 
620   EqCacheValue.unionSets(LV, RV);
621   return 0;
622 }
623 
624 // Return negative, zero, or positive, if LHS is less than, equal to, or greater
625 // than RHS, respectively. A three-way result allows recursive comparisons to be
626 // more efficient.
627 static int CompareSCEVComplexity(
628     EquivalenceClasses<const SCEV *> &EqCacheSCEV,
629     EquivalenceClasses<const Value *> &EqCacheValue,
630     const LoopInfo *const LI, const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS,
631     DominatorTree &DT, unsigned Depth = 0) {
632   // Fast-path: SCEVs are uniqued so we can do a quick equality check.
633   if (LHS == RHS)
634     return 0;
635 
636   // Primarily, sort the SCEVs by their getSCEVType().
637   unsigned LType = LHS->getSCEVType(), RType = RHS->getSCEVType();
638   if (LType != RType)
639     return (int)LType - (int)RType;
640 
641   if (Depth > MaxSCEVCompareDepth || EqCacheSCEV.isEquivalent(LHS, RHS))
642     return 0;
643   // Aside from the getSCEVType() ordering, the particular ordering
644   // isn't very important except that it's beneficial to be consistent,
645   // so that (a + b) and (b + a) don't end up as different expressions.
646   switch (static_cast<SCEVTypes>(LType)) {
647   case scUnknown: {
648     const SCEVUnknown *LU = cast<SCEVUnknown>(LHS);
649     const SCEVUnknown *RU = cast<SCEVUnknown>(RHS);
650 
651     int X = CompareValueComplexity(EqCacheValue, LI, LU->getValue(),
652                                    RU->getValue(), Depth + 1);
653     if (X == 0)
654       EqCacheSCEV.unionSets(LHS, RHS);
655     return X;
656   }
657 
658   case scConstant: {
659     const SCEVConstant *LC = cast<SCEVConstant>(LHS);
660     const SCEVConstant *RC = cast<SCEVConstant>(RHS);
661 
662     // Compare constant values.
663     const APInt &LA = LC->getAPInt();
664     const APInt &RA = RC->getAPInt();
665     unsigned LBitWidth = LA.getBitWidth(), RBitWidth = RA.getBitWidth();
666     if (LBitWidth != RBitWidth)
667       return (int)LBitWidth - (int)RBitWidth;
668     return LA.ult(RA) ? -1 : 1;
669   }
670 
671   case scAddRecExpr: {
672     const SCEVAddRecExpr *LA = cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(LHS);
673     const SCEVAddRecExpr *RA = cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(RHS);
674 
675     // There is always a dominance between two recs that are used by one SCEV,
676     // so we can safely sort recs by loop header dominance. We require such
677     // order in getAddExpr.
678     const Loop *LLoop = LA->getLoop(), *RLoop = RA->getLoop();
679     if (LLoop != RLoop) {
680       const BasicBlock *LHead = LLoop->getHeader(), *RHead = RLoop->getHeader();
681       assert(LHead != RHead && "Two loops share the same header?");
682       if (DT.dominates(LHead, RHead))
683         return 1;
684       else
685         assert(DT.dominates(RHead, LHead) &&
686                "No dominance between recurrences used by one SCEV?");
687       return -1;
688     }
689 
690     // Addrec complexity grows with operand count.
691     unsigned LNumOps = LA->getNumOperands(), RNumOps = RA->getNumOperands();
692     if (LNumOps != RNumOps)
693       return (int)LNumOps - (int)RNumOps;
694 
695     // Lexicographically compare.
696     for (unsigned i = 0; i != LNumOps; ++i) {
697       int X = CompareSCEVComplexity(EqCacheSCEV, EqCacheValue, LI,
698                                     LA->getOperand(i), RA->getOperand(i), DT,
699                                     Depth + 1);
700       if (X != 0)
701         return X;
702     }
703     EqCacheSCEV.unionSets(LHS, RHS);
704     return 0;
705   }
706 
707   case scAddExpr:
708   case scMulExpr:
709   case scSMaxExpr:
710   case scUMaxExpr: {
711     const SCEVNAryExpr *LC = cast<SCEVNAryExpr>(LHS);
712     const SCEVNAryExpr *RC = cast<SCEVNAryExpr>(RHS);
713 
714     // Lexicographically compare n-ary expressions.
715     unsigned LNumOps = LC->getNumOperands(), RNumOps = RC->getNumOperands();
716     if (LNumOps != RNumOps)
717       return (int)LNumOps - (int)RNumOps;
718 
719     for (unsigned i = 0; i != LNumOps; ++i) {
720       int X = CompareSCEVComplexity(EqCacheSCEV, EqCacheValue, LI,
721                                     LC->getOperand(i), RC->getOperand(i), DT,
722                                     Depth + 1);
723       if (X != 0)
724         return X;
725     }
726     EqCacheSCEV.unionSets(LHS, RHS);
727     return 0;
728   }
729 
730   case scUDivExpr: {
731     const SCEVUDivExpr *LC = cast<SCEVUDivExpr>(LHS);
732     const SCEVUDivExpr *RC = cast<SCEVUDivExpr>(RHS);
733 
734     // Lexicographically compare udiv expressions.
735     int X = CompareSCEVComplexity(EqCacheSCEV, EqCacheValue, LI, LC->getLHS(),
736                                   RC->getLHS(), DT, Depth + 1);
737     if (X != 0)
738       return X;
739     X = CompareSCEVComplexity(EqCacheSCEV, EqCacheValue, LI, LC->getRHS(),
740                               RC->getRHS(), DT, Depth + 1);
741     if (X == 0)
742       EqCacheSCEV.unionSets(LHS, RHS);
743     return X;
744   }
745 
746   case scTruncate:
747   case scZeroExtend:
748   case scSignExtend: {
749     const SCEVCastExpr *LC = cast<SCEVCastExpr>(LHS);
750     const SCEVCastExpr *RC = cast<SCEVCastExpr>(RHS);
751 
752     // Compare cast expressions by operand.
753     int X = CompareSCEVComplexity(EqCacheSCEV, EqCacheValue, LI,
754                                   LC->getOperand(), RC->getOperand(), DT,
755                                   Depth + 1);
756     if (X == 0)
757       EqCacheSCEV.unionSets(LHS, RHS);
758     return X;
759   }
760 
761   case scCouldNotCompute:
762     llvm_unreachable("Attempt to use a SCEVCouldNotCompute object!");
763   }
764   llvm_unreachable("Unknown SCEV kind!");
765 }
766 
767 /// Given a list of SCEV objects, order them by their complexity, and group
768 /// objects of the same complexity together by value.  When this routine is
769 /// finished, we know that any duplicates in the vector are consecutive and that
770 /// complexity is monotonically increasing.
771 ///
772 /// Note that we go take special precautions to ensure that we get deterministic
773 /// results from this routine.  In other words, we don't want the results of
774 /// this to depend on where the addresses of various SCEV objects happened to
775 /// land in memory.
776 static void GroupByComplexity(SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Ops,
777                               LoopInfo *LI, DominatorTree &DT) {
778   if (Ops.size() < 2) return;  // Noop
779 
780   EquivalenceClasses<const SCEV *> EqCacheSCEV;
781   EquivalenceClasses<const Value *> EqCacheValue;
782   if (Ops.size() == 2) {
783     // This is the common case, which also happens to be trivially simple.
784     // Special case it.
785     const SCEV *&LHS = Ops[0], *&RHS = Ops[1];
786     if (CompareSCEVComplexity(EqCacheSCEV, EqCacheValue, LI, RHS, LHS, DT) < 0)
787       std::swap(LHS, RHS);
788     return;
789   }
790 
791   // Do the rough sort by complexity.
792   std::stable_sort(Ops.begin(), Ops.end(),
793                    [&](const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS) {
794                      return CompareSCEVComplexity(EqCacheSCEV, EqCacheValue, LI,
795                                                   LHS, RHS, DT) < 0;
796                    });
797 
798   // Now that we are sorted by complexity, group elements of the same
799   // complexity.  Note that this is, at worst, N^2, but the vector is likely to
800   // be extremely short in practice.  Note that we take this approach because we
801   // do not want to depend on the addresses of the objects we are grouping.
802   for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ops.size(); i != e-2; ++i) {
803     const SCEV *S = Ops[i];
804     unsigned Complexity = S->getSCEVType();
805 
806     // If there are any objects of the same complexity and same value as this
807     // one, group them.
808     for (unsigned j = i+1; j != e && Ops[j]->getSCEVType() == Complexity; ++j) {
809       if (Ops[j] == S) { // Found a duplicate.
810         // Move it to immediately after i'th element.
811         std::swap(Ops[i+1], Ops[j]);
812         ++i;   // no need to rescan it.
813         if (i == e-2) return;  // Done!
814       }
815     }
816   }
817 }
818 
819 // Returns the size of the SCEV S.
820 static inline int sizeOfSCEV(const SCEV *S) {
821   struct FindSCEVSize {
822     int Size = 0;
823 
824     FindSCEVSize() = default;
825 
826     bool follow(const SCEV *S) {
827       ++Size;
828       // Keep looking at all operands of S.
829       return true;
830     }
831 
832     bool isDone() const {
833       return false;
834     }
835   };
836 
837   FindSCEVSize F;
838   SCEVTraversal<FindSCEVSize> ST(F);
839   ST.visitAll(S);
840   return F.Size;
841 }
842 
843 namespace {
844 
845 struct SCEVDivision : public SCEVVisitor<SCEVDivision, void> {
846 public:
847   // Computes the Quotient and Remainder of the division of Numerator by
848   // Denominator.
849   static void divide(ScalarEvolution &SE, const SCEV *Numerator,
850                      const SCEV *Denominator, const SCEV **Quotient,
851                      const SCEV **Remainder) {
852     assert(Numerator && Denominator && "Uninitialized SCEV");
853 
854     SCEVDivision D(SE, Numerator, Denominator);
855 
856     // Check for the trivial case here to avoid having to check for it in the
857     // rest of the code.
858     if (Numerator == Denominator) {
859       *Quotient = D.One;
860       *Remainder = D.Zero;
861       return;
862     }
863 
864     if (Numerator->isZero()) {
865       *Quotient = D.Zero;
866       *Remainder = D.Zero;
867       return;
868     }
869 
870     // A simple case when N/1. The quotient is N.
871     if (Denominator->isOne()) {
872       *Quotient = Numerator;
873       *Remainder = D.Zero;
874       return;
875     }
876 
877     // Split the Denominator when it is a product.
878     if (const SCEVMulExpr *T = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(Denominator)) {
879       const SCEV *Q, *R;
880       *Quotient = Numerator;
881       for (const SCEV *Op : T->operands()) {
882         divide(SE, *Quotient, Op, &Q, &R);
883         *Quotient = Q;
884 
885         // Bail out when the Numerator is not divisible by one of the terms of
886         // the Denominator.
887         if (!R->isZero()) {
888           *Quotient = D.Zero;
889           *Remainder = Numerator;
890           return;
891         }
892       }
893       *Remainder = D.Zero;
894       return;
895     }
896 
897     D.visit(Numerator);
898     *Quotient = D.Quotient;
899     *Remainder = D.Remainder;
900   }
901 
902   // Except in the trivial case described above, we do not know how to divide
903   // Expr by Denominator for the following functions with empty implementation.
904   void visitTruncateExpr(const SCEVTruncateExpr *Numerator) {}
905   void visitZeroExtendExpr(const SCEVZeroExtendExpr *Numerator) {}
906   void visitSignExtendExpr(const SCEVSignExtendExpr *Numerator) {}
907   void visitUDivExpr(const SCEVUDivExpr *Numerator) {}
908   void visitSMaxExpr(const SCEVSMaxExpr *Numerator) {}
909   void visitUMaxExpr(const SCEVUMaxExpr *Numerator) {}
910   void visitUnknown(const SCEVUnknown *Numerator) {}
911   void visitCouldNotCompute(const SCEVCouldNotCompute *Numerator) {}
912 
913   void visitConstant(const SCEVConstant *Numerator) {
914     if (const SCEVConstant *D = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Denominator)) {
915       APInt NumeratorVal = Numerator->getAPInt();
916       APInt DenominatorVal = D->getAPInt();
917       uint32_t NumeratorBW = NumeratorVal.getBitWidth();
918       uint32_t DenominatorBW = DenominatorVal.getBitWidth();
919 
920       if (NumeratorBW > DenominatorBW)
921         DenominatorVal = DenominatorVal.sext(NumeratorBW);
922       else if (NumeratorBW < DenominatorBW)
923         NumeratorVal = NumeratorVal.sext(DenominatorBW);
924 
925       APInt QuotientVal(NumeratorVal.getBitWidth(), 0);
926       APInt RemainderVal(NumeratorVal.getBitWidth(), 0);
927       APInt::sdivrem(NumeratorVal, DenominatorVal, QuotientVal, RemainderVal);
928       Quotient = SE.getConstant(QuotientVal);
929       Remainder = SE.getConstant(RemainderVal);
930       return;
931     }
932   }
933 
934   void visitAddRecExpr(const SCEVAddRecExpr *Numerator) {
935     const SCEV *StartQ, *StartR, *StepQ, *StepR;
936     if (!Numerator->isAffine())
937       return cannotDivide(Numerator);
938     divide(SE, Numerator->getStart(), Denominator, &StartQ, &StartR);
939     divide(SE, Numerator->getStepRecurrence(SE), Denominator, &StepQ, &StepR);
940     // Bail out if the types do not match.
941     Type *Ty = Denominator->getType();
942     if (Ty != StartQ->getType() || Ty != StartR->getType() ||
943         Ty != StepQ->getType() || Ty != StepR->getType())
944       return cannotDivide(Numerator);
945     Quotient = SE.getAddRecExpr(StartQ, StepQ, Numerator->getLoop(),
946                                 Numerator->getNoWrapFlags());
947     Remainder = SE.getAddRecExpr(StartR, StepR, Numerator->getLoop(),
948                                  Numerator->getNoWrapFlags());
949   }
950 
951   void visitAddExpr(const SCEVAddExpr *Numerator) {
952     SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> Qs, Rs;
953     Type *Ty = Denominator->getType();
954 
955     for (const SCEV *Op : Numerator->operands()) {
956       const SCEV *Q, *R;
957       divide(SE, Op, Denominator, &Q, &R);
958 
959       // Bail out if types do not match.
960       if (Ty != Q->getType() || Ty != R->getType())
961         return cannotDivide(Numerator);
962 
963       Qs.push_back(Q);
964       Rs.push_back(R);
965     }
966 
967     if (Qs.size() == 1) {
968       Quotient = Qs[0];
969       Remainder = Rs[0];
970       return;
971     }
972 
973     Quotient = SE.getAddExpr(Qs);
974     Remainder = SE.getAddExpr(Rs);
975   }
976 
977   void visitMulExpr(const SCEVMulExpr *Numerator) {
978     SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> Qs;
979     Type *Ty = Denominator->getType();
980 
981     bool FoundDenominatorTerm = false;
982     for (const SCEV *Op : Numerator->operands()) {
983       // Bail out if types do not match.
984       if (Ty != Op->getType())
985         return cannotDivide(Numerator);
986 
987       if (FoundDenominatorTerm) {
988         Qs.push_back(Op);
989         continue;
990       }
991 
992       // Check whether Denominator divides one of the product operands.
993       const SCEV *Q, *R;
994       divide(SE, Op, Denominator, &Q, &R);
995       if (!R->isZero()) {
996         Qs.push_back(Op);
997         continue;
998       }
999 
1000       // Bail out if types do not match.
1001       if (Ty != Q->getType())
1002         return cannotDivide(Numerator);
1003 
1004       FoundDenominatorTerm = true;
1005       Qs.push_back(Q);
1006     }
1007 
1008     if (FoundDenominatorTerm) {
1009       Remainder = Zero;
1010       if (Qs.size() == 1)
1011         Quotient = Qs[0];
1012       else
1013         Quotient = SE.getMulExpr(Qs);
1014       return;
1015     }
1016 
1017     if (!isa<SCEVUnknown>(Denominator))
1018       return cannotDivide(Numerator);
1019 
1020     // The Remainder is obtained by replacing Denominator by 0 in Numerator.
1021     ValueToValueMap RewriteMap;
1022     RewriteMap[cast<SCEVUnknown>(Denominator)->getValue()] =
1023         cast<SCEVConstant>(Zero)->getValue();
1024     Remainder = SCEVParameterRewriter::rewrite(Numerator, SE, RewriteMap, true);
1025 
1026     if (Remainder->isZero()) {
1027       // The Quotient is obtained by replacing Denominator by 1 in Numerator.
1028       RewriteMap[cast<SCEVUnknown>(Denominator)->getValue()] =
1029           cast<SCEVConstant>(One)->getValue();
1030       Quotient =
1031           SCEVParameterRewriter::rewrite(Numerator, SE, RewriteMap, true);
1032       return;
1033     }
1034 
1035     // Quotient is (Numerator - Remainder) divided by Denominator.
1036     const SCEV *Q, *R;
1037     const SCEV *Diff = SE.getMinusSCEV(Numerator, Remainder);
1038     // This SCEV does not seem to simplify: fail the division here.
1039     if (sizeOfSCEV(Diff) > sizeOfSCEV(Numerator))
1040       return cannotDivide(Numerator);
1041     divide(SE, Diff, Denominator, &Q, &R);
1042     if (R != Zero)
1043       return cannotDivide(Numerator);
1044     Quotient = Q;
1045   }
1046 
1047 private:
1048   SCEVDivision(ScalarEvolution &S, const SCEV *Numerator,
1049                const SCEV *Denominator)
1050       : SE(S), Denominator(Denominator) {
1051     Zero = SE.getZero(Denominator->getType());
1052     One = SE.getOne(Denominator->getType());
1053 
1054     // We generally do not know how to divide Expr by Denominator. We
1055     // initialize the division to a "cannot divide" state to simplify the rest
1056     // of the code.
1057     cannotDivide(Numerator);
1058   }
1059 
1060   // Convenience function for giving up on the division. We set the quotient to
1061   // be equal to zero and the remainder to be equal to the numerator.
1062   void cannotDivide(const SCEV *Numerator) {
1063     Quotient = Zero;
1064     Remainder = Numerator;
1065   }
1066 
1067   ScalarEvolution &SE;
1068   const SCEV *Denominator, *Quotient, *Remainder, *Zero, *One;
1069 };
1070 
1071 } // end anonymous namespace
1072 
1073 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1074 //                      Simple SCEV method implementations
1075 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1076 
1077 /// Compute BC(It, K).  The result has width W.  Assume, K > 0.
1078 static const SCEV *BinomialCoefficient(const SCEV *It, unsigned K,
1079                                        ScalarEvolution &SE,
1080                                        Type *ResultTy) {
1081   // Handle the simplest case efficiently.
1082   if (K == 1)
1083     return SE.getTruncateOrZeroExtend(It, ResultTy);
1084 
1085   // We are using the following formula for BC(It, K):
1086   //
1087   //   BC(It, K) = (It * (It - 1) * ... * (It - K + 1)) / K!
1088   //
1089   // Suppose, W is the bitwidth of the return value.  We must be prepared for
1090   // overflow.  Hence, we must assure that the result of our computation is
1091   // equal to the accurate one modulo 2^W.  Unfortunately, division isn't
1092   // safe in modular arithmetic.
1093   //
1094   // However, this code doesn't use exactly that formula; the formula it uses
1095   // is something like the following, where T is the number of factors of 2 in
1096   // K! (i.e. trailing zeros in the binary representation of K!), and ^ is
1097   // exponentiation:
1098   //
1099   //   BC(It, K) = (It * (It - 1) * ... * (It - K + 1)) / 2^T / (K! / 2^T)
1100   //
1101   // This formula is trivially equivalent to the previous formula.  However,
1102   // this formula can be implemented much more efficiently.  The trick is that
1103   // K! / 2^T is odd, and exact division by an odd number *is* safe in modular
1104   // arithmetic.  To do exact division in modular arithmetic, all we have
1105   // to do is multiply by the inverse.  Therefore, this step can be done at
1106   // width W.
1107   //
1108   // The next issue is how to safely do the division by 2^T.  The way this
1109   // is done is by doing the multiplication step at a width of at least W + T
1110   // bits.  This way, the bottom W+T bits of the product are accurate. Then,
1111   // when we perform the division by 2^T (which is equivalent to a right shift
1112   // by T), the bottom W bits are accurate.  Extra bits are okay; they'll get
1113   // truncated out after the division by 2^T.
1114   //
1115   // In comparison to just directly using the first formula, this technique
1116   // is much more efficient; using the first formula requires W * K bits,
1117   // but this formula less than W + K bits. Also, the first formula requires
1118   // a division step, whereas this formula only requires multiplies and shifts.
1119   //
1120   // It doesn't matter whether the subtraction step is done in the calculation
1121   // width or the input iteration count's width; if the subtraction overflows,
1122   // the result must be zero anyway.  We prefer here to do it in the width of
1123   // the induction variable because it helps a lot for certain cases; CodeGen
1124   // isn't smart enough to ignore the overflow, which leads to much less
1125   // efficient code if the width of the subtraction is wider than the native
1126   // register width.
1127   //
1128   // (It's possible to not widen at all by pulling out factors of 2 before
1129   // the multiplication; for example, K=2 can be calculated as
1130   // It/2*(It+(It*INT_MIN/INT_MIN)+-1). However, it requires
1131   // extra arithmetic, so it's not an obvious win, and it gets
1132   // much more complicated for K > 3.)
1133 
1134   // Protection from insane SCEVs; this bound is conservative,
1135   // but it probably doesn't matter.
1136   if (K > 1000)
1137     return SE.getCouldNotCompute();
1138 
1139   unsigned W = SE.getTypeSizeInBits(ResultTy);
1140 
1141   // Calculate K! / 2^T and T; we divide out the factors of two before
1142   // multiplying for calculating K! / 2^T to avoid overflow.
1143   // Other overflow doesn't matter because we only care about the bottom
1144   // W bits of the result.
1145   APInt OddFactorial(W, 1);
1146   unsigned T = 1;
1147   for (unsigned i = 3; i <= K; ++i) {
1148     APInt Mult(W, i);
1149     unsigned TwoFactors = Mult.countTrailingZeros();
1150     T += TwoFactors;
1151     Mult.lshrInPlace(TwoFactors);
1152     OddFactorial *= Mult;
1153   }
1154 
1155   // We need at least W + T bits for the multiplication step
1156   unsigned CalculationBits = W + T;
1157 
1158   // Calculate 2^T, at width T+W.
1159   APInt DivFactor = APInt::getOneBitSet(CalculationBits, T);
1160 
1161   // Calculate the multiplicative inverse of K! / 2^T;
1162   // this multiplication factor will perform the exact division by
1163   // K! / 2^T.
1164   APInt Mod = APInt::getSignedMinValue(W+1);
1165   APInt MultiplyFactor = OddFactorial.zext(W+1);
1166   MultiplyFactor = MultiplyFactor.multiplicativeInverse(Mod);
1167   MultiplyFactor = MultiplyFactor.trunc(W);
1168 
1169   // Calculate the product, at width T+W
1170   IntegerType *CalculationTy = IntegerType::get(SE.getContext(),
1171                                                       CalculationBits);
1172   const SCEV *Dividend = SE.getTruncateOrZeroExtend(It, CalculationTy);
1173   for (unsigned i = 1; i != K; ++i) {
1174     const SCEV *S = SE.getMinusSCEV(It, SE.getConstant(It->getType(), i));
1175     Dividend = SE.getMulExpr(Dividend,
1176                              SE.getTruncateOrZeroExtend(S, CalculationTy));
1177   }
1178 
1179   // Divide by 2^T
1180   const SCEV *DivResult = SE.getUDivExpr(Dividend, SE.getConstant(DivFactor));
1181 
1182   // Truncate the result, and divide by K! / 2^T.
1183 
1184   return SE.getMulExpr(SE.getConstant(MultiplyFactor),
1185                        SE.getTruncateOrZeroExtend(DivResult, ResultTy));
1186 }
1187 
1188 /// Return the value of this chain of recurrences at the specified iteration
1189 /// number.  We can evaluate this recurrence by multiplying each element in the
1190 /// chain by the binomial coefficient corresponding to it.  In other words, we
1191 /// can evaluate {A,+,B,+,C,+,D} as:
1192 ///
1193 ///   A*BC(It, 0) + B*BC(It, 1) + C*BC(It, 2) + D*BC(It, 3)
1194 ///
1195 /// where BC(It, k) stands for binomial coefficient.
1196 const SCEV *SCEVAddRecExpr::evaluateAtIteration(const SCEV *It,
1197                                                 ScalarEvolution &SE) const {
1198   const SCEV *Result = getStart();
1199   for (unsigned i = 1, e = getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i) {
1200     // The computation is correct in the face of overflow provided that the
1201     // multiplication is performed _after_ the evaluation of the binomial
1202     // coefficient.
1203     const SCEV *Coeff = BinomialCoefficient(It, i, SE, getType());
1204     if (isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(Coeff))
1205       return Coeff;
1206 
1207     Result = SE.getAddExpr(Result, SE.getMulExpr(getOperand(i), Coeff));
1208   }
1209   return Result;
1210 }
1211 
1212 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1213 //                    SCEV Expression folder implementations
1214 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1215 
1216 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getTruncateExpr(const SCEV *Op,
1217                                              Type *Ty) {
1218   assert(getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) > getTypeSizeInBits(Ty) &&
1219          "This is not a truncating conversion!");
1220   assert(isSCEVable(Ty) &&
1221          "This is not a conversion to a SCEVable type!");
1222   Ty = getEffectiveSCEVType(Ty);
1223 
1224   FoldingSetNodeID ID;
1225   ID.AddInteger(scTruncate);
1226   ID.AddPointer(Op);
1227   ID.AddPointer(Ty);
1228   void *IP = nullptr;
1229   if (const SCEV *S = UniqueSCEVs.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP)) return S;
1230 
1231   // Fold if the operand is constant.
1232   if (const SCEVConstant *SC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Op))
1233     return getConstant(
1234       cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getTrunc(SC->getValue(), Ty)));
1235 
1236   // trunc(trunc(x)) --> trunc(x)
1237   if (const SCEVTruncateExpr *ST = dyn_cast<SCEVTruncateExpr>(Op))
1238     return getTruncateExpr(ST->getOperand(), Ty);
1239 
1240   // trunc(sext(x)) --> sext(x) if widening or trunc(x) if narrowing
1241   if (const SCEVSignExtendExpr *SS = dyn_cast<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(Op))
1242     return getTruncateOrSignExtend(SS->getOperand(), Ty);
1243 
1244   // trunc(zext(x)) --> zext(x) if widening or trunc(x) if narrowing
1245   if (const SCEVZeroExtendExpr *SZ = dyn_cast<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(Op))
1246     return getTruncateOrZeroExtend(SZ->getOperand(), Ty);
1247 
1248   // trunc(x1 + ... + xN) --> trunc(x1) + ... + trunc(xN) and
1249   // trunc(x1 * ... * xN) --> trunc(x1) * ... * trunc(xN),
1250   // if after transforming we have at most one truncate, not counting truncates
1251   // that replace other casts.
1252   if (isa<SCEVAddExpr>(Op) || isa<SCEVMulExpr>(Op)) {
1253     auto *CommOp = cast<SCEVCommutativeExpr>(Op);
1254     SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> Operands;
1255     unsigned numTruncs = 0;
1256     for (unsigned i = 0, e = CommOp->getNumOperands(); i != e && numTruncs < 2;
1257          ++i) {
1258       const SCEV *S = getTruncateExpr(CommOp->getOperand(i), Ty);
1259       if (!isa<SCEVCastExpr>(CommOp->getOperand(i)) && isa<SCEVTruncateExpr>(S))
1260         numTruncs++;
1261       Operands.push_back(S);
1262     }
1263     if (numTruncs < 2) {
1264       if (isa<SCEVAddExpr>(Op))
1265         return getAddExpr(Operands);
1266       else if (isa<SCEVMulExpr>(Op))
1267         return getMulExpr(Operands);
1268       else
1269         llvm_unreachable("Unexpected SCEV type for Op.");
1270     }
1271     // Although we checked in the beginning that ID is not in the cache, it is
1272     // possible that during recursion and different modification ID was inserted
1273     // into the cache. So if we find it, just return it.
1274     if (const SCEV *S = UniqueSCEVs.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP))
1275       return S;
1276   }
1277 
1278   // If the input value is a chrec scev, truncate the chrec's operands.
1279   if (const SCEVAddRecExpr *AddRec = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Op)) {
1280     SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> Operands;
1281     for (const SCEV *Op : AddRec->operands())
1282       Operands.push_back(getTruncateExpr(Op, Ty));
1283     return getAddRecExpr(Operands, AddRec->getLoop(), SCEV::FlagAnyWrap);
1284   }
1285 
1286   // The cast wasn't folded; create an explicit cast node. We can reuse
1287   // the existing insert position since if we get here, we won't have
1288   // made any changes which would invalidate it.
1289   SCEV *S = new (SCEVAllocator) SCEVTruncateExpr(ID.Intern(SCEVAllocator),
1290                                                  Op, Ty);
1291   UniqueSCEVs.InsertNode(S, IP);
1292   addToLoopUseLists(S);
1293   return S;
1294 }
1295 
1296 // Get the limit of a recurrence such that incrementing by Step cannot cause
1297 // signed overflow as long as the value of the recurrence within the
1298 // loop does not exceed this limit before incrementing.
1299 static const SCEV *getSignedOverflowLimitForStep(const SCEV *Step,
1300                                                  ICmpInst::Predicate *Pred,
1301                                                  ScalarEvolution *SE) {
1302   unsigned BitWidth = SE->getTypeSizeInBits(Step->getType());
1303   if (SE->isKnownPositive(Step)) {
1304     *Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
1305     return SE->getConstant(APInt::getSignedMinValue(BitWidth) -
1306                            SE->getSignedRangeMax(Step));
1307   }
1308   if (SE->isKnownNegative(Step)) {
1309     *Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
1310     return SE->getConstant(APInt::getSignedMaxValue(BitWidth) -
1311                            SE->getSignedRangeMin(Step));
1312   }
1313   return nullptr;
1314 }
1315 
1316 // Get the limit of a recurrence such that incrementing by Step cannot cause
1317 // unsigned overflow as long as the value of the recurrence within the loop does
1318 // not exceed this limit before incrementing.
1319 static const SCEV *getUnsignedOverflowLimitForStep(const SCEV *Step,
1320                                                    ICmpInst::Predicate *Pred,
1321                                                    ScalarEvolution *SE) {
1322   unsigned BitWidth = SE->getTypeSizeInBits(Step->getType());
1323   *Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
1324 
1325   return SE->getConstant(APInt::getMinValue(BitWidth) -
1326                          SE->getUnsignedRangeMax(Step));
1327 }
1328 
1329 namespace {
1330 
1331 struct ExtendOpTraitsBase {
1332   typedef const SCEV *(ScalarEvolution::*GetExtendExprTy)(const SCEV *, Type *,
1333                                                           unsigned);
1334 };
1335 
1336 // Used to make code generic over signed and unsigned overflow.
1337 template <typename ExtendOp> struct ExtendOpTraits {
1338   // Members present:
1339   //
1340   // static const SCEV::NoWrapFlags WrapType;
1341   //
1342   // static const ExtendOpTraitsBase::GetExtendExprTy GetExtendExpr;
1343   //
1344   // static const SCEV *getOverflowLimitForStep(const SCEV *Step,
1345   //                                           ICmpInst::Predicate *Pred,
1346   //                                           ScalarEvolution *SE);
1347 };
1348 
1349 template <>
1350 struct ExtendOpTraits<SCEVSignExtendExpr> : public ExtendOpTraitsBase {
1351   static const SCEV::NoWrapFlags WrapType = SCEV::FlagNSW;
1352 
1353   static const GetExtendExprTy GetExtendExpr;
1354 
1355   static const SCEV *getOverflowLimitForStep(const SCEV *Step,
1356                                              ICmpInst::Predicate *Pred,
1357                                              ScalarEvolution *SE) {
1358     return getSignedOverflowLimitForStep(Step, Pred, SE);
1359   }
1360 };
1361 
1362 const ExtendOpTraitsBase::GetExtendExprTy ExtendOpTraits<
1363     SCEVSignExtendExpr>::GetExtendExpr = &ScalarEvolution::getSignExtendExpr;
1364 
1365 template <>
1366 struct ExtendOpTraits<SCEVZeroExtendExpr> : public ExtendOpTraitsBase {
1367   static const SCEV::NoWrapFlags WrapType = SCEV::FlagNUW;
1368 
1369   static const GetExtendExprTy GetExtendExpr;
1370 
1371   static const SCEV *getOverflowLimitForStep(const SCEV *Step,
1372                                              ICmpInst::Predicate *Pred,
1373                                              ScalarEvolution *SE) {
1374     return getUnsignedOverflowLimitForStep(Step, Pred, SE);
1375   }
1376 };
1377 
1378 const ExtendOpTraitsBase::GetExtendExprTy ExtendOpTraits<
1379     SCEVZeroExtendExpr>::GetExtendExpr = &ScalarEvolution::getZeroExtendExpr;
1380 
1381 } // end anonymous namespace
1382 
1383 // The recurrence AR has been shown to have no signed/unsigned wrap or something
1384 // close to it. Typically, if we can prove NSW/NUW for AR, then we can just as
1385 // easily prove NSW/NUW for its preincrement or postincrement sibling. This
1386 // allows normalizing a sign/zero extended AddRec as such: {sext/zext(Step +
1387 // Start),+,Step} => {(Step + sext/zext(Start),+,Step} As a result, the
1388 // expression "Step + sext/zext(PreIncAR)" is congruent with
1389 // "sext/zext(PostIncAR)"
1390 template <typename ExtendOpTy>
1391 static const SCEV *getPreStartForExtend(const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR, Type *Ty,
1392                                         ScalarEvolution *SE, unsigned Depth) {
1393   auto WrapType = ExtendOpTraits<ExtendOpTy>::WrapType;
1394   auto GetExtendExpr = ExtendOpTraits<ExtendOpTy>::GetExtendExpr;
1395 
1396   const Loop *L = AR->getLoop();
1397   const SCEV *Start = AR->getStart();
1398   const SCEV *Step = AR->getStepRecurrence(*SE);
1399 
1400   // Check for a simple looking step prior to loop entry.
1401   const SCEVAddExpr *SA = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(Start);
1402   if (!SA)
1403     return nullptr;
1404 
1405   // Create an AddExpr for "PreStart" after subtracting Step. Full SCEV
1406   // subtraction is expensive. For this purpose, perform a quick and dirty
1407   // difference, by checking for Step in the operand list.
1408   SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> DiffOps;
1409   for (const SCEV *Op : SA->operands())
1410     if (Op != Step)
1411       DiffOps.push_back(Op);
1412 
1413   if (DiffOps.size() == SA->getNumOperands())
1414     return nullptr;
1415 
1416   // Try to prove `WrapType` (SCEV::FlagNSW or SCEV::FlagNUW) on `PreStart` +
1417   // `Step`:
1418 
1419   // 1. NSW/NUW flags on the step increment.
1420   auto PreStartFlags =
1421     ScalarEvolution::maskFlags(SA->getNoWrapFlags(), SCEV::FlagNUW);
1422   const SCEV *PreStart = SE->getAddExpr(DiffOps, PreStartFlags);
1423   const SCEVAddRecExpr *PreAR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(
1424       SE->getAddRecExpr(PreStart, Step, L, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap));
1425 
1426   // "{S,+,X} is <nsw>/<nuw>" and "the backedge is taken at least once" implies
1427   // "S+X does not sign/unsign-overflow".
1428   //
1429 
1430   const SCEV *BECount = SE->getBackedgeTakenCount(L);
1431   if (PreAR && PreAR->getNoWrapFlags(WrapType) &&
1432       !isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(BECount) && SE->isKnownPositive(BECount))
1433     return PreStart;
1434 
1435   // 2. Direct overflow check on the step operation's expression.
1436   unsigned BitWidth = SE->getTypeSizeInBits(AR->getType());
1437   Type *WideTy = IntegerType::get(SE->getContext(), BitWidth * 2);
1438   const SCEV *OperandExtendedStart =
1439       SE->getAddExpr((SE->*GetExtendExpr)(PreStart, WideTy, Depth),
1440                      (SE->*GetExtendExpr)(Step, WideTy, Depth));
1441   if ((SE->*GetExtendExpr)(Start, WideTy, Depth) == OperandExtendedStart) {
1442     if (PreAR && AR->getNoWrapFlags(WrapType)) {
1443       // If we know `AR` == {`PreStart`+`Step`,+,`Step`} is `WrapType` (FlagNSW
1444       // or FlagNUW) and that `PreStart` + `Step` is `WrapType` too, then
1445       // `PreAR` == {`PreStart`,+,`Step`} is also `WrapType`.  Cache this fact.
1446       const_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr *>(PreAR)->setNoWrapFlags(WrapType);
1447     }
1448     return PreStart;
1449   }
1450 
1451   // 3. Loop precondition.
1452   ICmpInst::Predicate Pred;
1453   const SCEV *OverflowLimit =
1454       ExtendOpTraits<ExtendOpTy>::getOverflowLimitForStep(Step, &Pred, SE);
1455 
1456   if (OverflowLimit &&
1457       SE->isLoopEntryGuardedByCond(L, Pred, PreStart, OverflowLimit))
1458     return PreStart;
1459 
1460   return nullptr;
1461 }
1462 
1463 // Get the normalized zero or sign extended expression for this AddRec's Start.
1464 template <typename ExtendOpTy>
1465 static const SCEV *getExtendAddRecStart(const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR, Type *Ty,
1466                                         ScalarEvolution *SE,
1467                                         unsigned Depth) {
1468   auto GetExtendExpr = ExtendOpTraits<ExtendOpTy>::GetExtendExpr;
1469 
1470   const SCEV *PreStart = getPreStartForExtend<ExtendOpTy>(AR, Ty, SE, Depth);
1471   if (!PreStart)
1472     return (SE->*GetExtendExpr)(AR->getStart(), Ty, Depth);
1473 
1474   return SE->getAddExpr((SE->*GetExtendExpr)(AR->getStepRecurrence(*SE), Ty,
1475                                              Depth),
1476                         (SE->*GetExtendExpr)(PreStart, Ty, Depth));
1477 }
1478 
1479 // Try to prove away overflow by looking at "nearby" add recurrences.  A
1480 // motivating example for this rule: if we know `{0,+,4}` is `ult` `-1` and it
1481 // does not itself wrap then we can conclude that `{1,+,4}` is `nuw`.
1482 //
1483 // Formally:
1484 //
1485 //     {S,+,X} == {S-T,+,X} + T
1486 //  => Ext({S,+,X}) == Ext({S-T,+,X} + T)
1487 //
1488 // If ({S-T,+,X} + T) does not overflow  ... (1)
1489 //
1490 //  RHS == Ext({S-T,+,X} + T) == Ext({S-T,+,X}) + Ext(T)
1491 //
1492 // If {S-T,+,X} does not overflow  ... (2)
1493 //
1494 //  RHS == Ext({S-T,+,X}) + Ext(T) == {Ext(S-T),+,Ext(X)} + Ext(T)
1495 //      == {Ext(S-T)+Ext(T),+,Ext(X)}
1496 //
1497 // If (S-T)+T does not overflow  ... (3)
1498 //
1499 //  RHS == {Ext(S-T)+Ext(T),+,Ext(X)} == {Ext(S-T+T),+,Ext(X)}
1500 //      == {Ext(S),+,Ext(X)} == LHS
1501 //
1502 // Thus, if (1), (2) and (3) are true for some T, then
1503 //   Ext({S,+,X}) == {Ext(S),+,Ext(X)}
1504 //
1505 // (3) is implied by (1) -- "(S-T)+T does not overflow" is simply "({S-T,+,X}+T)
1506 // does not overflow" restricted to the 0th iteration.  Therefore we only need
1507 // to check for (1) and (2).
1508 //
1509 // In the current context, S is `Start`, X is `Step`, Ext is `ExtendOpTy` and T
1510 // is `Delta` (defined below).
1511 template <typename ExtendOpTy>
1512 bool ScalarEvolution::proveNoWrapByVaryingStart(const SCEV *Start,
1513                                                 const SCEV *Step,
1514                                                 const Loop *L) {
1515   auto WrapType = ExtendOpTraits<ExtendOpTy>::WrapType;
1516 
1517   // We restrict `Start` to a constant to prevent SCEV from spending too much
1518   // time here.  It is correct (but more expensive) to continue with a
1519   // non-constant `Start` and do a general SCEV subtraction to compute
1520   // `PreStart` below.
1521   const SCEVConstant *StartC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Start);
1522   if (!StartC)
1523     return false;
1524 
1525   APInt StartAI = StartC->getAPInt();
1526 
1527   for (unsigned Delta : {-2, -1, 1, 2}) {
1528     const SCEV *PreStart = getConstant(StartAI - Delta);
1529 
1530     FoldingSetNodeID ID;
1531     ID.AddInteger(scAddRecExpr);
1532     ID.AddPointer(PreStart);
1533     ID.AddPointer(Step);
1534     ID.AddPointer(L);
1535     void *IP = nullptr;
1536     const auto *PreAR =
1537       static_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr *>(UniqueSCEVs.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP));
1538 
1539     // Give up if we don't already have the add recurrence we need because
1540     // actually constructing an add recurrence is relatively expensive.
1541     if (PreAR && PreAR->getNoWrapFlags(WrapType)) {  // proves (2)
1542       const SCEV *DeltaS = getConstant(StartC->getType(), Delta);
1543       ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE;
1544       const SCEV *Limit = ExtendOpTraits<ExtendOpTy>::getOverflowLimitForStep(
1545           DeltaS, &Pred, this);
1546       if (Limit && isKnownPredicate(Pred, PreAR, Limit))  // proves (1)
1547         return true;
1548     }
1549   }
1550 
1551   return false;
1552 }
1553 
1554 // Finds an integer D for an expression (C + x + y + ...) such that the top
1555 // level addition in (D + (C - D + x + y + ...)) would not wrap (signed or
1556 // unsigned) and the number of trailing zeros of (C - D + x + y + ...) is
1557 // maximized, where C is the \p ConstantTerm, x, y, ... are arbitrary SCEVs, and
1558 // the (C + x + y + ...) expression is \p WholeAddExpr.
1559 static APInt extractConstantWithoutWrapping(ScalarEvolution &SE,
1560                                             const SCEVConstant *ConstantTerm,
1561                                             const SCEVAddExpr *WholeAddExpr) {
1562   const APInt C = ConstantTerm->getAPInt();
1563   const unsigned BitWidth = C.getBitWidth();
1564   // Find number of trailing zeros of (x + y + ...) w/o the C first:
1565   uint32_t TZ = BitWidth;
1566   for (unsigned I = 1, E = WholeAddExpr->getNumOperands(); I < E && TZ; ++I)
1567     TZ = std::min(TZ, SE.GetMinTrailingZeros(WholeAddExpr->getOperand(I)));
1568   if (TZ) {
1569     // Set D to be as many least significant bits of C as possible while still
1570     // guaranteeing that adding D to (C - D + x + y + ...) won't cause a wrap:
1571     return TZ < BitWidth ? C.trunc(TZ).zext(BitWidth) : C;
1572   }
1573   return APInt(BitWidth, 0);
1574 }
1575 
1576 // Finds an integer D for an affine AddRec expression {C,+,x} such that the top
1577 // level addition in (D + {C-D,+,x}) would not wrap (signed or unsigned) and the
1578 // number of trailing zeros of (C - D + x * n) is maximized, where C is the \p
1579 // ConstantStart, x is an arbitrary \p Step, and n is the loop trip count.
1580 static APInt extractConstantWithoutWrapping(ScalarEvolution &SE,
1581                                             const APInt &ConstantStart,
1582                                             const SCEV *Step) {
1583   const unsigned BitWidth = ConstantStart.getBitWidth();
1584   const uint32_t TZ = SE.GetMinTrailingZeros(Step);
1585   if (TZ)
1586     return TZ < BitWidth ? ConstantStart.trunc(TZ).zext(BitWidth)
1587                          : ConstantStart;
1588   return APInt(BitWidth, 0);
1589 }
1590 
1591 const SCEV *
1592 ScalarEvolution::getZeroExtendExpr(const SCEV *Op, Type *Ty, unsigned Depth) {
1593   assert(getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) < getTypeSizeInBits(Ty) &&
1594          "This is not an extending conversion!");
1595   assert(isSCEVable(Ty) &&
1596          "This is not a conversion to a SCEVable type!");
1597   Ty = getEffectiveSCEVType(Ty);
1598 
1599   // Fold if the operand is constant.
1600   if (const SCEVConstant *SC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Op))
1601     return getConstant(
1602       cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getZExt(SC->getValue(), Ty)));
1603 
1604   // zext(zext(x)) --> zext(x)
1605   if (const SCEVZeroExtendExpr *SZ = dyn_cast<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(Op))
1606     return getZeroExtendExpr(SZ->getOperand(), Ty, Depth + 1);
1607 
1608   // Before doing any expensive analysis, check to see if we've already
1609   // computed a SCEV for this Op and Ty.
1610   FoldingSetNodeID ID;
1611   ID.AddInteger(scZeroExtend);
1612   ID.AddPointer(Op);
1613   ID.AddPointer(Ty);
1614   void *IP = nullptr;
1615   if (const SCEV *S = UniqueSCEVs.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP)) return S;
1616   if (Depth > MaxExtDepth) {
1617     SCEV *S = new (SCEVAllocator) SCEVZeroExtendExpr(ID.Intern(SCEVAllocator),
1618                                                      Op, Ty);
1619     UniqueSCEVs.InsertNode(S, IP);
1620     addToLoopUseLists(S);
1621     return S;
1622   }
1623 
1624   // zext(trunc(x)) --> zext(x) or x or trunc(x)
1625   if (const SCEVTruncateExpr *ST = dyn_cast<SCEVTruncateExpr>(Op)) {
1626     // It's possible the bits taken off by the truncate were all zero bits. If
1627     // so, we should be able to simplify this further.
1628     const SCEV *X = ST->getOperand();
1629     ConstantRange CR = getUnsignedRange(X);
1630     unsigned TruncBits = getTypeSizeInBits(ST->getType());
1631     unsigned NewBits = getTypeSizeInBits(Ty);
1632     if (CR.truncate(TruncBits).zeroExtend(NewBits).contains(
1633             CR.zextOrTrunc(NewBits)))
1634       return getTruncateOrZeroExtend(X, Ty);
1635   }
1636 
1637   // If the input value is a chrec scev, and we can prove that the value
1638   // did not overflow the old, smaller, value, we can zero extend all of the
1639   // operands (often constants).  This allows analysis of something like
1640   // this:  for (unsigned char X = 0; X < 100; ++X) { int Y = X; }
1641   if (const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Op))
1642     if (AR->isAffine()) {
1643       const SCEV *Start = AR->getStart();
1644       const SCEV *Step = AR->getStepRecurrence(*this);
1645       unsigned BitWidth = getTypeSizeInBits(AR->getType());
1646       const Loop *L = AR->getLoop();
1647 
1648       if (!AR->hasNoUnsignedWrap()) {
1649         auto NewFlags = proveNoWrapViaConstantRanges(AR);
1650         const_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr *>(AR)->setNoWrapFlags(NewFlags);
1651       }
1652 
1653       // If we have special knowledge that this addrec won't overflow,
1654       // we don't need to do any further analysis.
1655       if (AR->hasNoUnsignedWrap())
1656         return getAddRecExpr(
1657             getExtendAddRecStart<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(AR, Ty, this, Depth + 1),
1658             getZeroExtendExpr(Step, Ty, Depth + 1), L, AR->getNoWrapFlags());
1659 
1660       // Check whether the backedge-taken count is SCEVCouldNotCompute.
1661       // Note that this serves two purposes: It filters out loops that are
1662       // simply not analyzable, and it covers the case where this code is
1663       // being called from within backedge-taken count analysis, such that
1664       // attempting to ask for the backedge-taken count would likely result
1665       // in infinite recursion. In the later case, the analysis code will
1666       // cope with a conservative value, and it will take care to purge
1667       // that value once it has finished.
1668       const SCEV *MaxBECount = getMaxBackedgeTakenCount(L);
1669       if (!isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(MaxBECount)) {
1670         // Manually compute the final value for AR, checking for
1671         // overflow.
1672 
1673         // Check whether the backedge-taken count can be losslessly casted to
1674         // the addrec's type. The count is always unsigned.
1675         const SCEV *CastedMaxBECount =
1676           getTruncateOrZeroExtend(MaxBECount, Start->getType());
1677         const SCEV *RecastedMaxBECount =
1678           getTruncateOrZeroExtend(CastedMaxBECount, MaxBECount->getType());
1679         if (MaxBECount == RecastedMaxBECount) {
1680           Type *WideTy = IntegerType::get(getContext(), BitWidth * 2);
1681           // Check whether Start+Step*MaxBECount has no unsigned overflow.
1682           const SCEV *ZMul = getMulExpr(CastedMaxBECount, Step,
1683                                         SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1);
1684           const SCEV *ZAdd = getZeroExtendExpr(getAddExpr(Start, ZMul,
1685                                                           SCEV::FlagAnyWrap,
1686                                                           Depth + 1),
1687                                                WideTy, Depth + 1);
1688           const SCEV *WideStart = getZeroExtendExpr(Start, WideTy, Depth + 1);
1689           const SCEV *WideMaxBECount =
1690             getZeroExtendExpr(CastedMaxBECount, WideTy, Depth + 1);
1691           const SCEV *OperandExtendedAdd =
1692             getAddExpr(WideStart,
1693                        getMulExpr(WideMaxBECount,
1694                                   getZeroExtendExpr(Step, WideTy, Depth + 1),
1695                                   SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1),
1696                        SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1);
1697           if (ZAdd == OperandExtendedAdd) {
1698             // Cache knowledge of AR NUW, which is propagated to this AddRec.
1699             const_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr *>(AR)->setNoWrapFlags(SCEV::FlagNUW);
1700             // Return the expression with the addrec on the outside.
1701             return getAddRecExpr(
1702                 getExtendAddRecStart<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(AR, Ty, this,
1703                                                          Depth + 1),
1704                 getZeroExtendExpr(Step, Ty, Depth + 1), L,
1705                 AR->getNoWrapFlags());
1706           }
1707           // Similar to above, only this time treat the step value as signed.
1708           // This covers loops that count down.
1709           OperandExtendedAdd =
1710             getAddExpr(WideStart,
1711                        getMulExpr(WideMaxBECount,
1712                                   getSignExtendExpr(Step, WideTy, Depth + 1),
1713                                   SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1),
1714                        SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1);
1715           if (ZAdd == OperandExtendedAdd) {
1716             // Cache knowledge of AR NW, which is propagated to this AddRec.
1717             // Negative step causes unsigned wrap, but it still can't self-wrap.
1718             const_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr *>(AR)->setNoWrapFlags(SCEV::FlagNW);
1719             // Return the expression with the addrec on the outside.
1720             return getAddRecExpr(
1721                 getExtendAddRecStart<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(AR, Ty, this,
1722                                                          Depth + 1),
1723                 getSignExtendExpr(Step, Ty, Depth + 1), L,
1724                 AR->getNoWrapFlags());
1725           }
1726         }
1727       }
1728 
1729       // Normally, in the cases we can prove no-overflow via a
1730       // backedge guarding condition, we can also compute a backedge
1731       // taken count for the loop.  The exceptions are assumptions and
1732       // guards present in the loop -- SCEV is not great at exploiting
1733       // these to compute max backedge taken counts, but can still use
1734       // these to prove lack of overflow.  Use this fact to avoid
1735       // doing extra work that may not pay off.
1736       if (!isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(MaxBECount) || HasGuards ||
1737           !AC.assumptions().empty()) {
1738         // If the backedge is guarded by a comparison with the pre-inc
1739         // value the addrec is safe. Also, if the entry is guarded by
1740         // a comparison with the start value and the backedge is
1741         // guarded by a comparison with the post-inc value, the addrec
1742         // is safe.
1743         if (isKnownPositive(Step)) {
1744           const SCEV *N = getConstant(APInt::getMinValue(BitWidth) -
1745                                       getUnsignedRangeMax(Step));
1746           if (isLoopBackedgeGuardedByCond(L, ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, AR, N) ||
1747               isKnownOnEveryIteration(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, AR, N)) {
1748             // Cache knowledge of AR NUW, which is propagated to this
1749             // AddRec.
1750             const_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr *>(AR)->setNoWrapFlags(SCEV::FlagNUW);
1751             // Return the expression with the addrec on the outside.
1752             return getAddRecExpr(
1753                 getExtendAddRecStart<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(AR, Ty, this,
1754                                                          Depth + 1),
1755                 getZeroExtendExpr(Step, Ty, Depth + 1), L,
1756                 AR->getNoWrapFlags());
1757           }
1758         } else if (isKnownNegative(Step)) {
1759           const SCEV *N = getConstant(APInt::getMaxValue(BitWidth) -
1760                                       getSignedRangeMin(Step));
1761           if (isLoopBackedgeGuardedByCond(L, ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, AR, N) ||
1762               isKnownOnEveryIteration(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, AR, N)) {
1763             // Cache knowledge of AR NW, which is propagated to this
1764             // AddRec.  Negative step causes unsigned wrap, but it
1765             // still can't self-wrap.
1766             const_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr *>(AR)->setNoWrapFlags(SCEV::FlagNW);
1767             // Return the expression with the addrec on the outside.
1768             return getAddRecExpr(
1769                 getExtendAddRecStart<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(AR, Ty, this,
1770                                                          Depth + 1),
1771                 getSignExtendExpr(Step, Ty, Depth + 1), L,
1772                 AR->getNoWrapFlags());
1773           }
1774         }
1775       }
1776 
1777       // zext({C,+,Step}) --> (zext(D) + zext({C-D,+,Step}))<nuw><nsw>
1778       // if D + (C - D + Step * n) could be proven to not unsigned wrap
1779       // where D maximizes the number of trailing zeros of (C - D + Step * n)
1780       if (const auto *SC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Start)) {
1781         const APInt &C = SC->getAPInt();
1782         const APInt &D = extractConstantWithoutWrapping(*this, C, Step);
1783         if (D != 0) {
1784           const SCEV *SZExtD = getZeroExtendExpr(getConstant(D), Ty, Depth);
1785           const SCEV *SResidual =
1786               getAddRecExpr(getConstant(C - D), Step, L, AR->getNoWrapFlags());
1787           const SCEV *SZExtR = getZeroExtendExpr(SResidual, Ty, Depth + 1);
1788           return getAddExpr(SZExtD, SZExtR,
1789                             (SCEV::NoWrapFlags)(SCEV::FlagNSW | SCEV::FlagNUW),
1790                             Depth + 1);
1791         }
1792       }
1793 
1794       if (proveNoWrapByVaryingStart<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(Start, Step, L)) {
1795         const_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr *>(AR)->setNoWrapFlags(SCEV::FlagNUW);
1796         return getAddRecExpr(
1797             getExtendAddRecStart<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(AR, Ty, this, Depth + 1),
1798             getZeroExtendExpr(Step, Ty, Depth + 1), L, AR->getNoWrapFlags());
1799       }
1800     }
1801 
1802   // zext(A % B) --> zext(A) % zext(B)
1803   {
1804     const SCEV *LHS;
1805     const SCEV *RHS;
1806     if (matchURem(Op, LHS, RHS))
1807       return getURemExpr(getZeroExtendExpr(LHS, Ty, Depth + 1),
1808                          getZeroExtendExpr(RHS, Ty, Depth + 1));
1809   }
1810 
1811   // zext(A / B) --> zext(A) / zext(B).
1812   if (auto *Div = dyn_cast<SCEVUDivExpr>(Op))
1813     return getUDivExpr(getZeroExtendExpr(Div->getLHS(), Ty, Depth + 1),
1814                        getZeroExtendExpr(Div->getRHS(), Ty, Depth + 1));
1815 
1816   if (auto *SA = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(Op)) {
1817     // zext((A + B + ...)<nuw>) --> (zext(A) + zext(B) + ...)<nuw>
1818     if (SA->hasNoUnsignedWrap()) {
1819       // If the addition does not unsign overflow then we can, by definition,
1820       // commute the zero extension with the addition operation.
1821       SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> Ops;
1822       for (const auto *Op : SA->operands())
1823         Ops.push_back(getZeroExtendExpr(Op, Ty, Depth + 1));
1824       return getAddExpr(Ops, SCEV::FlagNUW, Depth + 1);
1825     }
1826 
1827     // zext(C + x + y + ...) --> (zext(D) + zext((C - D) + x + y + ...))
1828     // if D + (C - D + x + y + ...) could be proven to not unsigned wrap
1829     // where D maximizes the number of trailing zeros of (C - D + x + y + ...)
1830     //
1831     // Often address arithmetics contain expressions like
1832     // (zext (add (shl X, C1), C2)), for instance, (zext (5 + (4 * X))).
1833     // This transformation is useful while proving that such expressions are
1834     // equal or differ by a small constant amount, see LoadStoreVectorizer pass.
1835     if (const auto *SC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(SA->getOperand(0))) {
1836       const APInt &D = extractConstantWithoutWrapping(*this, SC, SA);
1837       if (D != 0) {
1838         const SCEV *SZExtD = getZeroExtendExpr(getConstant(D), Ty, Depth);
1839         const SCEV *SResidual =
1840             getAddExpr(getConstant(-D), SA, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth);
1841         const SCEV *SZExtR = getZeroExtendExpr(SResidual, Ty, Depth + 1);
1842         return getAddExpr(SZExtD, SZExtR,
1843                           (SCEV::NoWrapFlags)(SCEV::FlagNSW | SCEV::FlagNUW),
1844                           Depth + 1);
1845       }
1846     }
1847   }
1848 
1849   if (auto *SM = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(Op)) {
1850     // zext((A * B * ...)<nuw>) --> (zext(A) * zext(B) * ...)<nuw>
1851     if (SM->hasNoUnsignedWrap()) {
1852       // If the multiply does not unsign overflow then we can, by definition,
1853       // commute the zero extension with the multiply operation.
1854       SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> Ops;
1855       for (const auto *Op : SM->operands())
1856         Ops.push_back(getZeroExtendExpr(Op, Ty, Depth + 1));
1857       return getMulExpr(Ops, SCEV::FlagNUW, Depth + 1);
1858     }
1859 
1860     // zext(2^K * (trunc X to iN)) to iM ->
1861     // 2^K * (zext(trunc X to i{N-K}) to iM)<nuw>
1862     //
1863     // Proof:
1864     //
1865     //     zext(2^K * (trunc X to iN)) to iM
1866     //   = zext((trunc X to iN) << K) to iM
1867     //   = zext((trunc X to i{N-K}) << K)<nuw> to iM
1868     //     (because shl removes the top K bits)
1869     //   = zext((2^K * (trunc X to i{N-K}))<nuw>) to iM
1870     //   = (2^K * (zext(trunc X to i{N-K}) to iM))<nuw>.
1871     //
1872     if (SM->getNumOperands() == 2)
1873       if (auto *MulLHS = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(SM->getOperand(0)))
1874         if (MulLHS->getAPInt().isPowerOf2())
1875           if (auto *TruncRHS = dyn_cast<SCEVTruncateExpr>(SM->getOperand(1))) {
1876             int NewTruncBits = getTypeSizeInBits(TruncRHS->getType()) -
1877                                MulLHS->getAPInt().logBase2();
1878             Type *NewTruncTy = IntegerType::get(getContext(), NewTruncBits);
1879             return getMulExpr(
1880                 getZeroExtendExpr(MulLHS, Ty),
1881                 getZeroExtendExpr(
1882                     getTruncateExpr(TruncRHS->getOperand(), NewTruncTy), Ty),
1883                 SCEV::FlagNUW, Depth + 1);
1884           }
1885   }
1886 
1887   // The cast wasn't folded; create an explicit cast node.
1888   // Recompute the insert position, as it may have been invalidated.
1889   if (const SCEV *S = UniqueSCEVs.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP)) return S;
1890   SCEV *S = new (SCEVAllocator) SCEVZeroExtendExpr(ID.Intern(SCEVAllocator),
1891                                                    Op, Ty);
1892   UniqueSCEVs.InsertNode(S, IP);
1893   addToLoopUseLists(S);
1894   return S;
1895 }
1896 
1897 const SCEV *
1898 ScalarEvolution::getSignExtendExpr(const SCEV *Op, Type *Ty, unsigned Depth) {
1899   assert(getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) < getTypeSizeInBits(Ty) &&
1900          "This is not an extending conversion!");
1901   assert(isSCEVable(Ty) &&
1902          "This is not a conversion to a SCEVable type!");
1903   Ty = getEffectiveSCEVType(Ty);
1904 
1905   // Fold if the operand is constant.
1906   if (const SCEVConstant *SC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Op))
1907     return getConstant(
1908       cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getSExt(SC->getValue(), Ty)));
1909 
1910   // sext(sext(x)) --> sext(x)
1911   if (const SCEVSignExtendExpr *SS = dyn_cast<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(Op))
1912     return getSignExtendExpr(SS->getOperand(), Ty, Depth + 1);
1913 
1914   // sext(zext(x)) --> zext(x)
1915   if (const SCEVZeroExtendExpr *SZ = dyn_cast<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(Op))
1916     return getZeroExtendExpr(SZ->getOperand(), Ty, Depth + 1);
1917 
1918   // Before doing any expensive analysis, check to see if we've already
1919   // computed a SCEV for this Op and Ty.
1920   FoldingSetNodeID ID;
1921   ID.AddInteger(scSignExtend);
1922   ID.AddPointer(Op);
1923   ID.AddPointer(Ty);
1924   void *IP = nullptr;
1925   if (const SCEV *S = UniqueSCEVs.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP)) return S;
1926   // Limit recursion depth.
1927   if (Depth > MaxExtDepth) {
1928     SCEV *S = new (SCEVAllocator) SCEVSignExtendExpr(ID.Intern(SCEVAllocator),
1929                                                      Op, Ty);
1930     UniqueSCEVs.InsertNode(S, IP);
1931     addToLoopUseLists(S);
1932     return S;
1933   }
1934 
1935   // sext(trunc(x)) --> sext(x) or x or trunc(x)
1936   if (const SCEVTruncateExpr *ST = dyn_cast<SCEVTruncateExpr>(Op)) {
1937     // It's possible the bits taken off by the truncate were all sign bits. If
1938     // so, we should be able to simplify this further.
1939     const SCEV *X = ST->getOperand();
1940     ConstantRange CR = getSignedRange(X);
1941     unsigned TruncBits = getTypeSizeInBits(ST->getType());
1942     unsigned NewBits = getTypeSizeInBits(Ty);
1943     if (CR.truncate(TruncBits).signExtend(NewBits).contains(
1944             CR.sextOrTrunc(NewBits)))
1945       return getTruncateOrSignExtend(X, Ty);
1946   }
1947 
1948   if (auto *SA = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(Op)) {
1949     // sext((A + B + ...)<nsw>) --> (sext(A) + sext(B) + ...)<nsw>
1950     if (SA->hasNoSignedWrap()) {
1951       // If the addition does not sign overflow then we can, by definition,
1952       // commute the sign extension with the addition operation.
1953       SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> Ops;
1954       for (const auto *Op : SA->operands())
1955         Ops.push_back(getSignExtendExpr(Op, Ty, Depth + 1));
1956       return getAddExpr(Ops, SCEV::FlagNSW, Depth + 1);
1957     }
1958 
1959     // sext(C + x + y + ...) --> (sext(D) + sext((C - D) + x + y + ...))
1960     // if D + (C - D + x + y + ...) could be proven to not signed wrap
1961     // where D maximizes the number of trailing zeros of (C - D + x + y + ...)
1962     //
1963     // For instance, this will bring two seemingly different expressions:
1964     //     1 + sext(5 + 20 * %x + 24 * %y)  and
1965     //         sext(6 + 20 * %x + 24 * %y)
1966     // to the same form:
1967     //     2 + sext(4 + 20 * %x + 24 * %y)
1968     if (const auto *SC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(SA->getOperand(0))) {
1969       const APInt &D = extractConstantWithoutWrapping(*this, SC, SA);
1970       if (D != 0) {
1971         const SCEV *SSExtD = getSignExtendExpr(getConstant(D), Ty, Depth);
1972         const SCEV *SResidual =
1973             getAddExpr(getConstant(-D), SA, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth);
1974         const SCEV *SSExtR = getSignExtendExpr(SResidual, Ty, Depth + 1);
1975         return getAddExpr(SSExtD, SSExtR,
1976                           (SCEV::NoWrapFlags)(SCEV::FlagNSW | SCEV::FlagNUW),
1977                           Depth + 1);
1978       }
1979     }
1980   }
1981   // If the input value is a chrec scev, and we can prove that the value
1982   // did not overflow the old, smaller, value, we can sign extend all of the
1983   // operands (often constants).  This allows analysis of something like
1984   // this:  for (signed char X = 0; X < 100; ++X) { int Y = X; }
1985   if (const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Op))
1986     if (AR->isAffine()) {
1987       const SCEV *Start = AR->getStart();
1988       const SCEV *Step = AR->getStepRecurrence(*this);
1989       unsigned BitWidth = getTypeSizeInBits(AR->getType());
1990       const Loop *L = AR->getLoop();
1991 
1992       if (!AR->hasNoSignedWrap()) {
1993         auto NewFlags = proveNoWrapViaConstantRanges(AR);
1994         const_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr *>(AR)->setNoWrapFlags(NewFlags);
1995       }
1996 
1997       // If we have special knowledge that this addrec won't overflow,
1998       // we don't need to do any further analysis.
1999       if (AR->hasNoSignedWrap())
2000         return getAddRecExpr(
2001             getExtendAddRecStart<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(AR, Ty, this, Depth + 1),
2002             getSignExtendExpr(Step, Ty, Depth + 1), L, SCEV::FlagNSW);
2003 
2004       // Check whether the backedge-taken count is SCEVCouldNotCompute.
2005       // Note that this serves two purposes: It filters out loops that are
2006       // simply not analyzable, and it covers the case where this code is
2007       // being called from within backedge-taken count analysis, such that
2008       // attempting to ask for the backedge-taken count would likely result
2009       // in infinite recursion. In the later case, the analysis code will
2010       // cope with a conservative value, and it will take care to purge
2011       // that value once it has finished.
2012       const SCEV *MaxBECount = getMaxBackedgeTakenCount(L);
2013       if (!isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(MaxBECount)) {
2014         // Manually compute the final value for AR, checking for
2015         // overflow.
2016 
2017         // Check whether the backedge-taken count can be losslessly casted to
2018         // the addrec's type. The count is always unsigned.
2019         const SCEV *CastedMaxBECount =
2020           getTruncateOrZeroExtend(MaxBECount, Start->getType());
2021         const SCEV *RecastedMaxBECount =
2022           getTruncateOrZeroExtend(CastedMaxBECount, MaxBECount->getType());
2023         if (MaxBECount == RecastedMaxBECount) {
2024           Type *WideTy = IntegerType::get(getContext(), BitWidth * 2);
2025           // Check whether Start+Step*MaxBECount has no signed overflow.
2026           const SCEV *SMul = getMulExpr(CastedMaxBECount, Step,
2027                                         SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1);
2028           const SCEV *SAdd = getSignExtendExpr(getAddExpr(Start, SMul,
2029                                                           SCEV::FlagAnyWrap,
2030                                                           Depth + 1),
2031                                                WideTy, Depth + 1);
2032           const SCEV *WideStart = getSignExtendExpr(Start, WideTy, Depth + 1);
2033           const SCEV *WideMaxBECount =
2034             getZeroExtendExpr(CastedMaxBECount, WideTy, Depth + 1);
2035           const SCEV *OperandExtendedAdd =
2036             getAddExpr(WideStart,
2037                        getMulExpr(WideMaxBECount,
2038                                   getSignExtendExpr(Step, WideTy, Depth + 1),
2039                                   SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1),
2040                        SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1);
2041           if (SAdd == OperandExtendedAdd) {
2042             // Cache knowledge of AR NSW, which is propagated to this AddRec.
2043             const_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr *>(AR)->setNoWrapFlags(SCEV::FlagNSW);
2044             // Return the expression with the addrec on the outside.
2045             return getAddRecExpr(
2046                 getExtendAddRecStart<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(AR, Ty, this,
2047                                                          Depth + 1),
2048                 getSignExtendExpr(Step, Ty, Depth + 1), L,
2049                 AR->getNoWrapFlags());
2050           }
2051           // Similar to above, only this time treat the step value as unsigned.
2052           // This covers loops that count up with an unsigned step.
2053           OperandExtendedAdd =
2054             getAddExpr(WideStart,
2055                        getMulExpr(WideMaxBECount,
2056                                   getZeroExtendExpr(Step, WideTy, Depth + 1),
2057                                   SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1),
2058                        SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1);
2059           if (SAdd == OperandExtendedAdd) {
2060             // If AR wraps around then
2061             //
2062             //    abs(Step) * MaxBECount > unsigned-max(AR->getType())
2063             // => SAdd != OperandExtendedAdd
2064             //
2065             // Thus (AR is not NW => SAdd != OperandExtendedAdd) <=>
2066             // (SAdd == OperandExtendedAdd => AR is NW)
2067 
2068             const_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr *>(AR)->setNoWrapFlags(SCEV::FlagNW);
2069 
2070             // Return the expression with the addrec on the outside.
2071             return getAddRecExpr(
2072                 getExtendAddRecStart<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(AR, Ty, this,
2073                                                          Depth + 1),
2074                 getZeroExtendExpr(Step, Ty, Depth + 1), L,
2075                 AR->getNoWrapFlags());
2076           }
2077         }
2078       }
2079 
2080       // Normally, in the cases we can prove no-overflow via a
2081       // backedge guarding condition, we can also compute a backedge
2082       // taken count for the loop.  The exceptions are assumptions and
2083       // guards present in the loop -- SCEV is not great at exploiting
2084       // these to compute max backedge taken counts, but can still use
2085       // these to prove lack of overflow.  Use this fact to avoid
2086       // doing extra work that may not pay off.
2087 
2088       if (!isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(MaxBECount) || HasGuards ||
2089           !AC.assumptions().empty()) {
2090         // If the backedge is guarded by a comparison with the pre-inc
2091         // value the addrec is safe. Also, if the entry is guarded by
2092         // a comparison with the start value and the backedge is
2093         // guarded by a comparison with the post-inc value, the addrec
2094         // is safe.
2095         ICmpInst::Predicate Pred;
2096         const SCEV *OverflowLimit =
2097             getSignedOverflowLimitForStep(Step, &Pred, this);
2098         if (OverflowLimit &&
2099             (isLoopBackedgeGuardedByCond(L, Pred, AR, OverflowLimit) ||
2100              isKnownOnEveryIteration(Pred, AR, OverflowLimit))) {
2101           // Cache knowledge of AR NSW, then propagate NSW to the wide AddRec.
2102           const_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr *>(AR)->setNoWrapFlags(SCEV::FlagNSW);
2103           return getAddRecExpr(
2104               getExtendAddRecStart<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(AR, Ty, this, Depth + 1),
2105               getSignExtendExpr(Step, Ty, Depth + 1), L, AR->getNoWrapFlags());
2106         }
2107       }
2108 
2109       // sext({C,+,Step}) --> (sext(D) + sext({C-D,+,Step}))<nuw><nsw>
2110       // if D + (C - D + Step * n) could be proven to not signed wrap
2111       // where D maximizes the number of trailing zeros of (C - D + Step * n)
2112       if (const auto *SC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Start)) {
2113         const APInt &C = SC->getAPInt();
2114         const APInt &D = extractConstantWithoutWrapping(*this, C, Step);
2115         if (D != 0) {
2116           const SCEV *SSExtD = getSignExtendExpr(getConstant(D), Ty, Depth);
2117           const SCEV *SResidual =
2118               getAddRecExpr(getConstant(C - D), Step, L, AR->getNoWrapFlags());
2119           const SCEV *SSExtR = getSignExtendExpr(SResidual, Ty, Depth + 1);
2120           return getAddExpr(SSExtD, SSExtR,
2121                             (SCEV::NoWrapFlags)(SCEV::FlagNSW | SCEV::FlagNUW),
2122                             Depth + 1);
2123         }
2124       }
2125 
2126       if (proveNoWrapByVaryingStart<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(Start, Step, L)) {
2127         const_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr *>(AR)->setNoWrapFlags(SCEV::FlagNSW);
2128         return getAddRecExpr(
2129             getExtendAddRecStart<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(AR, Ty, this, Depth + 1),
2130             getSignExtendExpr(Step, Ty, Depth + 1), L, AR->getNoWrapFlags());
2131       }
2132     }
2133 
2134   // If the input value is provably positive and we could not simplify
2135   // away the sext build a zext instead.
2136   if (isKnownNonNegative(Op))
2137     return getZeroExtendExpr(Op, Ty, Depth + 1);
2138 
2139   // The cast wasn't folded; create an explicit cast node.
2140   // Recompute the insert position, as it may have been invalidated.
2141   if (const SCEV *S = UniqueSCEVs.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP)) return S;
2142   SCEV *S = new (SCEVAllocator) SCEVSignExtendExpr(ID.Intern(SCEVAllocator),
2143                                                    Op, Ty);
2144   UniqueSCEVs.InsertNode(S, IP);
2145   addToLoopUseLists(S);
2146   return S;
2147 }
2148 
2149 /// getAnyExtendExpr - Return a SCEV for the given operand extended with
2150 /// unspecified bits out to the given type.
2151 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getAnyExtendExpr(const SCEV *Op,
2152                                               Type *Ty) {
2153   assert(getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) < getTypeSizeInBits(Ty) &&
2154          "This is not an extending conversion!");
2155   assert(isSCEVable(Ty) &&
2156          "This is not a conversion to a SCEVable type!");
2157   Ty = getEffectiveSCEVType(Ty);
2158 
2159   // Sign-extend negative constants.
2160   if (const SCEVConstant *SC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Op))
2161     if (SC->getAPInt().isNegative())
2162       return getSignExtendExpr(Op, Ty);
2163 
2164   // Peel off a truncate cast.
2165   if (const SCEVTruncateExpr *T = dyn_cast<SCEVTruncateExpr>(Op)) {
2166     const SCEV *NewOp = T->getOperand();
2167     if (getTypeSizeInBits(NewOp->getType()) < getTypeSizeInBits(Ty))
2168       return getAnyExtendExpr(NewOp, Ty);
2169     return getTruncateOrNoop(NewOp, Ty);
2170   }
2171 
2172   // Next try a zext cast. If the cast is folded, use it.
2173   const SCEV *ZExt = getZeroExtendExpr(Op, Ty);
2174   if (!isa<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(ZExt))
2175     return ZExt;
2176 
2177   // Next try a sext cast. If the cast is folded, use it.
2178   const SCEV *SExt = getSignExtendExpr(Op, Ty);
2179   if (!isa<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(SExt))
2180     return SExt;
2181 
2182   // Force the cast to be folded into the operands of an addrec.
2183   if (const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Op)) {
2184     SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> Ops;
2185     for (const SCEV *Op : AR->operands())
2186       Ops.push_back(getAnyExtendExpr(Op, Ty));
2187     return getAddRecExpr(Ops, AR->getLoop(), SCEV::FlagNW);
2188   }
2189 
2190   // If the expression is obviously signed, use the sext cast value.
2191   if (isa<SCEVSMaxExpr>(Op))
2192     return SExt;
2193 
2194   // Absent any other information, use the zext cast value.
2195   return ZExt;
2196 }
2197 
2198 /// Process the given Ops list, which is a list of operands to be added under
2199 /// the given scale, update the given map. This is a helper function for
2200 /// getAddRecExpr. As an example of what it does, given a sequence of operands
2201 /// that would form an add expression like this:
2202 ///
2203 ///    m + n + 13 + (A * (o + p + (B * (q + m + 29)))) + r + (-1 * r)
2204 ///
2205 /// where A and B are constants, update the map with these values:
2206 ///
2207 ///    (m, 1+A*B), (n, 1), (o, A), (p, A), (q, A*B), (r, 0)
2208 ///
2209 /// and add 13 + A*B*29 to AccumulatedConstant.
2210 /// This will allow getAddRecExpr to produce this:
2211 ///
2212 ///    13+A*B*29 + n + (m * (1+A*B)) + ((o + p) * A) + (q * A*B)
2213 ///
2214 /// This form often exposes folding opportunities that are hidden in
2215 /// the original operand list.
2216 ///
2217 /// Return true iff it appears that any interesting folding opportunities
2218 /// may be exposed. This helps getAddRecExpr short-circuit extra work in
2219 /// the common case where no interesting opportunities are present, and
2220 /// is also used as a check to avoid infinite recursion.
2221 static bool
2222 CollectAddOperandsWithScales(DenseMap<const SCEV *, APInt> &M,
2223                              SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &NewOps,
2224                              APInt &AccumulatedConstant,
2225                              const SCEV *const *Ops, size_t NumOperands,
2226                              const APInt &Scale,
2227                              ScalarEvolution &SE) {
2228   bool Interesting = false;
2229 
2230   // Iterate over the add operands. They are sorted, with constants first.
2231   unsigned i = 0;
2232   while (const SCEVConstant *C = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[i])) {
2233     ++i;
2234     // Pull a buried constant out to the outside.
2235     if (Scale != 1 || AccumulatedConstant != 0 || C->getValue()->isZero())
2236       Interesting = true;
2237     AccumulatedConstant += Scale * C->getAPInt();
2238   }
2239 
2240   // Next comes everything else. We're especially interested in multiplies
2241   // here, but they're in the middle, so just visit the rest with one loop.
2242   for (; i != NumOperands; ++i) {
2243     const SCEVMulExpr *Mul = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(Ops[i]);
2244     if (Mul && isa<SCEVConstant>(Mul->getOperand(0))) {
2245       APInt NewScale =
2246           Scale * cast<SCEVConstant>(Mul->getOperand(0))->getAPInt();
2247       if (Mul->getNumOperands() == 2 && isa<SCEVAddExpr>(Mul->getOperand(1))) {
2248         // A multiplication of a constant with another add; recurse.
2249         const SCEVAddExpr *Add = cast<SCEVAddExpr>(Mul->getOperand(1));
2250         Interesting |=
2251           CollectAddOperandsWithScales(M, NewOps, AccumulatedConstant,
2252                                        Add->op_begin(), Add->getNumOperands(),
2253                                        NewScale, SE);
2254       } else {
2255         // A multiplication of a constant with some other value. Update
2256         // the map.
2257         SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> MulOps(Mul->op_begin()+1, Mul->op_end());
2258         const SCEV *Key = SE.getMulExpr(MulOps);
2259         auto Pair = M.insert({Key, NewScale});
2260         if (Pair.second) {
2261           NewOps.push_back(Pair.first->first);
2262         } else {
2263           Pair.first->second += NewScale;
2264           // The map already had an entry for this value, which may indicate
2265           // a folding opportunity.
2266           Interesting = true;
2267         }
2268       }
2269     } else {
2270       // An ordinary operand. Update the map.
2271       std::pair<DenseMap<const SCEV *, APInt>::iterator, bool> Pair =
2272           M.insert({Ops[i], Scale});
2273       if (Pair.second) {
2274         NewOps.push_back(Pair.first->first);
2275       } else {
2276         Pair.first->second += Scale;
2277         // The map already had an entry for this value, which may indicate
2278         // a folding opportunity.
2279         Interesting = true;
2280       }
2281     }
2282   }
2283 
2284   return Interesting;
2285 }
2286 
2287 // We're trying to construct a SCEV of type `Type' with `Ops' as operands and
2288 // `OldFlags' as can't-wrap behavior.  Infer a more aggressive set of
2289 // can't-overflow flags for the operation if possible.
2290 static SCEV::NoWrapFlags
2291 StrengthenNoWrapFlags(ScalarEvolution *SE, SCEVTypes Type,
2292                       const SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Ops,
2293                       SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags) {
2294   using namespace std::placeholders;
2295 
2296   using OBO = OverflowingBinaryOperator;
2297 
2298   bool CanAnalyze =
2299       Type == scAddExpr || Type == scAddRecExpr || Type == scMulExpr;
2300   (void)CanAnalyze;
2301   assert(CanAnalyze && "don't call from other places!");
2302 
2303   int SignOrUnsignMask = SCEV::FlagNUW | SCEV::FlagNSW;
2304   SCEV::NoWrapFlags SignOrUnsignWrap =
2305       ScalarEvolution::maskFlags(Flags, SignOrUnsignMask);
2306 
2307   // If FlagNSW is true and all the operands are non-negative, infer FlagNUW.
2308   auto IsKnownNonNegative = [&](const SCEV *S) {
2309     return SE->isKnownNonNegative(S);
2310   };
2311 
2312   if (SignOrUnsignWrap == SCEV::FlagNSW && all_of(Ops, IsKnownNonNegative))
2313     Flags =
2314         ScalarEvolution::setFlags(Flags, (SCEV::NoWrapFlags)SignOrUnsignMask);
2315 
2316   SignOrUnsignWrap = ScalarEvolution::maskFlags(Flags, SignOrUnsignMask);
2317 
2318   if (SignOrUnsignWrap != SignOrUnsignMask &&
2319       (Type == scAddExpr || Type == scMulExpr) && Ops.size() == 2 &&
2320       isa<SCEVConstant>(Ops[0])) {
2321 
2322     auto Opcode = [&] {
2323       switch (Type) {
2324       case scAddExpr:
2325         return Instruction::Add;
2326       case scMulExpr:
2327         return Instruction::Mul;
2328       default:
2329         llvm_unreachable("Unexpected SCEV op.");
2330       }
2331     }();
2332 
2333     const APInt &C = cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[0])->getAPInt();
2334 
2335     // (A <opcode> C) --> (A <opcode> C)<nsw> if the op doesn't sign overflow.
2336     if (!(SignOrUnsignWrap & SCEV::FlagNSW)) {
2337       auto NSWRegion = ConstantRange::makeGuaranteedNoWrapRegion(
2338           Opcode, C, OBO::NoSignedWrap);
2339       if (NSWRegion.contains(SE->getSignedRange(Ops[1])))
2340         Flags = ScalarEvolution::setFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNSW);
2341     }
2342 
2343     // (A <opcode> C) --> (A <opcode> C)<nuw> if the op doesn't unsign overflow.
2344     if (!(SignOrUnsignWrap & SCEV::FlagNUW)) {
2345       auto NUWRegion = ConstantRange::makeGuaranteedNoWrapRegion(
2346           Opcode, C, OBO::NoUnsignedWrap);
2347       if (NUWRegion.contains(SE->getUnsignedRange(Ops[1])))
2348         Flags = ScalarEvolution::setFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNUW);
2349     }
2350   }
2351 
2352   return Flags;
2353 }
2354 
2355 bool ScalarEvolution::isAvailableAtLoopEntry(const SCEV *S, const Loop *L) {
2356   return isLoopInvariant(S, L) && properlyDominates(S, L->getHeader());
2357 }
2358 
2359 /// Get a canonical add expression, or something simpler if possible.
2360 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getAddExpr(SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Ops,
2361                                         SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags,
2362                                         unsigned Depth) {
2363   assert(!(Flags & ~(SCEV::FlagNUW | SCEV::FlagNSW)) &&
2364          "only nuw or nsw allowed");
2365   assert(!Ops.empty() && "Cannot get empty add!");
2366   if (Ops.size() == 1) return Ops[0];
2367 #ifndef NDEBUG
2368   Type *ETy = getEffectiveSCEVType(Ops[0]->getType());
2369   for (unsigned i = 1, e = Ops.size(); i != e; ++i)
2370     assert(getEffectiveSCEVType(Ops[i]->getType()) == ETy &&
2371            "SCEVAddExpr operand types don't match!");
2372 #endif
2373 
2374   // Sort by complexity, this groups all similar expression types together.
2375   GroupByComplexity(Ops, &LI, DT);
2376 
2377   Flags = StrengthenNoWrapFlags(this, scAddExpr, Ops, Flags);
2378 
2379   // If there are any constants, fold them together.
2380   unsigned Idx = 0;
2381   if (const SCEVConstant *LHSC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[0])) {
2382     ++Idx;
2383     assert(Idx < Ops.size());
2384     while (const SCEVConstant *RHSC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[Idx])) {
2385       // We found two constants, fold them together!
2386       Ops[0] = getConstant(LHSC->getAPInt() + RHSC->getAPInt());
2387       if (Ops.size() == 2) return Ops[0];
2388       Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+1);  // Erase the folded element
2389       LHSC = cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[0]);
2390     }
2391 
2392     // If we are left with a constant zero being added, strip it off.
2393     if (LHSC->getValue()->isZero()) {
2394       Ops.erase(Ops.begin());
2395       --Idx;
2396     }
2397 
2398     if (Ops.size() == 1) return Ops[0];
2399   }
2400 
2401   // Limit recursion calls depth.
2402   if (Depth > MaxArithDepth)
2403     return getOrCreateAddExpr(Ops, Flags);
2404 
2405   // Okay, check to see if the same value occurs in the operand list more than
2406   // once.  If so, merge them together into an multiply expression.  Since we
2407   // sorted the list, these values are required to be adjacent.
2408   Type *Ty = Ops[0]->getType();
2409   bool FoundMatch = false;
2410   for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ops.size(); i != e-1; ++i)
2411     if (Ops[i] == Ops[i+1]) {      //  X + Y + Y  -->  X + Y*2
2412       // Scan ahead to count how many equal operands there are.
2413       unsigned Count = 2;
2414       while (i+Count != e && Ops[i+Count] == Ops[i])
2415         ++Count;
2416       // Merge the values into a multiply.
2417       const SCEV *Scale = getConstant(Ty, Count);
2418       const SCEV *Mul = getMulExpr(Scale, Ops[i], SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1);
2419       if (Ops.size() == Count)
2420         return Mul;
2421       Ops[i] = Mul;
2422       Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+i+1, Ops.begin()+i+Count);
2423       --i; e -= Count - 1;
2424       FoundMatch = true;
2425     }
2426   if (FoundMatch)
2427     return getAddExpr(Ops, Flags, Depth + 1);
2428 
2429   // Check for truncates. If all the operands are truncated from the same
2430   // type, see if factoring out the truncate would permit the result to be
2431   // folded. eg., n*trunc(x) + m*trunc(y) --> trunc(trunc(m)*x + trunc(n)*y)
2432   // if the contents of the resulting outer trunc fold to something simple.
2433   auto FindTruncSrcType = [&]() -> Type * {
2434     // We're ultimately looking to fold an addrec of truncs and muls of only
2435     // constants and truncs, so if we find any other types of SCEV
2436     // as operands of the addrec then we bail and return nullptr here.
2437     // Otherwise, we return the type of the operand of a trunc that we find.
2438     if (auto *T = dyn_cast<SCEVTruncateExpr>(Ops[Idx]))
2439       return T->getOperand()->getType();
2440     if (const auto *Mul = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(Ops[Idx])) {
2441       const auto *LastOp = Mul->getOperand(Mul->getNumOperands() - 1);
2442       if (const auto *T = dyn_cast<SCEVTruncateExpr>(LastOp))
2443         return T->getOperand()->getType();
2444     }
2445     return nullptr;
2446   };
2447   if (auto *SrcType = FindTruncSrcType()) {
2448     SmallVector<const SCEV *, 8> LargeOps;
2449     bool Ok = true;
2450     // Check all the operands to see if they can be represented in the
2451     // source type of the truncate.
2452     for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ops.size(); i != e; ++i) {
2453       if (const SCEVTruncateExpr *T = dyn_cast<SCEVTruncateExpr>(Ops[i])) {
2454         if (T->getOperand()->getType() != SrcType) {
2455           Ok = false;
2456           break;
2457         }
2458         LargeOps.push_back(T->getOperand());
2459       } else if (const SCEVConstant *C = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[i])) {
2460         LargeOps.push_back(getAnyExtendExpr(C, SrcType));
2461       } else if (const SCEVMulExpr *M = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(Ops[i])) {
2462         SmallVector<const SCEV *, 8> LargeMulOps;
2463         for (unsigned j = 0, f = M->getNumOperands(); j != f && Ok; ++j) {
2464           if (const SCEVTruncateExpr *T =
2465                 dyn_cast<SCEVTruncateExpr>(M->getOperand(j))) {
2466             if (T->getOperand()->getType() != SrcType) {
2467               Ok = false;
2468               break;
2469             }
2470             LargeMulOps.push_back(T->getOperand());
2471           } else if (const auto *C = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(M->getOperand(j))) {
2472             LargeMulOps.push_back(getAnyExtendExpr(C, SrcType));
2473           } else {
2474             Ok = false;
2475             break;
2476           }
2477         }
2478         if (Ok)
2479           LargeOps.push_back(getMulExpr(LargeMulOps, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1));
2480       } else {
2481         Ok = false;
2482         break;
2483       }
2484     }
2485     if (Ok) {
2486       // Evaluate the expression in the larger type.
2487       const SCEV *Fold = getAddExpr(LargeOps, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1);
2488       // If it folds to something simple, use it. Otherwise, don't.
2489       if (isa<SCEVConstant>(Fold) || isa<SCEVUnknown>(Fold))
2490         return getTruncateExpr(Fold, Ty);
2491     }
2492   }
2493 
2494   // Skip past any other cast SCEVs.
2495   while (Idx < Ops.size() && Ops[Idx]->getSCEVType() < scAddExpr)
2496     ++Idx;
2497 
2498   // If there are add operands they would be next.
2499   if (Idx < Ops.size()) {
2500     bool DeletedAdd = false;
2501     while (const SCEVAddExpr *Add = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(Ops[Idx])) {
2502       if (Ops.size() > AddOpsInlineThreshold ||
2503           Add->getNumOperands() > AddOpsInlineThreshold)
2504         break;
2505       // If we have an add, expand the add operands onto the end of the operands
2506       // list.
2507       Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+Idx);
2508       Ops.append(Add->op_begin(), Add->op_end());
2509       DeletedAdd = true;
2510     }
2511 
2512     // If we deleted at least one add, we added operands to the end of the list,
2513     // and they are not necessarily sorted.  Recurse to resort and resimplify
2514     // any operands we just acquired.
2515     if (DeletedAdd)
2516       return getAddExpr(Ops, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1);
2517   }
2518 
2519   // Skip over the add expression until we get to a multiply.
2520   while (Idx < Ops.size() && Ops[Idx]->getSCEVType() < scMulExpr)
2521     ++Idx;
2522 
2523   // Check to see if there are any folding opportunities present with
2524   // operands multiplied by constant values.
2525   if (Idx < Ops.size() && isa<SCEVMulExpr>(Ops[Idx])) {
2526     uint64_t BitWidth = getTypeSizeInBits(Ty);
2527     DenseMap<const SCEV *, APInt> M;
2528     SmallVector<const SCEV *, 8> NewOps;
2529     APInt AccumulatedConstant(BitWidth, 0);
2530     if (CollectAddOperandsWithScales(M, NewOps, AccumulatedConstant,
2531                                      Ops.data(), Ops.size(),
2532                                      APInt(BitWidth, 1), *this)) {
2533       struct APIntCompare {
2534         bool operator()(const APInt &LHS, const APInt &RHS) const {
2535           return LHS.ult(RHS);
2536         }
2537       };
2538 
2539       // Some interesting folding opportunity is present, so its worthwhile to
2540       // re-generate the operands list. Group the operands by constant scale,
2541       // to avoid multiplying by the same constant scale multiple times.
2542       std::map<APInt, SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4>, APIntCompare> MulOpLists;
2543       for (const SCEV *NewOp : NewOps)
2544         MulOpLists[M.find(NewOp)->second].push_back(NewOp);
2545       // Re-generate the operands list.
2546       Ops.clear();
2547       if (AccumulatedConstant != 0)
2548         Ops.push_back(getConstant(AccumulatedConstant));
2549       for (auto &MulOp : MulOpLists)
2550         if (MulOp.first != 0)
2551           Ops.push_back(getMulExpr(
2552               getConstant(MulOp.first),
2553               getAddExpr(MulOp.second, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1),
2554               SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1));
2555       if (Ops.empty())
2556         return getZero(Ty);
2557       if (Ops.size() == 1)
2558         return Ops[0];
2559       return getAddExpr(Ops, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1);
2560     }
2561   }
2562 
2563   // If we are adding something to a multiply expression, make sure the
2564   // something is not already an operand of the multiply.  If so, merge it into
2565   // the multiply.
2566   for (; Idx < Ops.size() && isa<SCEVMulExpr>(Ops[Idx]); ++Idx) {
2567     const SCEVMulExpr *Mul = cast<SCEVMulExpr>(Ops[Idx]);
2568     for (unsigned MulOp = 0, e = Mul->getNumOperands(); MulOp != e; ++MulOp) {
2569       const SCEV *MulOpSCEV = Mul->getOperand(MulOp);
2570       if (isa<SCEVConstant>(MulOpSCEV))
2571         continue;
2572       for (unsigned AddOp = 0, e = Ops.size(); AddOp != e; ++AddOp)
2573         if (MulOpSCEV == Ops[AddOp]) {
2574           // Fold W + X + (X * Y * Z)  -->  W + (X * ((Y*Z)+1))
2575           const SCEV *InnerMul = Mul->getOperand(MulOp == 0);
2576           if (Mul->getNumOperands() != 2) {
2577             // If the multiply has more than two operands, we must get the
2578             // Y*Z term.
2579             SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> MulOps(Mul->op_begin(),
2580                                                 Mul->op_begin()+MulOp);
2581             MulOps.append(Mul->op_begin()+MulOp+1, Mul->op_end());
2582             InnerMul = getMulExpr(MulOps, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1);
2583           }
2584           SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> TwoOps = {getOne(Ty), InnerMul};
2585           const SCEV *AddOne = getAddExpr(TwoOps, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1);
2586           const SCEV *OuterMul = getMulExpr(AddOne, MulOpSCEV,
2587                                             SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1);
2588           if (Ops.size() == 2) return OuterMul;
2589           if (AddOp < Idx) {
2590             Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+AddOp);
2591             Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+Idx-1);
2592           } else {
2593             Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+Idx);
2594             Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+AddOp-1);
2595           }
2596           Ops.push_back(OuterMul);
2597           return getAddExpr(Ops, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1);
2598         }
2599 
2600       // Check this multiply against other multiplies being added together.
2601       for (unsigned OtherMulIdx = Idx+1;
2602            OtherMulIdx < Ops.size() && isa<SCEVMulExpr>(Ops[OtherMulIdx]);
2603            ++OtherMulIdx) {
2604         const SCEVMulExpr *OtherMul = cast<SCEVMulExpr>(Ops[OtherMulIdx]);
2605         // If MulOp occurs in OtherMul, we can fold the two multiplies
2606         // together.
2607         for (unsigned OMulOp = 0, e = OtherMul->getNumOperands();
2608              OMulOp != e; ++OMulOp)
2609           if (OtherMul->getOperand(OMulOp) == MulOpSCEV) {
2610             // Fold X + (A*B*C) + (A*D*E) --> X + (A*(B*C+D*E))
2611             const SCEV *InnerMul1 = Mul->getOperand(MulOp == 0);
2612             if (Mul->getNumOperands() != 2) {
2613               SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> MulOps(Mul->op_begin(),
2614                                                   Mul->op_begin()+MulOp);
2615               MulOps.append(Mul->op_begin()+MulOp+1, Mul->op_end());
2616               InnerMul1 = getMulExpr(MulOps, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1);
2617             }
2618             const SCEV *InnerMul2 = OtherMul->getOperand(OMulOp == 0);
2619             if (OtherMul->getNumOperands() != 2) {
2620               SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> MulOps(OtherMul->op_begin(),
2621                                                   OtherMul->op_begin()+OMulOp);
2622               MulOps.append(OtherMul->op_begin()+OMulOp+1, OtherMul->op_end());
2623               InnerMul2 = getMulExpr(MulOps, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1);
2624             }
2625             SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> TwoOps = {InnerMul1, InnerMul2};
2626             const SCEV *InnerMulSum =
2627                 getAddExpr(TwoOps, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1);
2628             const SCEV *OuterMul = getMulExpr(MulOpSCEV, InnerMulSum,
2629                                               SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1);
2630             if (Ops.size() == 2) return OuterMul;
2631             Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+Idx);
2632             Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+OtherMulIdx-1);
2633             Ops.push_back(OuterMul);
2634             return getAddExpr(Ops, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1);
2635           }
2636       }
2637     }
2638   }
2639 
2640   // If there are any add recurrences in the operands list, see if any other
2641   // added values are loop invariant.  If so, we can fold them into the
2642   // recurrence.
2643   while (Idx < Ops.size() && Ops[Idx]->getSCEVType() < scAddRecExpr)
2644     ++Idx;
2645 
2646   // Scan over all recurrences, trying to fold loop invariants into them.
2647   for (; Idx < Ops.size() && isa<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Ops[Idx]); ++Idx) {
2648     // Scan all of the other operands to this add and add them to the vector if
2649     // they are loop invariant w.r.t. the recurrence.
2650     SmallVector<const SCEV *, 8> LIOps;
2651     const SCEVAddRecExpr *AddRec = cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Ops[Idx]);
2652     const Loop *AddRecLoop = AddRec->getLoop();
2653     for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ops.size(); i != e; ++i)
2654       if (isAvailableAtLoopEntry(Ops[i], AddRecLoop)) {
2655         LIOps.push_back(Ops[i]);
2656         Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+i);
2657         --i; --e;
2658       }
2659 
2660     // If we found some loop invariants, fold them into the recurrence.
2661     if (!LIOps.empty()) {
2662       //  NLI + LI + {Start,+,Step}  -->  NLI + {LI+Start,+,Step}
2663       LIOps.push_back(AddRec->getStart());
2664 
2665       SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> AddRecOps(AddRec->op_begin(),
2666                                              AddRec->op_end());
2667       // This follows from the fact that the no-wrap flags on the outer add
2668       // expression are applicable on the 0th iteration, when the add recurrence
2669       // will be equal to its start value.
2670       AddRecOps[0] = getAddExpr(LIOps, Flags, Depth + 1);
2671 
2672       // Build the new addrec. Propagate the NUW and NSW flags if both the
2673       // outer add and the inner addrec are guaranteed to have no overflow.
2674       // Always propagate NW.
2675       Flags = AddRec->getNoWrapFlags(setFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNW));
2676       const SCEV *NewRec = getAddRecExpr(AddRecOps, AddRecLoop, Flags);
2677 
2678       // If all of the other operands were loop invariant, we are done.
2679       if (Ops.size() == 1) return NewRec;
2680 
2681       // Otherwise, add the folded AddRec by the non-invariant parts.
2682       for (unsigned i = 0;; ++i)
2683         if (Ops[i] == AddRec) {
2684           Ops[i] = NewRec;
2685           break;
2686         }
2687       return getAddExpr(Ops, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1);
2688     }
2689 
2690     // Okay, if there weren't any loop invariants to be folded, check to see if
2691     // there are multiple AddRec's with the same loop induction variable being
2692     // added together.  If so, we can fold them.
2693     for (unsigned OtherIdx = Idx+1;
2694          OtherIdx < Ops.size() && isa<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Ops[OtherIdx]);
2695          ++OtherIdx) {
2696       // We expect the AddRecExpr's to be sorted in reverse dominance order,
2697       // so that the 1st found AddRecExpr is dominated by all others.
2698       assert(DT.dominates(
2699            cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Ops[OtherIdx])->getLoop()->getHeader(),
2700            AddRec->getLoop()->getHeader()) &&
2701         "AddRecExprs are not sorted in reverse dominance order?");
2702       if (AddRecLoop == cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Ops[OtherIdx])->getLoop()) {
2703         // Other + {A,+,B}<L> + {C,+,D}<L>  -->  Other + {A+C,+,B+D}<L>
2704         SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> AddRecOps(AddRec->op_begin(),
2705                                                AddRec->op_end());
2706         for (; OtherIdx != Ops.size() && isa<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Ops[OtherIdx]);
2707              ++OtherIdx) {
2708           const auto *OtherAddRec = cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Ops[OtherIdx]);
2709           if (OtherAddRec->getLoop() == AddRecLoop) {
2710             for (unsigned i = 0, e = OtherAddRec->getNumOperands();
2711                  i != e; ++i) {
2712               if (i >= AddRecOps.size()) {
2713                 AddRecOps.append(OtherAddRec->op_begin()+i,
2714                                  OtherAddRec->op_end());
2715                 break;
2716               }
2717               SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> TwoOps = {
2718                   AddRecOps[i], OtherAddRec->getOperand(i)};
2719               AddRecOps[i] = getAddExpr(TwoOps, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1);
2720             }
2721             Ops.erase(Ops.begin() + OtherIdx); --OtherIdx;
2722           }
2723         }
2724         // Step size has changed, so we cannot guarantee no self-wraparound.
2725         Ops[Idx] = getAddRecExpr(AddRecOps, AddRecLoop, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap);
2726         return getAddExpr(Ops, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1);
2727       }
2728     }
2729 
2730     // Otherwise couldn't fold anything into this recurrence.  Move onto the
2731     // next one.
2732   }
2733 
2734   // Okay, it looks like we really DO need an add expr.  Check to see if we
2735   // already have one, otherwise create a new one.
2736   return getOrCreateAddExpr(Ops, Flags);
2737 }
2738 
2739 const SCEV *
2740 ScalarEvolution::getOrCreateAddExpr(SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Ops,
2741                                     SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags) {
2742   FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2743   ID.AddInteger(scAddExpr);
2744   for (const SCEV *Op : Ops)
2745     ID.AddPointer(Op);
2746   void *IP = nullptr;
2747   SCEVAddExpr *S =
2748       static_cast<SCEVAddExpr *>(UniqueSCEVs.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP));
2749   if (!S) {
2750     const SCEV **O = SCEVAllocator.Allocate<const SCEV *>(Ops.size());
2751     std::uninitialized_copy(Ops.begin(), Ops.end(), O);
2752     S = new (SCEVAllocator)
2753         SCEVAddExpr(ID.Intern(SCEVAllocator), O, Ops.size());
2754     UniqueSCEVs.InsertNode(S, IP);
2755     addToLoopUseLists(S);
2756   }
2757   S->setNoWrapFlags(Flags);
2758   return S;
2759 }
2760 
2761 const SCEV *
2762 ScalarEvolution::getOrCreateAddRecExpr(SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Ops,
2763                                        const Loop *L, SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags) {
2764   FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2765   ID.AddInteger(scAddRecExpr);
2766   for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ops.size(); i != e; ++i)
2767     ID.AddPointer(Ops[i]);
2768   ID.AddPointer(L);
2769   void *IP = nullptr;
2770   SCEVAddRecExpr *S =
2771       static_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr *>(UniqueSCEVs.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP));
2772   if (!S) {
2773     const SCEV **O = SCEVAllocator.Allocate<const SCEV *>(Ops.size());
2774     std::uninitialized_copy(Ops.begin(), Ops.end(), O);
2775     S = new (SCEVAllocator)
2776         SCEVAddRecExpr(ID.Intern(SCEVAllocator), O, Ops.size(), L);
2777     UniqueSCEVs.InsertNode(S, IP);
2778     addToLoopUseLists(S);
2779   }
2780   S->setNoWrapFlags(Flags);
2781   return S;
2782 }
2783 
2784 const SCEV *
2785 ScalarEvolution::getOrCreateMulExpr(SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Ops,
2786                                     SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags) {
2787   FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2788   ID.AddInteger(scMulExpr);
2789   for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ops.size(); i != e; ++i)
2790     ID.AddPointer(Ops[i]);
2791   void *IP = nullptr;
2792   SCEVMulExpr *S =
2793     static_cast<SCEVMulExpr *>(UniqueSCEVs.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP));
2794   if (!S) {
2795     const SCEV **O = SCEVAllocator.Allocate<const SCEV *>(Ops.size());
2796     std::uninitialized_copy(Ops.begin(), Ops.end(), O);
2797     S = new (SCEVAllocator) SCEVMulExpr(ID.Intern(SCEVAllocator),
2798                                         O, Ops.size());
2799     UniqueSCEVs.InsertNode(S, IP);
2800     addToLoopUseLists(S);
2801   }
2802   S->setNoWrapFlags(Flags);
2803   return S;
2804 }
2805 
2806 static uint64_t umul_ov(uint64_t i, uint64_t j, bool &Overflow) {
2807   uint64_t k = i*j;
2808   if (j > 1 && k / j != i) Overflow = true;
2809   return k;
2810 }
2811 
2812 /// Compute the result of "n choose k", the binomial coefficient.  If an
2813 /// intermediate computation overflows, Overflow will be set and the return will
2814 /// be garbage. Overflow is not cleared on absence of overflow.
2815 static uint64_t Choose(uint64_t n, uint64_t k, bool &Overflow) {
2816   // We use the multiplicative formula:
2817   //     n(n-1)(n-2)...(n-(k-1)) / k(k-1)(k-2)...1 .
2818   // At each iteration, we take the n-th term of the numeral and divide by the
2819   // (k-n)th term of the denominator.  This division will always produce an
2820   // integral result, and helps reduce the chance of overflow in the
2821   // intermediate computations. However, we can still overflow even when the
2822   // final result would fit.
2823 
2824   if (n == 0 || n == k) return 1;
2825   if (k > n) return 0;
2826 
2827   if (k > n/2)
2828     k = n-k;
2829 
2830   uint64_t r = 1;
2831   for (uint64_t i = 1; i <= k; ++i) {
2832     r = umul_ov(r, n-(i-1), Overflow);
2833     r /= i;
2834   }
2835   return r;
2836 }
2837 
2838 /// Determine if any of the operands in this SCEV are a constant or if
2839 /// any of the add or multiply expressions in this SCEV contain a constant.
2840 static bool containsConstantInAddMulChain(const SCEV *StartExpr) {
2841   struct FindConstantInAddMulChain {
2842     bool FoundConstant = false;
2843 
2844     bool follow(const SCEV *S) {
2845       FoundConstant |= isa<SCEVConstant>(S);
2846       return isa<SCEVAddExpr>(S) || isa<SCEVMulExpr>(S);
2847     }
2848 
2849     bool isDone() const {
2850       return FoundConstant;
2851     }
2852   };
2853 
2854   FindConstantInAddMulChain F;
2855   SCEVTraversal<FindConstantInAddMulChain> ST(F);
2856   ST.visitAll(StartExpr);
2857   return F.FoundConstant;
2858 }
2859 
2860 /// Get a canonical multiply expression, or something simpler if possible.
2861 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getMulExpr(SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Ops,
2862                                         SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags,
2863                                         unsigned Depth) {
2864   assert(Flags == maskFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNUW | SCEV::FlagNSW) &&
2865          "only nuw or nsw allowed");
2866   assert(!Ops.empty() && "Cannot get empty mul!");
2867   if (Ops.size() == 1) return Ops[0];
2868 #ifndef NDEBUG
2869   Type *ETy = getEffectiveSCEVType(Ops[0]->getType());
2870   for (unsigned i = 1, e = Ops.size(); i != e; ++i)
2871     assert(getEffectiveSCEVType(Ops[i]->getType()) == ETy &&
2872            "SCEVMulExpr operand types don't match!");
2873 #endif
2874 
2875   // Sort by complexity, this groups all similar expression types together.
2876   GroupByComplexity(Ops, &LI, DT);
2877 
2878   Flags = StrengthenNoWrapFlags(this, scMulExpr, Ops, Flags);
2879 
2880   // Limit recursion calls depth.
2881   if (Depth > MaxArithDepth)
2882     return getOrCreateMulExpr(Ops, Flags);
2883 
2884   // If there are any constants, fold them together.
2885   unsigned Idx = 0;
2886   if (const SCEVConstant *LHSC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[0])) {
2887 
2888     if (Ops.size() == 2)
2889       // C1*(C2+V) -> C1*C2 + C1*V
2890       if (const SCEVAddExpr *Add = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(Ops[1]))
2891         // If any of Add's ops are Adds or Muls with a constant, apply this
2892         // transformation as well.
2893         //
2894         // TODO: There are some cases where this transformation is not
2895         // profitable; for example, Add = (C0 + X) * Y + Z.  Maybe the scope of
2896         // this transformation should be narrowed down.
2897         if (Add->getNumOperands() == 2 && containsConstantInAddMulChain(Add))
2898           return getAddExpr(getMulExpr(LHSC, Add->getOperand(0),
2899                                        SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1),
2900                             getMulExpr(LHSC, Add->getOperand(1),
2901                                        SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1),
2902                             SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1);
2903 
2904     ++Idx;
2905     while (const SCEVConstant *RHSC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[Idx])) {
2906       // We found two constants, fold them together!
2907       ConstantInt *Fold =
2908           ConstantInt::get(getContext(), LHSC->getAPInt() * RHSC->getAPInt());
2909       Ops[0] = getConstant(Fold);
2910       Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+1);  // Erase the folded element
2911       if (Ops.size() == 1) return Ops[0];
2912       LHSC = cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[0]);
2913     }
2914 
2915     // If we are left with a constant one being multiplied, strip it off.
2916     if (cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[0])->getValue()->isOne()) {
2917       Ops.erase(Ops.begin());
2918       --Idx;
2919     } else if (cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[0])->getValue()->isZero()) {
2920       // If we have a multiply of zero, it will always be zero.
2921       return Ops[0];
2922     } else if (Ops[0]->isAllOnesValue()) {
2923       // If we have a mul by -1 of an add, try distributing the -1 among the
2924       // add operands.
2925       if (Ops.size() == 2) {
2926         if (const SCEVAddExpr *Add = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(Ops[1])) {
2927           SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> NewOps;
2928           bool AnyFolded = false;
2929           for (const SCEV *AddOp : Add->operands()) {
2930             const SCEV *Mul = getMulExpr(Ops[0], AddOp, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap,
2931                                          Depth + 1);
2932             if (!isa<SCEVMulExpr>(Mul)) AnyFolded = true;
2933             NewOps.push_back(Mul);
2934           }
2935           if (AnyFolded)
2936             return getAddExpr(NewOps, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1);
2937         } else if (const auto *AddRec = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Ops[1])) {
2938           // Negation preserves a recurrence's no self-wrap property.
2939           SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> Operands;
2940           for (const SCEV *AddRecOp : AddRec->operands())
2941             Operands.push_back(getMulExpr(Ops[0], AddRecOp, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap,
2942                                           Depth + 1));
2943 
2944           return getAddRecExpr(Operands, AddRec->getLoop(),
2945                                AddRec->getNoWrapFlags(SCEV::FlagNW));
2946         }
2947       }
2948     }
2949 
2950     if (Ops.size() == 1)
2951       return Ops[0];
2952   }
2953 
2954   // Skip over the add expression until we get to a multiply.
2955   while (Idx < Ops.size() && Ops[Idx]->getSCEVType() < scMulExpr)
2956     ++Idx;
2957 
2958   // If there are mul operands inline them all into this expression.
2959   if (Idx < Ops.size()) {
2960     bool DeletedMul = false;
2961     while (const SCEVMulExpr *Mul = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(Ops[Idx])) {
2962       if (Ops.size() > MulOpsInlineThreshold)
2963         break;
2964       // If we have an mul, expand the mul operands onto the end of the
2965       // operands list.
2966       Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+Idx);
2967       Ops.append(Mul->op_begin(), Mul->op_end());
2968       DeletedMul = true;
2969     }
2970 
2971     // If we deleted at least one mul, we added operands to the end of the
2972     // list, and they are not necessarily sorted.  Recurse to resort and
2973     // resimplify any operands we just acquired.
2974     if (DeletedMul)
2975       return getMulExpr(Ops, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1);
2976   }
2977 
2978   // If there are any add recurrences in the operands list, see if any other
2979   // added values are loop invariant.  If so, we can fold them into the
2980   // recurrence.
2981   while (Idx < Ops.size() && Ops[Idx]->getSCEVType() < scAddRecExpr)
2982     ++Idx;
2983 
2984   // Scan over all recurrences, trying to fold loop invariants into them.
2985   for (; Idx < Ops.size() && isa<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Ops[Idx]); ++Idx) {
2986     // Scan all of the other operands to this mul and add them to the vector
2987     // if they are loop invariant w.r.t. the recurrence.
2988     SmallVector<const SCEV *, 8> LIOps;
2989     const SCEVAddRecExpr *AddRec = cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Ops[Idx]);
2990     const Loop *AddRecLoop = AddRec->getLoop();
2991     for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ops.size(); i != e; ++i)
2992       if (isAvailableAtLoopEntry(Ops[i], AddRecLoop)) {
2993         LIOps.push_back(Ops[i]);
2994         Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+i);
2995         --i; --e;
2996       }
2997 
2998     // If we found some loop invariants, fold them into the recurrence.
2999     if (!LIOps.empty()) {
3000       //  NLI * LI * {Start,+,Step}  -->  NLI * {LI*Start,+,LI*Step}
3001       SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> NewOps;
3002       NewOps.reserve(AddRec->getNumOperands());
3003       const SCEV *Scale = getMulExpr(LIOps, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1);
3004       for (unsigned i = 0, e = AddRec->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
3005         NewOps.push_back(getMulExpr(Scale, AddRec->getOperand(i),
3006                                     SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1));
3007 
3008       // Build the new addrec. Propagate the NUW and NSW flags if both the
3009       // outer mul and the inner addrec are guaranteed to have no overflow.
3010       //
3011       // No self-wrap cannot be guaranteed after changing the step size, but
3012       // will be inferred if either NUW or NSW is true.
3013       Flags = AddRec->getNoWrapFlags(clearFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNW));
3014       const SCEV *NewRec = getAddRecExpr(NewOps, AddRecLoop, Flags);
3015 
3016       // If all of the other operands were loop invariant, we are done.
3017       if (Ops.size() == 1) return NewRec;
3018 
3019       // Otherwise, multiply the folded AddRec by the non-invariant parts.
3020       for (unsigned i = 0;; ++i)
3021         if (Ops[i] == AddRec) {
3022           Ops[i] = NewRec;
3023           break;
3024         }
3025       return getMulExpr(Ops, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1);
3026     }
3027 
3028     // Okay, if there weren't any loop invariants to be folded, check to see
3029     // if there are multiple AddRec's with the same loop induction variable
3030     // being multiplied together.  If so, we can fold them.
3031 
3032     // {A1,+,A2,+,...,+,An}<L> * {B1,+,B2,+,...,+,Bn}<L>
3033     // = {x=1 in [ sum y=x..2x [ sum z=max(y-x, y-n)..min(x,n) [
3034     //       choose(x, 2x)*choose(2x-y, x-z)*A_{y-z}*B_z
3035     //   ]]],+,...up to x=2n}.
3036     // Note that the arguments to choose() are always integers with values
3037     // known at compile time, never SCEV objects.
3038     //
3039     // The implementation avoids pointless extra computations when the two
3040     // addrec's are of different length (mathematically, it's equivalent to
3041     // an infinite stream of zeros on the right).
3042     bool OpsModified = false;
3043     for (unsigned OtherIdx = Idx+1;
3044          OtherIdx != Ops.size() && isa<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Ops[OtherIdx]);
3045          ++OtherIdx) {
3046       const SCEVAddRecExpr *OtherAddRec =
3047         dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Ops[OtherIdx]);
3048       if (!OtherAddRec || OtherAddRec->getLoop() != AddRecLoop)
3049         continue;
3050 
3051       // Limit max number of arguments to avoid creation of unreasonably big
3052       // SCEVAddRecs with very complex operands.
3053       if (AddRec->getNumOperands() + OtherAddRec->getNumOperands() - 1 >
3054           MaxAddRecSize)
3055         continue;
3056 
3057       bool Overflow = false;
3058       Type *Ty = AddRec->getType();
3059       bool LargerThan64Bits = getTypeSizeInBits(Ty) > 64;
3060       SmallVector<const SCEV*, 7> AddRecOps;
3061       for (int x = 0, xe = AddRec->getNumOperands() +
3062              OtherAddRec->getNumOperands() - 1; x != xe && !Overflow; ++x) {
3063         const SCEV *Term = getZero(Ty);
3064         for (int y = x, ye = 2*x+1; y != ye && !Overflow; ++y) {
3065           uint64_t Coeff1 = Choose(x, 2*x - y, Overflow);
3066           for (int z = std::max(y-x, y-(int)AddRec->getNumOperands()+1),
3067                  ze = std::min(x+1, (int)OtherAddRec->getNumOperands());
3068                z < ze && !Overflow; ++z) {
3069             uint64_t Coeff2 = Choose(2*x - y, x-z, Overflow);
3070             uint64_t Coeff;
3071             if (LargerThan64Bits)
3072               Coeff = umul_ov(Coeff1, Coeff2, Overflow);
3073             else
3074               Coeff = Coeff1*Coeff2;
3075             const SCEV *CoeffTerm = getConstant(Ty, Coeff);
3076             const SCEV *Term1 = AddRec->getOperand(y-z);
3077             const SCEV *Term2 = OtherAddRec->getOperand(z);
3078             Term = getAddExpr(Term, getMulExpr(CoeffTerm, Term1, Term2,
3079                                                SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1),
3080                               SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1);
3081           }
3082         }
3083         AddRecOps.push_back(Term);
3084       }
3085       if (!Overflow) {
3086         const SCEV *NewAddRec = getAddRecExpr(AddRecOps, AddRec->getLoop(),
3087                                               SCEV::FlagAnyWrap);
3088         if (Ops.size() == 2) return NewAddRec;
3089         Ops[Idx] = NewAddRec;
3090         Ops.erase(Ops.begin() + OtherIdx); --OtherIdx;
3091         OpsModified = true;
3092         AddRec = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(NewAddRec);
3093         if (!AddRec)
3094           break;
3095       }
3096     }
3097     if (OpsModified)
3098       return getMulExpr(Ops, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1);
3099 
3100     // Otherwise couldn't fold anything into this recurrence.  Move onto the
3101     // next one.
3102   }
3103 
3104   // Okay, it looks like we really DO need an mul expr.  Check to see if we
3105   // already have one, otherwise create a new one.
3106   return getOrCreateMulExpr(Ops, Flags);
3107 }
3108 
3109 /// Represents an unsigned remainder expression based on unsigned division.
3110 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getURemExpr(const SCEV *LHS,
3111                                          const SCEV *RHS) {
3112   assert(getEffectiveSCEVType(LHS->getType()) ==
3113          getEffectiveSCEVType(RHS->getType()) &&
3114          "SCEVURemExpr operand types don't match!");
3115 
3116   // Short-circuit easy cases
3117   if (const SCEVConstant *RHSC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(RHS)) {
3118     // If constant is one, the result is trivial
3119     if (RHSC->getValue()->isOne())
3120       return getZero(LHS->getType()); // X urem 1 --> 0
3121 
3122     // If constant is a power of two, fold into a zext(trunc(LHS)).
3123     if (RHSC->getAPInt().isPowerOf2()) {
3124       Type *FullTy = LHS->getType();
3125       Type *TruncTy =
3126           IntegerType::get(getContext(), RHSC->getAPInt().logBase2());
3127       return getZeroExtendExpr(getTruncateExpr(LHS, TruncTy), FullTy);
3128     }
3129   }
3130 
3131   // Fallback to %a == %x urem %y == %x -<nuw> ((%x udiv %y) *<nuw> %y)
3132   const SCEV *UDiv = getUDivExpr(LHS, RHS);
3133   const SCEV *Mult = getMulExpr(UDiv, RHS, SCEV::FlagNUW);
3134   return getMinusSCEV(LHS, Mult, SCEV::FlagNUW);
3135 }
3136 
3137 /// Get a canonical unsigned division expression, or something simpler if
3138 /// possible.
3139 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getUDivExpr(const SCEV *LHS,
3140                                          const SCEV *RHS) {
3141   assert(getEffectiveSCEVType(LHS->getType()) ==
3142          getEffectiveSCEVType(RHS->getType()) &&
3143          "SCEVUDivExpr operand types don't match!");
3144 
3145   if (const SCEVConstant *RHSC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(RHS)) {
3146     if (RHSC->getValue()->isOne())
3147       return LHS;                               // X udiv 1 --> x
3148     // If the denominator is zero, the result of the udiv is undefined. Don't
3149     // try to analyze it, because the resolution chosen here may differ from
3150     // the resolution chosen in other parts of the compiler.
3151     if (!RHSC->getValue()->isZero()) {
3152       // Determine if the division can be folded into the operands of
3153       // its operands.
3154       // TODO: Generalize this to non-constants by using known-bits information.
3155       Type *Ty = LHS->getType();
3156       unsigned LZ = RHSC->getAPInt().countLeadingZeros();
3157       unsigned MaxShiftAmt = getTypeSizeInBits(Ty) - LZ - 1;
3158       // For non-power-of-two values, effectively round the value up to the
3159       // nearest power of two.
3160       if (!RHSC->getAPInt().isPowerOf2())
3161         ++MaxShiftAmt;
3162       IntegerType *ExtTy =
3163         IntegerType::get(getContext(), getTypeSizeInBits(Ty) + MaxShiftAmt);
3164       if (const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(LHS))
3165         if (const SCEVConstant *Step =
3166             dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(AR->getStepRecurrence(*this))) {
3167           // {X,+,N}/C --> {X/C,+,N/C} if safe and N/C can be folded.
3168           const APInt &StepInt = Step->getAPInt();
3169           const APInt &DivInt = RHSC->getAPInt();
3170           if (!StepInt.urem(DivInt) &&
3171               getZeroExtendExpr(AR, ExtTy) ==
3172               getAddRecExpr(getZeroExtendExpr(AR->getStart(), ExtTy),
3173                             getZeroExtendExpr(Step, ExtTy),
3174                             AR->getLoop(), SCEV::FlagAnyWrap)) {
3175             SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> Operands;
3176             for (const SCEV *Op : AR->operands())
3177               Operands.push_back(getUDivExpr(Op, RHS));
3178             return getAddRecExpr(Operands, AR->getLoop(), SCEV::FlagNW);
3179           }
3180           /// Get a canonical UDivExpr for a recurrence.
3181           /// {X,+,N}/C => {Y,+,N}/C where Y=X-(X%N). Safe when C%N=0.
3182           // We can currently only fold X%N if X is constant.
3183           const SCEVConstant *StartC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(AR->getStart());
3184           if (StartC && !DivInt.urem(StepInt) &&
3185               getZeroExtendExpr(AR, ExtTy) ==
3186               getAddRecExpr(getZeroExtendExpr(AR->getStart(), ExtTy),
3187                             getZeroExtendExpr(Step, ExtTy),
3188                             AR->getLoop(), SCEV::FlagAnyWrap)) {
3189             const APInt &StartInt = StartC->getAPInt();
3190             const APInt &StartRem = StartInt.urem(StepInt);
3191             if (StartRem != 0)
3192               LHS = getAddRecExpr(getConstant(StartInt - StartRem), Step,
3193                                   AR->getLoop(), SCEV::FlagNW);
3194           }
3195         }
3196       // (A*B)/C --> A*(B/C) if safe and B/C can be folded.
3197       if (const SCEVMulExpr *M = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(LHS)) {
3198         SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> Operands;
3199         for (const SCEV *Op : M->operands())
3200           Operands.push_back(getZeroExtendExpr(Op, ExtTy));
3201         if (getZeroExtendExpr(M, ExtTy) == getMulExpr(Operands))
3202           // Find an operand that's safely divisible.
3203           for (unsigned i = 0, e = M->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i) {
3204             const SCEV *Op = M->getOperand(i);
3205             const SCEV *Div = getUDivExpr(Op, RHSC);
3206             if (!isa<SCEVUDivExpr>(Div) && getMulExpr(Div, RHSC) == Op) {
3207               Operands = SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4>(M->op_begin(),
3208                                                       M->op_end());
3209               Operands[i] = Div;
3210               return getMulExpr(Operands);
3211             }
3212           }
3213       }
3214 
3215       // (A/B)/C --> A/(B*C) if safe and B*C can be folded.
3216       if (const SCEVUDivExpr *OtherDiv = dyn_cast<SCEVUDivExpr>(LHS)) {
3217         if (auto *DivisorConstant =
3218                 dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(OtherDiv->getRHS())) {
3219           bool Overflow = false;
3220           APInt NewRHS =
3221               DivisorConstant->getAPInt().umul_ov(RHSC->getAPInt(), Overflow);
3222           if (Overflow) {
3223             return getConstant(RHSC->getType(), 0, false);
3224           }
3225           return getUDivExpr(OtherDiv->getLHS(), getConstant(NewRHS));
3226         }
3227       }
3228 
3229       // (A+B)/C --> (A/C + B/C) if safe and A/C and B/C can be folded.
3230       if (const SCEVAddExpr *A = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(LHS)) {
3231         SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> Operands;
3232         for (const SCEV *Op : A->operands())
3233           Operands.push_back(getZeroExtendExpr(Op, ExtTy));
3234         if (getZeroExtendExpr(A, ExtTy) == getAddExpr(Operands)) {
3235           Operands.clear();
3236           for (unsigned i = 0, e = A->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i) {
3237             const SCEV *Op = getUDivExpr(A->getOperand(i), RHS);
3238             if (isa<SCEVUDivExpr>(Op) ||
3239                 getMulExpr(Op, RHS) != A->getOperand(i))
3240               break;
3241             Operands.push_back(Op);
3242           }
3243           if (Operands.size() == A->getNumOperands())
3244             return getAddExpr(Operands);
3245         }
3246       }
3247 
3248       // Fold if both operands are constant.
3249       if (const SCEVConstant *LHSC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(LHS)) {
3250         Constant *LHSCV = LHSC->getValue();
3251         Constant *RHSCV = RHSC->getValue();
3252         return getConstant(cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getUDiv(LHSCV,
3253                                                                    RHSCV)));
3254       }
3255     }
3256   }
3257 
3258   FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3259   ID.AddInteger(scUDivExpr);
3260   ID.AddPointer(LHS);
3261   ID.AddPointer(RHS);
3262   void *IP = nullptr;
3263   if (const SCEV *S = UniqueSCEVs.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP)) return S;
3264   SCEV *S = new (SCEVAllocator) SCEVUDivExpr(ID.Intern(SCEVAllocator),
3265                                              LHS, RHS);
3266   UniqueSCEVs.InsertNode(S, IP);
3267   addToLoopUseLists(S);
3268   return S;
3269 }
3270 
3271 static const APInt gcd(const SCEVConstant *C1, const SCEVConstant *C2) {
3272   APInt A = C1->getAPInt().abs();
3273   APInt B = C2->getAPInt().abs();
3274   uint32_t ABW = A.getBitWidth();
3275   uint32_t BBW = B.getBitWidth();
3276 
3277   if (ABW > BBW)
3278     B = B.zext(ABW);
3279   else if (ABW < BBW)
3280     A = A.zext(BBW);
3281 
3282   return APIntOps::GreatestCommonDivisor(std::move(A), std::move(B));
3283 }
3284 
3285 /// Get a canonical unsigned division expression, or something simpler if
3286 /// possible. There is no representation for an exact udiv in SCEV IR, but we
3287 /// can attempt to remove factors from the LHS and RHS.  We can't do this when
3288 /// it's not exact because the udiv may be clearing bits.
3289 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getUDivExactExpr(const SCEV *LHS,
3290                                               const SCEV *RHS) {
3291   // TODO: we could try to find factors in all sorts of things, but for now we
3292   // just deal with u/exact (multiply, constant). See SCEVDivision towards the
3293   // end of this file for inspiration.
3294 
3295   const SCEVMulExpr *Mul = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(LHS);
3296   if (!Mul || !Mul->hasNoUnsignedWrap())
3297     return getUDivExpr(LHS, RHS);
3298 
3299   if (const SCEVConstant *RHSCst = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(RHS)) {
3300     // If the mulexpr multiplies by a constant, then that constant must be the
3301     // first element of the mulexpr.
3302     if (const auto *LHSCst = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Mul->getOperand(0))) {
3303       if (LHSCst == RHSCst) {
3304         SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> Operands;
3305         Operands.append(Mul->op_begin() + 1, Mul->op_end());
3306         return getMulExpr(Operands);
3307       }
3308 
3309       // We can't just assume that LHSCst divides RHSCst cleanly, it could be
3310       // that there's a factor provided by one of the other terms. We need to
3311       // check.
3312       APInt Factor = gcd(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3313       if (!Factor.isIntN(1)) {
3314         LHSCst =
3315             cast<SCEVConstant>(getConstant(LHSCst->getAPInt().udiv(Factor)));
3316         RHSCst =
3317             cast<SCEVConstant>(getConstant(RHSCst->getAPInt().udiv(Factor)));
3318         SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> Operands;
3319         Operands.push_back(LHSCst);
3320         Operands.append(Mul->op_begin() + 1, Mul->op_end());
3321         LHS = getMulExpr(Operands);
3322         RHS = RHSCst;
3323         Mul = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(LHS);
3324         if (!Mul)
3325           return getUDivExactExpr(LHS, RHS);
3326       }
3327     }
3328   }
3329 
3330   for (int i = 0, e = Mul->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i) {
3331     if (Mul->getOperand(i) == RHS) {
3332       SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> Operands;
3333       Operands.append(Mul->op_begin(), Mul->op_begin() + i);
3334       Operands.append(Mul->op_begin() + i + 1, Mul->op_end());
3335       return getMulExpr(Operands);
3336     }
3337   }
3338 
3339   return getUDivExpr(LHS, RHS);
3340 }
3341 
3342 /// Get an add recurrence expression for the specified loop.  Simplify the
3343 /// expression as much as possible.
3344 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getAddRecExpr(const SCEV *Start, const SCEV *Step,
3345                                            const Loop *L,
3346                                            SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags) {
3347   SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> Operands;
3348   Operands.push_back(Start);
3349   if (const SCEVAddRecExpr *StepChrec = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Step))
3350     if (StepChrec->getLoop() == L) {
3351       Operands.append(StepChrec->op_begin(), StepChrec->op_end());
3352       return getAddRecExpr(Operands, L, maskFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNW));
3353     }
3354 
3355   Operands.push_back(Step);
3356   return getAddRecExpr(Operands, L, Flags);
3357 }
3358 
3359 /// Get an add recurrence expression for the specified loop.  Simplify the
3360 /// expression as much as possible.
3361 const SCEV *
3362 ScalarEvolution::getAddRecExpr(SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Operands,
3363                                const Loop *L, SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags) {
3364   if (Operands.size() == 1) return Operands[0];
3365 #ifndef NDEBUG
3366   Type *ETy = getEffectiveSCEVType(Operands[0]->getType());
3367   for (unsigned i = 1, e = Operands.size(); i != e; ++i)
3368     assert(getEffectiveSCEVType(Operands[i]->getType()) == ETy &&
3369            "SCEVAddRecExpr operand types don't match!");
3370   for (unsigned i = 0, e = Operands.size(); i != e; ++i)
3371     assert(isLoopInvariant(Operands[i], L) &&
3372            "SCEVAddRecExpr operand is not loop-invariant!");
3373 #endif
3374 
3375   if (Operands.back()->isZero()) {
3376     Operands.pop_back();
3377     return getAddRecExpr(Operands, L, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap); // {X,+,0}  -->  X
3378   }
3379 
3380   // It's tempting to want to call getMaxBackedgeTakenCount count here and
3381   // use that information to infer NUW and NSW flags. However, computing a
3382   // BE count requires calling getAddRecExpr, so we may not yet have a
3383   // meaningful BE count at this point (and if we don't, we'd be stuck
3384   // with a SCEVCouldNotCompute as the cached BE count).
3385 
3386   Flags = StrengthenNoWrapFlags(this, scAddRecExpr, Operands, Flags);
3387 
3388   // Canonicalize nested AddRecs in by nesting them in order of loop depth.
3389   if (const SCEVAddRecExpr *NestedAR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Operands[0])) {
3390     const Loop *NestedLoop = NestedAR->getLoop();
3391     if (L->contains(NestedLoop)
3392             ? (L->getLoopDepth() < NestedLoop->getLoopDepth())
3393             : (!NestedLoop->contains(L) &&
3394                DT.dominates(L->getHeader(), NestedLoop->getHeader()))) {
3395       SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> NestedOperands(NestedAR->op_begin(),
3396                                                   NestedAR->op_end());
3397       Operands[0] = NestedAR->getStart();
3398       // AddRecs require their operands be loop-invariant with respect to their
3399       // loops. Don't perform this transformation if it would break this
3400       // requirement.
3401       bool AllInvariant = all_of(
3402           Operands, [&](const SCEV *Op) { return isLoopInvariant(Op, L); });
3403 
3404       if (AllInvariant) {
3405         // Create a recurrence for the outer loop with the same step size.
3406         //
3407         // The outer recurrence keeps its NW flag but only keeps NUW/NSW if the
3408         // inner recurrence has the same property.
3409         SCEV::NoWrapFlags OuterFlags =
3410           maskFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNW | NestedAR->getNoWrapFlags());
3411 
3412         NestedOperands[0] = getAddRecExpr(Operands, L, OuterFlags);
3413         AllInvariant = all_of(NestedOperands, [&](const SCEV *Op) {
3414           return isLoopInvariant(Op, NestedLoop);
3415         });
3416 
3417         if (AllInvariant) {
3418           // Ok, both add recurrences are valid after the transformation.
3419           //
3420           // The inner recurrence keeps its NW flag but only keeps NUW/NSW if
3421           // the outer recurrence has the same property.
3422           SCEV::NoWrapFlags InnerFlags =
3423             maskFlags(NestedAR->getNoWrapFlags(), SCEV::FlagNW | Flags);
3424           return getAddRecExpr(NestedOperands, NestedLoop, InnerFlags);
3425         }
3426       }
3427       // Reset Operands to its original state.
3428       Operands[0] = NestedAR;
3429     }
3430   }
3431 
3432   // Okay, it looks like we really DO need an addrec expr.  Check to see if we
3433   // already have one, otherwise create a new one.
3434   return getOrCreateAddRecExpr(Operands, L, Flags);
3435 }
3436 
3437 const SCEV *
3438 ScalarEvolution::getGEPExpr(GEPOperator *GEP,
3439                             const SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &IndexExprs) {
3440   const SCEV *BaseExpr = getSCEV(GEP->getPointerOperand());
3441   // getSCEV(Base)->getType() has the same address space as Base->getType()
3442   // because SCEV::getType() preserves the address space.
3443   Type *IntPtrTy = getEffectiveSCEVType(BaseExpr->getType());
3444   // FIXME(PR23527): Don't blindly transfer the inbounds flag from the GEP
3445   // instruction to its SCEV, because the Instruction may be guarded by control
3446   // flow and the no-overflow bits may not be valid for the expression in any
3447   // context. This can be fixed similarly to how these flags are handled for
3448   // adds.
3449   SCEV::NoWrapFlags Wrap = GEP->isInBounds() ? SCEV::FlagNSW
3450                                              : SCEV::FlagAnyWrap;
3451 
3452   const SCEV *TotalOffset = getZero(IntPtrTy);
3453   // The array size is unimportant. The first thing we do on CurTy is getting
3454   // its element type.
3455   Type *CurTy = ArrayType::get(GEP->getSourceElementType(), 0);
3456   for (const SCEV *IndexExpr : IndexExprs) {
3457     // Compute the (potentially symbolic) offset in bytes for this index.
3458     if (StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(CurTy)) {
3459       // For a struct, add the member offset.
3460       ConstantInt *Index = cast<SCEVConstant>(IndexExpr)->getValue();
3461       unsigned FieldNo = Index->getZExtValue();
3462       const SCEV *FieldOffset = getOffsetOfExpr(IntPtrTy, STy, FieldNo);
3463 
3464       // Add the field offset to the running total offset.
3465       TotalOffset = getAddExpr(TotalOffset, FieldOffset);
3466 
3467       // Update CurTy to the type of the field at Index.
3468       CurTy = STy->getTypeAtIndex(Index);
3469     } else {
3470       // Update CurTy to its element type.
3471       CurTy = cast<SequentialType>(CurTy)->getElementType();
3472       // For an array, add the element offset, explicitly scaled.
3473       const SCEV *ElementSize = getSizeOfExpr(IntPtrTy, CurTy);
3474       // Getelementptr indices are signed.
3475       IndexExpr = getTruncateOrSignExtend(IndexExpr, IntPtrTy);
3476 
3477       // Multiply the index by the element size to compute the element offset.
3478       const SCEV *LocalOffset = getMulExpr(IndexExpr, ElementSize, Wrap);
3479 
3480       // Add the element offset to the running total offset.
3481       TotalOffset = getAddExpr(TotalOffset, LocalOffset);
3482     }
3483   }
3484 
3485   // Add the total offset from all the GEP indices to the base.
3486   return getAddExpr(BaseExpr, TotalOffset, Wrap);
3487 }
3488 
3489 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getSMaxExpr(const SCEV *LHS,
3490                                          const SCEV *RHS) {
3491   SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> Ops = {LHS, RHS};
3492   return getSMaxExpr(Ops);
3493 }
3494 
3495 const SCEV *
3496 ScalarEvolution::getSMaxExpr(SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Ops) {
3497   assert(!Ops.empty() && "Cannot get empty smax!");
3498   if (Ops.size() == 1) return Ops[0];
3499 #ifndef NDEBUG
3500   Type *ETy = getEffectiveSCEVType(Ops[0]->getType());
3501   for (unsigned i = 1, e = Ops.size(); i != e; ++i)
3502     assert(getEffectiveSCEVType(Ops[i]->getType()) == ETy &&
3503            "SCEVSMaxExpr operand types don't match!");
3504 #endif
3505 
3506   // Sort by complexity, this groups all similar expression types together.
3507   GroupByComplexity(Ops, &LI, DT);
3508 
3509   // If there are any constants, fold them together.
3510   unsigned Idx = 0;
3511   if (const SCEVConstant *LHSC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[0])) {
3512     ++Idx;
3513     assert(Idx < Ops.size());
3514     while (const SCEVConstant *RHSC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[Idx])) {
3515       // We found two constants, fold them together!
3516       ConstantInt *Fold = ConstantInt::get(
3517           getContext(), APIntOps::smax(LHSC->getAPInt(), RHSC->getAPInt()));
3518       Ops[0] = getConstant(Fold);
3519       Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+1);  // Erase the folded element
3520       if (Ops.size() == 1) return Ops[0];
3521       LHSC = cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[0]);
3522     }
3523 
3524     // If we are left with a constant minimum-int, strip it off.
3525     if (cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[0])->getValue()->isMinValue(true)) {
3526       Ops.erase(Ops.begin());
3527       --Idx;
3528     } else if (cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[0])->getValue()->isMaxValue(true)) {
3529       // If we have an smax with a constant maximum-int, it will always be
3530       // maximum-int.
3531       return Ops[0];
3532     }
3533 
3534     if (Ops.size() == 1) return Ops[0];
3535   }
3536 
3537   // Find the first SMax
3538   while (Idx < Ops.size() && Ops[Idx]->getSCEVType() < scSMaxExpr)
3539     ++Idx;
3540 
3541   // Check to see if one of the operands is an SMax. If so, expand its operands
3542   // onto our operand list, and recurse to simplify.
3543   if (Idx < Ops.size()) {
3544     bool DeletedSMax = false;
3545     while (const SCEVSMaxExpr *SMax = dyn_cast<SCEVSMaxExpr>(Ops[Idx])) {
3546       Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+Idx);
3547       Ops.append(SMax->op_begin(), SMax->op_end());
3548       DeletedSMax = true;
3549     }
3550 
3551     if (DeletedSMax)
3552       return getSMaxExpr(Ops);
3553   }
3554 
3555   // Okay, check to see if the same value occurs in the operand list twice.  If
3556   // so, delete one.  Since we sorted the list, these values are required to
3557   // be adjacent.
3558   for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ops.size()-1; i != e; ++i)
3559     //  X smax Y smax Y  -->  X smax Y
3560     //  X smax Y         -->  X, if X is always greater than Y
3561     if (Ops[i] == Ops[i+1] ||
3562         isKnownPredicate(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, Ops[i], Ops[i+1])) {
3563       Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+i+1, Ops.begin()+i+2);
3564       --i; --e;
3565     } else if (isKnownPredicate(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, Ops[i], Ops[i+1])) {
3566       Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+i, Ops.begin()+i+1);
3567       --i; --e;
3568     }
3569 
3570   if (Ops.size() == 1) return Ops[0];
3571 
3572   assert(!Ops.empty() && "Reduced smax down to nothing!");
3573 
3574   // Okay, it looks like we really DO need an smax expr.  Check to see if we
3575   // already have one, otherwise create a new one.
3576   FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3577   ID.AddInteger(scSMaxExpr);
3578   for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ops.size(); i != e; ++i)
3579     ID.AddPointer(Ops[i]);
3580   void *IP = nullptr;
3581   if (const SCEV *S = UniqueSCEVs.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP)) return S;
3582   const SCEV **O = SCEVAllocator.Allocate<const SCEV *>(Ops.size());
3583   std::uninitialized_copy(Ops.begin(), Ops.end(), O);
3584   SCEV *S = new (SCEVAllocator) SCEVSMaxExpr(ID.Intern(SCEVAllocator),
3585                                              O, Ops.size());
3586   UniqueSCEVs.InsertNode(S, IP);
3587   addToLoopUseLists(S);
3588   return S;
3589 }
3590 
3591 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getUMaxExpr(const SCEV *LHS,
3592                                          const SCEV *RHS) {
3593   SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> Ops = {LHS, RHS};
3594   return getUMaxExpr(Ops);
3595 }
3596 
3597 const SCEV *
3598 ScalarEvolution::getUMaxExpr(SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Ops) {
3599   assert(!Ops.empty() && "Cannot get empty umax!");
3600   if (Ops.size() == 1) return Ops[0];
3601 #ifndef NDEBUG
3602   Type *ETy = getEffectiveSCEVType(Ops[0]->getType());
3603   for (unsigned i = 1, e = Ops.size(); i != e; ++i)
3604     assert(getEffectiveSCEVType(Ops[i]->getType()) == ETy &&
3605            "SCEVUMaxExpr operand types don't match!");
3606 #endif
3607 
3608   // Sort by complexity, this groups all similar expression types together.
3609   GroupByComplexity(Ops, &LI, DT);
3610 
3611   // If there are any constants, fold them together.
3612   unsigned Idx = 0;
3613   if (const SCEVConstant *LHSC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[0])) {
3614     ++Idx;
3615     assert(Idx < Ops.size());
3616     while (const SCEVConstant *RHSC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[Idx])) {
3617       // We found two constants, fold them together!
3618       ConstantInt *Fold = ConstantInt::get(
3619           getContext(), APIntOps::umax(LHSC->getAPInt(), RHSC->getAPInt()));
3620       Ops[0] = getConstant(Fold);
3621       Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+1);  // Erase the folded element
3622       if (Ops.size() == 1) return Ops[0];
3623       LHSC = cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[0]);
3624     }
3625 
3626     // If we are left with a constant minimum-int, strip it off.
3627     if (cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[0])->getValue()->isMinValue(false)) {
3628       Ops.erase(Ops.begin());
3629       --Idx;
3630     } else if (cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[0])->getValue()->isMaxValue(false)) {
3631       // If we have an umax with a constant maximum-int, it will always be
3632       // maximum-int.
3633       return Ops[0];
3634     }
3635 
3636     if (Ops.size() == 1) return Ops[0];
3637   }
3638 
3639   // Find the first UMax
3640   while (Idx < Ops.size() && Ops[Idx]->getSCEVType() < scUMaxExpr)
3641     ++Idx;
3642 
3643   // Check to see if one of the operands is a UMax. If so, expand its operands
3644   // onto our operand list, and recurse to simplify.
3645   if (Idx < Ops.size()) {
3646     bool DeletedUMax = false;
3647     while (const SCEVUMaxExpr *UMax = dyn_cast<SCEVUMaxExpr>(Ops[Idx])) {
3648       Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+Idx);
3649       Ops.append(UMax->op_begin(), UMax->op_end());
3650       DeletedUMax = true;
3651     }
3652 
3653     if (DeletedUMax)
3654       return getUMaxExpr(Ops);
3655   }
3656 
3657   // Okay, check to see if the same value occurs in the operand list twice.  If
3658   // so, delete one.  Since we sorted the list, these values are required to
3659   // be adjacent.
3660   for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ops.size()-1; i != e; ++i)
3661     //  X umax Y umax Y  -->  X umax Y
3662     //  X umax Y         -->  X, if X is always greater than Y
3663     if (Ops[i] == Ops[i + 1] || isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(
3664                                     ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, Ops[i], Ops[i + 1])) {
3665       Ops.erase(Ops.begin() + i + 1, Ops.begin() + i + 2);
3666       --i; --e;
3667     } else if (isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, Ops[i],
3668                                                Ops[i + 1])) {
3669       Ops.erase(Ops.begin() + i, Ops.begin() + i + 1);
3670       --i; --e;
3671     }
3672 
3673   if (Ops.size() == 1) return Ops[0];
3674 
3675   assert(!Ops.empty() && "Reduced umax down to nothing!");
3676 
3677   // Okay, it looks like we really DO need a umax expr.  Check to see if we
3678   // already have one, otherwise create a new one.
3679   FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3680   ID.AddInteger(scUMaxExpr);
3681   for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ops.size(); i != e; ++i)
3682     ID.AddPointer(Ops[i]);
3683   void *IP = nullptr;
3684   if (const SCEV *S = UniqueSCEVs.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP)) return S;
3685   const SCEV **O = SCEVAllocator.Allocate<const SCEV *>(Ops.size());
3686   std::uninitialized_copy(Ops.begin(), Ops.end(), O);
3687   SCEV *S = new (SCEVAllocator) SCEVUMaxExpr(ID.Intern(SCEVAllocator),
3688                                              O, Ops.size());
3689   UniqueSCEVs.InsertNode(S, IP);
3690   addToLoopUseLists(S);
3691   return S;
3692 }
3693 
3694 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getSMinExpr(const SCEV *LHS,
3695                                          const SCEV *RHS) {
3696   SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> Ops = { LHS, RHS };
3697   return getSMinExpr(Ops);
3698 }
3699 
3700 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getSMinExpr(SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Ops) {
3701   // ~smax(~x, ~y, ~z) == smin(x, y, z).
3702   SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> NotOps;
3703   for (auto *S : Ops)
3704     NotOps.push_back(getNotSCEV(S));
3705   return getNotSCEV(getSMaxExpr(NotOps));
3706 }
3707 
3708 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getUMinExpr(const SCEV *LHS,
3709                                          const SCEV *RHS) {
3710   SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> Ops = { LHS, RHS };
3711   return getUMinExpr(Ops);
3712 }
3713 
3714 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getUMinExpr(SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Ops) {
3715   assert(!Ops.empty() && "At least one operand must be!");
3716   // Trivial case.
3717   if (Ops.size() == 1)
3718     return Ops[0];
3719 
3720   // ~umax(~x, ~y, ~z) == umin(x, y, z).
3721   SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> NotOps;
3722   for (auto *S : Ops)
3723     NotOps.push_back(getNotSCEV(S));
3724   return getNotSCEV(getUMaxExpr(NotOps));
3725 }
3726 
3727 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getSizeOfExpr(Type *IntTy, Type *AllocTy) {
3728   // We can bypass creating a target-independent
3729   // constant expression and then folding it back into a ConstantInt.
3730   // This is just a compile-time optimization.
3731   return getConstant(IntTy, getDataLayout().getTypeAllocSize(AllocTy));
3732 }
3733 
3734 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getOffsetOfExpr(Type *IntTy,
3735                                              StructType *STy,
3736                                              unsigned FieldNo) {
3737   // We can bypass creating a target-independent
3738   // constant expression and then folding it back into a ConstantInt.
3739   // This is just a compile-time optimization.
3740   return getConstant(
3741       IntTy, getDataLayout().getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(FieldNo));
3742 }
3743 
3744 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getUnknown(Value *V) {
3745   // Don't attempt to do anything other than create a SCEVUnknown object
3746   // here.  createSCEV only calls getUnknown after checking for all other
3747   // interesting possibilities, and any other code that calls getUnknown
3748   // is doing so in order to hide a value from SCEV canonicalization.
3749 
3750   FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3751   ID.AddInteger(scUnknown);
3752   ID.AddPointer(V);
3753   void *IP = nullptr;
3754   if (SCEV *S = UniqueSCEVs.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP)) {
3755     assert(cast<SCEVUnknown>(S)->getValue() == V &&
3756            "Stale SCEVUnknown in uniquing map!");
3757     return S;
3758   }
3759   SCEV *S = new (SCEVAllocator) SCEVUnknown(ID.Intern(SCEVAllocator), V, this,
3760                                             FirstUnknown);
3761   FirstUnknown = cast<SCEVUnknown>(S);
3762   UniqueSCEVs.InsertNode(S, IP);
3763   return S;
3764 }
3765 
3766 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
3767 //            Basic SCEV Analysis and PHI Idiom Recognition Code
3768 //
3769 
3770 /// Test if values of the given type are analyzable within the SCEV
3771 /// framework. This primarily includes integer types, and it can optionally
3772 /// include pointer types if the ScalarEvolution class has access to
3773 /// target-specific information.
3774 bool ScalarEvolution::isSCEVable(Type *Ty) const {
3775   // Integers and pointers are always SCEVable.
3776   return Ty->isIntOrPtrTy();
3777 }
3778 
3779 /// Return the size in bits of the specified type, for which isSCEVable must
3780 /// return true.
3781 uint64_t ScalarEvolution::getTypeSizeInBits(Type *Ty) const {
3782   assert(isSCEVable(Ty) && "Type is not SCEVable!");
3783   if (Ty->isPointerTy())
3784     return getDataLayout().getIndexTypeSizeInBits(Ty);
3785   return getDataLayout().getTypeSizeInBits(Ty);
3786 }
3787 
3788 /// Return a type with the same bitwidth as the given type and which represents
3789 /// how SCEV will treat the given type, for which isSCEVable must return
3790 /// true. For pointer types, this is the pointer-sized integer type.
3791 Type *ScalarEvolution::getEffectiveSCEVType(Type *Ty) const {
3792   assert(isSCEVable(Ty) && "Type is not SCEVable!");
3793 
3794   if (Ty->isIntegerTy())
3795     return Ty;
3796 
3797   // The only other support type is pointer.
3798   assert(Ty->isPointerTy() && "Unexpected non-pointer non-integer type!");
3799   return getDataLayout().getIntPtrType(Ty);
3800 }
3801 
3802 Type *ScalarEvolution::getWiderType(Type *T1, Type *T2) const {
3803   return  getTypeSizeInBits(T1) >= getTypeSizeInBits(T2) ? T1 : T2;
3804 }
3805 
3806 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getCouldNotCompute() {
3807   return CouldNotCompute.get();
3808 }
3809 
3810 bool ScalarEvolution::checkValidity(const SCEV *S) const {
3811   bool ContainsNulls = SCEVExprContains(S, [](const SCEV *S) {
3812     auto *SU = dyn_cast<SCEVUnknown>(S);
3813     return SU && SU->getValue() == nullptr;
3814   });
3815 
3816   return !ContainsNulls;
3817 }
3818 
3819 bool ScalarEvolution::containsAddRecurrence(const SCEV *S) {
3820   HasRecMapType::iterator I = HasRecMap.find(S);
3821   if (I != HasRecMap.end())
3822     return I->second;
3823 
3824   bool FoundAddRec = SCEVExprContains(S, isa<SCEVAddRecExpr, const SCEV *>);
3825   HasRecMap.insert({S, FoundAddRec});
3826   return FoundAddRec;
3827 }
3828 
3829 /// Try to split a SCEVAddExpr into a pair of {SCEV, ConstantInt}.
3830 /// If \p S is a SCEVAddExpr and is composed of a sub SCEV S' and an
3831 /// offset I, then return {S', I}, else return {\p S, nullptr}.
3832 static std::pair<const SCEV *, ConstantInt *> splitAddExpr(const SCEV *S) {
3833   const auto *Add = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(S);
3834   if (!Add)
3835     return {S, nullptr};
3836 
3837   if (Add->getNumOperands() != 2)
3838     return {S, nullptr};
3839 
3840   auto *ConstOp = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Add->getOperand(0));
3841   if (!ConstOp)
3842     return {S, nullptr};
3843 
3844   return {Add->getOperand(1), ConstOp->getValue()};
3845 }
3846 
3847 /// Return the ValueOffsetPair set for \p S. \p S can be represented
3848 /// by the value and offset from any ValueOffsetPair in the set.
3849 SetVector<ScalarEvolution::ValueOffsetPair> *
3850 ScalarEvolution::getSCEVValues(const SCEV *S) {
3851   ExprValueMapType::iterator SI = ExprValueMap.find_as(S);
3852   if (SI == ExprValueMap.end())
3853     return nullptr;
3854 #ifndef NDEBUG
3855   if (VerifySCEVMap) {
3856     // Check there is no dangling Value in the set returned.
3857     for (const auto &VE : SI->second)
3858       assert(ValueExprMap.count(VE.first));
3859   }
3860 #endif
3861   return &SI->second;
3862 }
3863 
3864 /// Erase Value from ValueExprMap and ExprValueMap. ValueExprMap.erase(V)
3865 /// cannot be used separately. eraseValueFromMap should be used to remove
3866 /// V from ValueExprMap and ExprValueMap at the same time.
3867 void ScalarEvolution::eraseValueFromMap(Value *V) {
3868   ValueExprMapType::iterator I = ValueExprMap.find_as(V);
3869   if (I != ValueExprMap.end()) {
3870     const SCEV *S = I->second;
3871     // Remove {V, 0} from the set of ExprValueMap[S]
3872     if (SetVector<ValueOffsetPair> *SV = getSCEVValues(S))
3873       SV->remove({V, nullptr});
3874 
3875     // Remove {V, Offset} from the set of ExprValueMap[Stripped]
3876     const SCEV *Stripped;
3877     ConstantInt *Offset;
3878     std::tie(Stripped, Offset) = splitAddExpr(S);
3879     if (Offset != nullptr) {
3880       if (SetVector<ValueOffsetPair> *SV = getSCEVValues(Stripped))
3881         SV->remove({V, Offset});
3882     }
3883     ValueExprMap.erase(V);
3884   }
3885 }
3886 
3887 /// Check whether value has nuw/nsw/exact set but SCEV does not.
3888 /// TODO: In reality it is better to check the poison recursevely
3889 /// but this is better than nothing.
3890 static bool SCEVLostPoisonFlags(const SCEV *S, const Value *V) {
3891   if (auto *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
3892     if (isa<OverflowingBinaryOperator>(I)) {
3893       if (auto *NS = dyn_cast<SCEVNAryExpr>(S)) {
3894         if (I->hasNoSignedWrap() && !NS->hasNoSignedWrap())
3895           return true;
3896         if (I->hasNoUnsignedWrap() && !NS->hasNoUnsignedWrap())
3897           return true;
3898       }
3899     } else if (isa<PossiblyExactOperator>(I) && I->isExact())
3900       return true;
3901   }
3902   return false;
3903 }
3904 
3905 /// Return an existing SCEV if it exists, otherwise analyze the expression and
3906 /// create a new one.
3907 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getSCEV(Value *V) {
3908   assert(isSCEVable(V->getType()) && "Value is not SCEVable!");
3909 
3910   const SCEV *S = getExistingSCEV(V);
3911   if (S == nullptr) {
3912     S = createSCEV(V);
3913     // During PHI resolution, it is possible to create two SCEVs for the same
3914     // V, so it is needed to double check whether V->S is inserted into
3915     // ValueExprMap before insert S->{V, 0} into ExprValueMap.
3916     std::pair<ValueExprMapType::iterator, bool> Pair =
3917         ValueExprMap.insert({SCEVCallbackVH(V, this), S});
3918     if (Pair.second && !SCEVLostPoisonFlags(S, V)) {
3919       ExprValueMap[S].insert({V, nullptr});
3920 
3921       // If S == Stripped + Offset, add Stripped -> {V, Offset} into
3922       // ExprValueMap.
3923       const SCEV *Stripped = S;
3924       ConstantInt *Offset = nullptr;
3925       std::tie(Stripped, Offset) = splitAddExpr(S);
3926       // If stripped is SCEVUnknown, don't bother to save
3927       // Stripped -> {V, offset}. It doesn't simplify and sometimes even
3928       // increase the complexity of the expansion code.
3929       // If V is GetElementPtrInst, don't save Stripped -> {V, offset}
3930       // because it may generate add/sub instead of GEP in SCEV expansion.
3931       if (Offset != nullptr && !isa<SCEVUnknown>(Stripped) &&
3932           !isa<GetElementPtrInst>(V))
3933         ExprValueMap[Stripped].insert({V, Offset});
3934     }
3935   }
3936   return S;
3937 }
3938 
3939 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getExistingSCEV(Value *V) {
3940   assert(isSCEVable(V->getType()) && "Value is not SCEVable!");
3941 
3942   ValueExprMapType::iterator I = ValueExprMap.find_as(V);
3943   if (I != ValueExprMap.end()) {
3944     const SCEV *S = I->second;
3945     if (checkValidity(S))
3946       return S;
3947     eraseValueFromMap(V);
3948     forgetMemoizedResults(S);
3949   }
3950   return nullptr;
3951 }
3952 
3953 /// Return a SCEV corresponding to -V = -1*V
3954 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getNegativeSCEV(const SCEV *V,
3955                                              SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags) {
3956   if (const SCEVConstant *VC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(V))
3957     return getConstant(
3958                cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(VC->getValue())));
3959 
3960   Type *Ty = V->getType();
3961   Ty = getEffectiveSCEVType(Ty);
3962   return getMulExpr(
3963       V, getConstant(cast<ConstantInt>(Constant::getAllOnesValue(Ty))), Flags);
3964 }
3965 
3966 /// Return a SCEV corresponding to ~V = -1-V
3967 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getNotSCEV(const SCEV *V) {
3968   if (const SCEVConstant *VC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(V))
3969     return getConstant(
3970                 cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNot(VC->getValue())));
3971 
3972   Type *Ty = V->getType();
3973   Ty = getEffectiveSCEVType(Ty);
3974   const SCEV *AllOnes =
3975                    getConstant(cast<ConstantInt>(Constant::getAllOnesValue(Ty)));
3976   return getMinusSCEV(AllOnes, V);
3977 }
3978 
3979 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getMinusSCEV(const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS,
3980                                           SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags,
3981                                           unsigned Depth) {
3982   // Fast path: X - X --> 0.
3983   if (LHS == RHS)
3984     return getZero(LHS->getType());
3985 
3986   // We represent LHS - RHS as LHS + (-1)*RHS. This transformation
3987   // makes it so that we cannot make much use of NUW.
3988   auto AddFlags = SCEV::FlagAnyWrap;
3989   const bool RHSIsNotMinSigned =
3990       !getSignedRangeMin(RHS).isMinSignedValue();
3991   if (maskFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNSW) == SCEV::FlagNSW) {
3992     // Let M be the minimum representable signed value. Then (-1)*RHS
3993     // signed-wraps if and only if RHS is M. That can happen even for
3994     // a NSW subtraction because e.g. (-1)*M signed-wraps even though
3995     // -1 - M does not. So to transfer NSW from LHS - RHS to LHS +
3996     // (-1)*RHS, we need to prove that RHS != M.
3997     //
3998     // If LHS is non-negative and we know that LHS - RHS does not
3999     // signed-wrap, then RHS cannot be M. So we can rule out signed-wrap
4000     // either by proving that RHS > M or that LHS >= 0.
4001     if (RHSIsNotMinSigned || isKnownNonNegative(LHS)) {
4002       AddFlags = SCEV::FlagNSW;
4003     }
4004   }
4005 
4006   // FIXME: Find a correct way to transfer NSW to (-1)*M when LHS -
4007   // RHS is NSW and LHS >= 0.
4008   //
4009   // The difficulty here is that the NSW flag may have been proven
4010   // relative to a loop that is to be found in a recurrence in LHS and
4011   // not in RHS. Applying NSW to (-1)*M may then let the NSW have a
4012   // larger scope than intended.
4013   auto NegFlags = RHSIsNotMinSigned ? SCEV::FlagNSW : SCEV::FlagAnyWrap;
4014 
4015   return getAddExpr(LHS, getNegativeSCEV(RHS, NegFlags), AddFlags, Depth);
4016 }
4017 
4018 const SCEV *
4019 ScalarEvolution::getTruncateOrZeroExtend(const SCEV *V, Type *Ty) {
4020   Type *SrcTy = V->getType();
4021   assert(SrcTy->isIntOrPtrTy() && Ty->isIntOrPtrTy() &&
4022          "Cannot truncate or zero extend with non-integer arguments!");
4023   if (getTypeSizeInBits(SrcTy) == getTypeSizeInBits(Ty))
4024     return V;  // No conversion
4025   if (getTypeSizeInBits(SrcTy) > getTypeSizeInBits(Ty))
4026     return getTruncateExpr(V, Ty);
4027   return getZeroExtendExpr(V, Ty);
4028 }
4029 
4030 const SCEV *
4031 ScalarEvolution::getTruncateOrSignExtend(const SCEV *V,
4032                                          Type *Ty) {
4033   Type *SrcTy = V->getType();
4034   assert(SrcTy->isIntOrPtrTy() && Ty->isIntOrPtrTy() &&
4035          "Cannot truncate or zero extend with non-integer arguments!");
4036   if (getTypeSizeInBits(SrcTy) == getTypeSizeInBits(Ty))
4037     return V;  // No conversion
4038   if (getTypeSizeInBits(SrcTy) > getTypeSizeInBits(Ty))
4039     return getTruncateExpr(V, Ty);
4040   return getSignExtendExpr(V, Ty);
4041 }
4042 
4043 const SCEV *
4044 ScalarEvolution::getNoopOrZeroExtend(const SCEV *V, Type *Ty) {
4045   Type *SrcTy = V->getType();
4046   assert(SrcTy->isIntOrPtrTy() && Ty->isIntOrPtrTy() &&
4047          "Cannot noop or zero extend with non-integer arguments!");
4048   assert(getTypeSizeInBits(SrcTy) <= getTypeSizeInBits(Ty) &&
4049          "getNoopOrZeroExtend cannot truncate!");
4050   if (getTypeSizeInBits(SrcTy) == getTypeSizeInBits(Ty))
4051     return V;  // No conversion
4052   return getZeroExtendExpr(V, Ty);
4053 }
4054 
4055 const SCEV *
4056 ScalarEvolution::getNoopOrSignExtend(const SCEV *V, Type *Ty) {
4057   Type *SrcTy = V->getType();
4058   assert(SrcTy->isIntOrPtrTy() && Ty->isIntOrPtrTy() &&
4059          "Cannot noop or sign extend with non-integer arguments!");
4060   assert(getTypeSizeInBits(SrcTy) <= getTypeSizeInBits(Ty) &&
4061          "getNoopOrSignExtend cannot truncate!");
4062   if (getTypeSizeInBits(SrcTy) == getTypeSizeInBits(Ty))
4063     return V;  // No conversion
4064   return getSignExtendExpr(V, Ty);
4065 }
4066 
4067 const SCEV *
4068 ScalarEvolution::getNoopOrAnyExtend(const SCEV *V, Type *Ty) {
4069   Type *SrcTy = V->getType();
4070   assert(SrcTy->isIntOrPtrTy() && Ty->isIntOrPtrTy() &&
4071          "Cannot noop or any extend with non-integer arguments!");
4072   assert(getTypeSizeInBits(SrcTy) <= getTypeSizeInBits(Ty) &&
4073          "getNoopOrAnyExtend cannot truncate!");
4074   if (getTypeSizeInBits(SrcTy) == getTypeSizeInBits(Ty))
4075     return V;  // No conversion
4076   return getAnyExtendExpr(V, Ty);
4077 }
4078 
4079 const SCEV *
4080 ScalarEvolution::getTruncateOrNoop(const SCEV *V, Type *Ty) {
4081   Type *SrcTy = V->getType();
4082   assert(SrcTy->isIntOrPtrTy() && Ty->isIntOrPtrTy() &&
4083          "Cannot truncate or noop with non-integer arguments!");
4084   assert(getTypeSizeInBits(SrcTy) >= getTypeSizeInBits(Ty) &&
4085          "getTruncateOrNoop cannot extend!");
4086   if (getTypeSizeInBits(SrcTy) == getTypeSizeInBits(Ty))
4087     return V;  // No conversion
4088   return getTruncateExpr(V, Ty);
4089 }
4090 
4091 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getUMaxFromMismatchedTypes(const SCEV *LHS,
4092                                                         const SCEV *RHS) {
4093   const SCEV *PromotedLHS = LHS;
4094   const SCEV *PromotedRHS = RHS;
4095 
4096   if (getTypeSizeInBits(LHS->getType()) > getTypeSizeInBits(RHS->getType()))
4097     PromotedRHS = getZeroExtendExpr(RHS, LHS->getType());
4098   else
4099     PromotedLHS = getNoopOrZeroExtend(LHS, RHS->getType());
4100 
4101   return getUMaxExpr(PromotedLHS, PromotedRHS);
4102 }
4103 
4104 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getUMinFromMismatchedTypes(const SCEV *LHS,
4105                                                         const SCEV *RHS) {
4106   SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> Ops = { LHS, RHS };
4107   return getUMinFromMismatchedTypes(Ops);
4108 }
4109 
4110 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getUMinFromMismatchedTypes(
4111     SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Ops) {
4112   assert(!Ops.empty() && "At least one operand must be!");
4113   // Trivial case.
4114   if (Ops.size() == 1)
4115     return Ops[0];
4116 
4117   // Find the max type first.
4118   Type *MaxType = nullptr;
4119   for (auto *S : Ops)
4120     if (MaxType)
4121       MaxType = getWiderType(MaxType, S->getType());
4122     else
4123       MaxType = S->getType();
4124 
4125   // Extend all ops to max type.
4126   SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> PromotedOps;
4127   for (auto *S : Ops)
4128     PromotedOps.push_back(getNoopOrZeroExtend(S, MaxType));
4129 
4130   // Generate umin.
4131   return getUMinExpr(PromotedOps);
4132 }
4133 
4134 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getPointerBase(const SCEV *V) {
4135   // A pointer operand may evaluate to a nonpointer expression, such as null.
4136   if (!V->getType()->isPointerTy())
4137     return V;
4138 
4139   if (const SCEVCastExpr *Cast = dyn_cast<SCEVCastExpr>(V)) {
4140     return getPointerBase(Cast->getOperand());
4141   } else if (const SCEVNAryExpr *NAry = dyn_cast<SCEVNAryExpr>(V)) {
4142     const SCEV *PtrOp = nullptr;
4143     for (const SCEV *NAryOp : NAry->operands()) {
4144       if (NAryOp->getType()->isPointerTy()) {
4145         // Cannot find the base of an expression with multiple pointer operands.
4146         if (PtrOp)
4147           return V;
4148         PtrOp = NAryOp;
4149       }
4150     }
4151     if (!PtrOp)
4152       return V;
4153     return getPointerBase(PtrOp);
4154   }
4155   return V;
4156 }
4157 
4158 /// Push users of the given Instruction onto the given Worklist.
4159 static void
4160 PushDefUseChildren(Instruction *I,
4161                    SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &Worklist) {
4162   // Push the def-use children onto the Worklist stack.
4163   for (User *U : I->users())
4164     Worklist.push_back(cast<Instruction>(U));
4165 }
4166 
4167 void ScalarEvolution::forgetSymbolicName(Instruction *PN, const SCEV *SymName) {
4168   SmallVector<Instruction *, 16> Worklist;
4169   PushDefUseChildren(PN, Worklist);
4170 
4171   SmallPtrSet<Instruction *, 8> Visited;
4172   Visited.insert(PN);
4173   while (!Worklist.empty()) {
4174     Instruction *I = Worklist.pop_back_val();
4175     if (!Visited.insert(I).second)
4176       continue;
4177 
4178     auto It = ValueExprMap.find_as(static_cast<Value *>(I));
4179     if (It != ValueExprMap.end()) {
4180       const SCEV *Old = It->second;
4181 
4182       // Short-circuit the def-use traversal if the symbolic name
4183       // ceases to appear in expressions.
4184       if (Old != SymName && !hasOperand(Old, SymName))
4185         continue;
4186 
4187       // SCEVUnknown for a PHI either means that it has an unrecognized
4188       // structure, it's a PHI that's in the progress of being computed
4189       // by createNodeForPHI, or it's a single-value PHI. In the first case,
4190       // additional loop trip count information isn't going to change anything.
4191       // In the second case, createNodeForPHI will perform the necessary
4192       // updates on its own when it gets to that point. In the third, we do
4193       // want to forget the SCEVUnknown.
4194       if (!isa<PHINode>(I) ||
4195           !isa<SCEVUnknown>(Old) ||
4196           (I != PN && Old == SymName)) {
4197         eraseValueFromMap(It->first);
4198         forgetMemoizedResults(Old);
4199       }
4200     }
4201 
4202     PushDefUseChildren(I, Worklist);
4203   }
4204 }
4205 
4206 namespace {
4207 
4208 /// Takes SCEV S and Loop L. For each AddRec sub-expression, use its start
4209 /// expression in case its Loop is L. If it is not L then
4210 /// if IgnoreOtherLoops is true then use AddRec itself
4211 /// otherwise rewrite cannot be done.
4212 /// If SCEV contains non-invariant unknown SCEV rewrite cannot be done.
4213 class SCEVInitRewriter : public SCEVRewriteVisitor<SCEVInitRewriter> {
4214 public:
4215   static const SCEV *rewrite(const SCEV *S, const Loop *L, ScalarEvolution &SE,
4216                              bool IgnoreOtherLoops = true) {
4217     SCEVInitRewriter Rewriter(L, SE);
4218     const SCEV *Result = Rewriter.visit(S);
4219     if (Rewriter.hasSeenLoopVariantSCEVUnknown())
4220       return SE.getCouldNotCompute();
4221     return Rewriter.hasSeenOtherLoops() && !IgnoreOtherLoops
4222                ? SE.getCouldNotCompute()
4223                : Result;
4224   }
4225 
4226   const SCEV *visitUnknown(const SCEVUnknown *Expr) {
4227     if (!SE.isLoopInvariant(Expr, L))
4228       SeenLoopVariantSCEVUnknown = true;
4229     return Expr;
4230   }
4231 
4232   const SCEV *visitAddRecExpr(const SCEVAddRecExpr *Expr) {
4233     // Only re-write AddRecExprs for this loop.
4234     if (Expr->getLoop() == L)
4235       return Expr->getStart();
4236     SeenOtherLoops = true;
4237     return Expr;
4238   }
4239 
4240   bool hasSeenLoopVariantSCEVUnknown() { return SeenLoopVariantSCEVUnknown; }
4241 
4242   bool hasSeenOtherLoops() { return SeenOtherLoops; }
4243 
4244 private:
4245   explicit SCEVInitRewriter(const Loop *L, ScalarEvolution &SE)
4246       : SCEVRewriteVisitor(SE), L(L) {}
4247 
4248   const Loop *L;
4249   bool SeenLoopVariantSCEVUnknown = false;
4250   bool SeenOtherLoops = false;
4251 };
4252 
4253 /// Takes SCEV S and Loop L. For each AddRec sub-expression, use its post
4254 /// increment expression in case its Loop is L. If it is not L then
4255 /// use AddRec itself.
4256 /// If SCEV contains non-invariant unknown SCEV rewrite cannot be done.
4257 class SCEVPostIncRewriter : public SCEVRewriteVisitor<SCEVPostIncRewriter> {
4258 public:
4259   static const SCEV *rewrite(const SCEV *S, const Loop *L, ScalarEvolution &SE) {
4260     SCEVPostIncRewriter Rewriter(L, SE);
4261     const SCEV *Result = Rewriter.visit(S);
4262     return Rewriter.hasSeenLoopVariantSCEVUnknown()
4263         ? SE.getCouldNotCompute()
4264         : Result;
4265   }
4266 
4267   const SCEV *visitUnknown(const SCEVUnknown *Expr) {
4268     if (!SE.isLoopInvariant(Expr, L))
4269       SeenLoopVariantSCEVUnknown = true;
4270     return Expr;
4271   }
4272 
4273   const SCEV *visitAddRecExpr(const SCEVAddRecExpr *Expr) {
4274     // Only re-write AddRecExprs for this loop.
4275     if (Expr->getLoop() == L)
4276       return Expr->getPostIncExpr(SE);
4277     SeenOtherLoops = true;
4278     return Expr;
4279   }
4280 
4281   bool hasSeenLoopVariantSCEVUnknown() { return SeenLoopVariantSCEVUnknown; }
4282 
4283   bool hasSeenOtherLoops() { return SeenOtherLoops; }
4284 
4285 private:
4286   explicit SCEVPostIncRewriter(const Loop *L, ScalarEvolution &SE)
4287       : SCEVRewriteVisitor(SE), L(L) {}
4288 
4289   const Loop *L;
4290   bool SeenLoopVariantSCEVUnknown = false;
4291   bool SeenOtherLoops = false;
4292 };
4293 
4294 /// This class evaluates the compare condition by matching it against the
4295 /// condition of loop latch. If there is a match we assume a true value
4296 /// for the condition while building SCEV nodes.
4297 class SCEVBackedgeConditionFolder
4298     : public SCEVRewriteVisitor<SCEVBackedgeConditionFolder> {
4299 public:
4300   static const SCEV *rewrite(const SCEV *S, const Loop *L,
4301                              ScalarEvolution &SE) {
4302     bool IsPosBECond = false;
4303     Value *BECond = nullptr;
4304     if (BasicBlock *Latch = L->getLoopLatch()) {
4305       BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(Latch->getTerminator());
4306       if (BI && BI->isConditional()) {
4307         assert(BI->getSuccessor(0) != BI->getSuccessor(1) &&
4308                "Both outgoing branches should not target same header!");
4309         BECond = BI->getCondition();
4310         IsPosBECond = BI->getSuccessor(0) == L->getHeader();
4311       } else {
4312         return S;
4313       }
4314     }
4315     SCEVBackedgeConditionFolder Rewriter(L, BECond, IsPosBECond, SE);
4316     return Rewriter.visit(S);
4317   }
4318 
4319   const SCEV *visitUnknown(const SCEVUnknown *Expr) {
4320     const SCEV *Result = Expr;
4321     bool InvariantF = SE.isLoopInvariant(Expr, L);
4322 
4323     if (!InvariantF) {
4324       Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(Expr->getValue());
4325       switch (I->getOpcode()) {
4326       case Instruction::Select: {
4327         SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I);
4328         Optional<const SCEV *> Res =
4329             compareWithBackedgeCondition(SI->getCondition());
4330         if (Res.hasValue()) {
4331           bool IsOne = cast<SCEVConstant>(Res.getValue())->getValue()->isOne();
4332           Result = SE.getSCEV(IsOne ? SI->getTrueValue() : SI->getFalseValue());
4333         }
4334         break;
4335       }
4336       default: {
4337         Optional<const SCEV *> Res = compareWithBackedgeCondition(I);
4338         if (Res.hasValue())
4339           Result = Res.getValue();
4340         break;
4341       }
4342       }
4343     }
4344     return Result;
4345   }
4346 
4347 private:
4348   explicit SCEVBackedgeConditionFolder(const Loop *L, Value *BECond,
4349                                        bool IsPosBECond, ScalarEvolution &SE)
4350       : SCEVRewriteVisitor(SE), L(L), BackedgeCond(BECond),
4351         IsPositiveBECond(IsPosBECond) {}
4352 
4353   Optional<const SCEV *> compareWithBackedgeCondition(Value *IC);
4354 
4355   const Loop *L;
4356   /// Loop back condition.
4357   Value *BackedgeCond = nullptr;
4358   /// Set to true if loop back is on positive branch condition.
4359   bool IsPositiveBECond;
4360 };
4361 
4362 Optional<const SCEV *>
4363 SCEVBackedgeConditionFolder::compareWithBackedgeCondition(Value *IC) {
4364 
4365   // If value matches the backedge condition for loop latch,
4366   // then return a constant evolution node based on loopback
4367   // branch taken.
4368   if (BackedgeCond == IC)
4369     return IsPositiveBECond ? SE.getOne(Type::getInt1Ty(SE.getContext()))
4370                             : SE.getZero(Type::getInt1Ty(SE.getContext()));
4371   return None;
4372 }
4373 
4374 class SCEVShiftRewriter : public SCEVRewriteVisitor<SCEVShiftRewriter> {
4375 public:
4376   static const SCEV *rewrite(const SCEV *S, const Loop *L,
4377                              ScalarEvolution &SE) {
4378     SCEVShiftRewriter Rewriter(L, SE);
4379     const SCEV *Result = Rewriter.visit(S);
4380     return Rewriter.isValid() ? Result : SE.getCouldNotCompute();
4381   }
4382 
4383   const SCEV *visitUnknown(const SCEVUnknown *Expr) {
4384     // Only allow AddRecExprs for this loop.
4385     if (!SE.isLoopInvariant(Expr, L))
4386       Valid = false;
4387     return Expr;
4388   }
4389 
4390   const SCEV *visitAddRecExpr(const SCEVAddRecExpr *Expr) {
4391     if (Expr->getLoop() == L && Expr->isAffine())
4392       return SE.getMinusSCEV(Expr, Expr->getStepRecurrence(SE));
4393     Valid = false;
4394     return Expr;
4395   }
4396 
4397   bool isValid() { return Valid; }
4398 
4399 private:
4400   explicit SCEVShiftRewriter(const Loop *L, ScalarEvolution &SE)
4401       : SCEVRewriteVisitor(SE), L(L) {}
4402 
4403   const Loop *L;
4404   bool Valid = true;
4405 };
4406 
4407 } // end anonymous namespace
4408 
4409 SCEV::NoWrapFlags
4410 ScalarEvolution::proveNoWrapViaConstantRanges(const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR) {
4411   if (!AR->isAffine())
4412     return SCEV::FlagAnyWrap;
4413 
4414   using OBO = OverflowingBinaryOperator;
4415 
4416   SCEV::NoWrapFlags Result = SCEV::FlagAnyWrap;
4417 
4418   if (!AR->hasNoSignedWrap()) {
4419     ConstantRange AddRecRange = getSignedRange(AR);
4420     ConstantRange IncRange = getSignedRange(AR->getStepRecurrence(*this));
4421 
4422     auto NSWRegion = ConstantRange::makeGuaranteedNoWrapRegion(
4423         Instruction::Add, IncRange, OBO::NoSignedWrap);
4424     if (NSWRegion.contains(AddRecRange))
4425       Result = ScalarEvolution::setFlags(Result, SCEV::FlagNSW);
4426   }
4427 
4428   if (!AR->hasNoUnsignedWrap()) {
4429     ConstantRange AddRecRange = getUnsignedRange(AR);
4430     ConstantRange IncRange = getUnsignedRange(AR->getStepRecurrence(*this));
4431 
4432     auto NUWRegion = ConstantRange::makeGuaranteedNoWrapRegion(
4433         Instruction::Add, IncRange, OBO::NoUnsignedWrap);
4434     if (NUWRegion.contains(AddRecRange))
4435       Result = ScalarEvolution::setFlags(Result, SCEV::FlagNUW);
4436   }
4437 
4438   return Result;
4439 }
4440 
4441 namespace {
4442 
4443 /// Represents an abstract binary operation.  This may exist as a
4444 /// normal instruction or constant expression, or may have been
4445 /// derived from an expression tree.
4446 struct BinaryOp {
4447   unsigned Opcode;
4448   Value *LHS;
4449   Value *RHS;
4450   bool IsNSW = false;
4451   bool IsNUW = false;
4452 
4453   /// Op is set if this BinaryOp corresponds to a concrete LLVM instruction or
4454   /// constant expression.
4455   Operator *Op = nullptr;
4456 
4457   explicit BinaryOp(Operator *Op)
4458       : Opcode(Op->getOpcode()), LHS(Op->getOperand(0)), RHS(Op->getOperand(1)),
4459         Op(Op) {
4460     if (auto *OBO = dyn_cast<OverflowingBinaryOperator>(Op)) {
4461       IsNSW = OBO->hasNoSignedWrap();
4462       IsNUW = OBO->hasNoUnsignedWrap();
4463     }
4464   }
4465 
4466   explicit BinaryOp(unsigned Opcode, Value *LHS, Value *RHS, bool IsNSW = false,
4467                     bool IsNUW = false)
4468       : Opcode(Opcode), LHS(LHS), RHS(RHS), IsNSW(IsNSW), IsNUW(IsNUW) {}
4469 };
4470 
4471 } // end anonymous namespace
4472 
4473 /// Try to map \p V into a BinaryOp, and return \c None on failure.
4474 static Optional<BinaryOp> MatchBinaryOp(Value *V, DominatorTree &DT) {
4475   auto *Op = dyn_cast<Operator>(V);
4476   if (!Op)
4477     return None;
4478 
4479   // Implementation detail: all the cleverness here should happen without
4480   // creating new SCEV expressions -- our caller knowns tricks to avoid creating
4481   // SCEV expressions when possible, and we should not break that.
4482 
4483   switch (Op->getOpcode()) {
4484   case Instruction::Add:
4485   case Instruction::Sub:
4486   case Instruction::Mul:
4487   case Instruction::UDiv:
4488   case Instruction::URem:
4489   case Instruction::And:
4490   case Instruction::Or:
4491   case Instruction::AShr:
4492   case Instruction::Shl:
4493     return BinaryOp(Op);
4494 
4495   case Instruction::Xor:
4496     if (auto *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op->getOperand(1)))
4497       // If the RHS of the xor is a signmask, then this is just an add.
4498       // Instcombine turns add of signmask into xor as a strength reduction step.
4499       if (RHSC->getValue().isSignMask())
4500         return BinaryOp(Instruction::Add, Op->getOperand(0), Op->getOperand(1));
4501     return BinaryOp(Op);
4502 
4503   case Instruction::LShr:
4504     // Turn logical shift right of a constant into a unsigned divide.
4505     if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op->getOperand(1))) {
4506       uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Op->getType())->getBitWidth();
4507 
4508       // If the shift count is not less than the bitwidth, the result of
4509       // the shift is undefined. Don't try to analyze it, because the
4510       // resolution chosen here may differ from the resolution chosen in
4511       // other parts of the compiler.
4512       if (SA->getValue().ult(BitWidth)) {
4513         Constant *X =
4514             ConstantInt::get(SA->getContext(),
4515                              APInt::getOneBitSet(BitWidth, SA->getZExtValue()));
4516         return BinaryOp(Instruction::UDiv, Op->getOperand(0), X);
4517       }
4518     }
4519     return BinaryOp(Op);
4520 
4521   case Instruction::ExtractValue: {
4522     auto *EVI = cast<ExtractValueInst>(Op);
4523     if (EVI->getNumIndices() != 1 || EVI->getIndices()[0] != 0)
4524       break;
4525 
4526     auto *CI = dyn_cast<CallInst>(EVI->getAggregateOperand());
4527     if (!CI)
4528       break;
4529 
4530     if (auto *F = CI->getCalledFunction())
4531       switch (F->getIntrinsicID()) {
4532       case Intrinsic::sadd_with_overflow:
4533       case Intrinsic::uadd_with_overflow:
4534         if (!isOverflowIntrinsicNoWrap(cast<IntrinsicInst>(CI), DT))
4535           return BinaryOp(Instruction::Add, CI->getArgOperand(0),
4536                           CI->getArgOperand(1));
4537 
4538         // Now that we know that all uses of the arithmetic-result component of
4539         // CI are guarded by the overflow check, we can go ahead and pretend
4540         // that the arithmetic is non-overflowing.
4541         if (F->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::sadd_with_overflow)
4542           return BinaryOp(Instruction::Add, CI->getArgOperand(0),
4543                           CI->getArgOperand(1), /* IsNSW = */ true,
4544                           /* IsNUW = */ false);
4545         else
4546           return BinaryOp(Instruction::Add, CI->getArgOperand(0),
4547                           CI->getArgOperand(1), /* IsNSW = */ false,
4548                           /* IsNUW*/ true);
4549       case Intrinsic::ssub_with_overflow:
4550       case Intrinsic::usub_with_overflow:
4551         if (!isOverflowIntrinsicNoWrap(cast<IntrinsicInst>(CI), DT))
4552           return BinaryOp(Instruction::Sub, CI->getArgOperand(0),
4553                           CI->getArgOperand(1));
4554 
4555         // The same reasoning as sadd/uadd above.
4556         if (F->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::ssub_with_overflow)
4557           return BinaryOp(Instruction::Sub, CI->getArgOperand(0),
4558                           CI->getArgOperand(1), /* IsNSW = */ true,
4559                           /* IsNUW = */ false);
4560         else
4561           return BinaryOp(Instruction::Sub, CI->getArgOperand(0),
4562                           CI->getArgOperand(1), /* IsNSW = */ false,
4563                           /* IsNUW = */ true);
4564       case Intrinsic::smul_with_overflow:
4565       case Intrinsic::umul_with_overflow:
4566         return BinaryOp(Instruction::Mul, CI->getArgOperand(0),
4567                         CI->getArgOperand(1));
4568       default:
4569         break;
4570       }
4571     break;
4572   }
4573 
4574   default:
4575     break;
4576   }
4577 
4578   return None;
4579 }
4580 
4581 /// Helper function to createAddRecFromPHIWithCasts. We have a phi
4582 /// node whose symbolic (unknown) SCEV is \p SymbolicPHI, which is updated via
4583 /// the loop backedge by a SCEVAddExpr, possibly also with a few casts on the
4584 /// way. This function checks if \p Op, an operand of this SCEVAddExpr,
4585 /// follows one of the following patterns:
4586 /// Op == (SExt ix (Trunc iy (%SymbolicPHI) to ix) to iy)
4587 /// Op == (ZExt ix (Trunc iy (%SymbolicPHI) to ix) to iy)
4588 /// If the SCEV expression of \p Op conforms with one of the expected patterns
4589 /// we return the type of the truncation operation, and indicate whether the
4590 /// truncated type should be treated as signed/unsigned by setting
4591 /// \p Signed to true/false, respectively.
4592 static Type *isSimpleCastedPHI(const SCEV *Op, const SCEVUnknown *SymbolicPHI,
4593                                bool &Signed, ScalarEvolution &SE) {
4594   // The case where Op == SymbolicPHI (that is, with no type conversions on
4595   // the way) is handled by the regular add recurrence creating logic and
4596   // would have already been triggered in createAddRecForPHI. Reaching it here
4597   // means that createAddRecFromPHI had failed for this PHI before (e.g.,
4598   // because one of the other operands of the SCEVAddExpr updating this PHI is
4599   // not invariant).
4600   //
4601   // Here we look for the case where Op = (ext(trunc(SymbolicPHI))), and in
4602   // this case predicates that allow us to prove that Op == SymbolicPHI will
4603   // be added.
4604   if (Op == SymbolicPHI)
4605     return nullptr;
4606 
4607   unsigned SourceBits = SE.getTypeSizeInBits(SymbolicPHI->getType());
4608   unsigned NewBits = SE.getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType());
4609   if (SourceBits != NewBits)
4610     return nullptr;
4611 
4612   const SCEVSignExtendExpr *SExt = dyn_cast<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(Op);
4613   const SCEVZeroExtendExpr *ZExt = dyn_cast<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(Op);
4614   if (!SExt && !ZExt)
4615     return nullptr;
4616   const SCEVTruncateExpr *Trunc =
4617       SExt ? dyn_cast<SCEVTruncateExpr>(SExt->getOperand())
4618            : dyn_cast<SCEVTruncateExpr>(ZExt->getOperand());
4619   if (!Trunc)
4620     return nullptr;
4621   const SCEV *X = Trunc->getOperand();
4622   if (X != SymbolicPHI)
4623     return nullptr;
4624   Signed = SExt != nullptr;
4625   return Trunc->getType();
4626 }
4627 
4628 static const Loop *isIntegerLoopHeaderPHI(const PHINode *PN, LoopInfo &LI) {
4629   if (!PN->getType()->isIntegerTy())
4630     return nullptr;
4631   const Loop *L = LI.getLoopFor(PN->getParent());
4632   if (!L || L->getHeader() != PN->getParent())
4633     return nullptr;
4634   return L;
4635 }
4636 
4637 // Analyze \p SymbolicPHI, a SCEV expression of a phi node, and check if the
4638 // computation that updates the phi follows the following pattern:
4639 //   (SExt/ZExt ix (Trunc iy (%SymbolicPHI) to ix) to iy) + InvariantAccum
4640 // which correspond to a phi->trunc->sext/zext->add->phi update chain.
4641 // If so, try to see if it can be rewritten as an AddRecExpr under some
4642 // Predicates. If successful, return them as a pair. Also cache the results
4643 // of the analysis.
4644 //
4645 // Example usage scenario:
4646 //    Say the Rewriter is called for the following SCEV:
4647 //         8 * ((sext i32 (trunc i64 %X to i32) to i64) + %Step)
4648 //    where:
4649 //         %X = phi i64 (%Start, %BEValue)
4650 //    It will visitMul->visitAdd->visitSExt->visitTrunc->visitUnknown(%X),
4651 //    and call this function with %SymbolicPHI = %X.
4652 //
4653 //    The analysis will find that the value coming around the backedge has
4654 //    the following SCEV:
4655 //         BEValue = ((sext i32 (trunc i64 %X to i32) to i64) + %Step)
4656 //    Upon concluding that this matches the desired pattern, the function
4657 //    will return the pair {NewAddRec, SmallPredsVec} where:
4658 //         NewAddRec = {%Start,+,%Step}
4659 //         SmallPredsVec = {P1, P2, P3} as follows:
4660 //           P1(WrapPred): AR: {trunc(%Start),+,(trunc %Step)}<nsw> Flags: <nssw>
4661 //           P2(EqualPred): %Start == (sext i32 (trunc i64 %Start to i32) to i64)
4662 //           P3(EqualPred): %Step == (sext i32 (trunc i64 %Step to i32) to i64)
4663 //    The returned pair means that SymbolicPHI can be rewritten into NewAddRec
4664 //    under the predicates {P1,P2,P3}.
4665 //    This predicated rewrite will be cached in PredicatedSCEVRewrites:
4666 //         PredicatedSCEVRewrites[{%X,L}] = {NewAddRec, {P1,P2,P3)}
4667 //
4668 // TODO's:
4669 //
4670 // 1) Extend the Induction descriptor to also support inductions that involve
4671 //    casts: When needed (namely, when we are called in the context of the
4672 //    vectorizer induction analysis), a Set of cast instructions will be
4673 //    populated by this method, and provided back to isInductionPHI. This is
4674 //    needed to allow the vectorizer to properly record them to be ignored by
4675 //    the cost model and to avoid vectorizing them (otherwise these casts,
4676 //    which are redundant under the runtime overflow checks, will be
4677 //    vectorized, which can be costly).
4678 //
4679 // 2) Support additional induction/PHISCEV patterns: We also want to support
4680 //    inductions where the sext-trunc / zext-trunc operations (partly) occur
4681 //    after the induction update operation (the induction increment):
4682 //
4683 //      (Trunc iy (SExt/ZExt ix (%SymbolicPHI + InvariantAccum) to iy) to ix)
4684 //    which correspond to a phi->add->trunc->sext/zext->phi update chain.
4685 //
4686 //      (Trunc iy ((SExt/ZExt ix (%SymbolicPhi) to iy) + InvariantAccum) to ix)
4687 //    which correspond to a phi->trunc->add->sext/zext->phi update chain.
4688 //
4689 // 3) Outline common code with createAddRecFromPHI to avoid duplication.
4690 Optional<std::pair<const SCEV *, SmallVector<const SCEVPredicate *, 3>>>
4691 ScalarEvolution::createAddRecFromPHIWithCastsImpl(const SCEVUnknown *SymbolicPHI) {
4692   SmallVector<const SCEVPredicate *, 3> Predicates;
4693 
4694   // *** Part1: Analyze if we have a phi-with-cast pattern for which we can
4695   // return an AddRec expression under some predicate.
4696 
4697   auto *PN = cast<PHINode>(SymbolicPHI->getValue());
4698   const Loop *L = isIntegerLoopHeaderPHI(PN, LI);
4699   assert(L && "Expecting an integer loop header phi");
4700 
4701   // The loop may have multiple entrances or multiple exits; we can analyze
4702   // this phi as an addrec if it has a unique entry value and a unique
4703   // backedge value.
4704   Value *BEValueV = nullptr, *StartValueV = nullptr;
4705   for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
4706     Value *V = PN->getIncomingValue(i);
4707     if (L->contains(PN->getIncomingBlock(i))) {
4708       if (!BEValueV) {
4709         BEValueV = V;
4710       } else if (BEValueV != V) {
4711         BEValueV = nullptr;
4712         break;
4713       }
4714     } else if (!StartValueV) {
4715       StartValueV = V;
4716     } else if (StartValueV != V) {
4717       StartValueV = nullptr;
4718       break;
4719     }
4720   }
4721   if (!BEValueV || !StartValueV)
4722     return None;
4723 
4724   const SCEV *BEValue = getSCEV(BEValueV);
4725 
4726   // If the value coming around the backedge is an add with the symbolic
4727   // value we just inserted, possibly with casts that we can ignore under
4728   // an appropriate runtime guard, then we found a simple induction variable!
4729   const auto *Add = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(BEValue);
4730   if (!Add)
4731     return None;
4732 
4733   // If there is a single occurrence of the symbolic value, possibly
4734   // casted, replace it with a recurrence.
4735   unsigned FoundIndex = Add->getNumOperands();
4736   Type *TruncTy = nullptr;
4737   bool Signed;
4738   for (unsigned i = 0, e = Add->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4739     if ((TruncTy =
4740              isSimpleCastedPHI(Add->getOperand(i), SymbolicPHI, Signed, *this)))
4741       if (FoundIndex == e) {
4742         FoundIndex = i;
4743         break;
4744       }
4745 
4746   if (FoundIndex == Add->getNumOperands())
4747     return None;
4748 
4749   // Create an add with everything but the specified operand.
4750   SmallVector<const SCEV *, 8> Ops;
4751   for (unsigned i = 0, e = Add->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4752     if (i != FoundIndex)
4753       Ops.push_back(Add->getOperand(i));
4754   const SCEV *Accum = getAddExpr(Ops);
4755 
4756   // The runtime checks will not be valid if the step amount is
4757   // varying inside the loop.
4758   if (!isLoopInvariant(Accum, L))
4759     return None;
4760 
4761   // *** Part2: Create the predicates
4762 
4763   // Analysis was successful: we have a phi-with-cast pattern for which we
4764   // can return an AddRec expression under the following predicates:
4765   //
4766   // P1: A Wrap predicate that guarantees that Trunc(Start) + i*Trunc(Accum)
4767   //     fits within the truncated type (does not overflow) for i = 0 to n-1.
4768   // P2: An Equal predicate that guarantees that
4769   //     Start = (Ext ix (Trunc iy (Start) to ix) to iy)
4770   // P3: An Equal predicate that guarantees that
4771   //     Accum = (Ext ix (Trunc iy (Accum) to ix) to iy)
4772   //
4773   // As we next prove, the above predicates guarantee that:
4774   //     Start + i*Accum = (Ext ix (Trunc iy ( Start + i*Accum ) to ix) to iy)
4775   //
4776   //
4777   // More formally, we want to prove that:
4778   //     Expr(i+1) = Start + (i+1) * Accum
4779   //               = (Ext ix (Trunc iy (Expr(i)) to ix) to iy) + Accum
4780   //
4781   // Given that:
4782   // 1) Expr(0) = Start
4783   // 2) Expr(1) = Start + Accum
4784   //            = (Ext ix (Trunc iy (Start) to ix) to iy) + Accum :: from P2
4785   // 3) Induction hypothesis (step i):
4786   //    Expr(i) = (Ext ix (Trunc iy (Expr(i-1)) to ix) to iy) + Accum
4787   //
4788   // Proof:
4789   //  Expr(i+1) =
4790   //   = Start + (i+1)*Accum
4791   //   = (Start + i*Accum) + Accum
4792   //   = Expr(i) + Accum
4793   //   = (Ext ix (Trunc iy (Expr(i-1)) to ix) to iy) + Accum + Accum
4794   //                                                             :: from step i
4795   //
4796   //   = (Ext ix (Trunc iy (Start + (i-1)*Accum) to ix) to iy) + Accum + Accum
4797   //
4798   //   = (Ext ix (Trunc iy (Start + (i-1)*Accum) to ix) to iy)
4799   //     + (Ext ix (Trunc iy (Accum) to ix) to iy)
4800   //     + Accum                                                     :: from P3
4801   //
4802   //   = (Ext ix (Trunc iy ((Start + (i-1)*Accum) + Accum) to ix) to iy)
4803   //     + Accum                            :: from P1: Ext(x)+Ext(y)=>Ext(x+y)
4804   //
4805   //   = (Ext ix (Trunc iy (Start + i*Accum) to ix) to iy) + Accum
4806   //   = (Ext ix (Trunc iy (Expr(i)) to ix) to iy) + Accum
4807   //
4808   // By induction, the same applies to all iterations 1<=i<n:
4809   //
4810 
4811   // Create a truncated addrec for which we will add a no overflow check (P1).
4812   const SCEV *StartVal = getSCEV(StartValueV);
4813   const SCEV *PHISCEV =
4814       getAddRecExpr(getTruncateExpr(StartVal, TruncTy),
4815                     getTruncateExpr(Accum, TruncTy), L, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap);
4816 
4817   // PHISCEV can be either a SCEVConstant or a SCEVAddRecExpr.
4818   // ex: If truncated Accum is 0 and StartVal is a constant, then PHISCEV
4819   // will be constant.
4820   //
4821   //  If PHISCEV is a constant, then P1 degenerates into P2 or P3, so we don't
4822   // add P1.
4823   if (const auto *AR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(PHISCEV)) {
4824     SCEVWrapPredicate::IncrementWrapFlags AddedFlags =
4825         Signed ? SCEVWrapPredicate::IncrementNSSW
4826                : SCEVWrapPredicate::IncrementNUSW;
4827     const SCEVPredicate *AddRecPred = getWrapPredicate(AR, AddedFlags);
4828     Predicates.push_back(AddRecPred);
4829   }
4830 
4831   // Create the Equal Predicates P2,P3:
4832 
4833   // It is possible that the predicates P2 and/or P3 are computable at
4834   // compile time due to StartVal and/or Accum being constants.
4835   // If either one is, then we can check that now and escape if either P2
4836   // or P3 is false.
4837 
4838   // Construct the extended SCEV: (Ext ix (Trunc iy (Expr) to ix) to iy)
4839   // for each of StartVal and Accum
4840   auto getExtendedExpr = [&](const SCEV *Expr,
4841                              bool CreateSignExtend) -> const SCEV * {
4842     assert(isLoopInvariant(Expr, L) && "Expr is expected to be invariant");
4843     const SCEV *TruncatedExpr = getTruncateExpr(Expr, TruncTy);
4844     const SCEV *ExtendedExpr =
4845         CreateSignExtend ? getSignExtendExpr(TruncatedExpr, Expr->getType())
4846                          : getZeroExtendExpr(TruncatedExpr, Expr->getType());
4847     return ExtendedExpr;
4848   };
4849 
4850   // Given:
4851   //  ExtendedExpr = (Ext ix (Trunc iy (Expr) to ix) to iy
4852   //               = getExtendedExpr(Expr)
4853   // Determine whether the predicate P: Expr == ExtendedExpr
4854   // is known to be false at compile time
4855   auto PredIsKnownFalse = [&](const SCEV *Expr,
4856                               const SCEV *ExtendedExpr) -> bool {
4857     return Expr != ExtendedExpr &&
4858            isKnownPredicate(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Expr, ExtendedExpr);
4859   };
4860 
4861   const SCEV *StartExtended = getExtendedExpr(StartVal, Signed);
4862   if (PredIsKnownFalse(StartVal, StartExtended)) {
4863     LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "P2 is compile-time false\n";);
4864     return None;
4865   }
4866 
4867   // The Step is always Signed (because the overflow checks are either
4868   // NSSW or NUSW)
4869   const SCEV *AccumExtended = getExtendedExpr(Accum, /*CreateSignExtend=*/true);
4870   if (PredIsKnownFalse(Accum, AccumExtended)) {
4871     LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "P3 is compile-time false\n";);
4872     return None;
4873   }
4874 
4875   auto AppendPredicate = [&](const SCEV *Expr,
4876                              const SCEV *ExtendedExpr) -> void {
4877     if (Expr != ExtendedExpr &&
4878         !isKnownPredicate(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Expr, ExtendedExpr)) {
4879       const SCEVPredicate *Pred = getEqualPredicate(Expr, ExtendedExpr);
4880       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Added Predicate: " << *Pred);
4881       Predicates.push_back(Pred);
4882     }
4883   };
4884 
4885   AppendPredicate(StartVal, StartExtended);
4886   AppendPredicate(Accum, AccumExtended);
4887 
4888   // *** Part3: Predicates are ready. Now go ahead and create the new addrec in
4889   // which the casts had been folded away. The caller can rewrite SymbolicPHI
4890   // into NewAR if it will also add the runtime overflow checks specified in
4891   // Predicates.
4892   auto *NewAR = getAddRecExpr(StartVal, Accum, L, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap);
4893 
4894   std::pair<const SCEV *, SmallVector<const SCEVPredicate *, 3>> PredRewrite =
4895       std::make_pair(NewAR, Predicates);
4896   // Remember the result of the analysis for this SCEV at this locayyytion.
4897   PredicatedSCEVRewrites[{SymbolicPHI, L}] = PredRewrite;
4898   return PredRewrite;
4899 }
4900 
4901 Optional<std::pair<const SCEV *, SmallVector<const SCEVPredicate *, 3>>>
4902 ScalarEvolution::createAddRecFromPHIWithCasts(const SCEVUnknown *SymbolicPHI) {
4903   auto *PN = cast<PHINode>(SymbolicPHI->getValue());
4904   const Loop *L = isIntegerLoopHeaderPHI(PN, LI);
4905   if (!L)
4906     return None;
4907 
4908   // Check to see if we already analyzed this PHI.
4909   auto I = PredicatedSCEVRewrites.find({SymbolicPHI, L});
4910   if (I != PredicatedSCEVRewrites.end()) {
4911     std::pair<const SCEV *, SmallVector<const SCEVPredicate *, 3>> Rewrite =
4912         I->second;
4913     // Analysis was done before and failed to create an AddRec:
4914     if (Rewrite.first == SymbolicPHI)
4915       return None;
4916     // Analysis was done before and succeeded to create an AddRec under
4917     // a predicate:
4918     assert(isa<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Rewrite.first) && "Expected an AddRec");
4919     assert(!(Rewrite.second).empty() && "Expected to find Predicates");
4920     return Rewrite;
4921   }
4922 
4923   Optional<std::pair<const SCEV *, SmallVector<const SCEVPredicate *, 3>>>
4924     Rewrite = createAddRecFromPHIWithCastsImpl(SymbolicPHI);
4925 
4926   // Record in the cache that the analysis failed
4927   if (!Rewrite) {
4928     SmallVector<const SCEVPredicate *, 3> Predicates;
4929     PredicatedSCEVRewrites[{SymbolicPHI, L}] = {SymbolicPHI, Predicates};
4930     return None;
4931   }
4932 
4933   return Rewrite;
4934 }
4935 
4936 // FIXME: This utility is currently required because the Rewriter currently
4937 // does not rewrite this expression:
4938 // {0, +, (sext ix (trunc iy to ix) to iy)}
4939 // into {0, +, %step},
4940 // even when the following Equal predicate exists:
4941 // "%step == (sext ix (trunc iy to ix) to iy)".
4942 bool PredicatedScalarEvolution::areAddRecsEqualWithPreds(
4943     const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR1, const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR2) const {
4944   if (AR1 == AR2)
4945     return true;
4946 
4947   auto areExprsEqual = [&](const SCEV *Expr1, const SCEV *Expr2) -> bool {
4948     if (Expr1 != Expr2 && !Preds.implies(SE.getEqualPredicate(Expr1, Expr2)) &&
4949         !Preds.implies(SE.getEqualPredicate(Expr2, Expr1)))
4950       return false;
4951     return true;
4952   };
4953 
4954   if (!areExprsEqual(AR1->getStart(), AR2->getStart()) ||
4955       !areExprsEqual(AR1->getStepRecurrence(SE), AR2->getStepRecurrence(SE)))
4956     return false;
4957   return true;
4958 }
4959 
4960 /// A helper function for createAddRecFromPHI to handle simple cases.
4961 ///
4962 /// This function tries to find an AddRec expression for the simplest (yet most
4963 /// common) cases: PN = PHI(Start, OP(Self, LoopInvariant)).
4964 /// If it fails, createAddRecFromPHI will use a more general, but slow,
4965 /// technique for finding the AddRec expression.
4966 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::createSimpleAffineAddRec(PHINode *PN,
4967                                                       Value *BEValueV,
4968                                                       Value *StartValueV) {
4969   const Loop *L = LI.getLoopFor(PN->getParent());
4970   assert(L && L->getHeader() == PN->getParent());
4971   assert(BEValueV && StartValueV);
4972 
4973   auto BO = MatchBinaryOp(BEValueV, DT);
4974   if (!BO)
4975     return nullptr;
4976 
4977   if (BO->Opcode != Instruction::Add)
4978     return nullptr;
4979 
4980   const SCEV *Accum = nullptr;
4981   if (BO->LHS == PN && L->isLoopInvariant(BO->RHS))
4982     Accum = getSCEV(BO->RHS);
4983   else if (BO->RHS == PN && L->isLoopInvariant(BO->LHS))
4984     Accum = getSCEV(BO->LHS);
4985 
4986   if (!Accum)
4987     return nullptr;
4988 
4989   SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags = SCEV::FlagAnyWrap;
4990   if (BO->IsNUW)
4991     Flags = setFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNUW);
4992   if (BO->IsNSW)
4993     Flags = setFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNSW);
4994 
4995   const SCEV *StartVal = getSCEV(StartValueV);
4996   const SCEV *PHISCEV = getAddRecExpr(StartVal, Accum, L, Flags);
4997 
4998   ValueExprMap[SCEVCallbackVH(PN, this)] = PHISCEV;
4999 
5000   // We can add Flags to the post-inc expression only if we
5001   // know that it is *undefined behavior* for BEValueV to
5002   // overflow.
5003   if (auto *BEInst = dyn_cast<Instruction>(BEValueV))
5004     if (isLoopInvariant(Accum, L) && isAddRecNeverPoison(BEInst, L))
5005       (void)getAddRecExpr(getAddExpr(StartVal, Accum), Accum, L, Flags);
5006 
5007   return PHISCEV;
5008 }
5009 
5010 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::createAddRecFromPHI(PHINode *PN) {
5011   const Loop *L = LI.getLoopFor(PN->getParent());
5012   if (!L || L->getHeader() != PN->getParent())
5013     return nullptr;
5014 
5015   // The loop may have multiple entrances or multiple exits; we can analyze
5016   // this phi as an addrec if it has a unique entry value and a unique
5017   // backedge value.
5018   Value *BEValueV = nullptr, *StartValueV = nullptr;
5019   for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
5020     Value *V = PN->getIncomingValue(i);
5021     if (L->contains(PN->getIncomingBlock(i))) {
5022       if (!BEValueV) {
5023         BEValueV = V;
5024       } else if (BEValueV != V) {
5025         BEValueV = nullptr;
5026         break;
5027       }
5028     } else if (!StartValueV) {
5029       StartValueV = V;
5030     } else if (StartValueV != V) {
5031       StartValueV = nullptr;
5032       break;
5033     }
5034   }
5035   if (!BEValueV || !StartValueV)
5036     return nullptr;
5037 
5038   assert(ValueExprMap.find_as(PN) == ValueExprMap.end() &&
5039          "PHI node already processed?");
5040 
5041   // First, try to find AddRec expression without creating a fictituos symbolic
5042   // value for PN.
5043   if (auto *S = createSimpleAffineAddRec(PN, BEValueV, StartValueV))
5044     return S;
5045 
5046   // Handle PHI node value symbolically.
5047   const SCEV *SymbolicName = getUnknown(PN);
5048   ValueExprMap.insert({SCEVCallbackVH(PN, this), SymbolicName});
5049 
5050   // Using this symbolic name for the PHI, analyze the value coming around
5051   // the back-edge.
5052   const SCEV *BEValue = getSCEV(BEValueV);
5053 
5054   // NOTE: If BEValue is loop invariant, we know that the PHI node just
5055   // has a special value for the first iteration of the loop.
5056 
5057   // If the value coming around the backedge is an add with the symbolic
5058   // value we just inserted, then we found a simple induction variable!
5059   if (const SCEVAddExpr *Add = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(BEValue)) {
5060     // If there is a single occurrence of the symbolic value, replace it
5061     // with a recurrence.
5062     unsigned FoundIndex = Add->getNumOperands();
5063     for (unsigned i = 0, e = Add->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5064       if (Add->getOperand(i) == SymbolicName)
5065         if (FoundIndex == e) {
5066           FoundIndex = i;
5067           break;
5068         }
5069 
5070     if (FoundIndex != Add->getNumOperands()) {
5071       // Create an add with everything but the specified operand.
5072       SmallVector<const SCEV *, 8> Ops;
5073       for (unsigned i = 0, e = Add->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5074         if (i != FoundIndex)
5075           Ops.push_back(SCEVBackedgeConditionFolder::rewrite(Add->getOperand(i),
5076                                                              L, *this));
5077       const SCEV *Accum = getAddExpr(Ops);
5078 
5079       // This is not a valid addrec if the step amount is varying each
5080       // loop iteration, but is not itself an addrec in this loop.
5081       if (isLoopInvariant(Accum, L) ||
5082           (isa<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Accum) &&
5083            cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Accum)->getLoop() == L)) {
5084         SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags = SCEV::FlagAnyWrap;
5085 
5086         if (auto BO = MatchBinaryOp(BEValueV, DT)) {
5087           if (BO->Opcode == Instruction::Add && BO->LHS == PN) {
5088             if (BO->IsNUW)
5089               Flags = setFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNUW);
5090             if (BO->IsNSW)
5091               Flags = setFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNSW);
5092           }
5093         } else if (GEPOperator *GEP = dyn_cast<GEPOperator>(BEValueV)) {
5094           // If the increment is an inbounds GEP, then we know the address
5095           // space cannot be wrapped around. We cannot make any guarantee
5096           // about signed or unsigned overflow because pointers are
5097           // unsigned but we may have a negative index from the base
5098           // pointer. We can guarantee that no unsigned wrap occurs if the
5099           // indices form a positive value.
5100           if (GEP->isInBounds() && GEP->getOperand(0) == PN) {
5101             Flags = setFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNW);
5102 
5103             const SCEV *Ptr = getSCEV(GEP->getPointerOperand());
5104             if (isKnownPositive(getMinusSCEV(getSCEV(GEP), Ptr)))
5105               Flags = setFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNUW);
5106           }
5107 
5108           // We cannot transfer nuw and nsw flags from subtraction
5109           // operations -- sub nuw X, Y is not the same as add nuw X, -Y
5110           // for instance.
5111         }
5112 
5113         const SCEV *StartVal = getSCEV(StartValueV);
5114         const SCEV *PHISCEV = getAddRecExpr(StartVal, Accum, L, Flags);
5115 
5116         // Okay, for the entire analysis of this edge we assumed the PHI
5117         // to be symbolic.  We now need to go back and purge all of the
5118         // entries for the scalars that use the symbolic expression.
5119         forgetSymbolicName(PN, SymbolicName);
5120         ValueExprMap[SCEVCallbackVH(PN, this)] = PHISCEV;
5121 
5122         // We can add Flags to the post-inc expression only if we
5123         // know that it is *undefined behavior* for BEValueV to
5124         // overflow.
5125         if (auto *BEInst = dyn_cast<Instruction>(BEValueV))
5126           if (isLoopInvariant(Accum, L) && isAddRecNeverPoison(BEInst, L))
5127             (void)getAddRecExpr(getAddExpr(StartVal, Accum), Accum, L, Flags);
5128 
5129         return PHISCEV;
5130       }
5131     }
5132   } else {
5133     // Otherwise, this could be a loop like this:
5134     //     i = 0;  for (j = 1; ..; ++j) { ....  i = j; }
5135     // In this case, j = {1,+,1}  and BEValue is j.
5136     // Because the other in-value of i (0) fits the evolution of BEValue
5137     // i really is an addrec evolution.
5138     //
5139     // We can generalize this saying that i is the shifted value of BEValue
5140     // by one iteration:
5141     //   PHI(f(0), f({1,+,1})) --> f({0,+,1})
5142     const SCEV *Shifted = SCEVShiftRewriter::rewrite(BEValue, L, *this);
5143     const SCEV *Start = SCEVInitRewriter::rewrite(Shifted, L, *this, false);
5144     if (Shifted != getCouldNotCompute() &&
5145         Start != getCouldNotCompute()) {
5146       const SCEV *StartVal = getSCEV(StartValueV);
5147       if (Start == StartVal) {
5148         // Okay, for the entire analysis of this edge we assumed the PHI
5149         // to be symbolic.  We now need to go back and purge all of the
5150         // entries for the scalars that use the symbolic expression.
5151         forgetSymbolicName(PN, SymbolicName);
5152         ValueExprMap[SCEVCallbackVH(PN, this)] = Shifted;
5153         return Shifted;
5154       }
5155     }
5156   }
5157 
5158   // Remove the temporary PHI node SCEV that has been inserted while intending
5159   // to create an AddRecExpr for this PHI node. We can not keep this temporary
5160   // as it will prevent later (possibly simpler) SCEV expressions to be added
5161   // to the ValueExprMap.
5162   eraseValueFromMap(PN);
5163 
5164   return nullptr;
5165 }
5166 
5167 // Checks if the SCEV S is available at BB.  S is considered available at BB
5168 // if S can be materialized at BB without introducing a fault.
5169 static bool IsAvailableOnEntry(const Loop *L, DominatorTree &DT, const SCEV *S,
5170                                BasicBlock *BB) {
5171   struct CheckAvailable {
5172     bool TraversalDone = false;
5173     bool Available = true;
5174 
5175     const Loop *L = nullptr;  // The loop BB is in (can be nullptr)
5176     BasicBlock *BB = nullptr;
5177     DominatorTree &DT;
5178 
5179     CheckAvailable(const Loop *L, BasicBlock *BB, DominatorTree &DT)
5180       : L(L), BB(BB), DT(DT) {}
5181 
5182     bool setUnavailable() {
5183       TraversalDone = true;
5184       Available = false;
5185       return false;
5186     }
5187 
5188     bool follow(const SCEV *S) {
5189       switch (S->getSCEVType()) {
5190       case scConstant: case scTruncate: case scZeroExtend: case scSignExtend:
5191       case scAddExpr: case scMulExpr: case scUMaxExpr: case scSMaxExpr:
5192         // These expressions are available if their operand(s) is/are.
5193         return true;
5194 
5195       case scAddRecExpr: {
5196         // We allow add recurrences that are on the loop BB is in, or some
5197         // outer loop.  This guarantees availability because the value of the
5198         // add recurrence at BB is simply the "current" value of the induction
5199         // variable.  We can relax this in the future; for instance an add
5200         // recurrence on a sibling dominating loop is also available at BB.
5201         const auto *ARLoop = cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(S)->getLoop();
5202         if (L && (ARLoop == L || ARLoop->contains(L)))
5203           return true;
5204 
5205         return setUnavailable();
5206       }
5207 
5208       case scUnknown: {
5209         // For SCEVUnknown, we check for simple dominance.
5210         const auto *SU = cast<SCEVUnknown>(S);
5211         Value *V = SU->getValue();
5212 
5213         if (isa<Argument>(V))
5214           return false;
5215 
5216         if (isa<Instruction>(V) && DT.dominates(cast<Instruction>(V), BB))
5217           return false;
5218 
5219         return setUnavailable();
5220       }
5221 
5222       case scUDivExpr:
5223       case scCouldNotCompute:
5224         // We do not try to smart about these at all.
5225         return setUnavailable();
5226       }
5227       llvm_unreachable("switch should be fully covered!");
5228     }
5229 
5230     bool isDone() { return TraversalDone; }
5231   };
5232 
5233   CheckAvailable CA(L, BB, DT);
5234   SCEVTraversal<CheckAvailable> ST(CA);
5235 
5236   ST.visitAll(S);
5237   return CA.Available;
5238 }
5239 
5240 // Try to match a control flow sequence that branches out at BI and merges back
5241 // at Merge into a "C ? LHS : RHS" select pattern.  Return true on a successful
5242 // match.
5243 static bool BrPHIToSelect(DominatorTree &DT, BranchInst *BI, PHINode *Merge,
5244                           Value *&C, Value *&LHS, Value *&RHS) {
5245   C = BI->getCondition();
5246 
5247   BasicBlockEdge LeftEdge(BI->getParent(), BI->getSuccessor(0));
5248   BasicBlockEdge RightEdge(BI->getParent(), BI->getSuccessor(1));
5249 
5250   if (!LeftEdge.isSingleEdge())
5251     return false;
5252 
5253   assert(RightEdge.isSingleEdge() && "Follows from LeftEdge.isSingleEdge()");
5254 
5255   Use &LeftUse = Merge->getOperandUse(0);
5256   Use &RightUse = Merge->getOperandUse(1);
5257 
5258   if (DT.dominates(LeftEdge, LeftUse) && DT.dominates(RightEdge, RightUse)) {
5259     LHS = LeftUse;
5260     RHS = RightUse;
5261     return true;
5262   }
5263 
5264   if (DT.dominates(LeftEdge, RightUse) && DT.dominates(RightEdge, LeftUse)) {
5265     LHS = RightUse;
5266     RHS = LeftUse;
5267     return true;
5268   }
5269 
5270   return false;
5271 }
5272 
5273 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::createNodeFromSelectLikePHI(PHINode *PN) {
5274   auto IsReachable =
5275       [&](BasicBlock *BB) { return DT.isReachableFromEntry(BB); };
5276   if (PN->getNumIncomingValues() == 2 && all_of(PN->blocks(), IsReachable)) {
5277     const Loop *L = LI.getLoopFor(PN->getParent());
5278 
5279     // We don't want to break LCSSA, even in a SCEV expression tree.
5280     for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
5281       if (LI.getLoopFor(PN->getIncomingBlock(i)) != L)
5282         return nullptr;
5283 
5284     // Try to match
5285     //
5286     //  br %cond, label %left, label %right
5287     // left:
5288     //  br label %merge
5289     // right:
5290     //  br label %merge
5291     // merge:
5292     //  V = phi [ %x, %left ], [ %y, %right ]
5293     //
5294     // as "select %cond, %x, %y"
5295 
5296     BasicBlock *IDom = DT[PN->getParent()]->getIDom()->getBlock();
5297     assert(IDom && "At least the entry block should dominate PN");
5298 
5299     auto *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(IDom->getTerminator());
5300     Value *Cond = nullptr, *LHS = nullptr, *RHS = nullptr;
5301 
5302     if (BI && BI->isConditional() &&
5303         BrPHIToSelect(DT, BI, PN, Cond, LHS, RHS) &&
5304         IsAvailableOnEntry(L, DT, getSCEV(LHS), PN->getParent()) &&
5305         IsAvailableOnEntry(L, DT, getSCEV(RHS), PN->getParent()))
5306       return createNodeForSelectOrPHI(PN, Cond, LHS, RHS);
5307   }
5308 
5309   return nullptr;
5310 }
5311 
5312 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::createNodeForPHI(PHINode *PN) {
5313   if (const SCEV *S = createAddRecFromPHI(PN))
5314     return S;
5315 
5316   if (const SCEV *S = createNodeFromSelectLikePHI(PN))
5317     return S;
5318 
5319   // If the PHI has a single incoming value, follow that value, unless the
5320   // PHI's incoming blocks are in a different loop, in which case doing so
5321   // risks breaking LCSSA form. Instcombine would normally zap these, but
5322   // it doesn't have DominatorTree information, so it may miss cases.
5323   if (Value *V = SimplifyInstruction(PN, {getDataLayout(), &TLI, &DT, &AC}))
5324     if (LI.replacementPreservesLCSSAForm(PN, V))
5325       return getSCEV(V);
5326 
5327   // If it's not a loop phi, we can't handle it yet.
5328   return getUnknown(PN);
5329 }
5330 
5331 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::createNodeForSelectOrPHI(Instruction *I,
5332                                                       Value *Cond,
5333                                                       Value *TrueVal,
5334                                                       Value *FalseVal) {
5335   // Handle "constant" branch or select. This can occur for instance when a
5336   // loop pass transforms an inner loop and moves on to process the outer loop.
5337   if (auto *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Cond))
5338     return getSCEV(CI->isOne() ? TrueVal : FalseVal);
5339 
5340   // Try to match some simple smax or umax patterns.
5341   auto *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Cond);
5342   if (!ICI)
5343     return getUnknown(I);
5344 
5345   Value *LHS = ICI->getOperand(0);
5346   Value *RHS = ICI->getOperand(1);
5347 
5348   switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
5349   case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
5350   case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5351     std::swap(LHS, RHS);
5352     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
5353   case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5354   case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5355     // a >s b ? a+x : b+x  ->  smax(a, b)+x
5356     // a >s b ? b+x : a+x  ->  smin(a, b)+x
5357     if (getTypeSizeInBits(LHS->getType()) <= getTypeSizeInBits(I->getType())) {
5358       const SCEV *LS = getNoopOrSignExtend(getSCEV(LHS), I->getType());
5359       const SCEV *RS = getNoopOrSignExtend(getSCEV(RHS), I->getType());
5360       const SCEV *LA = getSCEV(TrueVal);
5361       const SCEV *RA = getSCEV(FalseVal);
5362       const SCEV *LDiff = getMinusSCEV(LA, LS);
5363       const SCEV *RDiff = getMinusSCEV(RA, RS);
5364       if (LDiff == RDiff)
5365         return getAddExpr(getSMaxExpr(LS, RS), LDiff);
5366       LDiff = getMinusSCEV(LA, RS);
5367       RDiff = getMinusSCEV(RA, LS);
5368       if (LDiff == RDiff)
5369         return getAddExpr(getSMinExpr(LS, RS), LDiff);
5370     }
5371     break;
5372   case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
5373   case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
5374     std::swap(LHS, RHS);
5375     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
5376   case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
5377   case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5378     // a >u b ? a+x : b+x  ->  umax(a, b)+x
5379     // a >u b ? b+x : a+x  ->  umin(a, b)+x
5380     if (getTypeSizeInBits(LHS->getType()) <= getTypeSizeInBits(I->getType())) {
5381       const SCEV *LS = getNoopOrZeroExtend(getSCEV(LHS), I->getType());
5382       const SCEV *RS = getNoopOrZeroExtend(getSCEV(RHS), I->getType());
5383       const SCEV *LA = getSCEV(TrueVal);
5384       const SCEV *RA = getSCEV(FalseVal);
5385       const SCEV *LDiff = getMinusSCEV(LA, LS);
5386       const SCEV *RDiff = getMinusSCEV(RA, RS);
5387       if (LDiff == RDiff)
5388         return getAddExpr(getUMaxExpr(LS, RS), LDiff);
5389       LDiff = getMinusSCEV(LA, RS);
5390       RDiff = getMinusSCEV(RA, LS);
5391       if (LDiff == RDiff)
5392         return getAddExpr(getUMinExpr(LS, RS), LDiff);
5393     }
5394     break;
5395   case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
5396     // n != 0 ? n+x : 1+x  ->  umax(n, 1)+x
5397     if (getTypeSizeInBits(LHS->getType()) <= getTypeSizeInBits(I->getType()) &&
5398         isa<ConstantInt>(RHS) && cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)->isZero()) {
5399       const SCEV *One = getOne(I->getType());
5400       const SCEV *LS = getNoopOrZeroExtend(getSCEV(LHS), I->getType());
5401       const SCEV *LA = getSCEV(TrueVal);
5402       const SCEV *RA = getSCEV(FalseVal);
5403       const SCEV *LDiff = getMinusSCEV(LA, LS);
5404       const SCEV *RDiff = getMinusSCEV(RA, One);
5405       if (LDiff == RDiff)
5406         return getAddExpr(getUMaxExpr(One, LS), LDiff);
5407     }
5408     break;
5409   case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
5410     // n == 0 ? 1+x : n+x  ->  umax(n, 1)+x
5411     if (getTypeSizeInBits(LHS->getType()) <= getTypeSizeInBits(I->getType()) &&
5412         isa<ConstantInt>(RHS) && cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)->isZero()) {
5413       const SCEV *One = getOne(I->getType());
5414       const SCEV *LS = getNoopOrZeroExtend(getSCEV(LHS), I->getType());
5415       const SCEV *LA = getSCEV(TrueVal);
5416       const SCEV *RA = getSCEV(FalseVal);
5417       const SCEV *LDiff = getMinusSCEV(LA, One);
5418       const SCEV *RDiff = getMinusSCEV(RA, LS);
5419       if (LDiff == RDiff)
5420         return getAddExpr(getUMaxExpr(One, LS), LDiff);
5421     }
5422     break;
5423   default:
5424     break;
5425   }
5426 
5427   return getUnknown(I);
5428 }
5429 
5430 /// Expand GEP instructions into add and multiply operations. This allows them
5431 /// to be analyzed by regular SCEV code.
5432 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::createNodeForGEP(GEPOperator *GEP) {
5433   // Don't attempt to analyze GEPs over unsized objects.
5434   if (!GEP->getSourceElementType()->isSized())
5435     return getUnknown(GEP);
5436 
5437   SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> IndexExprs;
5438   for (auto Index = GEP->idx_begin(); Index != GEP->idx_end(); ++Index)
5439     IndexExprs.push_back(getSCEV(*Index));
5440   return getGEPExpr(GEP, IndexExprs);
5441 }
5442 
5443 uint32_t ScalarEvolution::GetMinTrailingZerosImpl(const SCEV *S) {
5444   if (const SCEVConstant *C = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(S))
5445     return C->getAPInt().countTrailingZeros();
5446 
5447   if (const SCEVTruncateExpr *T = dyn_cast<SCEVTruncateExpr>(S))
5448     return std::min(GetMinTrailingZeros(T->getOperand()),
5449                     (uint32_t)getTypeSizeInBits(T->getType()));
5450 
5451   if (const SCEVZeroExtendExpr *E = dyn_cast<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(S)) {
5452     uint32_t OpRes = GetMinTrailingZeros(E->getOperand());
5453     return OpRes == getTypeSizeInBits(E->getOperand()->getType())
5454                ? getTypeSizeInBits(E->getType())
5455                : OpRes;
5456   }
5457 
5458   if (const SCEVSignExtendExpr *E = dyn_cast<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(S)) {
5459     uint32_t OpRes = GetMinTrailingZeros(E->getOperand());
5460     return OpRes == getTypeSizeInBits(E->getOperand()->getType())
5461                ? getTypeSizeInBits(E->getType())
5462                : OpRes;
5463   }
5464 
5465   if (const SCEVAddExpr *A = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(S)) {
5466     // The result is the min of all operands results.
5467     uint32_t MinOpRes = GetMinTrailingZeros(A->getOperand(0));
5468     for (unsigned i = 1, e = A->getNumOperands(); MinOpRes && i != e; ++i)
5469       MinOpRes = std::min(MinOpRes, GetMinTrailingZeros(A->getOperand(i)));
5470     return MinOpRes;
5471   }
5472 
5473   if (const SCEVMulExpr *M = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(S)) {
5474     // The result is the sum of all operands results.
5475     uint32_t SumOpRes = GetMinTrailingZeros(M->getOperand(0));
5476     uint32_t BitWidth = getTypeSizeInBits(M->getType());
5477     for (unsigned i = 1, e = M->getNumOperands();
5478          SumOpRes != BitWidth && i != e; ++i)
5479       SumOpRes =
5480           std::min(SumOpRes + GetMinTrailingZeros(M->getOperand(i)), BitWidth);
5481     return SumOpRes;
5482   }
5483 
5484   if (const SCEVAddRecExpr *A = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(S)) {
5485     // The result is the min of all operands results.
5486     uint32_t MinOpRes = GetMinTrailingZeros(A->getOperand(0));
5487     for (unsigned i = 1, e = A->getNumOperands(); MinOpRes && i != e; ++i)
5488       MinOpRes = std::min(MinOpRes, GetMinTrailingZeros(A->getOperand(i)));
5489     return MinOpRes;
5490   }
5491 
5492   if (const SCEVSMaxExpr *M = dyn_cast<SCEVSMaxExpr>(S)) {
5493     // The result is the min of all operands results.
5494     uint32_t MinOpRes = GetMinTrailingZeros(M->getOperand(0));
5495     for (unsigned i = 1, e = M->getNumOperands(); MinOpRes && i != e; ++i)
5496       MinOpRes = std::min(MinOpRes, GetMinTrailingZeros(M->getOperand(i)));
5497     return MinOpRes;
5498   }
5499 
5500   if (const SCEVUMaxExpr *M = dyn_cast<SCEVUMaxExpr>(S)) {
5501     // The result is the min of all operands results.
5502     uint32_t MinOpRes = GetMinTrailingZeros(M->getOperand(0));
5503     for (unsigned i = 1, e = M->getNumOperands(); MinOpRes && i != e; ++i)
5504       MinOpRes = std::min(MinOpRes, GetMinTrailingZeros(M->getOperand(i)));
5505     return MinOpRes;
5506   }
5507 
5508   if (const SCEVUnknown *U = dyn_cast<SCEVUnknown>(S)) {
5509     // For a SCEVUnknown, ask ValueTracking.
5510     KnownBits Known = computeKnownBits(U->getValue(), getDataLayout(), 0, &AC, nullptr, &DT);
5511     return Known.countMinTrailingZeros();
5512   }
5513 
5514   // SCEVUDivExpr
5515   return 0;
5516 }
5517 
5518 uint32_t ScalarEvolution::GetMinTrailingZeros(const SCEV *S) {
5519   auto I = MinTrailingZerosCache.find(S);
5520   if (I != MinTrailingZerosCache.end())
5521     return I->second;
5522 
5523   uint32_t Result = GetMinTrailingZerosImpl(S);
5524   auto InsertPair = MinTrailingZerosCache.insert({S, Result});
5525   assert(InsertPair.second && "Should insert a new key");
5526   return InsertPair.first->second;
5527 }
5528 
5529 /// Helper method to assign a range to V from metadata present in the IR.
5530 static Optional<ConstantRange> GetRangeFromMetadata(Value *V) {
5531   if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
5532     if (MDNode *MD = I->getMetadata(LLVMContext::MD_range))
5533       return getConstantRangeFromMetadata(*MD);
5534 
5535   return None;
5536 }
5537 
5538 /// Determine the range for a particular SCEV.  If SignHint is
5539 /// HINT_RANGE_UNSIGNED (resp. HINT_RANGE_SIGNED) then getRange prefers ranges
5540 /// with a "cleaner" unsigned (resp. signed) representation.
5541 const ConstantRange &
5542 ScalarEvolution::getRangeRef(const SCEV *S,
5543                              ScalarEvolution::RangeSignHint SignHint) {
5544   DenseMap<const SCEV *, ConstantRange> &Cache =
5545       SignHint == ScalarEvolution::HINT_RANGE_UNSIGNED ? UnsignedRanges
5546                                                        : SignedRanges;
5547 
5548   // See if we've computed this range already.
5549   DenseMap<const SCEV *, ConstantRange>::iterator I = Cache.find(S);
5550   if (I != Cache.end())
5551     return I->second;
5552 
5553   if (const SCEVConstant *C = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(S))
5554     return setRange(C, SignHint, ConstantRange(C->getAPInt()));
5555 
5556   unsigned BitWidth = getTypeSizeInBits(S->getType());
5557   ConstantRange ConservativeResult(BitWidth, /*isFullSet=*/true);
5558 
5559   // If the value has known zeros, the maximum value will have those known zeros
5560   // as well.
5561   uint32_t TZ = GetMinTrailingZeros(S);
5562   if (TZ != 0) {
5563     if (SignHint == ScalarEvolution::HINT_RANGE_UNSIGNED)
5564       ConservativeResult =
5565           ConstantRange(APInt::getMinValue(BitWidth),
5566                         APInt::getMaxValue(BitWidth).lshr(TZ).shl(TZ) + 1);
5567     else
5568       ConservativeResult = ConstantRange(
5569           APInt::getSignedMinValue(BitWidth),
5570           APInt::getSignedMaxValue(BitWidth).ashr(TZ).shl(TZ) + 1);
5571   }
5572 
5573   if (const SCEVAddExpr *Add = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(S)) {
5574     ConstantRange X = getRangeRef(Add->getOperand(0), SignHint);
5575     for (unsigned i = 1, e = Add->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5576       X = X.add(getRangeRef(Add->getOperand(i), SignHint));
5577     return setRange(Add, SignHint, ConservativeResult.intersectWith(X));
5578   }
5579 
5580   if (const SCEVMulExpr *Mul = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(S)) {
5581     ConstantRange X = getRangeRef(Mul->getOperand(0), SignHint);
5582     for (unsigned i = 1, e = Mul->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5583       X = X.multiply(getRangeRef(Mul->getOperand(i), SignHint));
5584     return setRange(Mul, SignHint, ConservativeResult.intersectWith(X));
5585   }
5586 
5587   if (const SCEVSMaxExpr *SMax = dyn_cast<SCEVSMaxExpr>(S)) {
5588     ConstantRange X = getRangeRef(SMax->getOperand(0), SignHint);
5589     for (unsigned i = 1, e = SMax->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5590       X = X.smax(getRangeRef(SMax->getOperand(i), SignHint));
5591     return setRange(SMax, SignHint, ConservativeResult.intersectWith(X));
5592   }
5593 
5594   if (const SCEVUMaxExpr *UMax = dyn_cast<SCEVUMaxExpr>(S)) {
5595     ConstantRange X = getRangeRef(UMax->getOperand(0), SignHint);
5596     for (unsigned i = 1, e = UMax->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5597       X = X.umax(getRangeRef(UMax->getOperand(i), SignHint));
5598     return setRange(UMax, SignHint, ConservativeResult.intersectWith(X));
5599   }
5600 
5601   if (const SCEVUDivExpr *UDiv = dyn_cast<SCEVUDivExpr>(S)) {
5602     ConstantRange X = getRangeRef(UDiv->getLHS(), SignHint);
5603     ConstantRange Y = getRangeRef(UDiv->getRHS(), SignHint);
5604     return setRange(UDiv, SignHint,
5605                     ConservativeResult.intersectWith(X.udiv(Y)));
5606   }
5607 
5608   if (const SCEVZeroExtendExpr *ZExt = dyn_cast<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(S)) {
5609     ConstantRange X = getRangeRef(ZExt->getOperand(), SignHint);
5610     return setRange(ZExt, SignHint,
5611                     ConservativeResult.intersectWith(X.zeroExtend(BitWidth)));
5612   }
5613 
5614   if (const SCEVSignExtendExpr *SExt = dyn_cast<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(S)) {
5615     ConstantRange X = getRangeRef(SExt->getOperand(), SignHint);
5616     return setRange(SExt, SignHint,
5617                     ConservativeResult.intersectWith(X.signExtend(BitWidth)));
5618   }
5619 
5620   if (const SCEVTruncateExpr *Trunc = dyn_cast<SCEVTruncateExpr>(S)) {
5621     ConstantRange X = getRangeRef(Trunc->getOperand(), SignHint);
5622     return setRange(Trunc, SignHint,
5623                     ConservativeResult.intersectWith(X.truncate(BitWidth)));
5624   }
5625 
5626   if (const SCEVAddRecExpr *AddRec = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(S)) {
5627     // If there's no unsigned wrap, the value will never be less than its
5628     // initial value.
5629     if (AddRec->hasNoUnsignedWrap())
5630       if (const SCEVConstant *C = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(AddRec->getStart()))
5631         if (!C->getValue()->isZero())
5632           ConservativeResult = ConservativeResult.intersectWith(
5633               ConstantRange(C->getAPInt(), APInt(BitWidth, 0)));
5634 
5635     // If there's no signed wrap, and all the operands have the same sign or
5636     // zero, the value won't ever change sign.
5637     if (AddRec->hasNoSignedWrap()) {
5638       bool AllNonNeg = true;
5639       bool AllNonPos = true;
5640       for (unsigned i = 0, e = AddRec->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i) {
5641         if (!isKnownNonNegative(AddRec->getOperand(i))) AllNonNeg = false;
5642         if (!isKnownNonPositive(AddRec->getOperand(i))) AllNonPos = false;
5643       }
5644       if (AllNonNeg)
5645         ConservativeResult = ConservativeResult.intersectWith(
5646           ConstantRange(APInt(BitWidth, 0),
5647                         APInt::getSignedMinValue(BitWidth)));
5648       else if (AllNonPos)
5649         ConservativeResult = ConservativeResult.intersectWith(
5650           ConstantRange(APInt::getSignedMinValue(BitWidth),
5651                         APInt(BitWidth, 1)));
5652     }
5653 
5654     // TODO: non-affine addrec
5655     if (AddRec->isAffine()) {
5656       const SCEV *MaxBECount = getMaxBackedgeTakenCount(AddRec->getLoop());
5657       if (!isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(MaxBECount) &&
5658           getTypeSizeInBits(MaxBECount->getType()) <= BitWidth) {
5659         auto RangeFromAffine = getRangeForAffineAR(
5660             AddRec->getStart(), AddRec->getStepRecurrence(*this), MaxBECount,
5661             BitWidth);
5662         if (!RangeFromAffine.isFullSet())
5663           ConservativeResult =
5664               ConservativeResult.intersectWith(RangeFromAffine);
5665 
5666         auto RangeFromFactoring = getRangeViaFactoring(
5667             AddRec->getStart(), AddRec->getStepRecurrence(*this), MaxBECount,
5668             BitWidth);
5669         if (!RangeFromFactoring.isFullSet())
5670           ConservativeResult =
5671               ConservativeResult.intersectWith(RangeFromFactoring);
5672       }
5673     }
5674 
5675     return setRange(AddRec, SignHint, std::move(ConservativeResult));
5676   }
5677 
5678   if (const SCEVUnknown *U = dyn_cast<SCEVUnknown>(S)) {
5679     // Check if the IR explicitly contains !range metadata.
5680     Optional<ConstantRange> MDRange = GetRangeFromMetadata(U->getValue());
5681     if (MDRange.hasValue())
5682       ConservativeResult = ConservativeResult.intersectWith(MDRange.getValue());
5683 
5684     // Split here to avoid paying the compile-time cost of calling both
5685     // computeKnownBits and ComputeNumSignBits.  This restriction can be lifted
5686     // if needed.
5687     const DataLayout &DL = getDataLayout();
5688     if (SignHint == ScalarEvolution::HINT_RANGE_UNSIGNED) {
5689       // For a SCEVUnknown, ask ValueTracking.
5690       KnownBits Known = computeKnownBits(U->getValue(), DL, 0, &AC, nullptr, &DT);
5691       if (Known.One != ~Known.Zero + 1)
5692         ConservativeResult =
5693             ConservativeResult.intersectWith(ConstantRange(Known.One,
5694                                                            ~Known.Zero + 1));
5695     } else {
5696       assert(SignHint == ScalarEvolution::HINT_RANGE_SIGNED &&
5697              "generalize as needed!");
5698       unsigned NS = ComputeNumSignBits(U->getValue(), DL, 0, &AC, nullptr, &DT);
5699       if (NS > 1)
5700         ConservativeResult = ConservativeResult.intersectWith(
5701             ConstantRange(APInt::getSignedMinValue(BitWidth).ashr(NS - 1),
5702                           APInt::getSignedMaxValue(BitWidth).ashr(NS - 1) + 1));
5703     }
5704 
5705     // A range of Phi is a subset of union of all ranges of its input.
5706     if (const PHINode *Phi = dyn_cast<PHINode>(U->getValue())) {
5707       // Make sure that we do not run over cycled Phis.
5708       if (PendingPhiRanges.insert(Phi).second) {
5709         ConstantRange RangeFromOps(BitWidth, /*isFullSet=*/false);
5710         for (auto &Op : Phi->operands()) {
5711           auto OpRange = getRangeRef(getSCEV(Op), SignHint);
5712           RangeFromOps = RangeFromOps.unionWith(OpRange);
5713           // No point to continue if we already have a full set.
5714           if (RangeFromOps.isFullSet())
5715             break;
5716         }
5717         ConservativeResult = ConservativeResult.intersectWith(RangeFromOps);
5718         bool Erased = PendingPhiRanges.erase(Phi);
5719         assert(Erased && "Failed to erase Phi properly?");
5720         (void) Erased;
5721       }
5722     }
5723 
5724     return setRange(U, SignHint, std::move(ConservativeResult));
5725   }
5726 
5727   return setRange(S, SignHint, std::move(ConservativeResult));
5728 }
5729 
5730 // Given a StartRange, Step and MaxBECount for an expression compute a range of
5731 // values that the expression can take. Initially, the expression has a value
5732 // from StartRange and then is changed by Step up to MaxBECount times. Signed
5733 // argument defines if we treat Step as signed or unsigned.
5734 static ConstantRange getRangeForAffineARHelper(APInt Step,
5735                                                const ConstantRange &StartRange,
5736                                                const APInt &MaxBECount,
5737                                                unsigned BitWidth, bool Signed) {
5738   // If either Step or MaxBECount is 0, then the expression won't change, and we
5739   // just need to return the initial range.
5740   if (Step == 0 || MaxBECount == 0)
5741     return StartRange;
5742 
5743   // If we don't know anything about the initial value (i.e. StartRange is
5744   // FullRange), then we don't know anything about the final range either.
5745   // Return FullRange.
5746   if (StartRange.isFullSet())
5747     return ConstantRange(BitWidth, /* isFullSet = */ true);
5748 
5749   // If Step is signed and negative, then we use its absolute value, but we also
5750   // note that we're moving in the opposite direction.
5751   bool Descending = Signed && Step.isNegative();
5752 
5753   if (Signed)
5754     // This is correct even for INT_SMIN. Let's look at i8 to illustrate this:
5755     // abs(INT_SMIN) = abs(-128) = abs(0x80) = -0x80 = 0x80 = 128.
5756     // This equations hold true due to the well-defined wrap-around behavior of
5757     // APInt.
5758     Step = Step.abs();
5759 
5760   // Check if Offset is more than full span of BitWidth. If it is, the
5761   // expression is guaranteed to overflow.
5762   if (APInt::getMaxValue(StartRange.getBitWidth()).udiv(Step).ult(MaxBECount))
5763     return ConstantRange(BitWidth, /* isFullSet = */ true);
5764 
5765   // Offset is by how much the expression can change. Checks above guarantee no
5766   // overflow here.
5767   APInt Offset = Step * MaxBECount;
5768 
5769   // Minimum value of the final range will match the minimal value of StartRange
5770   // if the expression is increasing and will be decreased by Offset otherwise.
5771   // Maximum value of the final range will match the maximal value of StartRange
5772   // if the expression is decreasing and will be increased by Offset otherwise.
5773   APInt StartLower = StartRange.getLower();
5774   APInt StartUpper = StartRange.getUpper() - 1;
5775   APInt MovedBoundary = Descending ? (StartLower - std::move(Offset))
5776                                    : (StartUpper + std::move(Offset));
5777 
5778   // It's possible that the new minimum/maximum value will fall into the initial
5779   // range (due to wrap around). This means that the expression can take any
5780   // value in this bitwidth, and we have to return full range.
5781   if (StartRange.contains(MovedBoundary))
5782     return ConstantRange(BitWidth, /* isFullSet = */ true);
5783 
5784   APInt NewLower =
5785       Descending ? std::move(MovedBoundary) : std::move(StartLower);
5786   APInt NewUpper =
5787       Descending ? std::move(StartUpper) : std::move(MovedBoundary);
5788   NewUpper += 1;
5789 
5790   // If we end up with full range, return a proper full range.
5791   if (NewLower == NewUpper)
5792     return ConstantRange(BitWidth, /* isFullSet = */ true);
5793 
5794   // No overflow detected, return [StartLower, StartUpper + Offset + 1) range.
5795   return ConstantRange(std::move(NewLower), std::move(NewUpper));
5796 }
5797 
5798 ConstantRange ScalarEvolution::getRangeForAffineAR(const SCEV *Start,
5799                                                    const SCEV *Step,
5800                                                    const SCEV *MaxBECount,
5801                                                    unsigned BitWidth) {
5802   assert(!isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(MaxBECount) &&
5803          getTypeSizeInBits(MaxBECount->getType()) <= BitWidth &&
5804          "Precondition!");
5805 
5806   MaxBECount = getNoopOrZeroExtend(MaxBECount, Start->getType());
5807   APInt MaxBECountValue = getUnsignedRangeMax(MaxBECount);
5808 
5809   // First, consider step signed.
5810   ConstantRange StartSRange = getSignedRange(Start);
5811   ConstantRange StepSRange = getSignedRange(Step);
5812 
5813   // If Step can be both positive and negative, we need to find ranges for the
5814   // maximum absolute step values in both directions and union them.
5815   ConstantRange SR =
5816       getRangeForAffineARHelper(StepSRange.getSignedMin(), StartSRange,
5817                                 MaxBECountValue, BitWidth, /* Signed = */ true);
5818   SR = SR.unionWith(getRangeForAffineARHelper(StepSRange.getSignedMax(),
5819                                               StartSRange, MaxBECountValue,
5820                                               BitWidth, /* Signed = */ true));
5821 
5822   // Next, consider step unsigned.
5823   ConstantRange UR = getRangeForAffineARHelper(
5824       getUnsignedRangeMax(Step), getUnsignedRange(Start),
5825       MaxBECountValue, BitWidth, /* Signed = */ false);
5826 
5827   // Finally, intersect signed and unsigned ranges.
5828   return SR.intersectWith(UR);
5829 }
5830 
5831 ConstantRange ScalarEvolution::getRangeViaFactoring(const SCEV *Start,
5832                                                     const SCEV *Step,
5833                                                     const SCEV *MaxBECount,
5834                                                     unsigned BitWidth) {
5835   //    RangeOf({C?A:B,+,C?P:Q}) == RangeOf(C?{A,+,P}:{B,+,Q})
5836   // == RangeOf({A,+,P}) union RangeOf({B,+,Q})
5837 
5838   struct SelectPattern {
5839     Value *Condition = nullptr;
5840     APInt TrueValue;
5841     APInt FalseValue;
5842 
5843     explicit SelectPattern(ScalarEvolution &SE, unsigned BitWidth,
5844                            const SCEV *S) {
5845       Optional<unsigned> CastOp;
5846       APInt Offset(BitWidth, 0);
5847 
5848       assert(SE.getTypeSizeInBits(S->getType()) == BitWidth &&
5849              "Should be!");
5850 
5851       // Peel off a constant offset:
5852       if (auto *SA = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(S)) {
5853         // In the future we could consider being smarter here and handle
5854         // {Start+Step,+,Step} too.
5855         if (SA->getNumOperands() != 2 || !isa<SCEVConstant>(SA->getOperand(0)))
5856           return;
5857 
5858         Offset = cast<SCEVConstant>(SA->getOperand(0))->getAPInt();
5859         S = SA->getOperand(1);
5860       }
5861 
5862       // Peel off a cast operation
5863       if (auto *SCast = dyn_cast<SCEVCastExpr>(S)) {
5864         CastOp = SCast->getSCEVType();
5865         S = SCast->getOperand();
5866       }
5867 
5868       using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
5869 
5870       auto *SU = dyn_cast<SCEVUnknown>(S);
5871       const APInt *TrueVal, *FalseVal;
5872       if (!SU ||
5873           !match(SU->getValue(), m_Select(m_Value(Condition), m_APInt(TrueVal),
5874                                           m_APInt(FalseVal)))) {
5875         Condition = nullptr;
5876         return;
5877       }
5878 
5879       TrueValue = *TrueVal;
5880       FalseValue = *FalseVal;
5881 
5882       // Re-apply the cast we peeled off earlier
5883       if (CastOp.hasValue())
5884         switch (*CastOp) {
5885         default:
5886           llvm_unreachable("Unknown SCEV cast type!");
5887 
5888         case scTruncate:
5889           TrueValue = TrueValue.trunc(BitWidth);
5890           FalseValue = FalseValue.trunc(BitWidth);
5891           break;
5892         case scZeroExtend:
5893           TrueValue = TrueValue.zext(BitWidth);
5894           FalseValue = FalseValue.zext(BitWidth);
5895           break;
5896         case scSignExtend:
5897           TrueValue = TrueValue.sext(BitWidth);
5898           FalseValue = FalseValue.sext(BitWidth);
5899           break;
5900         }
5901 
5902       // Re-apply the constant offset we peeled off earlier
5903       TrueValue += Offset;
5904       FalseValue += Offset;
5905     }
5906 
5907     bool isRecognized() { return Condition != nullptr; }
5908   };
5909 
5910   SelectPattern StartPattern(*this, BitWidth, Start);
5911   if (!StartPattern.isRecognized())
5912     return ConstantRange(BitWidth, /* isFullSet = */ true);
5913 
5914   SelectPattern StepPattern(*this, BitWidth, Step);
5915   if (!StepPattern.isRecognized())
5916     return ConstantRange(BitWidth, /* isFullSet = */ true);
5917 
5918   if (StartPattern.Condition != StepPattern.Condition) {
5919     // We don't handle this case today; but we could, by considering four
5920     // possibilities below instead of two. I'm not sure if there are cases where
5921     // that will help over what getRange already does, though.
5922     return ConstantRange(BitWidth, /* isFullSet = */ true);
5923   }
5924 
5925   // NB! Calling ScalarEvolution::getConstant is fine, but we should not try to
5926   // construct arbitrary general SCEV expressions here.  This function is called
5927   // from deep in the call stack, and calling getSCEV (on a sext instruction,
5928   // say) can end up caching a suboptimal value.
5929 
5930   // FIXME: without the explicit `this` receiver below, MSVC errors out with
5931   // C2352 and C2512 (otherwise it isn't needed).
5932 
5933   const SCEV *TrueStart = this->getConstant(StartPattern.TrueValue);
5934   const SCEV *TrueStep = this->getConstant(StepPattern.TrueValue);
5935   const SCEV *FalseStart = this->getConstant(StartPattern.FalseValue);
5936   const SCEV *FalseStep = this->getConstant(StepPattern.FalseValue);
5937 
5938   ConstantRange TrueRange =
5939       this->getRangeForAffineAR(TrueStart, TrueStep, MaxBECount, BitWidth);
5940   ConstantRange FalseRange =
5941       this->getRangeForAffineAR(FalseStart, FalseStep, MaxBECount, BitWidth);
5942 
5943   return TrueRange.unionWith(FalseRange);
5944 }
5945 
5946 SCEV::NoWrapFlags ScalarEvolution::getNoWrapFlagsFromUB(const Value *V) {
5947   if (isa<ConstantExpr>(V)) return SCEV::FlagAnyWrap;
5948   const BinaryOperator *BinOp = cast<BinaryOperator>(V);
5949 
5950   // Return early if there are no flags to propagate to the SCEV.
5951   SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags = SCEV::FlagAnyWrap;
5952   if (BinOp->hasNoUnsignedWrap())
5953     Flags = ScalarEvolution::setFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNUW);
5954   if (BinOp->hasNoSignedWrap())
5955     Flags = ScalarEvolution::setFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNSW);
5956   if (Flags == SCEV::FlagAnyWrap)
5957     return SCEV::FlagAnyWrap;
5958 
5959   return isSCEVExprNeverPoison(BinOp) ? Flags : SCEV::FlagAnyWrap;
5960 }
5961 
5962 bool ScalarEvolution::isSCEVExprNeverPoison(const Instruction *I) {
5963   // Here we check that I is in the header of the innermost loop containing I,
5964   // since we only deal with instructions in the loop header. The actual loop we
5965   // need to check later will come from an add recurrence, but getting that
5966   // requires computing the SCEV of the operands, which can be expensive. This
5967   // check we can do cheaply to rule out some cases early.
5968   Loop *InnermostContainingLoop = LI.getLoopFor(I->getParent());
5969   if (InnermostContainingLoop == nullptr ||
5970       InnermostContainingLoop->getHeader() != I->getParent())
5971     return false;
5972 
5973   // Only proceed if we can prove that I does not yield poison.
5974   if (!programUndefinedIfFullPoison(I))
5975     return false;
5976 
5977   // At this point we know that if I is executed, then it does not wrap
5978   // according to at least one of NSW or NUW. If I is not executed, then we do
5979   // not know if the calculation that I represents would wrap. Multiple
5980   // instructions can map to the same SCEV. If we apply NSW or NUW from I to
5981   // the SCEV, we must guarantee no wrapping for that SCEV also when it is
5982   // derived from other instructions that map to the same SCEV. We cannot make
5983   // that guarantee for cases where I is not executed. So we need to find the
5984   // loop that I is considered in relation to and prove that I is executed for
5985   // every iteration of that loop. That implies that the value that I
5986   // calculates does not wrap anywhere in the loop, so then we can apply the
5987   // flags to the SCEV.
5988   //
5989   // We check isLoopInvariant to disambiguate in case we are adding recurrences
5990   // from different loops, so that we know which loop to prove that I is
5991   // executed in.
5992   for (unsigned OpIndex = 0; OpIndex < I->getNumOperands(); ++OpIndex) {
5993     // I could be an extractvalue from a call to an overflow intrinsic.
5994     // TODO: We can do better here in some cases.
5995     if (!isSCEVable(I->getOperand(OpIndex)->getType()))
5996       return false;
5997     const SCEV *Op = getSCEV(I->getOperand(OpIndex));
5998     if (auto *AddRec = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Op)) {
5999       bool AllOtherOpsLoopInvariant = true;
6000       for (unsigned OtherOpIndex = 0; OtherOpIndex < I->getNumOperands();
6001            ++OtherOpIndex) {
6002         if (OtherOpIndex != OpIndex) {
6003           const SCEV *OtherOp = getSCEV(I->getOperand(OtherOpIndex));
6004           if (!isLoopInvariant(OtherOp, AddRec->getLoop())) {
6005             AllOtherOpsLoopInvariant = false;
6006             break;
6007           }
6008         }
6009       }
6010       if (AllOtherOpsLoopInvariant &&
6011           isGuaranteedToExecuteForEveryIteration(I, AddRec->getLoop()))
6012         return true;
6013     }
6014   }
6015   return false;
6016 }
6017 
6018 bool ScalarEvolution::isAddRecNeverPoison(const Instruction *I, const Loop *L) {
6019   // If we know that \c I can never be poison period, then that's enough.
6020   if (isSCEVExprNeverPoison(I))
6021     return true;
6022 
6023   // For an add recurrence specifically, we assume that infinite loops without
6024   // side effects are undefined behavior, and then reason as follows:
6025   //
6026   // If the add recurrence is poison in any iteration, it is poison on all
6027   // future iterations (since incrementing poison yields poison). If the result
6028   // of the add recurrence is fed into the loop latch condition and the loop
6029   // does not contain any throws or exiting blocks other than the latch, we now
6030   // have the ability to "choose" whether the backedge is taken or not (by
6031   // choosing a sufficiently evil value for the poison feeding into the branch)
6032   // for every iteration including and after the one in which \p I first became
6033   // poison.  There are two possibilities (let's call the iteration in which \p
6034   // I first became poison as K):
6035   //
6036   //  1. In the set of iterations including and after K, the loop body executes
6037   //     no side effects.  In this case executing the backege an infinte number
6038   //     of times will yield undefined behavior.
6039   //
6040   //  2. In the set of iterations including and after K, the loop body executes
6041   //     at least one side effect.  In this case, that specific instance of side
6042   //     effect is control dependent on poison, which also yields undefined
6043   //     behavior.
6044 
6045   auto *ExitingBB = L->getExitingBlock();
6046   auto *LatchBB = L->getLoopLatch();
6047   if (!ExitingBB || !LatchBB || ExitingBB != LatchBB)
6048     return false;
6049 
6050   SmallPtrSet<const Instruction *, 16> Pushed;
6051   SmallVector<const Instruction *, 8> PoisonStack;
6052 
6053   // We start by assuming \c I, the post-inc add recurrence, is poison.  Only
6054   // things that are known to be fully poison under that assumption go on the
6055   // PoisonStack.
6056   Pushed.insert(I);
6057   PoisonStack.push_back(I);
6058 
6059   bool LatchControlDependentOnPoison = false;
6060   while (!PoisonStack.empty() && !LatchControlDependentOnPoison) {
6061     const Instruction *Poison = PoisonStack.pop_back_val();
6062 
6063     for (auto *PoisonUser : Poison->users()) {
6064       if (propagatesFullPoison(cast<Instruction>(PoisonUser))) {
6065         if (Pushed.insert(cast<Instruction>(PoisonUser)).second)
6066           PoisonStack.push_back(cast<Instruction>(PoisonUser));
6067       } else if (auto *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(PoisonUser)) {
6068         assert(BI->isConditional() && "Only possibility!");
6069         if (BI->getParent() == LatchBB) {
6070           LatchControlDependentOnPoison = true;
6071           break;
6072         }
6073       }
6074     }
6075   }
6076 
6077   return LatchControlDependentOnPoison && loopHasNoAbnormalExits(L);
6078 }
6079 
6080 ScalarEvolution::LoopProperties
6081 ScalarEvolution::getLoopProperties(const Loop *L) {
6082   using LoopProperties = ScalarEvolution::LoopProperties;
6083 
6084   auto Itr = LoopPropertiesCache.find(L);
6085   if (Itr == LoopPropertiesCache.end()) {
6086     auto HasSideEffects = [](Instruction *I) {
6087       if (auto *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(I))
6088         return !SI->isSimple();
6089 
6090       return I->mayHaveSideEffects();
6091     };
6092 
6093     LoopProperties LP = {/* HasNoAbnormalExits */ true,
6094                          /*HasNoSideEffects*/ true};
6095 
6096     for (auto *BB : L->getBlocks())
6097       for (auto &I : *BB) {
6098         if (!isGuaranteedToTransferExecutionToSuccessor(&I))
6099           LP.HasNoAbnormalExits = false;
6100         if (HasSideEffects(&I))
6101           LP.HasNoSideEffects = false;
6102         if (!LP.HasNoAbnormalExits && !LP.HasNoSideEffects)
6103           break; // We're already as pessimistic as we can get.
6104       }
6105 
6106     auto InsertPair = LoopPropertiesCache.insert({L, LP});
6107     assert(InsertPair.second && "We just checked!");
6108     Itr = InsertPair.first;
6109   }
6110 
6111   return Itr->second;
6112 }
6113 
6114 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::createSCEV(Value *V) {
6115   if (!isSCEVable(V->getType()))
6116     return getUnknown(V);
6117 
6118   if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
6119     // Don't attempt to analyze instructions in blocks that aren't
6120     // reachable. Such instructions don't matter, and they aren't required
6121     // to obey basic rules for definitions dominating uses which this
6122     // analysis depends on.
6123     if (!DT.isReachableFromEntry(I->getParent()))
6124       return getUnknown(V);
6125   } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
6126     return getConstant(CI);
6127   else if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(V))
6128     return getZero(V->getType());
6129   else if (GlobalAlias *GA = dyn_cast<GlobalAlias>(V))
6130     return GA->isInterposable() ? getUnknown(V) : getSCEV(GA->getAliasee());
6131   else if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(V))
6132     return getUnknown(V);
6133 
6134   Operator *U = cast<Operator>(V);
6135   if (auto BO = MatchBinaryOp(U, DT)) {
6136     switch (BO->Opcode) {
6137     case Instruction::Add: {
6138       // The simple thing to do would be to just call getSCEV on both operands
6139       // and call getAddExpr with the result. However if we're looking at a
6140       // bunch of things all added together, this can be quite inefficient,
6141       // because it leads to N-1 getAddExpr calls for N ultimate operands.
6142       // Instead, gather up all the operands and make a single getAddExpr call.
6143       // LLVM IR canonical form means we need only traverse the left operands.
6144       SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> AddOps;
6145       do {
6146         if (BO->Op) {
6147           if (auto *OpSCEV = getExistingSCEV(BO->Op)) {
6148             AddOps.push_back(OpSCEV);
6149             break;
6150           }
6151 
6152           // If a NUW or NSW flag can be applied to the SCEV for this
6153           // addition, then compute the SCEV for this addition by itself
6154           // with a separate call to getAddExpr. We need to do that
6155           // instead of pushing the operands of the addition onto AddOps,
6156           // since the flags are only known to apply to this particular
6157           // addition - they may not apply to other additions that can be
6158           // formed with operands from AddOps.
6159           const SCEV *RHS = getSCEV(BO->RHS);
6160           SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags = getNoWrapFlagsFromUB(BO->Op);
6161           if (Flags != SCEV::FlagAnyWrap) {
6162             const SCEV *LHS = getSCEV(BO->LHS);
6163             if (BO->Opcode == Instruction::Sub)
6164               AddOps.push_back(getMinusSCEV(LHS, RHS, Flags));
6165             else
6166               AddOps.push_back(getAddExpr(LHS, RHS, Flags));
6167             break;
6168           }
6169         }
6170 
6171         if (BO->Opcode == Instruction::Sub)
6172           AddOps.push_back(getNegativeSCEV(getSCEV(BO->RHS)));
6173         else
6174           AddOps.push_back(getSCEV(BO->RHS));
6175 
6176         auto NewBO = MatchBinaryOp(BO->LHS, DT);
6177         if (!NewBO || (NewBO->Opcode != Instruction::Add &&
6178                        NewBO->Opcode != Instruction::Sub)) {
6179           AddOps.push_back(getSCEV(BO->LHS));
6180           break;
6181         }
6182         BO = NewBO;
6183       } while (true);
6184 
6185       return getAddExpr(AddOps);
6186     }
6187 
6188     case Instruction::Mul: {
6189       SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> MulOps;
6190       do {
6191         if (BO->Op) {
6192           if (auto *OpSCEV = getExistingSCEV(BO->Op)) {
6193             MulOps.push_back(OpSCEV);
6194             break;
6195           }
6196 
6197           SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags = getNoWrapFlagsFromUB(BO->Op);
6198           if (Flags != SCEV::FlagAnyWrap) {
6199             MulOps.push_back(
6200                 getMulExpr(getSCEV(BO->LHS), getSCEV(BO->RHS), Flags));
6201             break;
6202           }
6203         }
6204 
6205         MulOps.push_back(getSCEV(BO->RHS));
6206         auto NewBO = MatchBinaryOp(BO->LHS, DT);
6207         if (!NewBO || NewBO->Opcode != Instruction::Mul) {
6208           MulOps.push_back(getSCEV(BO->LHS));
6209           break;
6210         }
6211         BO = NewBO;
6212       } while (true);
6213 
6214       return getMulExpr(MulOps);
6215     }
6216     case Instruction::UDiv:
6217       return getUDivExpr(getSCEV(BO->LHS), getSCEV(BO->RHS));
6218     case Instruction::URem:
6219       return getURemExpr(getSCEV(BO->LHS), getSCEV(BO->RHS));
6220     case Instruction::Sub: {
6221       SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags = SCEV::FlagAnyWrap;
6222       if (BO->Op)
6223         Flags = getNoWrapFlagsFromUB(BO->Op);
6224       return getMinusSCEV(getSCEV(BO->LHS), getSCEV(BO->RHS), Flags);
6225     }
6226     case Instruction::And:
6227       // For an expression like x&255 that merely masks off the high bits,
6228       // use zext(trunc(x)) as the SCEV expression.
6229       if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->RHS)) {
6230         if (CI->isZero())
6231           return getSCEV(BO->RHS);
6232         if (CI->isMinusOne())
6233           return getSCEV(BO->LHS);
6234         const APInt &A = CI->getValue();
6235 
6236         // Instcombine's ShrinkDemandedConstant may strip bits out of
6237         // constants, obscuring what would otherwise be a low-bits mask.
6238         // Use computeKnownBits to compute what ShrinkDemandedConstant
6239         // knew about to reconstruct a low-bits mask value.
6240         unsigned LZ = A.countLeadingZeros();
6241         unsigned TZ = A.countTrailingZeros();
6242         unsigned BitWidth = A.getBitWidth();
6243         KnownBits Known(BitWidth);
6244         computeKnownBits(BO->LHS, Known, getDataLayout(),
6245                          0, &AC, nullptr, &DT);
6246 
6247         APInt EffectiveMask =
6248             APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - LZ - TZ).shl(TZ);
6249         if ((LZ != 0 || TZ != 0) && !((~A & ~Known.Zero) & EffectiveMask)) {
6250           const SCEV *MulCount = getConstant(APInt::getOneBitSet(BitWidth, TZ));
6251           const SCEV *LHS = getSCEV(BO->LHS);
6252           const SCEV *ShiftedLHS = nullptr;
6253           if (auto *LHSMul = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(LHS)) {
6254             if (auto *OpC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(LHSMul->getOperand(0))) {
6255               // For an expression like (x * 8) & 8, simplify the multiply.
6256               unsigned MulZeros = OpC->getAPInt().countTrailingZeros();
6257               unsigned GCD = std::min(MulZeros, TZ);
6258               APInt DivAmt = APInt::getOneBitSet(BitWidth, TZ - GCD);
6259               SmallVector<const SCEV*, 4> MulOps;
6260               MulOps.push_back(getConstant(OpC->getAPInt().lshr(GCD)));
6261               MulOps.append(LHSMul->op_begin() + 1, LHSMul->op_end());
6262               auto *NewMul = getMulExpr(MulOps, LHSMul->getNoWrapFlags());
6263               ShiftedLHS = getUDivExpr(NewMul, getConstant(DivAmt));
6264             }
6265           }
6266           if (!ShiftedLHS)
6267             ShiftedLHS = getUDivExpr(LHS, MulCount);
6268           return getMulExpr(
6269               getZeroExtendExpr(
6270                   getTruncateExpr(ShiftedLHS,
6271                       IntegerType::get(getContext(), BitWidth - LZ - TZ)),
6272                   BO->LHS->getType()),
6273               MulCount);
6274         }
6275       }
6276       break;
6277 
6278     case Instruction::Or:
6279       // If the RHS of the Or is a constant, we may have something like:
6280       // X*4+1 which got turned into X*4|1.  Handle this as an Add so loop
6281       // optimizations will transparently handle this case.
6282       //
6283       // In order for this transformation to be safe, the LHS must be of the
6284       // form X*(2^n) and the Or constant must be less than 2^n.
6285       if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->RHS)) {
6286         const SCEV *LHS = getSCEV(BO->LHS);
6287         const APInt &CIVal = CI->getValue();
6288         if (GetMinTrailingZeros(LHS) >=
6289             (CIVal.getBitWidth() - CIVal.countLeadingZeros())) {
6290           // Build a plain add SCEV.
6291           const SCEV *S = getAddExpr(LHS, getSCEV(CI));
6292           // If the LHS of the add was an addrec and it has no-wrap flags,
6293           // transfer the no-wrap flags, since an or won't introduce a wrap.
6294           if (const SCEVAddRecExpr *NewAR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(S)) {
6295             const SCEVAddRecExpr *OldAR = cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(LHS);
6296             const_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr *>(NewAR)->setNoWrapFlags(
6297                 OldAR->getNoWrapFlags());
6298           }
6299           return S;
6300         }
6301       }
6302       break;
6303 
6304     case Instruction::Xor:
6305       if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->RHS)) {
6306         // If the RHS of xor is -1, then this is a not operation.
6307         if (CI->isMinusOne())
6308           return getNotSCEV(getSCEV(BO->LHS));
6309 
6310         // Model xor(and(x, C), C) as and(~x, C), if C is a low-bits mask.
6311         // This is a variant of the check for xor with -1, and it handles
6312         // the case where instcombine has trimmed non-demanded bits out
6313         // of an xor with -1.
6314         if (auto *LBO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(BO->LHS))
6315           if (ConstantInt *LCI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LBO->getOperand(1)))
6316             if (LBO->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
6317                 LCI->getValue() == CI->getValue())
6318               if (const SCEVZeroExtendExpr *Z =
6319                       dyn_cast<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(getSCEV(BO->LHS))) {
6320                 Type *UTy = BO->LHS->getType();
6321                 const SCEV *Z0 = Z->getOperand();
6322                 Type *Z0Ty = Z0->getType();
6323                 unsigned Z0TySize = getTypeSizeInBits(Z0Ty);
6324 
6325                 // If C is a low-bits mask, the zero extend is serving to
6326                 // mask off the high bits. Complement the operand and
6327                 // re-apply the zext.
6328                 if (CI->getValue().isMask(Z0TySize))
6329                   return getZeroExtendExpr(getNotSCEV(Z0), UTy);
6330 
6331                 // If C is a single bit, it may be in the sign-bit position
6332                 // before the zero-extend. In this case, represent the xor
6333                 // using an add, which is equivalent, and re-apply the zext.
6334                 APInt Trunc = CI->getValue().trunc(Z0TySize);
6335                 if (Trunc.zext(getTypeSizeInBits(UTy)) == CI->getValue() &&
6336                     Trunc.isSignMask())
6337                   return getZeroExtendExpr(getAddExpr(Z0, getConstant(Trunc)),
6338                                            UTy);
6339               }
6340       }
6341       break;
6342 
6343     case Instruction::Shl:
6344       // Turn shift left of a constant amount into a multiply.
6345       if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->RHS)) {
6346         uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(SA->getType())->getBitWidth();
6347 
6348         // If the shift count is not less than the bitwidth, the result of
6349         // the shift is undefined. Don't try to analyze it, because the
6350         // resolution chosen here may differ from the resolution chosen in
6351         // other parts of the compiler.
6352         if (SA->getValue().uge(BitWidth))
6353           break;
6354 
6355         // It is currently not resolved how to interpret NSW for left
6356         // shift by BitWidth - 1, so we avoid applying flags in that
6357         // case. Remove this check (or this comment) once the situation
6358         // is resolved. See
6359         // http://lists.llvm.org/pipermail/llvm-dev/2015-April/084195.html
6360         // and http://reviews.llvm.org/D8890 .
6361         auto Flags = SCEV::FlagAnyWrap;
6362         if (BO->Op && SA->getValue().ult(BitWidth - 1))
6363           Flags = getNoWrapFlagsFromUB(BO->Op);
6364 
6365         Constant *X = ConstantInt::get(
6366             getContext(), APInt::getOneBitSet(BitWidth, SA->getZExtValue()));
6367         return getMulExpr(getSCEV(BO->LHS), getSCEV(X), Flags);
6368       }
6369       break;
6370 
6371     case Instruction::AShr: {
6372       // AShr X, C, where C is a constant.
6373       ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->RHS);
6374       if (!CI)
6375         break;
6376 
6377       Type *OuterTy = BO->LHS->getType();
6378       uint64_t BitWidth = getTypeSizeInBits(OuterTy);
6379       // If the shift count is not less than the bitwidth, the result of
6380       // the shift is undefined. Don't try to analyze it, because the
6381       // resolution chosen here may differ from the resolution chosen in
6382       // other parts of the compiler.
6383       if (CI->getValue().uge(BitWidth))
6384         break;
6385 
6386       if (CI->isZero())
6387         return getSCEV(BO->LHS); // shift by zero --> noop
6388 
6389       uint64_t AShrAmt = CI->getZExtValue();
6390       Type *TruncTy = IntegerType::get(getContext(), BitWidth - AShrAmt);
6391 
6392       Operator *L = dyn_cast<Operator>(BO->LHS);
6393       if (L && L->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6394         // X = Shl A, n
6395         // Y = AShr X, m
6396         // Both n and m are constant.
6397 
6398         const SCEV *ShlOp0SCEV = getSCEV(L->getOperand(0));
6399         if (L->getOperand(1) == BO->RHS)
6400           // For a two-shift sext-inreg, i.e. n = m,
6401           // use sext(trunc(x)) as the SCEV expression.
6402           return getSignExtendExpr(
6403               getTruncateExpr(ShlOp0SCEV, TruncTy), OuterTy);
6404 
6405         ConstantInt *ShlAmtCI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(L->getOperand(1));
6406         if (ShlAmtCI && ShlAmtCI->getValue().ult(BitWidth)) {
6407           uint64_t ShlAmt = ShlAmtCI->getZExtValue();
6408           if (ShlAmt > AShrAmt) {
6409             // When n > m, use sext(mul(trunc(x), 2^(n-m)))) as the SCEV
6410             // expression. We already checked that ShlAmt < BitWidth, so
6411             // the multiplier, 1 << (ShlAmt - AShrAmt), fits into TruncTy as
6412             // ShlAmt - AShrAmt < Amt.
6413             APInt Mul = APInt::getOneBitSet(BitWidth - AShrAmt,
6414                                             ShlAmt - AShrAmt);
6415             return getSignExtendExpr(
6416                 getMulExpr(getTruncateExpr(ShlOp0SCEV, TruncTy),
6417                 getConstant(Mul)), OuterTy);
6418           }
6419         }
6420       }
6421       break;
6422     }
6423     }
6424   }
6425 
6426   switch (U->getOpcode()) {
6427   case Instruction::Trunc:
6428     return getTruncateExpr(getSCEV(U->getOperand(0)), U->getType());
6429 
6430   case Instruction::ZExt:
6431     return getZeroExtendExpr(getSCEV(U->getOperand(0)), U->getType());
6432 
6433   case Instruction::SExt:
6434     if (auto BO = MatchBinaryOp(U->getOperand(0), DT)) {
6435       // The NSW flag of a subtract does not always survive the conversion to
6436       // A + (-1)*B.  By pushing sign extension onto its operands we are much
6437       // more likely to preserve NSW and allow later AddRec optimisations.
6438       //
6439       // NOTE: This is effectively duplicating this logic from getSignExtend:
6440       //   sext((A + B + ...)<nsw>) --> (sext(A) + sext(B) + ...)<nsw>
6441       // but by that point the NSW information has potentially been lost.
6442       if (BO->Opcode == Instruction::Sub && BO->IsNSW) {
6443         Type *Ty = U->getType();
6444         auto *V1 = getSignExtendExpr(getSCEV(BO->LHS), Ty);
6445         auto *V2 = getSignExtendExpr(getSCEV(BO->RHS), Ty);
6446         return getMinusSCEV(V1, V2, SCEV::FlagNSW);
6447       }
6448     }
6449     return getSignExtendExpr(getSCEV(U->getOperand(0)), U->getType());
6450 
6451   case Instruction::BitCast:
6452     // BitCasts are no-op casts so we just eliminate the cast.
6453     if (isSCEVable(U->getType()) && isSCEVable(U->getOperand(0)->getType()))
6454       return getSCEV(U->getOperand(0));
6455     break;
6456 
6457   // It's tempting to handle inttoptr and ptrtoint as no-ops, however this can
6458   // lead to pointer expressions which cannot safely be expanded to GEPs,
6459   // because ScalarEvolution doesn't respect the GEP aliasing rules when
6460   // simplifying integer expressions.
6461 
6462   case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
6463     return createNodeForGEP(cast<GEPOperator>(U));
6464 
6465   case Instruction::PHI:
6466     return createNodeForPHI(cast<PHINode>(U));
6467 
6468   case Instruction::Select:
6469     // U can also be a select constant expr, which let fall through.  Since
6470     // createNodeForSelect only works for a condition that is an `ICmpInst`, and
6471     // constant expressions cannot have instructions as operands, we'd have
6472     // returned getUnknown for a select constant expressions anyway.
6473     if (isa<Instruction>(U))
6474       return createNodeForSelectOrPHI(cast<Instruction>(U), U->getOperand(0),
6475                                       U->getOperand(1), U->getOperand(2));
6476     break;
6477 
6478   case Instruction::Call:
6479   case Instruction::Invoke:
6480     if (Value *RV = CallSite(U).getReturnedArgOperand())
6481       return getSCEV(RV);
6482     break;
6483   }
6484 
6485   return getUnknown(V);
6486 }
6487 
6488 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6489 //                   Iteration Count Computation Code
6490 //
6491 
6492 static unsigned getConstantTripCount(const SCEVConstant *ExitCount) {
6493   if (!ExitCount)
6494     return 0;
6495 
6496   ConstantInt *ExitConst = ExitCount->getValue();
6497 
6498   // Guard against huge trip counts.
6499   if (ExitConst->getValue().getActiveBits() > 32)
6500     return 0;
6501 
6502   // In case of integer overflow, this returns 0, which is correct.
6503   return ((unsigned)ExitConst->getZExtValue()) + 1;
6504 }
6505 
6506 unsigned ScalarEvolution::getSmallConstantTripCount(const Loop *L) {
6507   if (BasicBlock *ExitingBB = L->getExitingBlock())
6508     return getSmallConstantTripCount(L, ExitingBB);
6509 
6510   // No trip count information for multiple exits.
6511   return 0;
6512 }
6513 
6514 unsigned ScalarEvolution::getSmallConstantTripCount(const Loop *L,
6515                                                     BasicBlock *ExitingBlock) {
6516   assert(ExitingBlock && "Must pass a non-null exiting block!");
6517   assert(L->isLoopExiting(ExitingBlock) &&
6518          "Exiting block must actually branch out of the loop!");
6519   const SCEVConstant *ExitCount =
6520       dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(getExitCount(L, ExitingBlock));
6521   return getConstantTripCount(ExitCount);
6522 }
6523 
6524 unsigned ScalarEvolution::getSmallConstantMaxTripCount(const Loop *L) {
6525   const auto *MaxExitCount =
6526       dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(getMaxBackedgeTakenCount(L));
6527   return getConstantTripCount(MaxExitCount);
6528 }
6529 
6530 unsigned ScalarEvolution::getSmallConstantTripMultiple(const Loop *L) {
6531   if (BasicBlock *ExitingBB = L->getExitingBlock())
6532     return getSmallConstantTripMultiple(L, ExitingBB);
6533 
6534   // No trip multiple information for multiple exits.
6535   return 0;
6536 }
6537 
6538 /// Returns the largest constant divisor of the trip count of this loop as a
6539 /// normal unsigned value, if possible. This means that the actual trip count is
6540 /// always a multiple of the returned value (don't forget the trip count could
6541 /// very well be zero as well!).
6542 ///
6543 /// Returns 1 if the trip count is unknown or not guaranteed to be the
6544 /// multiple of a constant (which is also the case if the trip count is simply
6545 /// constant, use getSmallConstantTripCount for that case), Will also return 1
6546 /// if the trip count is very large (>= 2^32).
6547 ///
6548 /// As explained in the comments for getSmallConstantTripCount, this assumes
6549 /// that control exits the loop via ExitingBlock.
6550 unsigned
6551 ScalarEvolution::getSmallConstantTripMultiple(const Loop *L,
6552                                               BasicBlock *ExitingBlock) {
6553   assert(ExitingBlock && "Must pass a non-null exiting block!");
6554   assert(L->isLoopExiting(ExitingBlock) &&
6555          "Exiting block must actually branch out of the loop!");
6556   const SCEV *ExitCount = getExitCount(L, ExitingBlock);
6557   if (ExitCount == getCouldNotCompute())
6558     return 1;
6559 
6560   // Get the trip count from the BE count by adding 1.
6561   const SCEV *TCExpr = getAddExpr(ExitCount, getOne(ExitCount->getType()));
6562 
6563   const SCEVConstant *TC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(TCExpr);
6564   if (!TC)
6565     // Attempt to factor more general cases. Returns the greatest power of
6566     // two divisor. If overflow happens, the trip count expression is still
6567     // divisible by the greatest power of 2 divisor returned.
6568     return 1U << std::min((uint32_t)31, GetMinTrailingZeros(TCExpr));
6569 
6570   ConstantInt *Result = TC->getValue();
6571 
6572   // Guard against huge trip counts (this requires checking
6573   // for zero to handle the case where the trip count == -1 and the
6574   // addition wraps).
6575   if (!Result || Result->getValue().getActiveBits() > 32 ||
6576       Result->getValue().getActiveBits() == 0)
6577     return 1;
6578 
6579   return (unsigned)Result->getZExtValue();
6580 }
6581 
6582 /// Get the expression for the number of loop iterations for which this loop is
6583 /// guaranteed not to exit via ExitingBlock. Otherwise return
6584 /// SCEVCouldNotCompute.
6585 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getExitCount(const Loop *L,
6586                                           BasicBlock *ExitingBlock) {
6587   return getBackedgeTakenInfo(L).getExact(ExitingBlock, this);
6588 }
6589 
6590 const SCEV *
6591 ScalarEvolution::getPredicatedBackedgeTakenCount(const Loop *L,
6592                                                  SCEVUnionPredicate &Preds) {
6593   return getPredicatedBackedgeTakenInfo(L).getExact(L, this, &Preds);
6594 }
6595 
6596 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getBackedgeTakenCount(const Loop *L) {
6597   return getBackedgeTakenInfo(L).getExact(L, this);
6598 }
6599 
6600 /// Similar to getBackedgeTakenCount, except return the least SCEV value that is
6601 /// known never to be less than the actual backedge taken count.
6602 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getMaxBackedgeTakenCount(const Loop *L) {
6603   return getBackedgeTakenInfo(L).getMax(this);
6604 }
6605 
6606 bool ScalarEvolution::isBackedgeTakenCountMaxOrZero(const Loop *L) {
6607   return getBackedgeTakenInfo(L).isMaxOrZero(this);
6608 }
6609 
6610 /// Push PHI nodes in the header of the given loop onto the given Worklist.
6611 static void
6612 PushLoopPHIs(const Loop *L, SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &Worklist) {
6613   BasicBlock *Header = L->getHeader();
6614 
6615   // Push all Loop-header PHIs onto the Worklist stack.
6616   for (PHINode &PN : Header->phis())
6617     Worklist.push_back(&PN);
6618 }
6619 
6620 const ScalarEvolution::BackedgeTakenInfo &
6621 ScalarEvolution::getPredicatedBackedgeTakenInfo(const Loop *L) {
6622   auto &BTI = getBackedgeTakenInfo(L);
6623   if (BTI.hasFullInfo())
6624     return BTI;
6625 
6626   auto Pair = PredicatedBackedgeTakenCounts.insert({L, BackedgeTakenInfo()});
6627 
6628   if (!Pair.second)
6629     return Pair.first->second;
6630 
6631   BackedgeTakenInfo Result =
6632       computeBackedgeTakenCount(L, /*AllowPredicates=*/true);
6633 
6634   return PredicatedBackedgeTakenCounts.find(L)->second = std::move(Result);
6635 }
6636 
6637 const ScalarEvolution::BackedgeTakenInfo &
6638 ScalarEvolution::getBackedgeTakenInfo(const Loop *L) {
6639   // Initially insert an invalid entry for this loop. If the insertion
6640   // succeeds, proceed to actually compute a backedge-taken count and
6641   // update the value. The temporary CouldNotCompute value tells SCEV
6642   // code elsewhere that it shouldn't attempt to request a new
6643   // backedge-taken count, which could result in infinite recursion.
6644   std::pair<DenseMap<const Loop *, BackedgeTakenInfo>::iterator, bool> Pair =
6645       BackedgeTakenCounts.insert({L, BackedgeTakenInfo()});
6646   if (!Pair.second)
6647     return Pair.first->second;
6648 
6649   // computeBackedgeTakenCount may allocate memory for its result. Inserting it
6650   // into the BackedgeTakenCounts map transfers ownership. Otherwise, the result
6651   // must be cleared in this scope.
6652   BackedgeTakenInfo Result = computeBackedgeTakenCount(L);
6653 
6654   // In product build, there are no usage of statistic.
6655   (void)NumTripCountsComputed;
6656   (void)NumTripCountsNotComputed;
6657 #if LLVM_ENABLE_STATS || !defined(NDEBUG)
6658   const SCEV *BEExact = Result.getExact(L, this);
6659   if (BEExact != getCouldNotCompute()) {
6660     assert(isLoopInvariant(BEExact, L) &&
6661            isLoopInvariant(Result.getMax(this), L) &&
6662            "Computed backedge-taken count isn't loop invariant for loop!");
6663     ++NumTripCountsComputed;
6664   }
6665   else if (Result.getMax(this) == getCouldNotCompute() &&
6666            isa<PHINode>(L->getHeader()->begin())) {
6667     // Only count loops that have phi nodes as not being computable.
6668     ++NumTripCountsNotComputed;
6669   }
6670 #endif // LLVM_ENABLE_STATS || !defined(NDEBUG)
6671 
6672   // Now that we know more about the trip count for this loop, forget any
6673   // existing SCEV values for PHI nodes in this loop since they are only
6674   // conservative estimates made without the benefit of trip count
6675   // information. This is similar to the code in forgetLoop, except that
6676   // it handles SCEVUnknown PHI nodes specially.
6677   if (Result.hasAnyInfo()) {
6678     SmallVector<Instruction *, 16> Worklist;
6679     PushLoopPHIs(L, Worklist);
6680 
6681     SmallPtrSet<Instruction *, 8> Discovered;
6682     while (!Worklist.empty()) {
6683       Instruction *I = Worklist.pop_back_val();
6684 
6685       ValueExprMapType::iterator It =
6686         ValueExprMap.find_as(static_cast<Value *>(I));
6687       if (It != ValueExprMap.end()) {
6688         const SCEV *Old = It->second;
6689 
6690         // SCEVUnknown for a PHI either means that it has an unrecognized
6691         // structure, or it's a PHI that's in the progress of being computed
6692         // by createNodeForPHI.  In the former case, additional loop trip
6693         // count information isn't going to change anything. In the later
6694         // case, createNodeForPHI will perform the necessary updates on its
6695         // own when it gets to that point.
6696         if (!isa<PHINode>(I) || !isa<SCEVUnknown>(Old)) {
6697           eraseValueFromMap(It->first);
6698           forgetMemoizedResults(Old);
6699         }
6700         if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(I))
6701           ConstantEvolutionLoopExitValue.erase(PN);
6702       }
6703 
6704       // Since we don't need to invalidate anything for correctness and we're
6705       // only invalidating to make SCEV's results more precise, we get to stop
6706       // early to avoid invalidating too much.  This is especially important in
6707       // cases like:
6708       //
6709       //   %v = f(pn0, pn1) // pn0 and pn1 used through some other phi node
6710       // loop0:
6711       //   %pn0 = phi
6712       //   ...
6713       // loop1:
6714       //   %pn1 = phi
6715       //   ...
6716       //
6717       // where both loop0 and loop1's backedge taken count uses the SCEV
6718       // expression for %v.  If we don't have the early stop below then in cases
6719       // like the above, getBackedgeTakenInfo(loop1) will clear out the trip
6720       // count for loop0 and getBackedgeTakenInfo(loop0) will clear out the trip
6721       // count for loop1, effectively nullifying SCEV's trip count cache.
6722       for (auto *U : I->users())
6723         if (auto *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(U)) {
6724           auto *LoopForUser = LI.getLoopFor(I->getParent());
6725           if (LoopForUser && L->contains(LoopForUser) &&
6726               Discovered.insert(I).second)
6727             Worklist.push_back(I);
6728         }
6729     }
6730   }
6731 
6732   // Re-lookup the insert position, since the call to
6733   // computeBackedgeTakenCount above could result in a
6734   // recusive call to getBackedgeTakenInfo (on a different
6735   // loop), which would invalidate the iterator computed
6736   // earlier.
6737   return BackedgeTakenCounts.find(L)->second = std::move(Result);
6738 }
6739 
6740 void ScalarEvolution::forgetLoop(const Loop *L) {
6741   // Drop any stored trip count value.
6742   auto RemoveLoopFromBackedgeMap =
6743       [](DenseMap<const Loop *, BackedgeTakenInfo> &Map, const Loop *L) {
6744         auto BTCPos = Map.find(L);
6745         if (BTCPos != Map.end()) {
6746           BTCPos->second.clear();
6747           Map.erase(BTCPos);
6748         }
6749       };
6750 
6751   SmallVector<const Loop *, 16> LoopWorklist(1, L);
6752   SmallVector<Instruction *, 32> Worklist;
6753   SmallPtrSet<Instruction *, 16> Visited;
6754 
6755   // Iterate over all the loops and sub-loops to drop SCEV information.
6756   while (!LoopWorklist.empty()) {
6757     auto *CurrL = LoopWorklist.pop_back_val();
6758 
6759     RemoveLoopFromBackedgeMap(BackedgeTakenCounts, CurrL);
6760     RemoveLoopFromBackedgeMap(PredicatedBackedgeTakenCounts, CurrL);
6761 
6762     // Drop information about predicated SCEV rewrites for this loop.
6763     for (auto I = PredicatedSCEVRewrites.begin();
6764          I != PredicatedSCEVRewrites.end();) {
6765       std::pair<const SCEV *, const Loop *> Entry = I->first;
6766       if (Entry.second == CurrL)
6767         PredicatedSCEVRewrites.erase(I++);
6768       else
6769         ++I;
6770     }
6771 
6772     auto LoopUsersItr = LoopUsers.find(CurrL);
6773     if (LoopUsersItr != LoopUsers.end()) {
6774       for (auto *S : LoopUsersItr->second)
6775         forgetMemoizedResults(S);
6776       LoopUsers.erase(LoopUsersItr);
6777     }
6778 
6779     // Drop information about expressions based on loop-header PHIs.
6780     PushLoopPHIs(CurrL, Worklist);
6781 
6782     while (!Worklist.empty()) {
6783       Instruction *I = Worklist.pop_back_val();
6784       if (!Visited.insert(I).second)
6785         continue;
6786 
6787       ValueExprMapType::iterator It =
6788           ValueExprMap.find_as(static_cast<Value *>(I));
6789       if (It != ValueExprMap.end()) {
6790         eraseValueFromMap(It->first);
6791         forgetMemoizedResults(It->second);
6792         if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(I))
6793           ConstantEvolutionLoopExitValue.erase(PN);
6794       }
6795 
6796       PushDefUseChildren(I, Worklist);
6797     }
6798 
6799     LoopPropertiesCache.erase(CurrL);
6800     // Forget all contained loops too, to avoid dangling entries in the
6801     // ValuesAtScopes map.
6802     LoopWorklist.append(CurrL->begin(), CurrL->end());
6803   }
6804 }
6805 
6806 void ScalarEvolution::forgetTopmostLoop(const Loop *L) {
6807   while (Loop *Parent = L->getParentLoop())
6808     L = Parent;
6809   forgetLoop(L);
6810 }
6811 
6812 void ScalarEvolution::forgetValue(Value *V) {
6813   Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
6814   if (!I) return;
6815 
6816   // Drop information about expressions based on loop-header PHIs.
6817   SmallVector<Instruction *, 16> Worklist;
6818   Worklist.push_back(I);
6819 
6820   SmallPtrSet<Instruction *, 8> Visited;
6821   while (!Worklist.empty()) {
6822     I = Worklist.pop_back_val();
6823     if (!Visited.insert(I).second)
6824       continue;
6825 
6826     ValueExprMapType::iterator It =
6827       ValueExprMap.find_as(static_cast<Value *>(I));
6828     if (It != ValueExprMap.end()) {
6829       eraseValueFromMap(It->first);
6830       forgetMemoizedResults(It->second);
6831       if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(I))
6832         ConstantEvolutionLoopExitValue.erase(PN);
6833     }
6834 
6835     PushDefUseChildren(I, Worklist);
6836   }
6837 }
6838 
6839 /// Get the exact loop backedge taken count considering all loop exits. A
6840 /// computable result can only be returned for loops with all exiting blocks
6841 /// dominating the latch. howFarToZero assumes that the limit of each loop test
6842 /// is never skipped. This is a valid assumption as long as the loop exits via
6843 /// that test. For precise results, it is the caller's responsibility to specify
6844 /// the relevant loop exiting block using getExact(ExitingBlock, SE).
6845 const SCEV *
6846 ScalarEvolution::BackedgeTakenInfo::getExact(const Loop *L, ScalarEvolution *SE,
6847                                              SCEVUnionPredicate *Preds) const {
6848   // If any exits were not computable, the loop is not computable.
6849   if (!isComplete() || ExitNotTaken.empty())
6850     return SE->getCouldNotCompute();
6851 
6852   const BasicBlock *Latch = L->getLoopLatch();
6853   // All exiting blocks we have collected must dominate the only backedge.
6854   if (!Latch)
6855     return SE->getCouldNotCompute();
6856 
6857   // All exiting blocks we have gathered dominate loop's latch, so exact trip
6858   // count is simply a minimum out of all these calculated exit counts.
6859   SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> Ops;
6860   for (auto &ENT : ExitNotTaken) {
6861     const SCEV *BECount = ENT.ExactNotTaken;
6862     assert(BECount != SE->getCouldNotCompute() && "Bad exit SCEV!");
6863     assert(SE->DT.dominates(ENT.ExitingBlock, Latch) &&
6864            "We should only have known counts for exiting blocks that dominate "
6865            "latch!");
6866 
6867     Ops.push_back(BECount);
6868 
6869     if (Preds && !ENT.hasAlwaysTruePredicate())
6870       Preds->add(ENT.Predicate.get());
6871 
6872     assert((Preds || ENT.hasAlwaysTruePredicate()) &&
6873            "Predicate should be always true!");
6874   }
6875 
6876   return SE->getUMinFromMismatchedTypes(Ops);
6877 }
6878 
6879 /// Get the exact not taken count for this loop exit.
6880 const SCEV *
6881 ScalarEvolution::BackedgeTakenInfo::getExact(BasicBlock *ExitingBlock,
6882                                              ScalarEvolution *SE) const {
6883   for (auto &ENT : ExitNotTaken)
6884     if (ENT.ExitingBlock == ExitingBlock && ENT.hasAlwaysTruePredicate())
6885       return ENT.ExactNotTaken;
6886 
6887   return SE->getCouldNotCompute();
6888 }
6889 
6890 /// getMax - Get the max backedge taken count for the loop.
6891 const SCEV *
6892 ScalarEvolution::BackedgeTakenInfo::getMax(ScalarEvolution *SE) const {
6893   auto PredicateNotAlwaysTrue = [](const ExitNotTakenInfo &ENT) {
6894     return !ENT.hasAlwaysTruePredicate();
6895   };
6896 
6897   if (any_of(ExitNotTaken, PredicateNotAlwaysTrue) || !getMax())
6898     return SE->getCouldNotCompute();
6899 
6900   assert((isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(getMax()) || isa<SCEVConstant>(getMax())) &&
6901          "No point in having a non-constant max backedge taken count!");
6902   return getMax();
6903 }
6904 
6905 bool ScalarEvolution::BackedgeTakenInfo::isMaxOrZero(ScalarEvolution *SE) const {
6906   auto PredicateNotAlwaysTrue = [](const ExitNotTakenInfo &ENT) {
6907     return !ENT.hasAlwaysTruePredicate();
6908   };
6909   return MaxOrZero && !any_of(ExitNotTaken, PredicateNotAlwaysTrue);
6910 }
6911 
6912 bool ScalarEvolution::BackedgeTakenInfo::hasOperand(const SCEV *S,
6913                                                     ScalarEvolution *SE) const {
6914   if (getMax() && getMax() != SE->getCouldNotCompute() &&
6915       SE->hasOperand(getMax(), S))
6916     return true;
6917 
6918   for (auto &ENT : ExitNotTaken)
6919     if (ENT.ExactNotTaken != SE->getCouldNotCompute() &&
6920         SE->hasOperand(ENT.ExactNotTaken, S))
6921       return true;
6922 
6923   return false;
6924 }
6925 
6926 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit::ExitLimit(const SCEV *E)
6927     : ExactNotTaken(E), MaxNotTaken(E) {
6928   assert((isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(MaxNotTaken) ||
6929           isa<SCEVConstant>(MaxNotTaken)) &&
6930          "No point in having a non-constant max backedge taken count!");
6931 }
6932 
6933 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit::ExitLimit(
6934     const SCEV *E, const SCEV *M, bool MaxOrZero,
6935     ArrayRef<const SmallPtrSetImpl<const SCEVPredicate *> *> PredSetList)
6936     : ExactNotTaken(E), MaxNotTaken(M), MaxOrZero(MaxOrZero) {
6937   assert((isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(ExactNotTaken) ||
6938           !isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(MaxNotTaken)) &&
6939          "Exact is not allowed to be less precise than Max");
6940   assert((isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(MaxNotTaken) ||
6941           isa<SCEVConstant>(MaxNotTaken)) &&
6942          "No point in having a non-constant max backedge taken count!");
6943   for (auto *PredSet : PredSetList)
6944     for (auto *P : *PredSet)
6945       addPredicate(P);
6946 }
6947 
6948 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit::ExitLimit(
6949     const SCEV *E, const SCEV *M, bool MaxOrZero,
6950     const SmallPtrSetImpl<const SCEVPredicate *> &PredSet)
6951     : ExitLimit(E, M, MaxOrZero, {&PredSet}) {
6952   assert((isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(MaxNotTaken) ||
6953           isa<SCEVConstant>(MaxNotTaken)) &&
6954          "No point in having a non-constant max backedge taken count!");
6955 }
6956 
6957 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit::ExitLimit(const SCEV *E, const SCEV *M,
6958                                       bool MaxOrZero)
6959     : ExitLimit(E, M, MaxOrZero, None) {
6960   assert((isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(MaxNotTaken) ||
6961           isa<SCEVConstant>(MaxNotTaken)) &&
6962          "No point in having a non-constant max backedge taken count!");
6963 }
6964 
6965 /// Allocate memory for BackedgeTakenInfo and copy the not-taken count of each
6966 /// computable exit into a persistent ExitNotTakenInfo array.
6967 ScalarEvolution::BackedgeTakenInfo::BackedgeTakenInfo(
6968     SmallVectorImpl<ScalarEvolution::BackedgeTakenInfo::EdgeExitInfo>
6969         &&ExitCounts,
6970     bool Complete, const SCEV *MaxCount, bool MaxOrZero)
6971     : MaxAndComplete(MaxCount, Complete), MaxOrZero(MaxOrZero) {
6972   using EdgeExitInfo = ScalarEvolution::BackedgeTakenInfo::EdgeExitInfo;
6973 
6974   ExitNotTaken.reserve(ExitCounts.size());
6975   std::transform(
6976       ExitCounts.begin(), ExitCounts.end(), std::back_inserter(ExitNotTaken),
6977       [&](const EdgeExitInfo &EEI) {
6978         BasicBlock *ExitBB = EEI.first;
6979         const ExitLimit &EL = EEI.second;
6980         if (EL.Predicates.empty())
6981           return ExitNotTakenInfo(ExitBB, EL.ExactNotTaken, nullptr);
6982 
6983         std::unique_ptr<SCEVUnionPredicate> Predicate(new SCEVUnionPredicate);
6984         for (auto *Pred : EL.Predicates)
6985           Predicate->add(Pred);
6986 
6987         return ExitNotTakenInfo(ExitBB, EL.ExactNotTaken, std::move(Predicate));
6988       });
6989   assert((isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(MaxCount) || isa<SCEVConstant>(MaxCount)) &&
6990          "No point in having a non-constant max backedge taken count!");
6991 }
6992 
6993 /// Invalidate this result and free the ExitNotTakenInfo array.
6994 void ScalarEvolution::BackedgeTakenInfo::clear() {
6995   ExitNotTaken.clear();
6996 }
6997 
6998 /// Compute the number of times the backedge of the specified loop will execute.
6999 ScalarEvolution::BackedgeTakenInfo
7000 ScalarEvolution::computeBackedgeTakenCount(const Loop *L,
7001                                            bool AllowPredicates) {
7002   SmallVector<BasicBlock *, 8> ExitingBlocks;
7003   L->getExitingBlocks(ExitingBlocks);
7004 
7005   using EdgeExitInfo = ScalarEvolution::BackedgeTakenInfo::EdgeExitInfo;
7006 
7007   SmallVector<EdgeExitInfo, 4> ExitCounts;
7008   bool CouldComputeBECount = true;
7009   BasicBlock *Latch = L->getLoopLatch(); // may be NULL.
7010   const SCEV *MustExitMaxBECount = nullptr;
7011   const SCEV *MayExitMaxBECount = nullptr;
7012   bool MustExitMaxOrZero = false;
7013 
7014   // Compute the ExitLimit for each loop exit. Use this to populate ExitCounts
7015   // and compute maxBECount.
7016   // Do a union of all the predicates here.
7017   for (unsigned i = 0, e = ExitingBlocks.size(); i != e; ++i) {
7018     BasicBlock *ExitBB = ExitingBlocks[i];
7019     ExitLimit EL = computeExitLimit(L, ExitBB, AllowPredicates);
7020 
7021     assert((AllowPredicates || EL.Predicates.empty()) &&
7022            "Predicated exit limit when predicates are not allowed!");
7023 
7024     // 1. For each exit that can be computed, add an entry to ExitCounts.
7025     // CouldComputeBECount is true only if all exits can be computed.
7026     if (EL.ExactNotTaken == getCouldNotCompute())
7027       // We couldn't compute an exact value for this exit, so
7028       // we won't be able to compute an exact value for the loop.
7029       CouldComputeBECount = false;
7030     else
7031       ExitCounts.emplace_back(ExitBB, EL);
7032 
7033     // 2. Derive the loop's MaxBECount from each exit's max number of
7034     // non-exiting iterations. Partition the loop exits into two kinds:
7035     // LoopMustExits and LoopMayExits.
7036     //
7037     // If the exit dominates the loop latch, it is a LoopMustExit otherwise it
7038     // is a LoopMayExit.  If any computable LoopMustExit is found, then
7039     // MaxBECount is the minimum EL.MaxNotTaken of computable
7040     // LoopMustExits. Otherwise, MaxBECount is conservatively the maximum
7041     // EL.MaxNotTaken, where CouldNotCompute is considered greater than any
7042     // computable EL.MaxNotTaken.
7043     if (EL.MaxNotTaken != getCouldNotCompute() && Latch &&
7044         DT.dominates(ExitBB, Latch)) {
7045       if (!MustExitMaxBECount) {
7046         MustExitMaxBECount = EL.MaxNotTaken;
7047         MustExitMaxOrZero = EL.MaxOrZero;
7048       } else {
7049         MustExitMaxBECount =
7050             getUMinFromMismatchedTypes(MustExitMaxBECount, EL.MaxNotTaken);
7051       }
7052     } else if (MayExitMaxBECount != getCouldNotCompute()) {
7053       if (!MayExitMaxBECount || EL.MaxNotTaken == getCouldNotCompute())
7054         MayExitMaxBECount = EL.MaxNotTaken;
7055       else {
7056         MayExitMaxBECount =
7057             getUMaxFromMismatchedTypes(MayExitMaxBECount, EL.MaxNotTaken);
7058       }
7059     }
7060   }
7061   const SCEV *MaxBECount = MustExitMaxBECount ? MustExitMaxBECount :
7062     (MayExitMaxBECount ? MayExitMaxBECount : getCouldNotCompute());
7063   // The loop backedge will be taken the maximum or zero times if there's
7064   // a single exit that must be taken the maximum or zero times.
7065   bool MaxOrZero = (MustExitMaxOrZero && ExitingBlocks.size() == 1);
7066   return BackedgeTakenInfo(std::move(ExitCounts), CouldComputeBECount,
7067                            MaxBECount, MaxOrZero);
7068 }
7069 
7070 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit
7071 ScalarEvolution::computeExitLimit(const Loop *L, BasicBlock *ExitingBlock,
7072                                       bool AllowPredicates) {
7073   assert(L->contains(ExitingBlock) && "Exit count for non-loop block?");
7074   // If our exiting block does not dominate the latch, then its connection with
7075   // loop's exit limit may be far from trivial.
7076   const BasicBlock *Latch = L->getLoopLatch();
7077   if (!Latch || !DT.dominates(ExitingBlock, Latch))
7078     return getCouldNotCompute();
7079 
7080   bool IsOnlyExit = (L->getExitingBlock() != nullptr);
7081   Instruction *Term = ExitingBlock->getTerminator();
7082   if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(Term)) {
7083     assert(BI->isConditional() && "If unconditional, it can't be in loop!");
7084     bool ExitIfTrue = !L->contains(BI->getSuccessor(0));
7085     assert(ExitIfTrue == L->contains(BI->getSuccessor(1)) &&
7086            "It should have one successor in loop and one exit block!");
7087     // Proceed to the next level to examine the exit condition expression.
7088     return computeExitLimitFromCond(
7089         L, BI->getCondition(), ExitIfTrue,
7090         /*ControlsExit=*/IsOnlyExit, AllowPredicates);
7091   }
7092 
7093   if (SwitchInst *SI = dyn_cast<SwitchInst>(Term)) {
7094     // For switch, make sure that there is a single exit from the loop.
7095     BasicBlock *Exit = nullptr;
7096     for (auto *SBB : successors(ExitingBlock))
7097       if (!L->contains(SBB)) {
7098         if (Exit) // Multiple exit successors.
7099           return getCouldNotCompute();
7100         Exit = SBB;
7101       }
7102     assert(Exit && "Exiting block must have at least one exit");
7103     return computeExitLimitFromSingleExitSwitch(L, SI, Exit,
7104                                                 /*ControlsExit=*/IsOnlyExit);
7105   }
7106 
7107   return getCouldNotCompute();
7108 }
7109 
7110 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit ScalarEvolution::computeExitLimitFromCond(
7111     const Loop *L, Value *ExitCond, bool ExitIfTrue,
7112     bool ControlsExit, bool AllowPredicates) {
7113   ScalarEvolution::ExitLimitCacheTy Cache(L, ExitIfTrue, AllowPredicates);
7114   return computeExitLimitFromCondCached(Cache, L, ExitCond, ExitIfTrue,
7115                                         ControlsExit, AllowPredicates);
7116 }
7117 
7118 Optional<ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit>
7119 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimitCache::find(const Loop *L, Value *ExitCond,
7120                                       bool ExitIfTrue, bool ControlsExit,
7121                                       bool AllowPredicates) {
7122   (void)this->L;
7123   (void)this->ExitIfTrue;
7124   (void)this->AllowPredicates;
7125 
7126   assert(this->L == L && this->ExitIfTrue == ExitIfTrue &&
7127          this->AllowPredicates == AllowPredicates &&
7128          "Variance in assumed invariant key components!");
7129   auto Itr = TripCountMap.find({ExitCond, ControlsExit});
7130   if (Itr == TripCountMap.end())
7131     return None;
7132   return Itr->second;
7133 }
7134 
7135 void ScalarEvolution::ExitLimitCache::insert(const Loop *L, Value *ExitCond,
7136                                              bool ExitIfTrue,
7137                                              bool ControlsExit,
7138                                              bool AllowPredicates,
7139                                              const ExitLimit &EL) {
7140   assert(this->L == L && this->ExitIfTrue == ExitIfTrue &&
7141          this->AllowPredicates == AllowPredicates &&
7142          "Variance in assumed invariant key components!");
7143 
7144   auto InsertResult = TripCountMap.insert({{ExitCond, ControlsExit}, EL});
7145   assert(InsertResult.second && "Expected successful insertion!");
7146   (void)InsertResult;
7147   (void)ExitIfTrue;
7148 }
7149 
7150 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit ScalarEvolution::computeExitLimitFromCondCached(
7151     ExitLimitCacheTy &Cache, const Loop *L, Value *ExitCond, bool ExitIfTrue,
7152     bool ControlsExit, bool AllowPredicates) {
7153 
7154   if (auto MaybeEL =
7155           Cache.find(L, ExitCond, ExitIfTrue, ControlsExit, AllowPredicates))
7156     return *MaybeEL;
7157 
7158   ExitLimit EL = computeExitLimitFromCondImpl(Cache, L, ExitCond, ExitIfTrue,
7159                                               ControlsExit, AllowPredicates);
7160   Cache.insert(L, ExitCond, ExitIfTrue, ControlsExit, AllowPredicates, EL);
7161   return EL;
7162 }
7163 
7164 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit ScalarEvolution::computeExitLimitFromCondImpl(
7165     ExitLimitCacheTy &Cache, const Loop *L, Value *ExitCond, bool ExitIfTrue,
7166     bool ControlsExit, bool AllowPredicates) {
7167   // Check if the controlling expression for this loop is an And or Or.
7168   if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(ExitCond)) {
7169     if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
7170       // Recurse on the operands of the and.
7171       bool EitherMayExit = !ExitIfTrue;
7172       ExitLimit EL0 = computeExitLimitFromCondCached(
7173           Cache, L, BO->getOperand(0), ExitIfTrue,
7174           ControlsExit && !EitherMayExit, AllowPredicates);
7175       ExitLimit EL1 = computeExitLimitFromCondCached(
7176           Cache, L, BO->getOperand(1), ExitIfTrue,
7177           ControlsExit && !EitherMayExit, AllowPredicates);
7178       const SCEV *BECount = getCouldNotCompute();
7179       const SCEV *MaxBECount = getCouldNotCompute();
7180       if (EitherMayExit) {
7181         // Both conditions must be true for the loop to continue executing.
7182         // Choose the less conservative count.
7183         if (EL0.ExactNotTaken == getCouldNotCompute() ||
7184             EL1.ExactNotTaken == getCouldNotCompute())
7185           BECount = getCouldNotCompute();
7186         else
7187           BECount =
7188               getUMinFromMismatchedTypes(EL0.ExactNotTaken, EL1.ExactNotTaken);
7189         if (EL0.MaxNotTaken == getCouldNotCompute())
7190           MaxBECount = EL1.MaxNotTaken;
7191         else if (EL1.MaxNotTaken == getCouldNotCompute())
7192           MaxBECount = EL0.MaxNotTaken;
7193         else
7194           MaxBECount =
7195               getUMinFromMismatchedTypes(EL0.MaxNotTaken, EL1.MaxNotTaken);
7196       } else {
7197         // Both conditions must be true at the same time for the loop to exit.
7198         // For now, be conservative.
7199         if (EL0.MaxNotTaken == EL1.MaxNotTaken)
7200           MaxBECount = EL0.MaxNotTaken;
7201         if (EL0.ExactNotTaken == EL1.ExactNotTaken)
7202           BECount = EL0.ExactNotTaken;
7203       }
7204 
7205       // There are cases (e.g. PR26207) where computeExitLimitFromCond is able
7206       // to be more aggressive when computing BECount than when computing
7207       // MaxBECount.  In these cases it is possible for EL0.ExactNotTaken and
7208       // EL1.ExactNotTaken to match, but for EL0.MaxNotTaken and EL1.MaxNotTaken
7209       // to not.
7210       if (isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(MaxBECount) &&
7211           !isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(BECount))
7212         MaxBECount = getConstant(getUnsignedRangeMax(BECount));
7213 
7214       return ExitLimit(BECount, MaxBECount, false,
7215                        {&EL0.Predicates, &EL1.Predicates});
7216     }
7217     if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
7218       // Recurse on the operands of the or.
7219       bool EitherMayExit = ExitIfTrue;
7220       ExitLimit EL0 = computeExitLimitFromCondCached(
7221           Cache, L, BO->getOperand(0), ExitIfTrue,
7222           ControlsExit && !EitherMayExit, AllowPredicates);
7223       ExitLimit EL1 = computeExitLimitFromCondCached(
7224           Cache, L, BO->getOperand(1), ExitIfTrue,
7225           ControlsExit && !EitherMayExit, AllowPredicates);
7226       const SCEV *BECount = getCouldNotCompute();
7227       const SCEV *MaxBECount = getCouldNotCompute();
7228       if (EitherMayExit) {
7229         // Both conditions must be false for the loop to continue executing.
7230         // Choose the less conservative count.
7231         if (EL0.ExactNotTaken == getCouldNotCompute() ||
7232             EL1.ExactNotTaken == getCouldNotCompute())
7233           BECount = getCouldNotCompute();
7234         else
7235           BECount =
7236               getUMinFromMismatchedTypes(EL0.ExactNotTaken, EL1.ExactNotTaken);
7237         if (EL0.MaxNotTaken == getCouldNotCompute())
7238           MaxBECount = EL1.MaxNotTaken;
7239         else if (EL1.MaxNotTaken == getCouldNotCompute())
7240           MaxBECount = EL0.MaxNotTaken;
7241         else
7242           MaxBECount =
7243               getUMinFromMismatchedTypes(EL0.MaxNotTaken, EL1.MaxNotTaken);
7244       } else {
7245         // Both conditions must be false at the same time for the loop to exit.
7246         // For now, be conservative.
7247         if (EL0.MaxNotTaken == EL1.MaxNotTaken)
7248           MaxBECount = EL0.MaxNotTaken;
7249         if (EL0.ExactNotTaken == EL1.ExactNotTaken)
7250           BECount = EL0.ExactNotTaken;
7251       }
7252 
7253       return ExitLimit(BECount, MaxBECount, false,
7254                        {&EL0.Predicates, &EL1.Predicates});
7255     }
7256   }
7257 
7258   // With an icmp, it may be feasible to compute an exact backedge-taken count.
7259   // Proceed to the next level to examine the icmp.
7260   if (ICmpInst *ExitCondICmp = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(ExitCond)) {
7261     ExitLimit EL =
7262         computeExitLimitFromICmp(L, ExitCondICmp, ExitIfTrue, ControlsExit);
7263     if (EL.hasFullInfo() || !AllowPredicates)
7264       return EL;
7265 
7266     // Try again, but use SCEV predicates this time.
7267     return computeExitLimitFromICmp(L, ExitCondICmp, ExitIfTrue, ControlsExit,
7268                                     /*AllowPredicates=*/true);
7269   }
7270 
7271   // Check for a constant condition. These are normally stripped out by
7272   // SimplifyCFG, but ScalarEvolution may be used by a pass which wishes to
7273   // preserve the CFG and is temporarily leaving constant conditions
7274   // in place.
7275   if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ExitCond)) {
7276     if (ExitIfTrue == !CI->getZExtValue())
7277       // The backedge is always taken.
7278       return getCouldNotCompute();
7279     else
7280       // The backedge is never taken.
7281       return getZero(CI->getType());
7282   }
7283 
7284   // If it's not an integer or pointer comparison then compute it the hard way.
7285   return computeExitCountExhaustively(L, ExitCond, ExitIfTrue);
7286 }
7287 
7288 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit
7289 ScalarEvolution::computeExitLimitFromICmp(const Loop *L,
7290                                           ICmpInst *ExitCond,
7291                                           bool ExitIfTrue,
7292                                           bool ControlsExit,
7293                                           bool AllowPredicates) {
7294   // If the condition was exit on true, convert the condition to exit on false
7295   ICmpInst::Predicate Pred;
7296   if (!ExitIfTrue)
7297     Pred = ExitCond->getPredicate();
7298   else
7299     Pred = ExitCond->getInversePredicate();
7300   const ICmpInst::Predicate OriginalPred = Pred;
7301 
7302   // Handle common loops like: for (X = "string"; *X; ++X)
7303   if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(ExitCond->getOperand(0)))
7304     if (Constant *RHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(ExitCond->getOperand(1))) {
7305       ExitLimit ItCnt =
7306         computeLoadConstantCompareExitLimit(LI, RHS, L, Pred);
7307       if (ItCnt.hasAnyInfo())
7308         return ItCnt;
7309     }
7310 
7311   const SCEV *LHS = getSCEV(ExitCond->getOperand(0));
7312   const SCEV *RHS = getSCEV(ExitCond->getOperand(1));
7313 
7314   // Try to evaluate any dependencies out of the loop.
7315   LHS = getSCEVAtScope(LHS, L);
7316   RHS = getSCEVAtScope(RHS, L);
7317 
7318   // At this point, we would like to compute how many iterations of the
7319   // loop the predicate will return true for these inputs.
7320   if (isLoopInvariant(LHS, L) && !isLoopInvariant(RHS, L)) {
7321     // If there is a loop-invariant, force it into the RHS.
7322     std::swap(LHS, RHS);
7323     Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
7324   }
7325 
7326   // Simplify the operands before analyzing them.
7327   (void)SimplifyICmpOperands(Pred, LHS, RHS);
7328 
7329   // If we have a comparison of a chrec against a constant, try to use value
7330   // ranges to answer this query.
7331   if (const SCEVConstant *RHSC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(RHS))
7332     if (const SCEVAddRecExpr *AddRec = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(LHS))
7333       if (AddRec->getLoop() == L) {
7334         // Form the constant range.
7335         ConstantRange CompRange =
7336             ConstantRange::makeExactICmpRegion(Pred, RHSC->getAPInt());
7337 
7338         const SCEV *Ret = AddRec->getNumIterationsInRange(CompRange, *this);
7339         if (!isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(Ret)) return Ret;
7340       }
7341 
7342   switch (Pred) {
7343   case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: {                     // while (X != Y)
7344     // Convert to: while (X-Y != 0)
7345     ExitLimit EL = howFarToZero(getMinusSCEV(LHS, RHS), L, ControlsExit,
7346                                 AllowPredicates);
7347     if (EL.hasAnyInfo()) return EL;
7348     break;
7349   }
7350   case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: {                     // while (X == Y)
7351     // Convert to: while (X-Y == 0)
7352     ExitLimit EL = howFarToNonZero(getMinusSCEV(LHS, RHS), L);
7353     if (EL.hasAnyInfo()) return EL;
7354     break;
7355   }
7356   case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
7357   case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: {                    // while (X < Y)
7358     bool IsSigned = Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
7359     ExitLimit EL = howManyLessThans(LHS, RHS, L, IsSigned, ControlsExit,
7360                                     AllowPredicates);
7361     if (EL.hasAnyInfo()) return EL;
7362     break;
7363   }
7364   case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
7365   case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: {                    // while (X > Y)
7366     bool IsSigned = Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
7367     ExitLimit EL =
7368         howManyGreaterThans(LHS, RHS, L, IsSigned, ControlsExit,
7369                             AllowPredicates);
7370     if (EL.hasAnyInfo()) return EL;
7371     break;
7372   }
7373   default:
7374     break;
7375   }
7376 
7377   auto *ExhaustiveCount =
7378       computeExitCountExhaustively(L, ExitCond, ExitIfTrue);
7379 
7380   if (!isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(ExhaustiveCount))
7381     return ExhaustiveCount;
7382 
7383   return computeShiftCompareExitLimit(ExitCond->getOperand(0),
7384                                       ExitCond->getOperand(1), L, OriginalPred);
7385 }
7386 
7387 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit
7388 ScalarEvolution::computeExitLimitFromSingleExitSwitch(const Loop *L,
7389                                                       SwitchInst *Switch,
7390                                                       BasicBlock *ExitingBlock,
7391                                                       bool ControlsExit) {
7392   assert(!L->contains(ExitingBlock) && "Not an exiting block!");
7393 
7394   // Give up if the exit is the default dest of a switch.
7395   if (Switch->getDefaultDest() == ExitingBlock)
7396     return getCouldNotCompute();
7397 
7398   assert(L->contains(Switch->getDefaultDest()) &&
7399          "Default case must not exit the loop!");
7400   const SCEV *LHS = getSCEVAtScope(Switch->getCondition(), L);
7401   const SCEV *RHS = getConstant(Switch->findCaseDest(ExitingBlock));
7402 
7403   // while (X != Y) --> while (X-Y != 0)
7404   ExitLimit EL = howFarToZero(getMinusSCEV(LHS, RHS), L, ControlsExit);
7405   if (EL.hasAnyInfo())
7406     return EL;
7407 
7408   return getCouldNotCompute();
7409 }
7410 
7411 static ConstantInt *
7412 EvaluateConstantChrecAtConstant(const SCEVAddRecExpr *AddRec, ConstantInt *C,
7413                                 ScalarEvolution &SE) {
7414   const SCEV *InVal = SE.getConstant(C);
7415   const SCEV *Val = AddRec->evaluateAtIteration(InVal, SE);
7416   assert(isa<SCEVConstant>(Val) &&
7417          "Evaluation of SCEV at constant didn't fold correctly?");
7418   return cast<SCEVConstant>(Val)->getValue();
7419 }
7420 
7421 /// Given an exit condition of 'icmp op load X, cst', try to see if we can
7422 /// compute the backedge execution count.
7423 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit
7424 ScalarEvolution::computeLoadConstantCompareExitLimit(
7425   LoadInst *LI,
7426   Constant *RHS,
7427   const Loop *L,
7428   ICmpInst::Predicate predicate) {
7429   if (LI->isVolatile()) return getCouldNotCompute();
7430 
7431   // Check to see if the loaded pointer is a getelementptr of a global.
7432   // TODO: Use SCEV instead of manually grubbing with GEPs.
7433   GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(LI->getOperand(0));
7434   if (!GEP) return getCouldNotCompute();
7435 
7436   // Make sure that it is really a constant global we are gepping, with an
7437   // initializer, and make sure the first IDX is really 0.
7438   GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(GEP->getOperand(0));
7439   if (!GV || !GV->isConstant() || !GV->hasDefinitiveInitializer() ||
7440       GEP->getNumOperands() < 3 || !isa<Constant>(GEP->getOperand(1)) ||
7441       !cast<Constant>(GEP->getOperand(1))->isNullValue())
7442     return getCouldNotCompute();
7443 
7444   // Okay, we allow one non-constant index into the GEP instruction.
7445   Value *VarIdx = nullptr;
7446   std::vector<Constant*> Indexes;
7447   unsigned VarIdxNum = 0;
7448   for (unsigned i = 2, e = GEP->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
7449     if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i))) {
7450       Indexes.push_back(CI);
7451     } else if (!isa<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i))) {
7452       if (VarIdx) return getCouldNotCompute();  // Multiple non-constant idx's.
7453       VarIdx = GEP->getOperand(i);
7454       VarIdxNum = i-2;
7455       Indexes.push_back(nullptr);
7456     }
7457 
7458   // Loop-invariant loads may be a byproduct of loop optimization. Skip them.
7459   if (!VarIdx)
7460     return getCouldNotCompute();
7461 
7462   // Okay, we know we have a (load (gep GV, 0, X)) comparison with a constant.
7463   // Check to see if X is a loop variant variable value now.
7464   const SCEV *Idx = getSCEV(VarIdx);
7465   Idx = getSCEVAtScope(Idx, L);
7466 
7467   // We can only recognize very limited forms of loop index expressions, in
7468   // particular, only affine AddRec's like {C1,+,C2}.
7469   const SCEVAddRecExpr *IdxExpr = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Idx);
7470   if (!IdxExpr || !IdxExpr->isAffine() || isLoopInvariant(IdxExpr, L) ||
7471       !isa<SCEVConstant>(IdxExpr->getOperand(0)) ||
7472       !isa<SCEVConstant>(IdxExpr->getOperand(1)))
7473     return getCouldNotCompute();
7474 
7475   unsigned MaxSteps = MaxBruteForceIterations;
7476   for (unsigned IterationNum = 0; IterationNum != MaxSteps; ++IterationNum) {
7477     ConstantInt *ItCst = ConstantInt::get(
7478                            cast<IntegerType>(IdxExpr->getType()), IterationNum);
7479     ConstantInt *Val = EvaluateConstantChrecAtConstant(IdxExpr, ItCst, *this);
7480 
7481     // Form the GEP offset.
7482     Indexes[VarIdxNum] = Val;
7483 
7484     Constant *Result = ConstantFoldLoadThroughGEPIndices(GV->getInitializer(),
7485                                                          Indexes);
7486     if (!Result) break;  // Cannot compute!
7487 
7488     // Evaluate the condition for this iteration.
7489     Result = ConstantExpr::getICmp(predicate, Result, RHS);
7490     if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Result)) break;  // Couldn't decide for sure
7491     if (cast<ConstantInt>(Result)->getValue().isMinValue()) {
7492       ++NumArrayLenItCounts;
7493       return getConstant(ItCst);   // Found terminating iteration!
7494     }
7495   }
7496   return getCouldNotCompute();
7497 }
7498 
7499 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit ScalarEvolution::computeShiftCompareExitLimit(
7500     Value *LHS, Value *RHSV, const Loop *L, ICmpInst::Predicate Pred) {
7501   ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSV);
7502   if (!RHS)
7503     return getCouldNotCompute();
7504 
7505   const BasicBlock *Latch = L->getLoopLatch();
7506   if (!Latch)
7507     return getCouldNotCompute();
7508 
7509   const BasicBlock *Predecessor = L->getLoopPredecessor();
7510   if (!Predecessor)
7511     return getCouldNotCompute();
7512 
7513   // Return true if V is of the form "LHS `shift_op` <positive constant>".
7514   // Return LHS in OutLHS and shift_opt in OutOpCode.
7515   auto MatchPositiveShift =
7516       [](Value *V, Value *&OutLHS, Instruction::BinaryOps &OutOpCode) {
7517 
7518     using namespace PatternMatch;
7519 
7520     ConstantInt *ShiftAmt;
7521     if (match(V, m_LShr(m_Value(OutLHS), m_ConstantInt(ShiftAmt))))
7522       OutOpCode = Instruction::LShr;
7523     else if (match(V, m_AShr(m_Value(OutLHS), m_ConstantInt(ShiftAmt))))
7524       OutOpCode = Instruction::AShr;
7525     else if (match(V, m_Shl(m_Value(OutLHS), m_ConstantInt(ShiftAmt))))
7526       OutOpCode = Instruction::Shl;
7527     else
7528       return false;
7529 
7530     return ShiftAmt->getValue().isStrictlyPositive();
7531   };
7532 
7533   // Recognize a "shift recurrence" either of the form %iv or of %iv.shifted in
7534   //
7535   // loop:
7536   //   %iv = phi i32 [ %iv.shifted, %loop ], [ %val, %preheader ]
7537   //   %iv.shifted = lshr i32 %iv, <positive constant>
7538   //
7539   // Return true on a successful match.  Return the corresponding PHI node (%iv
7540   // above) in PNOut and the opcode of the shift operation in OpCodeOut.
7541   auto MatchShiftRecurrence =
7542       [&](Value *V, PHINode *&PNOut, Instruction::BinaryOps &OpCodeOut) {
7543     Optional<Instruction::BinaryOps> PostShiftOpCode;
7544 
7545     {
7546       Instruction::BinaryOps OpC;
7547       Value *V;
7548 
7549       // If we encounter a shift instruction, "peel off" the shift operation,
7550       // and remember that we did so.  Later when we inspect %iv's backedge
7551       // value, we will make sure that the backedge value uses the same
7552       // operation.
7553       //
7554       // Note: the peeled shift operation does not have to be the same
7555       // instruction as the one feeding into the PHI's backedge value.  We only
7556       // really care about it being the same *kind* of shift instruction --
7557       // that's all that is required for our later inferences to hold.
7558       if (MatchPositiveShift(LHS, V, OpC)) {
7559         PostShiftOpCode = OpC;
7560         LHS = V;
7561       }
7562     }
7563 
7564     PNOut = dyn_cast<PHINode>(LHS);
7565     if (!PNOut || PNOut->getParent() != L->getHeader())
7566       return false;
7567 
7568     Value *BEValue = PNOut->getIncomingValueForBlock(Latch);
7569     Value *OpLHS;
7570 
7571     return
7572         // The backedge value for the PHI node must be a shift by a positive
7573         // amount
7574         MatchPositiveShift(BEValue, OpLHS, OpCodeOut) &&
7575 
7576         // of the PHI node itself
7577         OpLHS == PNOut &&
7578 
7579         // and the kind of shift should be match the kind of shift we peeled
7580         // off, if any.
7581         (!PostShiftOpCode.hasValue() || *PostShiftOpCode == OpCodeOut);
7582   };
7583 
7584   PHINode *PN;
7585   Instruction::BinaryOps OpCode;
7586   if (!MatchShiftRecurrence(LHS, PN, OpCode))
7587     return getCouldNotCompute();
7588 
7589   const DataLayout &DL = getDataLayout();
7590 
7591   // The key rationale for this optimization is that for some kinds of shift
7592   // recurrences, the value of the recurrence "stabilizes" to either 0 or -1
7593   // within a finite number of iterations.  If the condition guarding the
7594   // backedge (in the sense that the backedge is taken if the condition is true)
7595   // is false for the value the shift recurrence stabilizes to, then we know
7596   // that the backedge is taken only a finite number of times.
7597 
7598   ConstantInt *StableValue = nullptr;
7599   switch (OpCode) {
7600   default:
7601     llvm_unreachable("Impossible case!");
7602 
7603   case Instruction::AShr: {
7604     // {K,ashr,<positive-constant>} stabilizes to signum(K) in at most
7605     // bitwidth(K) iterations.
7606     Value *FirstValue = PN->getIncomingValueForBlock(Predecessor);
7607     KnownBits Known = computeKnownBits(FirstValue, DL, 0, nullptr,
7608                                        Predecessor->getTerminator(), &DT);
7609     auto *Ty = cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType());
7610     if (Known.isNonNegative())
7611       StableValue = ConstantInt::get(Ty, 0);
7612     else if (Known.isNegative())
7613       StableValue = ConstantInt::get(Ty, -1, true);
7614     else
7615       return getCouldNotCompute();
7616 
7617     break;
7618   }
7619   case Instruction::LShr:
7620   case Instruction::Shl:
7621     // Both {K,lshr,<positive-constant>} and {K,shl,<positive-constant>}
7622     // stabilize to 0 in at most bitwidth(K) iterations.
7623     StableValue = ConstantInt::get(cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType()), 0);
7624     break;
7625   }
7626 
7627   auto *Result =
7628       ConstantFoldCompareInstOperands(Pred, StableValue, RHS, DL, &TLI);
7629   assert(Result->getType()->isIntegerTy(1) &&
7630          "Otherwise cannot be an operand to a branch instruction");
7631 
7632   if (Result->isZeroValue()) {
7633     unsigned BitWidth = getTypeSizeInBits(RHS->getType());
7634     const SCEV *UpperBound =
7635         getConstant(getEffectiveSCEVType(RHS->getType()), BitWidth);
7636     return ExitLimit(getCouldNotCompute(), UpperBound, false);
7637   }
7638 
7639   return getCouldNotCompute();
7640 }
7641 
7642 /// Return true if we can constant fold an instruction of the specified type,
7643 /// assuming that all operands were constants.
7644 static bool CanConstantFold(const Instruction *I) {
7645   if (isa<BinaryOperator>(I) || isa<CmpInst>(I) ||
7646       isa<SelectInst>(I) || isa<CastInst>(I) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(I) ||
7647       isa<LoadInst>(I))
7648     return true;
7649 
7650   if (const CallInst *CI = dyn_cast<CallInst>(I))
7651     if (const Function *F = CI->getCalledFunction())
7652       return canConstantFoldCallTo(CI, F);
7653   return false;
7654 }
7655 
7656 /// Determine whether this instruction can constant evolve within this loop
7657 /// assuming its operands can all constant evolve.
7658 static bool canConstantEvolve(Instruction *I, const Loop *L) {
7659   // An instruction outside of the loop can't be derived from a loop PHI.
7660   if (!L->contains(I)) return false;
7661 
7662   if (isa<PHINode>(I)) {
7663     // We don't currently keep track of the control flow needed to evaluate
7664     // PHIs, so we cannot handle PHIs inside of loops.
7665     return L->getHeader() == I->getParent();
7666   }
7667 
7668   // If we won't be able to constant fold this expression even if the operands
7669   // are constants, bail early.
7670   return CanConstantFold(I);
7671 }
7672 
7673 /// getConstantEvolvingPHIOperands - Implement getConstantEvolvingPHI by
7674 /// recursing through each instruction operand until reaching a loop header phi.
7675 static PHINode *
7676 getConstantEvolvingPHIOperands(Instruction *UseInst, const Loop *L,
7677                                DenseMap<Instruction *, PHINode *> &PHIMap,
7678                                unsigned Depth) {
7679   if (Depth > MaxConstantEvolvingDepth)
7680     return nullptr;
7681 
7682   // Otherwise, we can evaluate this instruction if all of its operands are
7683   // constant or derived from a PHI node themselves.
7684   PHINode *PHI = nullptr;
7685   for (Value *Op : UseInst->operands()) {
7686     if (isa<Constant>(Op)) continue;
7687 
7688     Instruction *OpInst = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op);
7689     if (!OpInst || !canConstantEvolve(OpInst, L)) return nullptr;
7690 
7691     PHINode *P = dyn_cast<PHINode>(OpInst);
7692     if (!P)
7693       // If this operand is already visited, reuse the prior result.
7694       // We may have P != PHI if this is the deepest point at which the
7695       // inconsistent paths meet.
7696       P = PHIMap.lookup(OpInst);
7697     if (!P) {
7698       // Recurse and memoize the results, whether a phi is found or not.
7699       // This recursive call invalidates pointers into PHIMap.
7700       P = getConstantEvolvingPHIOperands(OpInst, L, PHIMap, Depth + 1);
7701       PHIMap[OpInst] = P;
7702     }
7703     if (!P)
7704       return nullptr;  // Not evolving from PHI
7705     if (PHI && PHI != P)
7706       return nullptr;  // Evolving from multiple different PHIs.
7707     PHI = P;
7708   }
7709   // This is a expression evolving from a constant PHI!
7710   return PHI;
7711 }
7712 
7713 /// getConstantEvolvingPHI - Given an LLVM value and a loop, return a PHI node
7714 /// in the loop that V is derived from.  We allow arbitrary operations along the
7715 /// way, but the operands of an operation must either be constants or a value
7716 /// derived from a constant PHI.  If this expression does not fit with these
7717 /// constraints, return null.
7718 static PHINode *getConstantEvolvingPHI(Value *V, const Loop *L) {
7719   Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
7720   if (!I || !canConstantEvolve(I, L)) return nullptr;
7721 
7722   if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(I))
7723     return PN;
7724 
7725   // Record non-constant instructions contained by the loop.
7726   DenseMap<Instruction *, PHINode *> PHIMap;
7727   return getConstantEvolvingPHIOperands(I, L, PHIMap, 0);
7728 }
7729 
7730 /// EvaluateExpression - Given an expression that passes the
7731 /// getConstantEvolvingPHI predicate, evaluate its value assuming the PHI node
7732 /// in the loop has the value PHIVal.  If we can't fold this expression for some
7733 /// reason, return null.
7734 static Constant *EvaluateExpression(Value *V, const Loop *L,
7735                                     DenseMap<Instruction *, Constant *> &Vals,
7736                                     const DataLayout &DL,
7737                                     const TargetLibraryInfo *TLI) {
7738   // Convenient constant check, but redundant for recursive calls.
7739   if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V)) return C;
7740   Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
7741   if (!I) return nullptr;
7742 
7743   if (Constant *C = Vals.lookup(I)) return C;
7744 
7745   // An instruction inside the loop depends on a value outside the loop that we
7746   // weren't given a mapping for, or a value such as a call inside the loop.
7747   if (!canConstantEvolve(I, L)) return nullptr;
7748 
7749   // An unmapped PHI can be due to a branch or another loop inside this loop,
7750   // or due to this not being the initial iteration through a loop where we
7751   // couldn't compute the evolution of this particular PHI last time.
7752   if (isa<PHINode>(I)) return nullptr;
7753 
7754   std::vector<Constant*> Operands(I->getNumOperands());
7755 
7756   for (unsigned i = 0, e = I->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i) {
7757     Instruction *Operand = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I->getOperand(i));
7758     if (!Operand) {
7759       Operands[i] = dyn_cast<Constant>(I->getOperand(i));
7760       if (!Operands[i]) return nullptr;
7761       continue;
7762     }
7763     Constant *C = EvaluateExpression(Operand, L, Vals, DL, TLI);
7764     Vals[Operand] = C;
7765     if (!C) return nullptr;
7766     Operands[i] = C;
7767   }
7768 
7769   if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
7770     return ConstantFoldCompareInstOperands(CI->getPredicate(), Operands[0],
7771                                            Operands[1], DL, TLI);
7772   if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
7773     if (!LI->isVolatile())
7774       return ConstantFoldLoadFromConstPtr(Operands[0], LI->getType(), DL);
7775   }
7776   return ConstantFoldInstOperands(I, Operands, DL, TLI);
7777 }
7778 
7779 
7780 // If every incoming value to PN except the one for BB is a specific Constant,
7781 // return that, else return nullptr.
7782 static Constant *getOtherIncomingValue(PHINode *PN, BasicBlock *BB) {
7783   Constant *IncomingVal = nullptr;
7784 
7785   for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
7786     if (PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == BB)
7787       continue;
7788 
7789     auto *CurrentVal = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i));
7790     if (!CurrentVal)
7791       return nullptr;
7792 
7793     if (IncomingVal != CurrentVal) {
7794       if (IncomingVal)
7795         return nullptr;
7796       IncomingVal = CurrentVal;
7797     }
7798   }
7799 
7800   return IncomingVal;
7801 }
7802 
7803 /// getConstantEvolutionLoopExitValue - If we know that the specified Phi is
7804 /// in the header of its containing loop, we know the loop executes a
7805 /// constant number of times, and the PHI node is just a recurrence
7806 /// involving constants, fold it.
7807 Constant *
7808 ScalarEvolution::getConstantEvolutionLoopExitValue(PHINode *PN,
7809                                                    const APInt &BEs,
7810                                                    const Loop *L) {
7811   auto I = ConstantEvolutionLoopExitValue.find(PN);
7812   if (I != ConstantEvolutionLoopExitValue.end())
7813     return I->second;
7814 
7815   if (BEs.ugt(MaxBruteForceIterations))
7816     return ConstantEvolutionLoopExitValue[PN] = nullptr;  // Not going to evaluate it.
7817 
7818   Constant *&RetVal = ConstantEvolutionLoopExitValue[PN];
7819 
7820   DenseMap<Instruction *, Constant *> CurrentIterVals;
7821   BasicBlock *Header = L->getHeader();
7822   assert(PN->getParent() == Header && "Can't evaluate PHI not in loop header!");
7823 
7824   BasicBlock *Latch = L->getLoopLatch();
7825   if (!Latch)
7826     return nullptr;
7827 
7828   for (PHINode &PHI : Header->phis()) {
7829     if (auto *StartCST = getOtherIncomingValue(&PHI, Latch))
7830       CurrentIterVals[&PHI] = StartCST;
7831   }
7832   if (!CurrentIterVals.count(PN))
7833     return RetVal = nullptr;
7834 
7835   Value *BEValue = PN->getIncomingValueForBlock(Latch);
7836 
7837   // Execute the loop symbolically to determine the exit value.
7838   assert(BEs.getActiveBits() < CHAR_BIT * sizeof(unsigned) &&
7839          "BEs is <= MaxBruteForceIterations which is an 'unsigned'!");
7840 
7841   unsigned NumIterations = BEs.getZExtValue(); // must be in range
7842   unsigned IterationNum = 0;
7843   const DataLayout &DL = getDataLayout();
7844   for (; ; ++IterationNum) {
7845     if (IterationNum == NumIterations)
7846       return RetVal = CurrentIterVals[PN];  // Got exit value!
7847 
7848     // Compute the value of the PHIs for the next iteration.
7849     // EvaluateExpression adds non-phi values to the CurrentIterVals map.
7850     DenseMap<Instruction *, Constant *> NextIterVals;
7851     Constant *NextPHI =
7852         EvaluateExpression(BEValue, L, CurrentIterVals, DL, &TLI);
7853     if (!NextPHI)
7854       return nullptr;        // Couldn't evaluate!
7855     NextIterVals[PN] = NextPHI;
7856 
7857     bool StoppedEvolving = NextPHI == CurrentIterVals[PN];
7858 
7859     // Also evaluate the other PHI nodes.  However, we don't get to stop if we
7860     // cease to be able to evaluate one of them or if they stop evolving,
7861     // because that doesn't necessarily prevent us from computing PN.
7862     SmallVector<std::pair<PHINode *, Constant *>, 8> PHIsToCompute;
7863     for (const auto &I : CurrentIterVals) {
7864       PHINode *PHI = dyn_cast<PHINode>(I.first);
7865       if (!PHI || PHI == PN || PHI->getParent() != Header) continue;
7866       PHIsToCompute.emplace_back(PHI, I.second);
7867     }
7868     // We use two distinct loops because EvaluateExpression may invalidate any
7869     // iterators into CurrentIterVals.
7870     for (const auto &I : PHIsToCompute) {
7871       PHINode *PHI = I.first;
7872       Constant *&NextPHI = NextIterVals[PHI];
7873       if (!NextPHI) {   // Not already computed.
7874         Value *BEValue = PHI->getIncomingValueForBlock(Latch);
7875         NextPHI = EvaluateExpression(BEValue, L, CurrentIterVals, DL, &TLI);
7876       }
7877       if (NextPHI != I.second)
7878         StoppedEvolving = false;
7879     }
7880 
7881     // If all entries in CurrentIterVals == NextIterVals then we can stop
7882     // iterating, the loop can't continue to change.
7883     if (StoppedEvolving)
7884       return RetVal = CurrentIterVals[PN];
7885 
7886     CurrentIterVals.swap(NextIterVals);
7887   }
7888 }
7889 
7890 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::computeExitCountExhaustively(const Loop *L,
7891                                                           Value *Cond,
7892                                                           bool ExitWhen) {
7893   PHINode *PN = getConstantEvolvingPHI(Cond, L);
7894   if (!PN) return getCouldNotCompute();
7895 
7896   // If the loop is canonicalized, the PHI will have exactly two entries.
7897   // That's the only form we support here.
7898   if (PN->getNumIncomingValues() != 2) return getCouldNotCompute();
7899 
7900   DenseMap<Instruction *, Constant *> CurrentIterVals;
7901   BasicBlock *Header = L->getHeader();
7902   assert(PN->getParent() == Header && "Can't evaluate PHI not in loop header!");
7903 
7904   BasicBlock *Latch = L->getLoopLatch();
7905   assert(Latch && "Should follow from NumIncomingValues == 2!");
7906 
7907   for (PHINode &PHI : Header->phis()) {
7908     if (auto *StartCST = getOtherIncomingValue(&PHI, Latch))
7909       CurrentIterVals[&PHI] = StartCST;
7910   }
7911   if (!CurrentIterVals.count(PN))
7912     return getCouldNotCompute();
7913 
7914   // Okay, we find a PHI node that defines the trip count of this loop.  Execute
7915   // the loop symbolically to determine when the condition gets a value of
7916   // "ExitWhen".
7917   unsigned MaxIterations = MaxBruteForceIterations;   // Limit analysis.
7918   const DataLayout &DL = getDataLayout();
7919   for (unsigned IterationNum = 0; IterationNum != MaxIterations;++IterationNum){
7920     auto *CondVal = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantInt>(
7921         EvaluateExpression(Cond, L, CurrentIterVals, DL, &TLI));
7922 
7923     // Couldn't symbolically evaluate.
7924     if (!CondVal) return getCouldNotCompute();
7925 
7926     if (CondVal->getValue() == uint64_t(ExitWhen)) {
7927       ++NumBruteForceTripCountsComputed;
7928       return getConstant(Type::getInt32Ty(getContext()), IterationNum);
7929     }
7930 
7931     // Update all the PHI nodes for the next iteration.
7932     DenseMap<Instruction *, Constant *> NextIterVals;
7933 
7934     // Create a list of which PHIs we need to compute. We want to do this before
7935     // calling EvaluateExpression on them because that may invalidate iterators
7936     // into CurrentIterVals.
7937     SmallVector<PHINode *, 8> PHIsToCompute;
7938     for (const auto &I : CurrentIterVals) {
7939       PHINode *PHI = dyn_cast<PHINode>(I.first);
7940       if (!PHI || PHI->getParent() != Header) continue;
7941       PHIsToCompute.push_back(PHI);
7942     }
7943     for (PHINode *PHI : PHIsToCompute) {
7944       Constant *&NextPHI = NextIterVals[PHI];
7945       if (NextPHI) continue;    // Already computed!
7946 
7947       Value *BEValue = PHI->getIncomingValueForBlock(Latch);
7948       NextPHI = EvaluateExpression(BEValue, L, CurrentIterVals, DL, &TLI);
7949     }
7950     CurrentIterVals.swap(NextIterVals);
7951   }
7952 
7953   // Too many iterations were needed to evaluate.
7954   return getCouldNotCompute();
7955 }
7956 
7957 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getSCEVAtScope(const SCEV *V, const Loop *L) {
7958   SmallVector<std::pair<const Loop *, const SCEV *>, 2> &Values =
7959       ValuesAtScopes[V];
7960   // Check to see if we've folded this expression at this loop before.
7961   for (auto &LS : Values)
7962     if (LS.first == L)
7963       return LS.second ? LS.second : V;
7964 
7965   Values.emplace_back(L, nullptr);
7966 
7967   // Otherwise compute it.
7968   const SCEV *C = computeSCEVAtScope(V, L);
7969   for (auto &LS : reverse(ValuesAtScopes[V]))
7970     if (LS.first == L) {
7971       LS.second = C;
7972       break;
7973     }
7974   return C;
7975 }
7976 
7977 /// This builds up a Constant using the ConstantExpr interface.  That way, we
7978 /// will return Constants for objects which aren't represented by a
7979 /// SCEVConstant, because SCEVConstant is restricted to ConstantInt.
7980 /// Returns NULL if the SCEV isn't representable as a Constant.
7981 static Constant *BuildConstantFromSCEV(const SCEV *V) {
7982   switch (static_cast<SCEVTypes>(V->getSCEVType())) {
7983     case scCouldNotCompute:
7984     case scAddRecExpr:
7985       break;
7986     case scConstant:
7987       return cast<SCEVConstant>(V)->getValue();
7988     case scUnknown:
7989       return dyn_cast<Constant>(cast<SCEVUnknown>(V)->getValue());
7990     case scSignExtend: {
7991       const SCEVSignExtendExpr *SS = cast<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(V);
7992       if (Constant *CastOp = BuildConstantFromSCEV(SS->getOperand()))
7993         return ConstantExpr::getSExt(CastOp, SS->getType());
7994       break;
7995     }
7996     case scZeroExtend: {
7997       const SCEVZeroExtendExpr *SZ = cast<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(V);
7998       if (Constant *CastOp = BuildConstantFromSCEV(SZ->getOperand()))
7999         return ConstantExpr::getZExt(CastOp, SZ->getType());
8000       break;
8001     }
8002     case scTruncate: {
8003       const SCEVTruncateExpr *ST = cast<SCEVTruncateExpr>(V);
8004       if (Constant *CastOp = BuildConstantFromSCEV(ST->getOperand()))
8005         return ConstantExpr::getTrunc(CastOp, ST->getType());
8006       break;
8007     }
8008     case scAddExpr: {
8009       const SCEVAddExpr *SA = cast<SCEVAddExpr>(V);
8010       if (Constant *C = BuildConstantFromSCEV(SA->getOperand(0))) {
8011         if (PointerType *PTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(C->getType())) {
8012           unsigned AS = PTy->getAddressSpace();
8013           Type *DestPtrTy = Type::getInt8PtrTy(C->getContext(), AS);
8014           C = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(C, DestPtrTy);
8015         }
8016         for (unsigned i = 1, e = SA->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i) {
8017           Constant *C2 = BuildConstantFromSCEV(SA->getOperand(i));
8018           if (!C2) return nullptr;
8019 
8020           // First pointer!
8021           if (!C->getType()->isPointerTy() && C2->getType()->isPointerTy()) {
8022             unsigned AS = C2->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace();
8023             std::swap(C, C2);
8024             Type *DestPtrTy = Type::getInt8PtrTy(C->getContext(), AS);
8025             // The offsets have been converted to bytes.  We can add bytes to an
8026             // i8* by GEP with the byte count in the first index.
8027             C = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(C, DestPtrTy);
8028           }
8029 
8030           // Don't bother trying to sum two pointers. We probably can't
8031           // statically compute a load that results from it anyway.
8032           if (C2->getType()->isPointerTy())
8033             return nullptr;
8034 
8035           if (PointerType *PTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(C->getType())) {
8036             if (PTy->getElementType()->isStructTy())
8037               C2 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(
8038                   C2, Type::getInt32Ty(C->getContext()), true);
8039             C = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(PTy->getElementType(), C, C2);
8040           } else
8041             C = ConstantExpr::getAdd(C, C2);
8042         }
8043         return C;
8044       }
8045       break;
8046     }
8047     case scMulExpr: {
8048       const SCEVMulExpr *SM = cast<SCEVMulExpr>(V);
8049       if (Constant *C = BuildConstantFromSCEV(SM->getOperand(0))) {
8050         // Don't bother with pointers at all.
8051         if (C->getType()->isPointerTy()) return nullptr;
8052         for (unsigned i = 1, e = SM->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i) {
8053           Constant *C2 = BuildConstantFromSCEV(SM->getOperand(i));
8054           if (!C2 || C2->getType()->isPointerTy()) return nullptr;
8055           C = ConstantExpr::getMul(C, C2);
8056         }
8057         return C;
8058       }
8059       break;
8060     }
8061     case scUDivExpr: {
8062       const SCEVUDivExpr *SU = cast<SCEVUDivExpr>(V);
8063       if (Constant *LHS = BuildConstantFromSCEV(SU->getLHS()))
8064         if (Constant *RHS = BuildConstantFromSCEV(SU->getRHS()))
8065           if (LHS->getType() == RHS->getType())
8066             return ConstantExpr::getUDiv(LHS, RHS);
8067       break;
8068     }
8069     case scSMaxExpr:
8070     case scUMaxExpr:
8071       break; // TODO: smax, umax.
8072   }
8073   return nullptr;
8074 }
8075 
8076 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::computeSCEVAtScope(const SCEV *V, const Loop *L) {
8077   if (isa<SCEVConstant>(V)) return V;
8078 
8079   // If this instruction is evolved from a constant-evolving PHI, compute the
8080   // exit value from the loop without using SCEVs.
8081   if (const SCEVUnknown *SU = dyn_cast<SCEVUnknown>(V)) {
8082     if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SU->getValue())) {
8083       const Loop *LI = this->LI[I->getParent()];
8084       if (LI && LI->getParentLoop() == L)  // Looking for loop exit value.
8085         if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(I))
8086           if (PN->getParent() == LI->getHeader()) {
8087             // Okay, there is no closed form solution for the PHI node.  Check
8088             // to see if the loop that contains it has a known backedge-taken
8089             // count.  If so, we may be able to force computation of the exit
8090             // value.
8091             const SCEV *BackedgeTakenCount = getBackedgeTakenCount(LI);
8092             if (const SCEVConstant *BTCC =
8093                   dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(BackedgeTakenCount)) {
8094 
8095               // This trivial case can show up in some degenerate cases where
8096               // the incoming IR has not yet been fully simplified.
8097               if (BTCC->getValue()->isZero()) {
8098                 Value *InitValue = nullptr;
8099                 bool MultipleInitValues = false;
8100                 for (unsigned i = 0; i < PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i++) {
8101                   if (!LI->contains(PN->getIncomingBlock(i))) {
8102                     if (!InitValue)
8103                       InitValue = PN->getIncomingValue(i);
8104                     else if (InitValue != PN->getIncomingValue(i)) {
8105                       MultipleInitValues = true;
8106                       break;
8107                     }
8108                   }
8109                   if (!MultipleInitValues && InitValue)
8110                     return getSCEV(InitValue);
8111                 }
8112               }
8113               // Okay, we know how many times the containing loop executes.  If
8114               // this is a constant evolving PHI node, get the final value at
8115               // the specified iteration number.
8116               Constant *RV =
8117                   getConstantEvolutionLoopExitValue(PN, BTCC->getAPInt(), LI);
8118               if (RV) return getSCEV(RV);
8119             }
8120           }
8121 
8122       // Okay, this is an expression that we cannot symbolically evaluate
8123       // into a SCEV.  Check to see if it's possible to symbolically evaluate
8124       // the arguments into constants, and if so, try to constant propagate the
8125       // result.  This is particularly useful for computing loop exit values.
8126       if (CanConstantFold(I)) {
8127         SmallVector<Constant *, 4> Operands;
8128         bool MadeImprovement = false;
8129         for (Value *Op : I->operands()) {
8130           if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
8131             Operands.push_back(C);
8132             continue;
8133           }
8134 
8135           // If any of the operands is non-constant and if they are
8136           // non-integer and non-pointer, don't even try to analyze them
8137           // with scev techniques.
8138           if (!isSCEVable(Op->getType()))
8139             return V;
8140 
8141           const SCEV *OrigV = getSCEV(Op);
8142           const SCEV *OpV = getSCEVAtScope(OrigV, L);
8143           MadeImprovement |= OrigV != OpV;
8144 
8145           Constant *C = BuildConstantFromSCEV(OpV);
8146           if (!C) return V;
8147           if (C->getType() != Op->getType())
8148             C = ConstantExpr::getCast(CastInst::getCastOpcode(C, false,
8149                                                               Op->getType(),
8150                                                               false),
8151                                       C, Op->getType());
8152           Operands.push_back(C);
8153         }
8154 
8155         // Check to see if getSCEVAtScope actually made an improvement.
8156         if (MadeImprovement) {
8157           Constant *C = nullptr;
8158           const DataLayout &DL = getDataLayout();
8159           if (const CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
8160             C = ConstantFoldCompareInstOperands(CI->getPredicate(), Operands[0],
8161                                                 Operands[1], DL, &TLI);
8162           else if (const LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
8163             if (!LI->isVolatile())
8164               C = ConstantFoldLoadFromConstPtr(Operands[0], LI->getType(), DL);
8165           } else
8166             C = ConstantFoldInstOperands(I, Operands, DL, &TLI);
8167           if (!C) return V;
8168           return getSCEV(C);
8169         }
8170       }
8171     }
8172 
8173     // This is some other type of SCEVUnknown, just return it.
8174     return V;
8175   }
8176 
8177   if (const SCEVCommutativeExpr *Comm = dyn_cast<SCEVCommutativeExpr>(V)) {
8178     // Avoid performing the look-up in the common case where the specified
8179     // expression has no loop-variant portions.
8180     for (unsigned i = 0, e = Comm->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i) {
8181       const SCEV *OpAtScope = getSCEVAtScope(Comm->getOperand(i), L);
8182       if (OpAtScope != Comm->getOperand(i)) {
8183         // Okay, at least one of these operands is loop variant but might be
8184         // foldable.  Build a new instance of the folded commutative expression.
8185         SmallVector<const SCEV *, 8> NewOps(Comm->op_begin(),
8186                                             Comm->op_begin()+i);
8187         NewOps.push_back(OpAtScope);
8188 
8189         for (++i; i != e; ++i) {
8190           OpAtScope = getSCEVAtScope(Comm->getOperand(i), L);
8191           NewOps.push_back(OpAtScope);
8192         }
8193         if (isa<SCEVAddExpr>(Comm))
8194           return getAddExpr(NewOps);
8195         if (isa<SCEVMulExpr>(Comm))
8196           return getMulExpr(NewOps);
8197         if (isa<SCEVSMaxExpr>(Comm))
8198           return getSMaxExpr(NewOps);
8199         if (isa<SCEVUMaxExpr>(Comm))
8200           return getUMaxExpr(NewOps);
8201         llvm_unreachable("Unknown commutative SCEV type!");
8202       }
8203     }
8204     // If we got here, all operands are loop invariant.
8205     return Comm;
8206   }
8207 
8208   if (const SCEVUDivExpr *Div = dyn_cast<SCEVUDivExpr>(V)) {
8209     const SCEV *LHS = getSCEVAtScope(Div->getLHS(), L);
8210     const SCEV *RHS = getSCEVAtScope(Div->getRHS(), L);
8211     if (LHS == Div->getLHS() && RHS == Div->getRHS())
8212       return Div;   // must be loop invariant
8213     return getUDivExpr(LHS, RHS);
8214   }
8215 
8216   // If this is a loop recurrence for a loop that does not contain L, then we
8217   // are dealing with the final value computed by the loop.
8218   if (const SCEVAddRecExpr *AddRec = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(V)) {
8219     // First, attempt to evaluate each operand.
8220     // Avoid performing the look-up in the common case where the specified
8221     // expression has no loop-variant portions.
8222     for (unsigned i = 0, e = AddRec->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i) {
8223       const SCEV *OpAtScope = getSCEVAtScope(AddRec->getOperand(i), L);
8224       if (OpAtScope == AddRec->getOperand(i))
8225         continue;
8226 
8227       // Okay, at least one of these operands is loop variant but might be
8228       // foldable.  Build a new instance of the folded commutative expression.
8229       SmallVector<const SCEV *, 8> NewOps(AddRec->op_begin(),
8230                                           AddRec->op_begin()+i);
8231       NewOps.push_back(OpAtScope);
8232       for (++i; i != e; ++i)
8233         NewOps.push_back(getSCEVAtScope(AddRec->getOperand(i), L));
8234 
8235       const SCEV *FoldedRec =
8236         getAddRecExpr(NewOps, AddRec->getLoop(),
8237                       AddRec->getNoWrapFlags(SCEV::FlagNW));
8238       AddRec = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(FoldedRec);
8239       // The addrec may be folded to a nonrecurrence, for example, if the
8240       // induction variable is multiplied by zero after constant folding. Go
8241       // ahead and return the folded value.
8242       if (!AddRec)
8243         return FoldedRec;
8244       break;
8245     }
8246 
8247     // If the scope is outside the addrec's loop, evaluate it by using the
8248     // loop exit value of the addrec.
8249     if (!AddRec->getLoop()->contains(L)) {
8250       // To evaluate this recurrence, we need to know how many times the AddRec
8251       // loop iterates.  Compute this now.
8252       const SCEV *BackedgeTakenCount = getBackedgeTakenCount(AddRec->getLoop());
8253       if (BackedgeTakenCount == getCouldNotCompute()) return AddRec;
8254 
8255       // Then, evaluate the AddRec.
8256       return AddRec->evaluateAtIteration(BackedgeTakenCount, *this);
8257     }
8258 
8259     return AddRec;
8260   }
8261 
8262   if (const SCEVZeroExtendExpr *Cast = dyn_cast<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(V)) {
8263     const SCEV *Op = getSCEVAtScope(Cast->getOperand(), L);
8264     if (Op == Cast->getOperand())
8265       return Cast;  // must be loop invariant
8266     return getZeroExtendExpr(Op, Cast->getType());
8267   }
8268 
8269   if (const SCEVSignExtendExpr *Cast = dyn_cast<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(V)) {
8270     const SCEV *Op = getSCEVAtScope(Cast->getOperand(), L);
8271     if (Op == Cast->getOperand())
8272       return Cast;  // must be loop invariant
8273     return getSignExtendExpr(Op, Cast->getType());
8274   }
8275 
8276   if (const SCEVTruncateExpr *Cast = dyn_cast<SCEVTruncateExpr>(V)) {
8277     const SCEV *Op = getSCEVAtScope(Cast->getOperand(), L);
8278     if (Op == Cast->getOperand())
8279       return Cast;  // must be loop invariant
8280     return getTruncateExpr(Op, Cast->getType());
8281   }
8282 
8283   llvm_unreachable("Unknown SCEV type!");
8284 }
8285 
8286 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getSCEVAtScope(Value *V, const Loop *L) {
8287   return getSCEVAtScope(getSCEV(V), L);
8288 }
8289 
8290 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::stripInjectiveFunctions(const SCEV *S) const {
8291   if (const SCEVZeroExtendExpr *ZExt = dyn_cast<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(S))
8292     return stripInjectiveFunctions(ZExt->getOperand());
8293   if (const SCEVSignExtendExpr *SExt = dyn_cast<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(S))
8294     return stripInjectiveFunctions(SExt->getOperand());
8295   return S;
8296 }
8297 
8298 /// Finds the minimum unsigned root of the following equation:
8299 ///
8300 ///     A * X = B (mod N)
8301 ///
8302 /// where N = 2^BW and BW is the common bit width of A and B. The signedness of
8303 /// A and B isn't important.
8304 ///
8305 /// If the equation does not have a solution, SCEVCouldNotCompute is returned.
8306 static const SCEV *SolveLinEquationWithOverflow(const APInt &A, const SCEV *B,
8307                                                ScalarEvolution &SE) {
8308   uint32_t BW = A.getBitWidth();
8309   assert(BW == SE.getTypeSizeInBits(B->getType()));
8310   assert(A != 0 && "A must be non-zero.");
8311 
8312   // 1. D = gcd(A, N)
8313   //
8314   // The gcd of A and N may have only one prime factor: 2. The number of
8315   // trailing zeros in A is its multiplicity
8316   uint32_t Mult2 = A.countTrailingZeros();
8317   // D = 2^Mult2
8318 
8319   // 2. Check if B is divisible by D.
8320   //
8321   // B is divisible by D if and only if the multiplicity of prime factor 2 for B
8322   // is not less than multiplicity of this prime factor for D.
8323   if (SE.GetMinTrailingZeros(B) < Mult2)
8324     return SE.getCouldNotCompute();
8325 
8326   // 3. Compute I: the multiplicative inverse of (A / D) in arithmetic
8327   // modulo (N / D).
8328   //
8329   // If D == 1, (N / D) == N == 2^BW, so we need one extra bit to represent
8330   // (N / D) in general. The inverse itself always fits into BW bits, though,
8331   // so we immediately truncate it.
8332   APInt AD = A.lshr(Mult2).zext(BW + 1);  // AD = A / D
8333   APInt Mod(BW + 1, 0);
8334   Mod.setBit(BW - Mult2);  // Mod = N / D
8335   APInt I = AD.multiplicativeInverse(Mod).trunc(BW);
8336 
8337   // 4. Compute the minimum unsigned root of the equation:
8338   // I * (B / D) mod (N / D)
8339   // To simplify the computation, we factor out the divide by D:
8340   // (I * B mod N) / D
8341   const SCEV *D = SE.getConstant(APInt::getOneBitSet(BW, Mult2));
8342   return SE.getUDivExactExpr(SE.getMulExpr(B, SE.getConstant(I)), D);
8343 }
8344 
8345 /// For a given quadratic addrec, generate coefficients of the corresponding
8346 /// quadratic equation, multiplied by a common value to ensure that they are
8347 /// integers.
8348 /// The returned value is a tuple { A, B, C, M, BitWidth }, where
8349 /// Ax^2 + Bx + C is the quadratic function, M is the value that A, B and C
8350 /// were multiplied by, and BitWidth is the bit width of the original addrec
8351 /// coefficients.
8352 /// This function returns None if the addrec coefficients are not compile-
8353 /// time constants.
8354 static Optional<std::tuple<APInt, APInt, APInt, APInt, unsigned>>
8355 GetQuadraticEquation(const SCEVAddRecExpr *AddRec) {
8356   assert(AddRec->getNumOperands() == 3 && "This is not a quadratic chrec!");
8357   const SCEVConstant *LC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(AddRec->getOperand(0));
8358   const SCEVConstant *MC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(AddRec->getOperand(1));
8359   const SCEVConstant *NC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(AddRec->getOperand(2));
8360   LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << __func__ << ": analyzing quadratic addrec: "
8361                     << *AddRec << '\n');
8362 
8363   // We currently can only solve this if the coefficients are constants.
8364   if (!LC || !MC || !NC) {
8365     LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << __func__ << ": coefficients are not constant\n");
8366     return None;
8367   }
8368 
8369   APInt L = LC->getAPInt();
8370   APInt M = MC->getAPInt();
8371   APInt N = NC->getAPInt();
8372   assert(!N.isNullValue() && "This is not a quadratic addrec");
8373 
8374   unsigned BitWidth = LC->getAPInt().getBitWidth();
8375   unsigned NewWidth = BitWidth + 1;
8376   LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << __func__ << ": addrec coeff bw: "
8377                     << BitWidth << '\n');
8378   // The sign-extension (as opposed to a zero-extension) here matches the
8379   // extension used in SolveQuadraticEquationWrap (with the same motivation).
8380   N = N.sext(NewWidth);
8381   M = M.sext(NewWidth);
8382   L = L.sext(NewWidth);
8383 
8384   // The increments are M, M+N, M+2N, ..., so the accumulated values are
8385   //   L+M, (L+M)+(M+N), (L+M)+(M+N)+(M+2N), ..., that is,
8386   //   L+M, L+2M+N, L+3M+3N, ...
8387   // After n iterations the accumulated value Acc is L + nM + n(n-1)/2 N.
8388   //
8389   // The equation Acc = 0 is then
8390   //   L + nM + n(n-1)/2 N = 0,  or  2L + 2M n + n(n-1) N = 0.
8391   // In a quadratic form it becomes:
8392   //   N n^2 + (2M-N) n + 2L = 0.
8393 
8394   APInt A = N;
8395   APInt B = 2 * M - A;
8396   APInt C = 2 * L;
8397   APInt T = APInt(NewWidth, 2);
8398   LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << __func__ << ": equation " << A << "x^2 + " << B
8399                     << "x + " << C << ", coeff bw: " << NewWidth
8400                     << ", multiplied by " << T << '\n');
8401   return std::make_tuple(A, B, C, T, BitWidth);
8402 }
8403 
8404 /// Helper function to compare optional APInts:
8405 /// (a) if X and Y both exist, return min(X, Y),
8406 /// (b) if neither X nor Y exist, return None,
8407 /// (c) if exactly one of X and Y exists, return that value.
8408 static Optional<APInt> MinOptional(Optional<APInt> X, Optional<APInt> Y) {
8409   if (X.hasValue() && Y.hasValue()) {
8410     unsigned W = std::max(X->getBitWidth(), Y->getBitWidth());
8411     APInt XW = X->sextOrSelf(W);
8412     APInt YW = Y->sextOrSelf(W);
8413     return XW.slt(YW) ? *X : *Y;
8414   }
8415   if (!X.hasValue() && !Y.hasValue())
8416     return None;
8417   return X.hasValue() ? *X : *Y;
8418 }
8419 
8420 /// Helper function to truncate an optional APInt to a given BitWidth.
8421 /// When solving addrec-related equations, it is preferable to return a value
8422 /// that has the same bit width as the original addrec's coefficients. If the
8423 /// solution fits in the original bit width, truncate it (except for i1).
8424 /// Returning a value of a different bit width may inhibit some optimizations.
8425 ///
8426 /// In general, a solution to a quadratic equation generated from an addrec
8427 /// may require BW+1 bits, where BW is the bit width of the addrec's
8428 /// coefficients. The reason is that the coefficients of the quadratic
8429 /// equation are BW+1 bits wide (to avoid truncation when converting from
8430 /// the addrec to the equation).
8431 static Optional<APInt> TruncIfPossible(Optional<APInt> X, unsigned BitWidth) {
8432   if (!X.hasValue())
8433     return None;
8434   unsigned W = X->getBitWidth();
8435   if (BitWidth > 1 && BitWidth < W && X->isIntN(BitWidth))
8436     return X->trunc(BitWidth);
8437   return X;
8438 }
8439 
8440 /// Let c(n) be the value of the quadratic chrec {L,+,M,+,N} after n
8441 /// iterations. The values L, M, N are assumed to be signed, and they
8442 /// should all have the same bit widths.
8443 /// Find the least n >= 0 such that c(n) = 0 in the arithmetic modulo 2^BW,
8444 /// where BW is the bit width of the addrec's coefficients.
8445 /// If the calculated value is a BW-bit integer (for BW > 1), it will be
8446 /// returned as such, otherwise the bit width of the returned value may
8447 /// be greater than BW.
8448 ///
8449 /// This function returns None if
8450 /// (a) the addrec coefficients are not constant, or
8451 /// (b) SolveQuadraticEquationWrap was unable to find a solution. For cases
8452 ///     like x^2 = 5, no integer solutions exist, in other cases an integer
8453 ///     solution may exist, but SolveQuadraticEquationWrap may fail to find it.
8454 static Optional<APInt>
8455 SolveQuadraticAddRecExact(const SCEVAddRecExpr *AddRec, ScalarEvolution &SE) {
8456   APInt A, B, C, M;
8457   unsigned BitWidth;
8458   auto T = GetQuadraticEquation(AddRec);
8459   if (!T.hasValue())
8460     return None;
8461 
8462   std::tie(A, B, C, M, BitWidth) = *T;
8463   LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << __func__ << ": solving for unsigned overflow\n");
8464   Optional<APInt> X = APIntOps::SolveQuadraticEquationWrap(A, B, C, BitWidth+1);
8465   if (!X.hasValue())
8466     return None;
8467 
8468   ConstantInt *CX = ConstantInt::get(SE.getContext(), *X);
8469   ConstantInt *V = EvaluateConstantChrecAtConstant(AddRec, CX, SE);
8470   if (!V->isZero())
8471     return None;
8472 
8473   return TruncIfPossible(X, BitWidth);
8474 }
8475 
8476 /// Let c(n) be the value of the quadratic chrec {0,+,M,+,N} after n
8477 /// iterations. The values M, N are assumed to be signed, and they
8478 /// should all have the same bit widths.
8479 /// Find the least n such that c(n) does not belong to the given range,
8480 /// while c(n-1) does.
8481 ///
8482 /// This function returns None if
8483 /// (a) the addrec coefficients are not constant, or
8484 /// (b) SolveQuadraticEquationWrap was unable to find a solution for the
8485 ///     bounds of the range.
8486 static Optional<APInt>
8487 SolveQuadraticAddRecRange(const SCEVAddRecExpr *AddRec,
8488                           const ConstantRange &Range, ScalarEvolution &SE) {
8489   assert(AddRec->getOperand(0)->isZero() &&
8490          "Starting value of addrec should be 0");
8491   LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << __func__ << ": solving boundary crossing for range "
8492                     << Range << ", addrec " << *AddRec << '\n');
8493   // This case is handled in getNumIterationsInRange. Here we can assume that
8494   // we start in the range.
8495   assert(Range.contains(APInt(SE.getTypeSizeInBits(AddRec->getType()), 0)) &&
8496          "Addrec's initial value should be in range");
8497 
8498   APInt A, B, C, M;
8499   unsigned BitWidth;
8500   auto T = GetQuadraticEquation(AddRec);
8501   if (!T.hasValue())
8502     return None;
8503 
8504   // Be careful about the return value: there can be two reasons for not
8505   // returning an actual number. First, if no solutions to the equations
8506   // were found, and second, if the solutions don't leave the given range.
8507   // The first case means that the actual solution is "unknown", the second
8508   // means that it's known, but not valid. If the solution is unknown, we
8509   // cannot make any conclusions.
8510   // Return a pair: the optional solution and a flag indicating if the
8511   // solution was found.
8512   auto SolveForBoundary = [&](APInt Bound) -> std::pair<Optional<APInt>,bool> {
8513     // Solve for signed overflow and unsigned overflow, pick the lower
8514     // solution.
8515     LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "SolveQuadraticAddRecRange: checking boundary "
8516                       << Bound << " (before multiplying by " << M << ")\n");
8517     Bound *= M; // The quadratic equation multiplier.
8518 
8519     Optional<APInt> SO = None;
8520     if (BitWidth > 1) {
8521       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "SolveQuadraticAddRecRange: solving for "
8522                            "signed overflow\n");
8523       SO = APIntOps::SolveQuadraticEquationWrap(A, B, -Bound, BitWidth);
8524     }
8525     LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "SolveQuadraticAddRecRange: solving for "
8526                          "unsigned overflow\n");
8527     Optional<APInt> UO = APIntOps::SolveQuadraticEquationWrap(A, B, -Bound,
8528                                                               BitWidth+1);
8529 
8530     auto LeavesRange = [&] (const APInt &X) {
8531       ConstantInt *C0 = ConstantInt::get(SE.getContext(), X);
8532       ConstantInt *V0 = EvaluateConstantChrecAtConstant(AddRec, C0, SE);
8533       if (Range.contains(V0->getValue()))
8534         return false;
8535       // X should be at least 1, so X-1 is non-negative.
8536       ConstantInt *C1 = ConstantInt::get(SE.getContext(), X-1);
8537       ConstantInt *V1 = EvaluateConstantChrecAtConstant(AddRec, C1, SE);
8538       if (Range.contains(V1->getValue()))
8539         return true;
8540       return false;
8541     };
8542 
8543     // If SolveQuadraticEquationWrap returns None, it means that there can
8544     // be a solution, but the function failed to find it. We cannot treat it
8545     // as "no solution".
8546     if (!SO.hasValue() || !UO.hasValue())
8547       return { None, false };
8548 
8549     // Check the smaller value first to see if it leaves the range.
8550     // At this point, both SO and UO must have values.
8551     Optional<APInt> Min = MinOptional(SO, UO);
8552     if (LeavesRange(*Min))
8553       return { Min, true };
8554     Optional<APInt> Max = Min == SO ? UO : SO;
8555     if (LeavesRange(*Max))
8556       return { Max, true };
8557 
8558     // Solutions were found, but were eliminated, hence the "true".
8559     return { None, true };
8560   };
8561 
8562   std::tie(A, B, C, M, BitWidth) = *T;
8563   // Lower bound is inclusive, subtract 1 to represent the exiting value.
8564   APInt Lower = Range.getLower().sextOrSelf(A.getBitWidth()) - 1;
8565   APInt Upper = Range.getUpper().sextOrSelf(A.getBitWidth());
8566   auto SL = SolveForBoundary(Lower);
8567   auto SU = SolveForBoundary(Upper);
8568   // If any of the solutions was unknown, no meaninigful conclusions can
8569   // be made.
8570   if (!SL.second || !SU.second)
8571     return None;
8572 
8573   // Claim: The correct solution is not some value between Min and Max.
8574   //
8575   // Justification: Assuming that Min and Max are different values, one of
8576   // them is when the first signed overflow happens, the other is when the
8577   // first unsigned overflow happens. Crossing the range boundary is only
8578   // possible via an overflow (treating 0 as a special case of it, modeling
8579   // an overflow as crossing k*2^W for some k).
8580   //
8581   // The interesting case here is when Min was eliminated as an invalid
8582   // solution, but Max was not. The argument is that if there was another
8583   // overflow between Min and Max, it would also have been eliminated if
8584   // it was considered.
8585   //
8586   // For a given boundary, it is possible to have two overflows of the same
8587   // type (signed/unsigned) without having the other type in between: this
8588   // can happen when the vertex of the parabola is between the iterations
8589   // corresponding to the overflows. This is only possible when the two
8590   // overflows cross k*2^W for the same k. In such case, if the second one
8591   // left the range (and was the first one to do so), the first overflow
8592   // would have to enter the range, which would mean that either we had left
8593   // the range before or that we started outside of it. Both of these cases
8594   // are contradictions.
8595   //
8596   // Claim: In the case where SolveForBoundary returns None, the correct
8597   // solution is not some value between the Max for this boundary and the
8598   // Min of the other boundary.
8599   //
8600   // Justification: Assume that we had such Max_A and Min_B corresponding
8601   // to range boundaries A and B and such that Max_A < Min_B. If there was
8602   // a solution between Max_A and Min_B, it would have to be caused by an
8603   // overflow corresponding to either A or B. It cannot correspond to B,
8604   // since Min_B is the first occurrence of such an overflow. If it
8605   // corresponded to A, it would have to be either a signed or an unsigned
8606   // overflow that is larger than both eliminated overflows for A. But
8607   // between the eliminated overflows and this overflow, the values would
8608   // cover the entire value space, thus crossing the other boundary, which
8609   // is a contradiction.
8610 
8611   return TruncIfPossible(MinOptional(SL.first, SU.first), BitWidth);
8612 }
8613 
8614 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit
8615 ScalarEvolution::howFarToZero(const SCEV *V, const Loop *L, bool ControlsExit,
8616                               bool AllowPredicates) {
8617 
8618   // This is only used for loops with a "x != y" exit test. The exit condition
8619   // is now expressed as a single expression, V = x-y. So the exit test is
8620   // effectively V != 0.  We know and take advantage of the fact that this
8621   // expression only being used in a comparison by zero context.
8622 
8623   SmallPtrSet<const SCEVPredicate *, 4> Predicates;
8624   // If the value is a constant
8625   if (const SCEVConstant *C = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(V)) {
8626     // If the value is already zero, the branch will execute zero times.
8627     if (C->getValue()->isZero()) return C;
8628     return getCouldNotCompute();  // Otherwise it will loop infinitely.
8629   }
8630 
8631   const SCEVAddRecExpr *AddRec =
8632       dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(stripInjectiveFunctions(V));
8633 
8634   if (!AddRec && AllowPredicates)
8635     // Try to make this an AddRec using runtime tests, in the first X
8636     // iterations of this loop, where X is the SCEV expression found by the
8637     // algorithm below.
8638     AddRec = convertSCEVToAddRecWithPredicates(V, L, Predicates);
8639 
8640   if (!AddRec || AddRec->getLoop() != L)
8641     return getCouldNotCompute();
8642 
8643   // If this is a quadratic (3-term) AddRec {L,+,M,+,N}, find the roots of
8644   // the quadratic equation to solve it.
8645   if (AddRec->isQuadratic() && AddRec->getType()->isIntegerTy()) {
8646     // We can only use this value if the chrec ends up with an exact zero
8647     // value at this index.  When solving for "X*X != 5", for example, we
8648     // should not accept a root of 2.
8649     if (auto S = SolveQuadraticAddRecExact(AddRec, *this)) {
8650       const auto *R = cast<SCEVConstant>(getConstant(S.getValue()));
8651       return ExitLimit(R, R, false, Predicates);
8652     }
8653     return getCouldNotCompute();
8654   }
8655 
8656   // Otherwise we can only handle this if it is affine.
8657   if (!AddRec->isAffine())
8658     return getCouldNotCompute();
8659 
8660   // If this is an affine expression, the execution count of this branch is
8661   // the minimum unsigned root of the following equation:
8662   //
8663   //     Start + Step*N = 0 (mod 2^BW)
8664   //
8665   // equivalent to:
8666   //
8667   //             Step*N = -Start (mod 2^BW)
8668   //
8669   // where BW is the common bit width of Start and Step.
8670 
8671   // Get the initial value for the loop.
8672   const SCEV *Start = getSCEVAtScope(AddRec->getStart(), L->getParentLoop());
8673   const SCEV *Step = getSCEVAtScope(AddRec->getOperand(1), L->getParentLoop());
8674 
8675   // For now we handle only constant steps.
8676   //
8677   // TODO: Handle a nonconstant Step given AddRec<NUW>. If the
8678   // AddRec is NUW, then (in an unsigned sense) it cannot be counting up to wrap
8679   // to 0, it must be counting down to equal 0. Consequently, N = Start / -Step.
8680   // We have not yet seen any such cases.
8681   const SCEVConstant *StepC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Step);
8682   if (!StepC || StepC->getValue()->isZero())
8683     return getCouldNotCompute();
8684 
8685   // For positive steps (counting up until unsigned overflow):
8686   //   N = -Start/Step (as unsigned)
8687   // For negative steps (counting down to zero):
8688   //   N = Start/-Step
8689   // First compute the unsigned distance from zero in the direction of Step.
8690   bool CountDown = StepC->getAPInt().isNegative();
8691   const SCEV *Distance = CountDown ? Start : getNegativeSCEV(Start);
8692 
8693   // Handle unitary steps, which cannot wraparound.
8694   // 1*N = -Start; -1*N = Start (mod 2^BW), so:
8695   //   N = Distance (as unsigned)
8696   if (StepC->getValue()->isOne() || StepC->getValue()->isMinusOne()) {
8697     APInt MaxBECount = getUnsignedRangeMax(Distance);
8698 
8699     // When a loop like "for (int i = 0; i != n; ++i) { /* body */ }" is rotated,
8700     // we end up with a loop whose backedge-taken count is n - 1.  Detect this
8701     // case, and see if we can improve the bound.
8702     //
8703     // Explicitly handling this here is necessary because getUnsignedRange
8704     // isn't context-sensitive; it doesn't know that we only care about the
8705     // range inside the loop.
8706     const SCEV *Zero = getZero(Distance->getType());
8707     const SCEV *One = getOne(Distance->getType());
8708     const SCEV *DistancePlusOne = getAddExpr(Distance, One);
8709     if (isLoopEntryGuardedByCond(L, ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, DistancePlusOne, Zero)) {
8710       // If Distance + 1 doesn't overflow, we can compute the maximum distance
8711       // as "unsigned_max(Distance + 1) - 1".
8712       ConstantRange CR = getUnsignedRange(DistancePlusOne);
8713       MaxBECount = APIntOps::umin(MaxBECount, CR.getUnsignedMax() - 1);
8714     }
8715     return ExitLimit(Distance, getConstant(MaxBECount), false, Predicates);
8716   }
8717 
8718   // If the condition controls loop exit (the loop exits only if the expression
8719   // is true) and the addition is no-wrap we can use unsigned divide to
8720   // compute the backedge count.  In this case, the step may not divide the
8721   // distance, but we don't care because if the condition is "missed" the loop
8722   // will have undefined behavior due to wrapping.
8723   if (ControlsExit && AddRec->hasNoSelfWrap() &&
8724       loopHasNoAbnormalExits(AddRec->getLoop())) {
8725     const SCEV *Exact =
8726         getUDivExpr(Distance, CountDown ? getNegativeSCEV(Step) : Step);
8727     const SCEV *Max =
8728         Exact == getCouldNotCompute()
8729             ? Exact
8730             : getConstant(getUnsignedRangeMax(Exact));
8731     return ExitLimit(Exact, Max, false, Predicates);
8732   }
8733 
8734   // Solve the general equation.
8735   const SCEV *E = SolveLinEquationWithOverflow(StepC->getAPInt(),
8736                                                getNegativeSCEV(Start), *this);
8737   const SCEV *M = E == getCouldNotCompute()
8738                       ? E
8739                       : getConstant(getUnsignedRangeMax(E));
8740   return ExitLimit(E, M, false, Predicates);
8741 }
8742 
8743 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit
8744 ScalarEvolution::howFarToNonZero(const SCEV *V, const Loop *L) {
8745   // Loops that look like: while (X == 0) are very strange indeed.  We don't
8746   // handle them yet except for the trivial case.  This could be expanded in the
8747   // future as needed.
8748 
8749   // If the value is a constant, check to see if it is known to be non-zero
8750   // already.  If so, the backedge will execute zero times.
8751   if (const SCEVConstant *C = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(V)) {
8752     if (!C->getValue()->isZero())
8753       return getZero(C->getType());
8754     return getCouldNotCompute();  // Otherwise it will loop infinitely.
8755   }
8756 
8757   // We could implement others, but I really doubt anyone writes loops like
8758   // this, and if they did, they would already be constant folded.
8759   return getCouldNotCompute();
8760 }
8761 
8762 std::pair<BasicBlock *, BasicBlock *>
8763 ScalarEvolution::getPredecessorWithUniqueSuccessorForBB(BasicBlock *BB) {
8764   // If the block has a unique predecessor, then there is no path from the
8765   // predecessor to the block that does not go through the direct edge
8766   // from the predecessor to the block.
8767   if (BasicBlock *Pred = BB->getSinglePredecessor())
8768     return {Pred, BB};
8769 
8770   // A loop's header is defined to be a block that dominates the loop.
8771   // If the header has a unique predecessor outside the loop, it must be
8772   // a block that has exactly one successor that can reach the loop.
8773   if (Loop *L = LI.getLoopFor(BB))
8774     return {L->getLoopPredecessor(), L->getHeader()};
8775 
8776   return {nullptr, nullptr};
8777 }
8778 
8779 /// SCEV structural equivalence is usually sufficient for testing whether two
8780 /// expressions are equal, however for the purposes of looking for a condition
8781 /// guarding a loop, it can be useful to be a little more general, since a
8782 /// front-end may have replicated the controlling expression.
8783 static bool HasSameValue(const SCEV *A, const SCEV *B) {
8784   // Quick check to see if they are the same SCEV.
8785   if (A == B) return true;
8786 
8787   auto ComputesEqualValues = [](const Instruction *A, const Instruction *B) {
8788     // Not all instructions that are "identical" compute the same value.  For
8789     // instance, two distinct alloca instructions allocating the same type are
8790     // identical and do not read memory; but compute distinct values.
8791     return A->isIdenticalTo(B) && (isa<BinaryOperator>(A) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(A));
8792   };
8793 
8794   // Otherwise, if they're both SCEVUnknown, it's possible that they hold
8795   // two different instructions with the same value. Check for this case.
8796   if (const SCEVUnknown *AU = dyn_cast<SCEVUnknown>(A))
8797     if (const SCEVUnknown *BU = dyn_cast<SCEVUnknown>(B))
8798       if (const Instruction *AI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(AU->getValue()))
8799         if (const Instruction *BI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(BU->getValue()))
8800           if (ComputesEqualValues(AI, BI))
8801             return true;
8802 
8803   // Otherwise assume they may have a different value.
8804   return false;
8805 }
8806 
8807 bool ScalarEvolution::SimplifyICmpOperands(ICmpInst::Predicate &Pred,
8808                                            const SCEV *&LHS, const SCEV *&RHS,
8809                                            unsigned Depth) {
8810   bool Changed = false;
8811   // Simplifies ICMP to trivial true or false by turning it into '0 == 0' or
8812   // '0 != 0'.
8813   auto TrivialCase = [&](bool TriviallyTrue) {
8814     LHS = RHS = getConstant(ConstantInt::getFalse(getContext()));
8815     Pred = TriviallyTrue ? ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ : ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
8816     return true;
8817   };
8818   // If we hit the max recursion limit bail out.
8819   if (Depth >= 3)
8820     return false;
8821 
8822   // Canonicalize a constant to the right side.
8823   if (const SCEVConstant *LHSC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(LHS)) {
8824     // Check for both operands constant.
8825     if (const SCEVConstant *RHSC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(RHS)) {
8826       if (ConstantExpr::getICmp(Pred,
8827                                 LHSC->getValue(),
8828                                 RHSC->getValue())->isNullValue())
8829         return TrivialCase(false);
8830       else
8831         return TrivialCase(true);
8832     }
8833     // Otherwise swap the operands to put the constant on the right.
8834     std::swap(LHS, RHS);
8835     Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
8836     Changed = true;
8837   }
8838 
8839   // If we're comparing an addrec with a value which is loop-invariant in the
8840   // addrec's loop, put the addrec on the left. Also make a dominance check,
8841   // as both operands could be addrecs loop-invariant in each other's loop.
8842   if (const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(RHS)) {
8843     const Loop *L = AR->getLoop();
8844     if (isLoopInvariant(LHS, L) && properlyDominates(LHS, L->getHeader())) {
8845       std::swap(LHS, RHS);
8846       Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
8847       Changed = true;
8848     }
8849   }
8850 
8851   // If there's a constant operand, canonicalize comparisons with boundary
8852   // cases, and canonicalize *-or-equal comparisons to regular comparisons.
8853   if (const SCEVConstant *RC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(RHS)) {
8854     const APInt &RA = RC->getAPInt();
8855 
8856     bool SimplifiedByConstantRange = false;
8857 
8858     if (!ICmpInst::isEquality(Pred)) {
8859       ConstantRange ExactCR = ConstantRange::makeExactICmpRegion(Pred, RA);
8860       if (ExactCR.isFullSet())
8861         return TrivialCase(true);
8862       else if (ExactCR.isEmptySet())
8863         return TrivialCase(false);
8864 
8865       APInt NewRHS;
8866       CmpInst::Predicate NewPred;
8867       if (ExactCR.getEquivalentICmp(NewPred, NewRHS) &&
8868           ICmpInst::isEquality(NewPred)) {
8869         // We were able to convert an inequality to an equality.
8870         Pred = NewPred;
8871         RHS = getConstant(NewRHS);
8872         Changed = SimplifiedByConstantRange = true;
8873       }
8874     }
8875 
8876     if (!SimplifiedByConstantRange) {
8877       switch (Pred) {
8878       default:
8879         break;
8880       case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
8881       case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
8882         // Fold ((-1) * %a) + %b == 0 (equivalent to %b-%a == 0) into %a == %b.
8883         if (!RA)
8884           if (const SCEVAddExpr *AE = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(LHS))
8885             if (const SCEVMulExpr *ME =
8886                     dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(AE->getOperand(0)))
8887               if (AE->getNumOperands() == 2 && ME->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
8888                   ME->getOperand(0)->isAllOnesValue()) {
8889                 RHS = AE->getOperand(1);
8890                 LHS = ME->getOperand(1);
8891                 Changed = true;
8892               }
8893         break;
8894 
8895 
8896         // The "Should have been caught earlier!" messages refer to the fact
8897         // that the ExactCR.isFullSet() or ExactCR.isEmptySet() check above
8898         // should have fired on the corresponding cases, and canonicalized the
8899         // check to trivial case.
8900 
8901       case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
8902         assert(!RA.isMinValue() && "Should have been caught earlier!");
8903         Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
8904         RHS = getConstant(RA - 1);
8905         Changed = true;
8906         break;
8907       case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
8908         assert(!RA.isMaxValue() && "Should have been caught earlier!");
8909         Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
8910         RHS = getConstant(RA + 1);
8911         Changed = true;
8912         break;
8913       case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
8914         assert(!RA.isMinSignedValue() && "Should have been caught earlier!");
8915         Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
8916         RHS = getConstant(RA - 1);
8917         Changed = true;
8918         break;
8919       case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
8920         assert(!RA.isMaxSignedValue() && "Should have been caught earlier!");
8921         Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
8922         RHS = getConstant(RA + 1);
8923         Changed = true;
8924         break;
8925       }
8926     }
8927   }
8928 
8929   // Check for obvious equality.
8930   if (HasSameValue(LHS, RHS)) {
8931     if (ICmpInst::isTrueWhenEqual(Pred))
8932       return TrivialCase(true);
8933     if (ICmpInst::isFalseWhenEqual(Pred))
8934       return TrivialCase(false);
8935   }
8936 
8937   // If possible, canonicalize GE/LE comparisons to GT/LT comparisons, by
8938   // adding or subtracting 1 from one of the operands.
8939   switch (Pred) {
8940   case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
8941     if (!getSignedRangeMax(RHS).isMaxSignedValue()) {
8942       RHS = getAddExpr(getConstant(RHS->getType(), 1, true), RHS,
8943                        SCEV::FlagNSW);
8944       Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
8945       Changed = true;
8946     } else if (!getSignedRangeMin(LHS).isMinSignedValue()) {
8947       LHS = getAddExpr(getConstant(RHS->getType(), (uint64_t)-1, true), LHS,
8948                        SCEV::FlagNSW);
8949       Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
8950       Changed = true;
8951     }
8952     break;
8953   case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
8954     if (!getSignedRangeMin(RHS).isMinSignedValue()) {
8955       RHS = getAddExpr(getConstant(RHS->getType(), (uint64_t)-1, true), RHS,
8956                        SCEV::FlagNSW);
8957       Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
8958       Changed = true;
8959     } else if (!getSignedRangeMax(LHS).isMaxSignedValue()) {
8960       LHS = getAddExpr(getConstant(RHS->getType(), 1, true), LHS,
8961                        SCEV::FlagNSW);
8962       Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
8963       Changed = true;
8964     }
8965     break;
8966   case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
8967     if (!getUnsignedRangeMax(RHS).isMaxValue()) {
8968       RHS = getAddExpr(getConstant(RHS->getType(), 1, true), RHS,
8969                        SCEV::FlagNUW);
8970       Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
8971       Changed = true;
8972     } else if (!getUnsignedRangeMin(LHS).isMinValue()) {
8973       LHS = getAddExpr(getConstant(RHS->getType(), (uint64_t)-1, true), LHS);
8974       Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
8975       Changed = true;
8976     }
8977     break;
8978   case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
8979     if (!getUnsignedRangeMin(RHS).isMinValue()) {
8980       RHS = getAddExpr(getConstant(RHS->getType(), (uint64_t)-1, true), RHS);
8981       Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
8982       Changed = true;
8983     } else if (!getUnsignedRangeMax(LHS).isMaxValue()) {
8984       LHS = getAddExpr(getConstant(RHS->getType(), 1, true), LHS,
8985                        SCEV::FlagNUW);
8986       Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
8987       Changed = true;
8988     }
8989     break;
8990   default:
8991     break;
8992   }
8993 
8994   // TODO: More simplifications are possible here.
8995 
8996   // Recursively simplify until we either hit a recursion limit or nothing
8997   // changes.
8998   if (Changed)
8999     return SimplifyICmpOperands(Pred, LHS, RHS, Depth+1);
9000 
9001   return Changed;
9002 }
9003 
9004 bool ScalarEvolution::isKnownNegative(const SCEV *S) {
9005   return getSignedRangeMax(S).isNegative();
9006 }
9007 
9008 bool ScalarEvolution::isKnownPositive(const SCEV *S) {
9009   return getSignedRangeMin(S).isStrictlyPositive();
9010 }
9011 
9012 bool ScalarEvolution::isKnownNonNegative(const SCEV *S) {
9013   return !getSignedRangeMin(S).isNegative();
9014 }
9015 
9016 bool ScalarEvolution::isKnownNonPositive(const SCEV *S) {
9017   return !getSignedRangeMax(S).isStrictlyPositive();
9018 }
9019 
9020 bool ScalarEvolution::isKnownNonZero(const SCEV *S) {
9021   return isKnownNegative(S) || isKnownPositive(S);
9022 }
9023 
9024 std::pair<const SCEV *, const SCEV *>
9025 ScalarEvolution::SplitIntoInitAndPostInc(const Loop *L, const SCEV *S) {
9026   // Compute SCEV on entry of loop L.
9027   const SCEV *Start = SCEVInitRewriter::rewrite(S, L, *this);
9028   if (Start == getCouldNotCompute())
9029     return { Start, Start };
9030   // Compute post increment SCEV for loop L.
9031   const SCEV *PostInc = SCEVPostIncRewriter::rewrite(S, L, *this);
9032   assert(PostInc != getCouldNotCompute() && "Unexpected could not compute");
9033   return { Start, PostInc };
9034 }
9035 
9036 bool ScalarEvolution::isKnownViaInduction(ICmpInst::Predicate Pred,
9037                                           const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS) {
9038   // First collect all loops.
9039   SmallPtrSet<const Loop *, 8> LoopsUsed;
9040   getUsedLoops(LHS, LoopsUsed);
9041   getUsedLoops(RHS, LoopsUsed);
9042 
9043   if (LoopsUsed.empty())
9044     return false;
9045 
9046   // Domination relationship must be a linear order on collected loops.
9047 #ifndef NDEBUG
9048   for (auto *L1 : LoopsUsed)
9049     for (auto *L2 : LoopsUsed)
9050       assert((DT.dominates(L1->getHeader(), L2->getHeader()) ||
9051               DT.dominates(L2->getHeader(), L1->getHeader())) &&
9052              "Domination relationship is not a linear order");
9053 #endif
9054 
9055   const Loop *MDL =
9056       *std::max_element(LoopsUsed.begin(), LoopsUsed.end(),
9057                         [&](const Loop *L1, const Loop *L2) {
9058          return DT.properlyDominates(L1->getHeader(), L2->getHeader());
9059        });
9060 
9061   // Get init and post increment value for LHS.
9062   auto SplitLHS = SplitIntoInitAndPostInc(MDL, LHS);
9063   // if LHS contains unknown non-invariant SCEV then bail out.
9064   if (SplitLHS.first == getCouldNotCompute())
9065     return false;
9066   assert (SplitLHS.second != getCouldNotCompute() && "Unexpected CNC");
9067   // Get init and post increment value for RHS.
9068   auto SplitRHS = SplitIntoInitAndPostInc(MDL, RHS);
9069   // if RHS contains unknown non-invariant SCEV then bail out.
9070   if (SplitRHS.first == getCouldNotCompute())
9071     return false;
9072   assert (SplitRHS.second != getCouldNotCompute() && "Unexpected CNC");
9073   // It is possible that init SCEV contains an invariant load but it does
9074   // not dominate MDL and is not available at MDL loop entry, so we should
9075   // check it here.
9076   if (!isAvailableAtLoopEntry(SplitLHS.first, MDL) ||
9077       !isAvailableAtLoopEntry(SplitRHS.first, MDL))
9078     return false;
9079 
9080   return isLoopEntryGuardedByCond(MDL, Pred, SplitLHS.first, SplitRHS.first) &&
9081          isLoopBackedgeGuardedByCond(MDL, Pred, SplitLHS.second,
9082                                      SplitRHS.second);
9083 }
9084 
9085 bool ScalarEvolution::isKnownPredicate(ICmpInst::Predicate Pred,
9086                                        const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS) {
9087   // Canonicalize the inputs first.
9088   (void)SimplifyICmpOperands(Pred, LHS, RHS);
9089 
9090   if (isKnownViaInduction(Pred, LHS, RHS))
9091     return true;
9092 
9093   if (isKnownPredicateViaSplitting(Pred, LHS, RHS))
9094     return true;
9095 
9096   // Otherwise see what can be done with some simple reasoning.
9097   return isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(Pred, LHS, RHS);
9098 }
9099 
9100 bool ScalarEvolution::isKnownOnEveryIteration(ICmpInst::Predicate Pred,
9101                                               const SCEVAddRecExpr *LHS,
9102                                               const SCEV *RHS) {
9103   const Loop *L = LHS->getLoop();
9104   return isLoopEntryGuardedByCond(L, Pred, LHS->getStart(), RHS) &&
9105          isLoopBackedgeGuardedByCond(L, Pred, LHS->getPostIncExpr(*this), RHS);
9106 }
9107 
9108 bool ScalarEvolution::isMonotonicPredicate(const SCEVAddRecExpr *LHS,
9109                                            ICmpInst::Predicate Pred,
9110                                            bool &Increasing) {
9111   bool Result = isMonotonicPredicateImpl(LHS, Pred, Increasing);
9112 
9113 #ifndef NDEBUG
9114   // Verify an invariant: inverting the predicate should turn a monotonically
9115   // increasing change to a monotonically decreasing one, and vice versa.
9116   bool IncreasingSwapped;
9117   bool ResultSwapped = isMonotonicPredicateImpl(
9118       LHS, ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred), IncreasingSwapped);
9119 
9120   assert(Result == ResultSwapped && "should be able to analyze both!");
9121   if (ResultSwapped)
9122     assert(Increasing == !IncreasingSwapped &&
9123            "monotonicity should flip as we flip the predicate");
9124 #endif
9125 
9126   return Result;
9127 }
9128 
9129 bool ScalarEvolution::isMonotonicPredicateImpl(const SCEVAddRecExpr *LHS,
9130                                                ICmpInst::Predicate Pred,
9131                                                bool &Increasing) {
9132 
9133   // A zero step value for LHS means the induction variable is essentially a
9134   // loop invariant value. We don't really depend on the predicate actually
9135   // flipping from false to true (for increasing predicates, and the other way
9136   // around for decreasing predicates), all we care about is that *if* the
9137   // predicate changes then it only changes from false to true.
9138   //
9139   // A zero step value in itself is not very useful, but there may be places
9140   // where SCEV can prove X >= 0 but not prove X > 0, so it is helpful to be
9141   // as general as possible.
9142 
9143   switch (Pred) {
9144   default:
9145     return false; // Conservative answer
9146 
9147   case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
9148   case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
9149   case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
9150   case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
9151     if (!LHS->hasNoUnsignedWrap())
9152       return false;
9153 
9154     Increasing = Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE;
9155     return true;
9156 
9157   case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
9158   case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
9159   case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
9160   case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: {
9161     if (!LHS->hasNoSignedWrap())
9162       return false;
9163 
9164     const SCEV *Step = LHS->getStepRecurrence(*this);
9165 
9166     if (isKnownNonNegative(Step)) {
9167       Increasing = Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
9168       return true;
9169     }
9170 
9171     if (isKnownNonPositive(Step)) {
9172       Increasing = Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
9173       return true;
9174     }
9175 
9176     return false;
9177   }
9178 
9179   }
9180 
9181   llvm_unreachable("switch has default clause!");
9182 }
9183 
9184 bool ScalarEvolution::isLoopInvariantPredicate(
9185     ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS, const Loop *L,
9186     ICmpInst::Predicate &InvariantPred, const SCEV *&InvariantLHS,
9187     const SCEV *&InvariantRHS) {
9188 
9189   // If there is a loop-invariant, force it into the RHS, otherwise bail out.
9190   if (!isLoopInvariant(RHS, L)) {
9191     if (!isLoopInvariant(LHS, L))
9192       return false;
9193 
9194     std::swap(LHS, RHS);
9195     Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
9196   }
9197 
9198   const SCEVAddRecExpr *ArLHS = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(LHS);
9199   if (!ArLHS || ArLHS->getLoop() != L)
9200     return false;
9201 
9202   bool Increasing;
9203   if (!isMonotonicPredicate(ArLHS, Pred, Increasing))
9204     return false;
9205 
9206   // If the predicate "ArLHS `Pred` RHS" monotonically increases from false to
9207   // true as the loop iterates, and the backedge is control dependent on
9208   // "ArLHS `Pred` RHS" == true then we can reason as follows:
9209   //
9210   //   * if the predicate was false in the first iteration then the predicate
9211   //     is never evaluated again, since the loop exits without taking the
9212   //     backedge.
9213   //   * if the predicate was true in the first iteration then it will
9214   //     continue to be true for all future iterations since it is
9215   //     monotonically increasing.
9216   //
9217   // For both the above possibilities, we can replace the loop varying
9218   // predicate with its value on the first iteration of the loop (which is
9219   // loop invariant).
9220   //
9221   // A similar reasoning applies for a monotonically decreasing predicate, by
9222   // replacing true with false and false with true in the above two bullets.
9223 
9224   auto P = Increasing ? Pred : ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(Pred);
9225 
9226   if (!isLoopBackedgeGuardedByCond(L, P, LHS, RHS))
9227     return false;
9228 
9229   InvariantPred = Pred;
9230   InvariantLHS = ArLHS->getStart();
9231   InvariantRHS = RHS;
9232   return true;
9233 }
9234 
9235 bool ScalarEvolution::isKnownPredicateViaConstantRanges(
9236     ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS) {
9237   if (HasSameValue(LHS, RHS))
9238     return ICmpInst::isTrueWhenEqual(Pred);
9239 
9240   // This code is split out from isKnownPredicate because it is called from
9241   // within isLoopEntryGuardedByCond.
9242 
9243   auto CheckRanges =
9244       [&](const ConstantRange &RangeLHS, const ConstantRange &RangeRHS) {
9245     return ConstantRange::makeSatisfyingICmpRegion(Pred, RangeRHS)
9246         .contains(RangeLHS);
9247   };
9248 
9249   // The check at the top of the function catches the case where the values are
9250   // known to be equal.
9251   if (Pred == CmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
9252     return false;
9253 
9254   if (Pred == CmpInst::ICMP_NE)
9255     return CheckRanges(getSignedRange(LHS), getSignedRange(RHS)) ||
9256            CheckRanges(getUnsignedRange(LHS), getUnsignedRange(RHS)) ||
9257            isKnownNonZero(getMinusSCEV(LHS, RHS));
9258 
9259   if (CmpInst::isSigned(Pred))
9260     return CheckRanges(getSignedRange(LHS), getSignedRange(RHS));
9261 
9262   return CheckRanges(getUnsignedRange(LHS), getUnsignedRange(RHS));
9263 }
9264 
9265 bool ScalarEvolution::isKnownPredicateViaNoOverflow(ICmpInst::Predicate Pred,
9266                                                     const SCEV *LHS,
9267                                                     const SCEV *RHS) {
9268   // Match Result to (X + Y)<ExpectedFlags> where Y is a constant integer.
9269   // Return Y via OutY.
9270   auto MatchBinaryAddToConst =
9271       [this](const SCEV *Result, const SCEV *X, APInt &OutY,
9272              SCEV::NoWrapFlags ExpectedFlags) {
9273     const SCEV *NonConstOp, *ConstOp;
9274     SCEV::NoWrapFlags FlagsPresent;
9275 
9276     if (!splitBinaryAdd(Result, ConstOp, NonConstOp, FlagsPresent) ||
9277         !isa<SCEVConstant>(ConstOp) || NonConstOp != X)
9278       return false;
9279 
9280     OutY = cast<SCEVConstant>(ConstOp)->getAPInt();
9281     return (FlagsPresent & ExpectedFlags) == ExpectedFlags;
9282   };
9283 
9284   APInt C;
9285 
9286   switch (Pred) {
9287   default:
9288     break;
9289 
9290   case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
9291     std::swap(LHS, RHS);
9292     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
9293   case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
9294     // X s<= (X + C)<nsw> if C >= 0
9295     if (MatchBinaryAddToConst(RHS, LHS, C, SCEV::FlagNSW) && C.isNonNegative())
9296       return true;
9297 
9298     // (X + C)<nsw> s<= X if C <= 0
9299     if (MatchBinaryAddToConst(LHS, RHS, C, SCEV::FlagNSW) &&
9300         !C.isStrictlyPositive())
9301       return true;
9302     break;
9303 
9304   case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
9305     std::swap(LHS, RHS);
9306     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
9307   case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
9308     // X s< (X + C)<nsw> if C > 0
9309     if (MatchBinaryAddToConst(RHS, LHS, C, SCEV::FlagNSW) &&
9310         C.isStrictlyPositive())
9311       return true;
9312 
9313     // (X + C)<nsw> s< X if C < 0
9314     if (MatchBinaryAddToConst(LHS, RHS, C, SCEV::FlagNSW) && C.isNegative())
9315       return true;
9316     break;
9317   }
9318 
9319   return false;
9320 }
9321 
9322 bool ScalarEvolution::isKnownPredicateViaSplitting(ICmpInst::Predicate Pred,
9323                                                    const SCEV *LHS,
9324                                                    const SCEV *RHS) {
9325   if (Pred != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT || ProvingSplitPredicate)
9326     return false;
9327 
9328   // Allowing arbitrary number of activations of isKnownPredicateViaSplitting on
9329   // the stack can result in exponential time complexity.
9330   SaveAndRestore<bool> Restore(ProvingSplitPredicate, true);
9331 
9332   // If L >= 0 then I `ult` L <=> I >= 0 && I `slt` L
9333   //
9334   // To prove L >= 0 we use isKnownNonNegative whereas to prove I >= 0 we use
9335   // isKnownPredicate.  isKnownPredicate is more powerful, but also more
9336   // expensive; and using isKnownNonNegative(RHS) is sufficient for most of the
9337   // interesting cases seen in practice.  We can consider "upgrading" L >= 0 to
9338   // use isKnownPredicate later if needed.
9339   return isKnownNonNegative(RHS) &&
9340          isKnownPredicate(CmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, getZero(LHS->getType())) &&
9341          isKnownPredicate(CmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHS, RHS);
9342 }
9343 
9344 bool ScalarEvolution::isImpliedViaGuard(BasicBlock *BB,
9345                                         ICmpInst::Predicate Pred,
9346                                         const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS) {
9347   // No need to even try if we know the module has no guards.
9348   if (!HasGuards)
9349     return false;
9350 
9351   return any_of(*BB, [&](Instruction &I) {
9352     using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
9353 
9354     Value *Condition;
9355     return match(&I, m_Intrinsic<Intrinsic::experimental_guard>(
9356                          m_Value(Condition))) &&
9357            isImpliedCond(Pred, LHS, RHS, Condition, false);
9358   });
9359 }
9360 
9361 /// isLoopBackedgeGuardedByCond - Test whether the backedge of the loop is
9362 /// protected by a conditional between LHS and RHS.  This is used to
9363 /// to eliminate casts.
9364 bool
9365 ScalarEvolution::isLoopBackedgeGuardedByCond(const Loop *L,
9366                                              ICmpInst::Predicate Pred,
9367                                              const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS) {
9368   // Interpret a null as meaning no loop, where there is obviously no guard
9369   // (interprocedural conditions notwithstanding).
9370   if (!L) return true;
9371 
9372   if (isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(Pred, LHS, RHS))
9373     return true;
9374 
9375   BasicBlock *Latch = L->getLoopLatch();
9376   if (!Latch)
9377     return false;
9378 
9379   BranchInst *LoopContinuePredicate =
9380     dyn_cast<BranchInst>(Latch->getTerminator());
9381   if (LoopContinuePredicate && LoopContinuePredicate->isConditional() &&
9382       isImpliedCond(Pred, LHS, RHS,
9383                     LoopContinuePredicate->getCondition(),
9384                     LoopContinuePredicate->getSuccessor(0) != L->getHeader()))
9385     return true;
9386 
9387   // We don't want more than one activation of the following loops on the stack
9388   // -- that can lead to O(n!) time complexity.
9389   if (WalkingBEDominatingConds)
9390     return false;
9391 
9392   SaveAndRestore<bool> ClearOnExit(WalkingBEDominatingConds, true);
9393 
9394   // See if we can exploit a trip count to prove the predicate.
9395   const auto &BETakenInfo = getBackedgeTakenInfo(L);
9396   const SCEV *LatchBECount = BETakenInfo.getExact(Latch, this);
9397   if (LatchBECount != getCouldNotCompute()) {
9398     // We know that Latch branches back to the loop header exactly
9399     // LatchBECount times.  This means the backdege condition at Latch is
9400     // equivalent to  "{0,+,1} u< LatchBECount".
9401     Type *Ty = LatchBECount->getType();
9402     auto NoWrapFlags = SCEV::NoWrapFlags(SCEV::FlagNUW | SCEV::FlagNW);
9403     const SCEV *LoopCounter =
9404       getAddRecExpr(getZero(Ty), getOne(Ty), L, NoWrapFlags);
9405     if (isImpliedCond(Pred, LHS, RHS, ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LoopCounter,
9406                       LatchBECount))
9407       return true;
9408   }
9409 
9410   // Check conditions due to any @llvm.assume intrinsics.
9411   for (auto &AssumeVH : AC.assumptions()) {
9412     if (!AssumeVH)
9413       continue;
9414     auto *CI = cast<CallInst>(AssumeVH);
9415     if (!DT.dominates(CI, Latch->getTerminator()))
9416       continue;
9417 
9418     if (isImpliedCond(Pred, LHS, RHS, CI->getArgOperand(0), false))
9419       return true;
9420   }
9421 
9422   // If the loop is not reachable from the entry block, we risk running into an
9423   // infinite loop as we walk up into the dom tree.  These loops do not matter
9424   // anyway, so we just return a conservative answer when we see them.
9425   if (!DT.isReachableFromEntry(L->getHeader()))
9426     return false;
9427 
9428   if (isImpliedViaGuard(Latch, Pred, LHS, RHS))
9429     return true;
9430 
9431   for (DomTreeNode *DTN = DT[Latch], *HeaderDTN = DT[L->getHeader()];
9432        DTN != HeaderDTN; DTN = DTN->getIDom()) {
9433     assert(DTN && "should reach the loop header before reaching the root!");
9434 
9435     BasicBlock *BB = DTN->getBlock();
9436     if (isImpliedViaGuard(BB, Pred, LHS, RHS))
9437       return true;
9438 
9439     BasicBlock *PBB = BB->getSinglePredecessor();
9440     if (!PBB)
9441       continue;
9442 
9443     BranchInst *ContinuePredicate = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(PBB->getTerminator());
9444     if (!ContinuePredicate || !ContinuePredicate->isConditional())
9445       continue;
9446 
9447     Value *Condition = ContinuePredicate->getCondition();
9448 
9449     // If we have an edge `E` within the loop body that dominates the only
9450     // latch, the condition guarding `E` also guards the backedge.  This
9451     // reasoning works only for loops with a single latch.
9452 
9453     BasicBlockEdge DominatingEdge(PBB, BB);
9454     if (DominatingEdge.isSingleEdge()) {
9455       // We're constructively (and conservatively) enumerating edges within the
9456       // loop body that dominate the latch.  The dominator tree better agree
9457       // with us on this:
9458       assert(DT.dominates(DominatingEdge, Latch) && "should be!");
9459 
9460       if (isImpliedCond(Pred, LHS, RHS, Condition,
9461                         BB != ContinuePredicate->getSuccessor(0)))
9462         return true;
9463     }
9464   }
9465 
9466   return false;
9467 }
9468 
9469 bool
9470 ScalarEvolution::isLoopEntryGuardedByCond(const Loop *L,
9471                                           ICmpInst::Predicate Pred,
9472                                           const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS) {
9473   // Interpret a null as meaning no loop, where there is obviously no guard
9474   // (interprocedural conditions notwithstanding).
9475   if (!L) return false;
9476 
9477   // Both LHS and RHS must be available at loop entry.
9478   assert(isAvailableAtLoopEntry(LHS, L) &&
9479          "LHS is not available at Loop Entry");
9480   assert(isAvailableAtLoopEntry(RHS, L) &&
9481          "RHS is not available at Loop Entry");
9482 
9483   if (isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(Pred, LHS, RHS))
9484     return true;
9485 
9486   // If we cannot prove strict comparison (e.g. a > b), maybe we can prove
9487   // the facts (a >= b && a != b) separately. A typical situation is when the
9488   // non-strict comparison is known from ranges and non-equality is known from
9489   // dominating predicates. If we are proving strict comparison, we always try
9490   // to prove non-equality and non-strict comparison separately.
9491   auto NonStrictPredicate = ICmpInst::getNonStrictPredicate(Pred);
9492   const bool ProvingStrictComparison = (Pred != NonStrictPredicate);
9493   bool ProvedNonStrictComparison = false;
9494   bool ProvedNonEquality = false;
9495 
9496   if (ProvingStrictComparison) {
9497     ProvedNonStrictComparison =
9498         isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(NonStrictPredicate, LHS, RHS);
9499     ProvedNonEquality =
9500         isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS);
9501     if (ProvedNonStrictComparison && ProvedNonEquality)
9502       return true;
9503   }
9504 
9505   // Try to prove (Pred, LHS, RHS) using isImpliedViaGuard.
9506   auto ProveViaGuard = [&](BasicBlock *Block) {
9507     if (isImpliedViaGuard(Block, Pred, LHS, RHS))
9508       return true;
9509     if (ProvingStrictComparison) {
9510       if (!ProvedNonStrictComparison)
9511         ProvedNonStrictComparison =
9512             isImpliedViaGuard(Block, NonStrictPredicate, LHS, RHS);
9513       if (!ProvedNonEquality)
9514         ProvedNonEquality =
9515             isImpliedViaGuard(Block, ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS);
9516       if (ProvedNonStrictComparison && ProvedNonEquality)
9517         return true;
9518     }
9519     return false;
9520   };
9521 
9522   // Try to prove (Pred, LHS, RHS) using isImpliedCond.
9523   auto ProveViaCond = [&](Value *Condition, bool Inverse) {
9524     if (isImpliedCond(Pred, LHS, RHS, Condition, Inverse))
9525       return true;
9526     if (ProvingStrictComparison) {
9527       if (!ProvedNonStrictComparison)
9528         ProvedNonStrictComparison =
9529             isImpliedCond(NonStrictPredicate, LHS, RHS, Condition, Inverse);
9530       if (!ProvedNonEquality)
9531         ProvedNonEquality =
9532             isImpliedCond(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS, Condition, Inverse);
9533       if (ProvedNonStrictComparison && ProvedNonEquality)
9534         return true;
9535     }
9536     return false;
9537   };
9538 
9539   // Starting at the loop predecessor, climb up the predecessor chain, as long
9540   // as there are predecessors that can be found that have unique successors
9541   // leading to the original header.
9542   for (std::pair<BasicBlock *, BasicBlock *>
9543          Pair(L->getLoopPredecessor(), L->getHeader());
9544        Pair.first;
9545        Pair = getPredecessorWithUniqueSuccessorForBB(Pair.first)) {
9546 
9547     if (ProveViaGuard(Pair.first))
9548       return true;
9549 
9550     BranchInst *LoopEntryPredicate =
9551       dyn_cast<BranchInst>(Pair.first->getTerminator());
9552     if (!LoopEntryPredicate ||
9553         LoopEntryPredicate->isUnconditional())
9554       continue;
9555 
9556     if (ProveViaCond(LoopEntryPredicate->getCondition(),
9557                      LoopEntryPredicate->getSuccessor(0) != Pair.second))
9558       return true;
9559   }
9560 
9561   // Check conditions due to any @llvm.assume intrinsics.
9562   for (auto &AssumeVH : AC.assumptions()) {
9563     if (!AssumeVH)
9564       continue;
9565     auto *CI = cast<CallInst>(AssumeVH);
9566     if (!DT.dominates(CI, L->getHeader()))
9567       continue;
9568 
9569     if (ProveViaCond(CI->getArgOperand(0), false))
9570       return true;
9571   }
9572 
9573   return false;
9574 }
9575 
9576 bool ScalarEvolution::isImpliedCond(ICmpInst::Predicate Pred,
9577                                     const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS,
9578                                     Value *FoundCondValue,
9579                                     bool Inverse) {
9580   if (!PendingLoopPredicates.insert(FoundCondValue).second)
9581     return false;
9582 
9583   auto ClearOnExit =
9584       make_scope_exit([&]() { PendingLoopPredicates.erase(FoundCondValue); });
9585 
9586   // Recursively handle And and Or conditions.
9587   if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FoundCondValue)) {
9588     if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
9589       if (!Inverse)
9590         return isImpliedCond(Pred, LHS, RHS, BO->getOperand(0), Inverse) ||
9591                isImpliedCond(Pred, LHS, RHS, BO->getOperand(1), Inverse);
9592     } else if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
9593       if (Inverse)
9594         return isImpliedCond(Pred, LHS, RHS, BO->getOperand(0), Inverse) ||
9595                isImpliedCond(Pred, LHS, RHS, BO->getOperand(1), Inverse);
9596     }
9597   }
9598 
9599   ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(FoundCondValue);
9600   if (!ICI) return false;
9601 
9602   // Now that we found a conditional branch that dominates the loop or controls
9603   // the loop latch. Check to see if it is the comparison we are looking for.
9604   ICmpInst::Predicate FoundPred;
9605   if (Inverse)
9606     FoundPred = ICI->getInversePredicate();
9607   else
9608     FoundPred = ICI->getPredicate();
9609 
9610   const SCEV *FoundLHS = getSCEV(ICI->getOperand(0));
9611   const SCEV *FoundRHS = getSCEV(ICI->getOperand(1));
9612 
9613   return isImpliedCond(Pred, LHS, RHS, FoundPred, FoundLHS, FoundRHS);
9614 }
9615 
9616 bool ScalarEvolution::isImpliedCond(ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, const SCEV *LHS,
9617                                     const SCEV *RHS,
9618                                     ICmpInst::Predicate FoundPred,
9619                                     const SCEV *FoundLHS,
9620                                     const SCEV *FoundRHS) {
9621   // Balance the types.
9622   if (getTypeSizeInBits(LHS->getType()) <
9623       getTypeSizeInBits(FoundLHS->getType())) {
9624     if (CmpInst::isSigned(Pred)) {
9625       LHS = getSignExtendExpr(LHS, FoundLHS->getType());
9626       RHS = getSignExtendExpr(RHS, FoundLHS->getType());
9627     } else {
9628       LHS = getZeroExtendExpr(LHS, FoundLHS->getType());
9629       RHS = getZeroExtendExpr(RHS, FoundLHS->getType());
9630     }
9631   } else if (getTypeSizeInBits(LHS->getType()) >
9632       getTypeSizeInBits(FoundLHS->getType())) {
9633     if (CmpInst::isSigned(FoundPred)) {
9634       FoundLHS = getSignExtendExpr(FoundLHS, LHS->getType());
9635       FoundRHS = getSignExtendExpr(FoundRHS, LHS->getType());
9636     } else {
9637       FoundLHS = getZeroExtendExpr(FoundLHS, LHS->getType());
9638       FoundRHS = getZeroExtendExpr(FoundRHS, LHS->getType());
9639     }
9640   }
9641 
9642   // Canonicalize the query to match the way instcombine will have
9643   // canonicalized the comparison.
9644   if (SimplifyICmpOperands(Pred, LHS, RHS))
9645     if (LHS == RHS)
9646       return CmpInst::isTrueWhenEqual(Pred);
9647   if (SimplifyICmpOperands(FoundPred, FoundLHS, FoundRHS))
9648     if (FoundLHS == FoundRHS)
9649       return CmpInst::isFalseWhenEqual(FoundPred);
9650 
9651   // Check to see if we can make the LHS or RHS match.
9652   if (LHS == FoundRHS || RHS == FoundLHS) {
9653     if (isa<SCEVConstant>(RHS)) {
9654       std::swap(FoundLHS, FoundRHS);
9655       FoundPred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(FoundPred);
9656     } else {
9657       std::swap(LHS, RHS);
9658       Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
9659     }
9660   }
9661 
9662   // Check whether the found predicate is the same as the desired predicate.
9663   if (FoundPred == Pred)
9664     return isImpliedCondOperands(Pred, LHS, RHS, FoundLHS, FoundRHS);
9665 
9666   // Check whether swapping the found predicate makes it the same as the
9667   // desired predicate.
9668   if (ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(FoundPred) == Pred) {
9669     if (isa<SCEVConstant>(RHS))
9670       return isImpliedCondOperands(Pred, LHS, RHS, FoundRHS, FoundLHS);
9671     else
9672       return isImpliedCondOperands(ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred),
9673                                    RHS, LHS, FoundLHS, FoundRHS);
9674   }
9675 
9676   // Unsigned comparison is the same as signed comparison when both the operands
9677   // are non-negative.
9678   if (CmpInst::isUnsigned(FoundPred) &&
9679       CmpInst::getSignedPredicate(FoundPred) == Pred &&
9680       isKnownNonNegative(FoundLHS) && isKnownNonNegative(FoundRHS))
9681     return isImpliedCondOperands(Pred, LHS, RHS, FoundLHS, FoundRHS);
9682 
9683   // Check if we can make progress by sharpening ranges.
9684   if (FoundPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE &&
9685       (isa<SCEVConstant>(FoundLHS) || isa<SCEVConstant>(FoundRHS))) {
9686 
9687     const SCEVConstant *C = nullptr;
9688     const SCEV *V = nullptr;
9689 
9690     if (isa<SCEVConstant>(FoundLHS)) {
9691       C = cast<SCEVConstant>(FoundLHS);
9692       V = FoundRHS;
9693     } else {
9694       C = cast<SCEVConstant>(FoundRHS);
9695       V = FoundLHS;
9696     }
9697 
9698     // The guarding predicate tells us that C != V. If the known range
9699     // of V is [C, t), we can sharpen the range to [C + 1, t).  The
9700     // range we consider has to correspond to same signedness as the
9701     // predicate we're interested in folding.
9702 
9703     APInt Min = ICmpInst::isSigned(Pred) ?
9704         getSignedRangeMin(V) : getUnsignedRangeMin(V);
9705 
9706     if (Min == C->getAPInt()) {
9707       // Given (V >= Min && V != Min) we conclude V >= (Min + 1).
9708       // This is true even if (Min + 1) wraps around -- in case of
9709       // wraparound, (Min + 1) < Min, so (V >= Min => V >= (Min + 1)).
9710 
9711       APInt SharperMin = Min + 1;
9712 
9713       switch (Pred) {
9714         case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
9715         case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
9716           // We know V `Pred` SharperMin.  If this implies LHS `Pred`
9717           // RHS, we're done.
9718           if (isImpliedCondOperands(Pred, LHS, RHS, V,
9719                                     getConstant(SharperMin)))
9720             return true;
9721           LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
9722 
9723         case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
9724         case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
9725           // We know from the range information that (V `Pred` Min ||
9726           // V == Min).  We know from the guarding condition that !(V
9727           // == Min).  This gives us
9728           //
9729           //       V `Pred` Min || V == Min && !(V == Min)
9730           //   =>  V `Pred` Min
9731           //
9732           // If V `Pred` Min implies LHS `Pred` RHS, we're done.
9733 
9734           if (isImpliedCondOperands(Pred, LHS, RHS, V, getConstant(Min)))
9735             return true;
9736           LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
9737 
9738         default:
9739           // No change
9740           break;
9741       }
9742     }
9743   }
9744 
9745   // Check whether the actual condition is beyond sufficient.
9746   if (FoundPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
9747     if (ICmpInst::isTrueWhenEqual(Pred))
9748       if (isImpliedCondOperands(Pred, LHS, RHS, FoundLHS, FoundRHS))
9749         return true;
9750   if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
9751     if (!ICmpInst::isTrueWhenEqual(FoundPred))
9752       if (isImpliedCondOperands(FoundPred, LHS, RHS, FoundLHS, FoundRHS))
9753         return true;
9754 
9755   // Otherwise assume the worst.
9756   return false;
9757 }
9758 
9759 bool ScalarEvolution::splitBinaryAdd(const SCEV *Expr,
9760                                      const SCEV *&L, const SCEV *&R,
9761                                      SCEV::NoWrapFlags &Flags) {
9762   const auto *AE = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(Expr);
9763   if (!AE || AE->getNumOperands() != 2)
9764     return false;
9765 
9766   L = AE->getOperand(0);
9767   R = AE->getOperand(1);
9768   Flags = AE->getNoWrapFlags();
9769   return true;
9770 }
9771 
9772 Optional<APInt> ScalarEvolution::computeConstantDifference(const SCEV *More,
9773                                                            const SCEV *Less) {
9774   // We avoid subtracting expressions here because this function is usually
9775   // fairly deep in the call stack (i.e. is called many times).
9776 
9777   if (isa<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Less) && isa<SCEVAddRecExpr>(More)) {
9778     const auto *LAR = cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Less);
9779     const auto *MAR = cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(More);
9780 
9781     if (LAR->getLoop() != MAR->getLoop())
9782       return None;
9783 
9784     // We look at affine expressions only; not for correctness but to keep
9785     // getStepRecurrence cheap.
9786     if (!LAR->isAffine() || !MAR->isAffine())
9787       return None;
9788 
9789     if (LAR->getStepRecurrence(*this) != MAR->getStepRecurrence(*this))
9790       return None;
9791 
9792     Less = LAR->getStart();
9793     More = MAR->getStart();
9794 
9795     // fall through
9796   }
9797 
9798   if (isa<SCEVConstant>(Less) && isa<SCEVConstant>(More)) {
9799     const auto &M = cast<SCEVConstant>(More)->getAPInt();
9800     const auto &L = cast<SCEVConstant>(Less)->getAPInt();
9801     return M - L;
9802   }
9803 
9804   SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags;
9805   const SCEV *LLess = nullptr, *RLess = nullptr;
9806   const SCEV *LMore = nullptr, *RMore = nullptr;
9807   const SCEVConstant *C1 = nullptr, *C2 = nullptr;
9808   // Compare (X + C1) vs X.
9809   if (splitBinaryAdd(Less, LLess, RLess, Flags))
9810     if ((C1 = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(LLess)))
9811       if (RLess == More)
9812         return -(C1->getAPInt());
9813 
9814   // Compare X vs (X + C2).
9815   if (splitBinaryAdd(More, LMore, RMore, Flags))
9816     if ((C2 = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(LMore)))
9817       if (RMore == Less)
9818         return C2->getAPInt();
9819 
9820   // Compare (X + C1) vs (X + C2).
9821   if (C1 && C2 && RLess == RMore)
9822     return C2->getAPInt() - C1->getAPInt();
9823 
9824   return None;
9825 }
9826 
9827 bool ScalarEvolution::isImpliedCondOperandsViaNoOverflow(
9828     ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS,
9829     const SCEV *FoundLHS, const SCEV *FoundRHS) {
9830   if (Pred != CmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Pred != CmpInst::ICMP_ULT)
9831     return false;
9832 
9833   const auto *AddRecLHS = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(LHS);
9834   if (!AddRecLHS)
9835     return false;
9836 
9837   const auto *AddRecFoundLHS = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(FoundLHS);
9838   if (!AddRecFoundLHS)
9839     return false;
9840 
9841   // We'd like to let SCEV reason about control dependencies, so we constrain
9842   // both the inequalities to be about add recurrences on the same loop.  This
9843   // way we can use isLoopEntryGuardedByCond later.
9844 
9845   const Loop *L = AddRecFoundLHS->getLoop();
9846   if (L != AddRecLHS->getLoop())
9847     return false;
9848 
9849   //  FoundLHS u< FoundRHS u< -C =>  (FoundLHS + C) u< (FoundRHS + C) ... (1)
9850   //
9851   //  FoundLHS s< FoundRHS s< INT_MIN - C => (FoundLHS + C) s< (FoundRHS + C)
9852   //                                                                  ... (2)
9853   //
9854   // Informal proof for (2), assuming (1) [*]:
9855   //
9856   // We'll also assume (A s< B) <=> ((A + INT_MIN) u< (B + INT_MIN)) ... (3)[**]
9857   //
9858   // Then
9859   //
9860   //       FoundLHS s< FoundRHS s< INT_MIN - C
9861   // <=>  (FoundLHS + INT_MIN) u< (FoundRHS + INT_MIN) u< -C   [ using (3) ]
9862   // <=>  (FoundLHS + INT_MIN + C) u< (FoundRHS + INT_MIN + C) [ using (1) ]
9863   // <=>  (FoundLHS + INT_MIN + C + INT_MIN) s<
9864   //                        (FoundRHS + INT_MIN + C + INT_MIN) [ using (3) ]
9865   // <=>  FoundLHS + C s< FoundRHS + C
9866   //
9867   // [*]: (1) can be proved by ruling out overflow.
9868   //
9869   // [**]: This can be proved by analyzing all the four possibilities:
9870   //    (A s< 0, B s< 0), (A s< 0, B s>= 0), (A s>= 0, B s< 0) and
9871   //    (A s>= 0, B s>= 0).
9872   //
9873   // Note:
9874   // Despite (2), "FoundRHS s< INT_MIN - C" does not mean that "FoundRHS + C"
9875   // will not sign underflow.  For instance, say FoundLHS = (i8 -128), FoundRHS
9876   // = (i8 -127) and C = (i8 -100).  Then INT_MIN - C = (i8 -28), and FoundRHS
9877   // s< (INT_MIN - C).  Lack of sign overflow / underflow in "FoundRHS + C" is
9878   // neither necessary nor sufficient to prove "(FoundLHS + C) s< (FoundRHS +
9879   // C)".
9880 
9881   Optional<APInt> LDiff = computeConstantDifference(LHS, FoundLHS);
9882   Optional<APInt> RDiff = computeConstantDifference(RHS, FoundRHS);
9883   if (!LDiff || !RDiff || *LDiff != *RDiff)
9884     return false;
9885 
9886   if (LDiff->isMinValue())
9887     return true;
9888 
9889   APInt FoundRHSLimit;
9890 
9891   if (Pred == CmpInst::ICMP_ULT) {
9892     FoundRHSLimit = -(*RDiff);
9893   } else {
9894     assert(Pred == CmpInst::ICMP_SLT && "Checked above!");
9895     FoundRHSLimit = APInt::getSignedMinValue(getTypeSizeInBits(RHS->getType())) - *RDiff;
9896   }
9897 
9898   // Try to prove (1) or (2), as needed.
9899   return isAvailableAtLoopEntry(FoundRHS, L) &&
9900          isLoopEntryGuardedByCond(L, Pred, FoundRHS,
9901                                   getConstant(FoundRHSLimit));
9902 }
9903 
9904 bool ScalarEvolution::isImpliedViaMerge(ICmpInst::Predicate Pred,
9905                                         const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS,
9906                                         const SCEV *FoundLHS,
9907                                         const SCEV *FoundRHS, unsigned Depth) {
9908   const PHINode *LPhi = nullptr, *RPhi = nullptr;
9909 
9910   auto ClearOnExit = make_scope_exit([&]() {
9911     if (LPhi) {
9912       bool Erased = PendingMerges.erase(LPhi);
9913       assert(Erased && "Failed to erase LPhi!");
9914       (void)Erased;
9915     }
9916     if (RPhi) {
9917       bool Erased = PendingMerges.erase(RPhi);
9918       assert(Erased && "Failed to erase RPhi!");
9919       (void)Erased;
9920     }
9921   });
9922 
9923   // Find respective Phis and check that they are not being pending.
9924   if (const SCEVUnknown *LU = dyn_cast<SCEVUnknown>(LHS))
9925     if (auto *Phi = dyn_cast<PHINode>(LU->getValue())) {
9926       if (!PendingMerges.insert(Phi).second)
9927         return false;
9928       LPhi = Phi;
9929     }
9930   if (const SCEVUnknown *RU = dyn_cast<SCEVUnknown>(RHS))
9931     if (auto *Phi = dyn_cast<PHINode>(RU->getValue())) {
9932       // If we detect a loop of Phi nodes being processed by this method, for
9933       // example:
9934       //
9935       //   %a = phi i32 [ %some1, %preheader ], [ %b, %latch ]
9936       //   %b = phi i32 [ %some2, %preheader ], [ %a, %latch ]
9937       //
9938       // we don't want to deal with a case that complex, so return conservative
9939       // answer false.
9940       if (!PendingMerges.insert(Phi).second)
9941         return false;
9942       RPhi = Phi;
9943     }
9944 
9945   // If none of LHS, RHS is a Phi, nothing to do here.
9946   if (!LPhi && !RPhi)
9947     return false;
9948 
9949   // If there is a SCEVUnknown Phi we are interested in, make it left.
9950   if (!LPhi) {
9951     std::swap(LHS, RHS);
9952     std::swap(FoundLHS, FoundRHS);
9953     std::swap(LPhi, RPhi);
9954     Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
9955   }
9956 
9957   assert(LPhi && "LPhi should definitely be a SCEVUnknown Phi!");
9958   const BasicBlock *LBB = LPhi->getParent();
9959   const SCEVAddRecExpr *RAR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(RHS);
9960 
9961   auto ProvedEasily = [&](const SCEV *S1, const SCEV *S2) {
9962     return isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(Pred, S1, S2) ||
9963            isImpliedCondOperandsViaRanges(Pred, S1, S2, FoundLHS, FoundRHS) ||
9964            isImpliedViaOperations(Pred, S1, S2, FoundLHS, FoundRHS, Depth);
9965   };
9966 
9967   if (RPhi && RPhi->getParent() == LBB) {
9968     // Case one: RHS is also a SCEVUnknown Phi from the same basic block.
9969     // If we compare two Phis from the same block, and for each entry block
9970     // the predicate is true for incoming values from this block, then the
9971     // predicate is also true for the Phis.
9972     for (const BasicBlock *IncBB : predecessors(LBB)) {
9973       const SCEV *L = getSCEV(LPhi->getIncomingValueForBlock(IncBB));
9974       const SCEV *R = getSCEV(RPhi->getIncomingValueForBlock(IncBB));
9975       if (!ProvedEasily(L, R))
9976         return false;
9977     }
9978   } else if (RAR && RAR->getLoop()->getHeader() == LBB) {
9979     // Case two: RHS is also a Phi from the same basic block, and it is an
9980     // AddRec. It means that there is a loop which has both AddRec and Unknown
9981     // PHIs, for it we can compare incoming values of AddRec from above the loop
9982     // and latch with their respective incoming values of LPhi.
9983     // TODO: Generalize to handle loops with many inputs in a header.
9984     if (LPhi->getNumIncomingValues() != 2) return false;
9985 
9986     auto *RLoop = RAR->getLoop();
9987     auto *Predecessor = RLoop->getLoopPredecessor();
9988     assert(Predecessor && "Loop with AddRec with no predecessor?");
9989     const SCEV *L1 = getSCEV(LPhi->getIncomingValueForBlock(Predecessor));
9990     if (!ProvedEasily(L1, RAR->getStart()))
9991       return false;
9992     auto *Latch = RLoop->getLoopLatch();
9993     assert(Latch && "Loop with AddRec with no latch?");
9994     const SCEV *L2 = getSCEV(LPhi->getIncomingValueForBlock(Latch));
9995     if (!ProvedEasily(L2, RAR->getPostIncExpr(*this)))
9996       return false;
9997   } else {
9998     // In all other cases go over inputs of LHS and compare each of them to RHS,
9999     // the predicate is true for (LHS, RHS) if it is true for all such pairs.
10000     // At this point RHS is either a non-Phi, or it is a Phi from some block
10001     // different from LBB.
10002     for (const BasicBlock *IncBB : predecessors(LBB)) {
10003       // Check that RHS is available in this block.
10004       if (!dominates(RHS, IncBB))
10005         return false;
10006       const SCEV *L = getSCEV(LPhi->getIncomingValueForBlock(IncBB));
10007       if (!ProvedEasily(L, RHS))
10008         return false;
10009     }
10010   }
10011   return true;
10012 }
10013 
10014 bool ScalarEvolution::isImpliedCondOperands(ICmpInst::Predicate Pred,
10015                                             const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS,
10016                                             const SCEV *FoundLHS,
10017                                             const SCEV *FoundRHS) {
10018   if (isImpliedCondOperandsViaRanges(Pred, LHS, RHS, FoundLHS, FoundRHS))
10019     return true;
10020 
10021   if (isImpliedCondOperandsViaNoOverflow(Pred, LHS, RHS, FoundLHS, FoundRHS))
10022     return true;
10023 
10024   return isImpliedCondOperandsHelper(Pred, LHS, RHS,
10025                                      FoundLHS, FoundRHS) ||
10026          // ~x < ~y --> x > y
10027          isImpliedCondOperandsHelper(Pred, LHS, RHS,
10028                                      getNotSCEV(FoundRHS),
10029                                      getNotSCEV(FoundLHS));
10030 }
10031 
10032 /// If Expr computes ~A, return A else return nullptr
10033 static const SCEV *MatchNotExpr(const SCEV *Expr) {
10034   const SCEVAddExpr *Add = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(Expr);
10035   if (!Add || Add->getNumOperands() != 2 ||
10036       !Add->getOperand(0)->isAllOnesValue())
10037     return nullptr;
10038 
10039   const SCEVMulExpr *AddRHS = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(Add->getOperand(1));
10040   if (!AddRHS || AddRHS->getNumOperands() != 2 ||
10041       !AddRHS->getOperand(0)->isAllOnesValue())
10042     return nullptr;
10043 
10044   return AddRHS->getOperand(1);
10045 }
10046 
10047 /// Is MaybeMaxExpr an SMax or UMax of Candidate and some other values?
10048 template<typename MaxExprType>
10049 static bool IsMaxConsistingOf(const SCEV *MaybeMaxExpr,
10050                               const SCEV *Candidate) {
10051   const MaxExprType *MaxExpr = dyn_cast<MaxExprType>(MaybeMaxExpr);
10052   if (!MaxExpr) return false;
10053 
10054   return find(MaxExpr->operands(), Candidate) != MaxExpr->op_end();
10055 }
10056 
10057 /// Is MaybeMinExpr an SMin or UMin of Candidate and some other values?
10058 template<typename MaxExprType>
10059 static bool IsMinConsistingOf(ScalarEvolution &SE,
10060                               const SCEV *MaybeMinExpr,
10061                               const SCEV *Candidate) {
10062   const SCEV *MaybeMaxExpr = MatchNotExpr(MaybeMinExpr);
10063   if (!MaybeMaxExpr)
10064     return false;
10065 
10066   return IsMaxConsistingOf<MaxExprType>(MaybeMaxExpr, SE.getNotSCEV(Candidate));
10067 }
10068 
10069 static bool IsKnownPredicateViaAddRecStart(ScalarEvolution &SE,
10070                                            ICmpInst::Predicate Pred,
10071                                            const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS) {
10072   // If both sides are affine addrecs for the same loop, with equal
10073   // steps, and we know the recurrences don't wrap, then we only
10074   // need to check the predicate on the starting values.
10075 
10076   if (!ICmpInst::isRelational(Pred))
10077     return false;
10078 
10079   const SCEVAddRecExpr *LAR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(LHS);
10080   if (!LAR)
10081     return false;
10082   const SCEVAddRecExpr *RAR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(RHS);
10083   if (!RAR)
10084     return false;
10085   if (LAR->getLoop() != RAR->getLoop())
10086     return false;
10087   if (!LAR->isAffine() || !RAR->isAffine())
10088     return false;
10089 
10090   if (LAR->getStepRecurrence(SE) != RAR->getStepRecurrence(SE))
10091     return false;
10092 
10093   SCEV::NoWrapFlags NW = ICmpInst::isSigned(Pred) ?
10094                          SCEV::FlagNSW : SCEV::FlagNUW;
10095   if (!LAR->getNoWrapFlags(NW) || !RAR->getNoWrapFlags(NW))
10096     return false;
10097 
10098   return SE.isKnownPredicate(Pred, LAR->getStart(), RAR->getStart());
10099 }
10100 
10101 /// Is LHS `Pred` RHS true on the virtue of LHS or RHS being a Min or Max
10102 /// expression?
10103 static bool IsKnownPredicateViaMinOrMax(ScalarEvolution &SE,
10104                                         ICmpInst::Predicate Pred,
10105                                         const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS) {
10106   switch (Pred) {
10107   default:
10108     return false;
10109 
10110   case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
10111     std::swap(LHS, RHS);
10112     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
10113   case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
10114     return
10115       // min(A, ...) <= A
10116       IsMinConsistingOf<SCEVSMaxExpr>(SE, LHS, RHS) ||
10117       // A <= max(A, ...)
10118       IsMaxConsistingOf<SCEVSMaxExpr>(RHS, LHS);
10119 
10120   case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
10121     std::swap(LHS, RHS);
10122     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
10123   case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
10124     return
10125       // min(A, ...) <= A
10126       IsMinConsistingOf<SCEVUMaxExpr>(SE, LHS, RHS) ||
10127       // A <= max(A, ...)
10128       IsMaxConsistingOf<SCEVUMaxExpr>(RHS, LHS);
10129   }
10130 
10131   llvm_unreachable("covered switch fell through?!");
10132 }
10133 
10134 bool ScalarEvolution::isImpliedViaOperations(ICmpInst::Predicate Pred,
10135                                              const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS,
10136                                              const SCEV *FoundLHS,
10137                                              const SCEV *FoundRHS,
10138                                              unsigned Depth) {
10139   assert(getTypeSizeInBits(LHS->getType()) ==
10140              getTypeSizeInBits(RHS->getType()) &&
10141          "LHS and RHS have different sizes?");
10142   assert(getTypeSizeInBits(FoundLHS->getType()) ==
10143              getTypeSizeInBits(FoundRHS->getType()) &&
10144          "FoundLHS and FoundRHS have different sizes?");
10145   // We want to avoid hurting the compile time with analysis of too big trees.
10146   if (Depth > MaxSCEVOperationsImplicationDepth)
10147     return false;
10148   // We only want to work with ICMP_SGT comparison so far.
10149   // TODO: Extend to ICMP_UGT?
10150   if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT) {
10151     Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
10152     std::swap(LHS, RHS);
10153     std::swap(FoundLHS, FoundRHS);
10154   }
10155   if (Pred != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT)
10156     return false;
10157 
10158   auto GetOpFromSExt = [&](const SCEV *S) {
10159     if (auto *Ext = dyn_cast<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(S))
10160       return Ext->getOperand();
10161     // TODO: If S is a SCEVConstant then you can cheaply "strip" the sext off
10162     // the constant in some cases.
10163     return S;
10164   };
10165 
10166   // Acquire values from extensions.
10167   auto *OrigLHS = LHS;
10168   auto *OrigFoundLHS = FoundLHS;
10169   LHS = GetOpFromSExt(LHS);
10170   FoundLHS = GetOpFromSExt(FoundLHS);
10171 
10172   // Is the SGT predicate can be proved trivially or using the found context.
10173   auto IsSGTViaContext = [&](const SCEV *S1, const SCEV *S2) {
10174     return isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, S1, S2) ||
10175            isImpliedViaOperations(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, S1, S2, OrigFoundLHS,
10176                                   FoundRHS, Depth + 1);
10177   };
10178 
10179   if (auto *LHSAddExpr = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(LHS)) {
10180     // We want to avoid creation of any new non-constant SCEV. Since we are
10181     // going to compare the operands to RHS, we should be certain that we don't
10182     // need any size extensions for this. So let's decline all cases when the
10183     // sizes of types of LHS and RHS do not match.
10184     // TODO: Maybe try to get RHS from sext to catch more cases?
10185     if (getTypeSizeInBits(LHS->getType()) != getTypeSizeInBits(RHS->getType()))
10186       return false;
10187 
10188     // Should not overflow.
10189     if (!LHSAddExpr->hasNoSignedWrap())
10190       return false;
10191 
10192     auto *LL = LHSAddExpr->getOperand(0);
10193     auto *LR = LHSAddExpr->getOperand(1);
10194     auto *MinusOne = getNegativeSCEV(getOne(RHS->getType()));
10195 
10196     // Checks that S1 >= 0 && S2 > RHS, trivially or using the found context.
10197     auto IsSumGreaterThanRHS = [&](const SCEV *S1, const SCEV *S2) {
10198       return IsSGTViaContext(S1, MinusOne) && IsSGTViaContext(S2, RHS);
10199     };
10200     // Try to prove the following rule:
10201     // (LHS = LL + LR) && (LL >= 0) && (LR > RHS) => (LHS > RHS).
10202     // (LHS = LL + LR) && (LR >= 0) && (LL > RHS) => (LHS > RHS).
10203     if (IsSumGreaterThanRHS(LL, LR) || IsSumGreaterThanRHS(LR, LL))
10204       return true;
10205   } else if (auto *LHSUnknownExpr = dyn_cast<SCEVUnknown>(LHS)) {
10206     Value *LL, *LR;
10207     // FIXME: Once we have SDiv implemented, we can get rid of this matching.
10208 
10209     using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
10210 
10211     if (match(LHSUnknownExpr->getValue(), m_SDiv(m_Value(LL), m_Value(LR)))) {
10212       // Rules for division.
10213       // We are going to perform some comparisons with Denominator and its
10214       // derivative expressions. In general case, creating a SCEV for it may
10215       // lead to a complex analysis of the entire graph, and in particular it
10216       // can request trip count recalculation for the same loop. This would
10217       // cache as SCEVCouldNotCompute to avoid the infinite recursion. To avoid
10218       // this, we only want to create SCEVs that are constants in this section.
10219       // So we bail if Denominator is not a constant.
10220       if (!isa<ConstantInt>(LR))
10221         return false;
10222 
10223       auto *Denominator = cast<SCEVConstant>(getSCEV(LR));
10224 
10225       // We want to make sure that LHS = FoundLHS / Denominator. If it is so,
10226       // then a SCEV for the numerator already exists and matches with FoundLHS.
10227       auto *Numerator = getExistingSCEV(LL);
10228       if (!Numerator || Numerator->getType() != FoundLHS->getType())
10229         return false;
10230 
10231       // Make sure that the numerator matches with FoundLHS and the denominator
10232       // is positive.
10233       if (!HasSameValue(Numerator, FoundLHS) || !isKnownPositive(Denominator))
10234         return false;
10235 
10236       auto *DTy = Denominator->getType();
10237       auto *FRHSTy = FoundRHS->getType();
10238       if (DTy->isPointerTy() != FRHSTy->isPointerTy())
10239         // One of types is a pointer and another one is not. We cannot extend
10240         // them properly to a wider type, so let us just reject this case.
10241         // TODO: Usage of getEffectiveSCEVType for DTy, FRHSTy etc should help
10242         // to avoid this check.
10243         return false;
10244 
10245       // Given that:
10246       // FoundLHS > FoundRHS, LHS = FoundLHS / Denominator, Denominator > 0.
10247       auto *WTy = getWiderType(DTy, FRHSTy);
10248       auto *DenominatorExt = getNoopOrSignExtend(Denominator, WTy);
10249       auto *FoundRHSExt = getNoopOrSignExtend(FoundRHS, WTy);
10250 
10251       // Try to prove the following rule:
10252       // (FoundRHS > Denominator - 2) && (RHS <= 0) => (LHS > RHS).
10253       // For example, given that FoundLHS > 2. It means that FoundLHS is at
10254       // least 3. If we divide it by Denominator < 4, we will have at least 1.
10255       auto *DenomMinusTwo = getMinusSCEV(DenominatorExt, getConstant(WTy, 2));
10256       if (isKnownNonPositive(RHS) &&
10257           IsSGTViaContext(FoundRHSExt, DenomMinusTwo))
10258         return true;
10259 
10260       // Try to prove the following rule:
10261       // (FoundRHS > -1 - Denominator) && (RHS < 0) => (LHS > RHS).
10262       // For example, given that FoundLHS > -3. Then FoundLHS is at least -2.
10263       // If we divide it by Denominator > 2, then:
10264       // 1. If FoundLHS is negative, then the result is 0.
10265       // 2. If FoundLHS is non-negative, then the result is non-negative.
10266       // Anyways, the result is non-negative.
10267       auto *MinusOne = getNegativeSCEV(getOne(WTy));
10268       auto *NegDenomMinusOne = getMinusSCEV(MinusOne, DenominatorExt);
10269       if (isKnownNegative(RHS) &&
10270           IsSGTViaContext(FoundRHSExt, NegDenomMinusOne))
10271         return true;
10272     }
10273   }
10274 
10275   // If our expression contained SCEVUnknown Phis, and we split it down and now
10276   // need to prove something for them, try to prove the predicate for every
10277   // possible incoming values of those Phis.
10278   if (isImpliedViaMerge(Pred, OrigLHS, RHS, OrigFoundLHS, FoundRHS, Depth + 1))
10279     return true;
10280 
10281   return false;
10282 }
10283 
10284 bool
10285 ScalarEvolution::isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(ICmpInst::Predicate Pred,
10286                                            const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS) {
10287   return isKnownPredicateViaConstantRanges(Pred, LHS, RHS) ||
10288          IsKnownPredicateViaMinOrMax(*this, Pred, LHS, RHS) ||
10289          IsKnownPredicateViaAddRecStart(*this, Pred, LHS, RHS) ||
10290          isKnownPredicateViaNoOverflow(Pred, LHS, RHS);
10291 }
10292 
10293 bool
10294 ScalarEvolution::isImpliedCondOperandsHelper(ICmpInst::Predicate Pred,
10295                                              const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS,
10296                                              const SCEV *FoundLHS,
10297                                              const SCEV *FoundRHS) {
10298   switch (Pred) {
10299   default: llvm_unreachable("Unexpected ICmpInst::Predicate value!");
10300   case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
10301   case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
10302     if (HasSameValue(LHS, FoundLHS) && HasSameValue(RHS, FoundRHS))
10303       return true;
10304     break;
10305   case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
10306   case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
10307     if (isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, LHS, FoundLHS) &&
10308         isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, RHS, FoundRHS))
10309       return true;
10310     break;
10311   case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
10312   case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
10313     if (isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, FoundLHS) &&
10314         isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, RHS, FoundRHS))
10315       return true;
10316     break;
10317   case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
10318   case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
10319     if (isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, LHS, FoundLHS) &&
10320         isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, RHS, FoundRHS))
10321       return true;
10322     break;
10323   case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
10324   case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
10325     if (isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, FoundLHS) &&
10326         isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, RHS, FoundRHS))
10327       return true;
10328     break;
10329   }
10330 
10331   // Maybe it can be proved via operations?
10332   if (isImpliedViaOperations(Pred, LHS, RHS, FoundLHS, FoundRHS))
10333     return true;
10334 
10335   return false;
10336 }
10337 
10338 bool ScalarEvolution::isImpliedCondOperandsViaRanges(ICmpInst::Predicate Pred,
10339                                                      const SCEV *LHS,
10340                                                      const SCEV *RHS,
10341                                                      const SCEV *FoundLHS,
10342                                                      const SCEV *FoundRHS) {
10343   if (!isa<SCEVConstant>(RHS) || !isa<SCEVConstant>(FoundRHS))
10344     // The restriction on `FoundRHS` be lifted easily -- it exists only to
10345     // reduce the compile time impact of this optimization.
10346     return false;
10347 
10348   Optional<APInt> Addend = computeConstantDifference(LHS, FoundLHS);
10349   if (!Addend)
10350     return false;
10351 
10352   const APInt &ConstFoundRHS = cast<SCEVConstant>(FoundRHS)->getAPInt();
10353 
10354   // `FoundLHSRange` is the range we know `FoundLHS` to be in by virtue of the
10355   // antecedent "`FoundLHS` `Pred` `FoundRHS`".
10356   ConstantRange FoundLHSRange =
10357       ConstantRange::makeAllowedICmpRegion(Pred, ConstFoundRHS);
10358 
10359   // Since `LHS` is `FoundLHS` + `Addend`, we can compute a range for `LHS`:
10360   ConstantRange LHSRange = FoundLHSRange.add(ConstantRange(*Addend));
10361 
10362   // We can also compute the range of values for `LHS` that satisfy the
10363   // consequent, "`LHS` `Pred` `RHS`":
10364   const APInt &ConstRHS = cast<SCEVConstant>(RHS)->getAPInt();
10365   ConstantRange SatisfyingLHSRange =
10366       ConstantRange::makeSatisfyingICmpRegion(Pred, ConstRHS);
10367 
10368   // The antecedent implies the consequent if every value of `LHS` that
10369   // satisfies the antecedent also satisfies the consequent.
10370   return SatisfyingLHSRange.contains(LHSRange);
10371 }
10372 
10373 bool ScalarEvolution::doesIVOverflowOnLT(const SCEV *RHS, const SCEV *Stride,
10374                                          bool IsSigned, bool NoWrap) {
10375   assert(isKnownPositive(Stride) && "Positive stride expected!");
10376 
10377   if (NoWrap) return false;
10378 
10379   unsigned BitWidth = getTypeSizeInBits(RHS->getType());
10380   const SCEV *One = getOne(Stride->getType());
10381 
10382   if (IsSigned) {
10383     APInt MaxRHS = getSignedRangeMax(RHS);
10384     APInt MaxValue = APInt::getSignedMaxValue(BitWidth);
10385     APInt MaxStrideMinusOne = getSignedRangeMax(getMinusSCEV(Stride, One));
10386 
10387     // SMaxRHS + SMaxStrideMinusOne > SMaxValue => overflow!
10388     return (std::move(MaxValue) - MaxStrideMinusOne).slt(MaxRHS);
10389   }
10390 
10391   APInt MaxRHS = getUnsignedRangeMax(RHS);
10392   APInt MaxValue = APInt::getMaxValue(BitWidth);
10393   APInt MaxStrideMinusOne = getUnsignedRangeMax(getMinusSCEV(Stride, One));
10394 
10395   // UMaxRHS + UMaxStrideMinusOne > UMaxValue => overflow!
10396   return (std::move(MaxValue) - MaxStrideMinusOne).ult(MaxRHS);
10397 }
10398 
10399 bool ScalarEvolution::doesIVOverflowOnGT(const SCEV *RHS, const SCEV *Stride,
10400                                          bool IsSigned, bool NoWrap) {
10401   if (NoWrap) return false;
10402 
10403   unsigned BitWidth = getTypeSizeInBits(RHS->getType());
10404   const SCEV *One = getOne(Stride->getType());
10405 
10406   if (IsSigned) {
10407     APInt MinRHS = getSignedRangeMin(RHS);
10408     APInt MinValue = APInt::getSignedMinValue(BitWidth);
10409     APInt MaxStrideMinusOne = getSignedRangeMax(getMinusSCEV(Stride, One));
10410 
10411     // SMinRHS - SMaxStrideMinusOne < SMinValue => overflow!
10412     return (std::move(MinValue) + MaxStrideMinusOne).sgt(MinRHS);
10413   }
10414 
10415   APInt MinRHS = getUnsignedRangeMin(RHS);
10416   APInt MinValue = APInt::getMinValue(BitWidth);
10417   APInt MaxStrideMinusOne = getUnsignedRangeMax(getMinusSCEV(Stride, One));
10418 
10419   // UMinRHS - UMaxStrideMinusOne < UMinValue => overflow!
10420   return (std::move(MinValue) + MaxStrideMinusOne).ugt(MinRHS);
10421 }
10422 
10423 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::computeBECount(const SCEV *Delta, const SCEV *Step,
10424                                             bool Equality) {
10425   const SCEV *One = getOne(Step->getType());
10426   Delta = Equality ? getAddExpr(Delta, Step)
10427                    : getAddExpr(Delta, getMinusSCEV(Step, One));
10428   return getUDivExpr(Delta, Step);
10429 }
10430 
10431 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::computeMaxBECountForLT(const SCEV *Start,
10432                                                     const SCEV *Stride,
10433                                                     const SCEV *End,
10434                                                     unsigned BitWidth,
10435                                                     bool IsSigned) {
10436 
10437   assert(!isKnownNonPositive(Stride) &&
10438          "Stride is expected strictly positive!");
10439   // Calculate the maximum backedge count based on the range of values
10440   // permitted by Start, End, and Stride.
10441   const SCEV *MaxBECount;
10442   APInt MinStart =
10443       IsSigned ? getSignedRangeMin(Start) : getUnsignedRangeMin(Start);
10444 
10445   APInt StrideForMaxBECount =
10446       IsSigned ? getSignedRangeMin(Stride) : getUnsignedRangeMin(Stride);
10447 
10448   // We already know that the stride is positive, so we paper over conservatism
10449   // in our range computation by forcing StrideForMaxBECount to be at least one.
10450   // In theory this is unnecessary, but we expect MaxBECount to be a
10451   // SCEVConstant, and (udiv <constant> 0) is not constant folded by SCEV (there
10452   // is nothing to constant fold it to).
10453   APInt One(BitWidth, 1, IsSigned);
10454   StrideForMaxBECount = APIntOps::smax(One, StrideForMaxBECount);
10455 
10456   APInt MaxValue = IsSigned ? APInt::getSignedMaxValue(BitWidth)
10457                             : APInt::getMaxValue(BitWidth);
10458   APInt Limit = MaxValue - (StrideForMaxBECount - 1);
10459 
10460   // Although End can be a MAX expression we estimate MaxEnd considering only
10461   // the case End = RHS of the loop termination condition. This is safe because
10462   // in the other case (End - Start) is zero, leading to a zero maximum backedge
10463   // taken count.
10464   APInt MaxEnd = IsSigned ? APIntOps::smin(getSignedRangeMax(End), Limit)
10465                           : APIntOps::umin(getUnsignedRangeMax(End), Limit);
10466 
10467   MaxBECount = computeBECount(getConstant(MaxEnd - MinStart) /* Delta */,
10468                               getConstant(StrideForMaxBECount) /* Step */,
10469                               false /* Equality */);
10470 
10471   return MaxBECount;
10472 }
10473 
10474 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit
10475 ScalarEvolution::howManyLessThans(const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS,
10476                                   const Loop *L, bool IsSigned,
10477                                   bool ControlsExit, bool AllowPredicates) {
10478   SmallPtrSet<const SCEVPredicate *, 4> Predicates;
10479 
10480   const SCEVAddRecExpr *IV = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(LHS);
10481   bool PredicatedIV = false;
10482 
10483   if (!IV && AllowPredicates) {
10484     // Try to make this an AddRec using runtime tests, in the first X
10485     // iterations of this loop, where X is the SCEV expression found by the
10486     // algorithm below.
10487     IV = convertSCEVToAddRecWithPredicates(LHS, L, Predicates);
10488     PredicatedIV = true;
10489   }
10490 
10491   // Avoid weird loops
10492   if (!IV || IV->getLoop() != L || !IV->isAffine())
10493     return getCouldNotCompute();
10494 
10495   bool NoWrap = ControlsExit &&
10496                 IV->getNoWrapFlags(IsSigned ? SCEV::FlagNSW : SCEV::FlagNUW);
10497 
10498   const SCEV *Stride = IV->getStepRecurrence(*this);
10499 
10500   bool PositiveStride = isKnownPositive(Stride);
10501 
10502   // Avoid negative or zero stride values.
10503   if (!PositiveStride) {
10504     // We can compute the correct backedge taken count for loops with unknown
10505     // strides if we can prove that the loop is not an infinite loop with side
10506     // effects. Here's the loop structure we are trying to handle -
10507     //
10508     // i = start
10509     // do {
10510     //   A[i] = i;
10511     //   i += s;
10512     // } while (i < end);
10513     //
10514     // The backedge taken count for such loops is evaluated as -
10515     // (max(end, start + stride) - start - 1) /u stride
10516     //
10517     // The additional preconditions that we need to check to prove correctness
10518     // of the above formula is as follows -
10519     //
10520     // a) IV is either nuw or nsw depending upon signedness (indicated by the
10521     //    NoWrap flag).
10522     // b) loop is single exit with no side effects.
10523     //
10524     //
10525     // Precondition a) implies that if the stride is negative, this is a single
10526     // trip loop. The backedge taken count formula reduces to zero in this case.
10527     //
10528     // Precondition b) implies that the unknown stride cannot be zero otherwise
10529     // we have UB.
10530     //
10531     // The positive stride case is the same as isKnownPositive(Stride) returning
10532     // true (original behavior of the function).
10533     //
10534     // We want to make sure that the stride is truly unknown as there are edge
10535     // cases where ScalarEvolution propagates no wrap flags to the
10536     // post-increment/decrement IV even though the increment/decrement operation
10537     // itself is wrapping. The computed backedge taken count may be wrong in
10538     // such cases. This is prevented by checking that the stride is not known to
10539     // be either positive or non-positive. For example, no wrap flags are
10540     // propagated to the post-increment IV of this loop with a trip count of 2 -
10541     //
10542     // unsigned char i;
10543     // for(i=127; i<128; i+=129)
10544     //   A[i] = i;
10545     //
10546     if (PredicatedIV || !NoWrap || isKnownNonPositive(Stride) ||
10547         !loopHasNoSideEffects(L))
10548       return getCouldNotCompute();
10549   } else if (!Stride->isOne() &&
10550              doesIVOverflowOnLT(RHS, Stride, IsSigned, NoWrap))
10551     // Avoid proven overflow cases: this will ensure that the backedge taken
10552     // count will not generate any unsigned overflow. Relaxed no-overflow
10553     // conditions exploit NoWrapFlags, allowing to optimize in presence of
10554     // undefined behaviors like the case of C language.
10555     return getCouldNotCompute();
10556 
10557   ICmpInst::Predicate Cond = IsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT
10558                                       : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
10559   const SCEV *Start = IV->getStart();
10560   const SCEV *End = RHS;
10561   // When the RHS is not invariant, we do not know the end bound of the loop and
10562   // cannot calculate the ExactBECount needed by ExitLimit. However, we can
10563   // calculate the MaxBECount, given the start, stride and max value for the end
10564   // bound of the loop (RHS), and the fact that IV does not overflow (which is
10565   // checked above).
10566   if (!isLoopInvariant(RHS, L)) {
10567     const SCEV *MaxBECount = computeMaxBECountForLT(
10568         Start, Stride, RHS, getTypeSizeInBits(LHS->getType()), IsSigned);
10569     return ExitLimit(getCouldNotCompute() /* ExactNotTaken */, MaxBECount,
10570                      false /*MaxOrZero*/, Predicates);
10571   }
10572   // If the backedge is taken at least once, then it will be taken
10573   // (End-Start)/Stride times (rounded up to a multiple of Stride), where Start
10574   // is the LHS value of the less-than comparison the first time it is evaluated
10575   // and End is the RHS.
10576   const SCEV *BECountIfBackedgeTaken =
10577     computeBECount(getMinusSCEV(End, Start), Stride, false);
10578   // If the loop entry is guarded by the result of the backedge test of the
10579   // first loop iteration, then we know the backedge will be taken at least
10580   // once and so the backedge taken count is as above. If not then we use the
10581   // expression (max(End,Start)-Start)/Stride to describe the backedge count,
10582   // as if the backedge is taken at least once max(End,Start) is End and so the
10583   // result is as above, and if not max(End,Start) is Start so we get a backedge
10584   // count of zero.
10585   const SCEV *BECount;
10586   if (isLoopEntryGuardedByCond(L, Cond, getMinusSCEV(Start, Stride), RHS))
10587     BECount = BECountIfBackedgeTaken;
10588   else {
10589     End = IsSigned ? getSMaxExpr(RHS, Start) : getUMaxExpr(RHS, Start);
10590     BECount = computeBECount(getMinusSCEV(End, Start), Stride, false);
10591   }
10592 
10593   const SCEV *MaxBECount;
10594   bool MaxOrZero = false;
10595   if (isa<SCEVConstant>(BECount))
10596     MaxBECount = BECount;
10597   else if (isa<SCEVConstant>(BECountIfBackedgeTaken)) {
10598     // If we know exactly how many times the backedge will be taken if it's
10599     // taken at least once, then the backedge count will either be that or
10600     // zero.
10601     MaxBECount = BECountIfBackedgeTaken;
10602     MaxOrZero = true;
10603   } else {
10604     MaxBECount = computeMaxBECountForLT(
10605         Start, Stride, RHS, getTypeSizeInBits(LHS->getType()), IsSigned);
10606   }
10607 
10608   if (isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(MaxBECount) &&
10609       !isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(BECount))
10610     MaxBECount = getConstant(getUnsignedRangeMax(BECount));
10611 
10612   return ExitLimit(BECount, MaxBECount, MaxOrZero, Predicates);
10613 }
10614 
10615 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit
10616 ScalarEvolution::howManyGreaterThans(const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS,
10617                                      const Loop *L, bool IsSigned,
10618                                      bool ControlsExit, bool AllowPredicates) {
10619   SmallPtrSet<const SCEVPredicate *, 4> Predicates;
10620   // We handle only IV > Invariant
10621   if (!isLoopInvariant(RHS, L))
10622     return getCouldNotCompute();
10623 
10624   const SCEVAddRecExpr *IV = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(LHS);
10625   if (!IV && AllowPredicates)
10626     // Try to make this an AddRec using runtime tests, in the first X
10627     // iterations of this loop, where X is the SCEV expression found by the
10628     // algorithm below.
10629     IV = convertSCEVToAddRecWithPredicates(LHS, L, Predicates);
10630 
10631   // Avoid weird loops
10632   if (!IV || IV->getLoop() != L || !IV->isAffine())
10633     return getCouldNotCompute();
10634 
10635   bool NoWrap = ControlsExit &&
10636                 IV->getNoWrapFlags(IsSigned ? SCEV::FlagNSW : SCEV::FlagNUW);
10637 
10638   const SCEV *Stride = getNegativeSCEV(IV->getStepRecurrence(*this));
10639 
10640   // Avoid negative or zero stride values
10641   if (!isKnownPositive(Stride))
10642     return getCouldNotCompute();
10643 
10644   // Avoid proven overflow cases: this will ensure that the backedge taken count
10645   // will not generate any unsigned overflow. Relaxed no-overflow conditions
10646   // exploit NoWrapFlags, allowing to optimize in presence of undefined
10647   // behaviors like the case of C language.
10648   if (!Stride->isOne() && doesIVOverflowOnGT(RHS, Stride, IsSigned, NoWrap))
10649     return getCouldNotCompute();
10650 
10651   ICmpInst::Predicate Cond = IsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT
10652                                       : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
10653 
10654   const SCEV *Start = IV->getStart();
10655   const SCEV *End = RHS;
10656   if (!isLoopEntryGuardedByCond(L, Cond, getAddExpr(Start, Stride), RHS))
10657     End = IsSigned ? getSMinExpr(RHS, Start) : getUMinExpr(RHS, Start);
10658 
10659   const SCEV *BECount = computeBECount(getMinusSCEV(Start, End), Stride, false);
10660 
10661   APInt MaxStart = IsSigned ? getSignedRangeMax(Start)
10662                             : getUnsignedRangeMax(Start);
10663 
10664   APInt MinStride = IsSigned ? getSignedRangeMin(Stride)
10665                              : getUnsignedRangeMin(Stride);
10666 
10667   unsigned BitWidth = getTypeSizeInBits(LHS->getType());
10668   APInt Limit = IsSigned ? APInt::getSignedMinValue(BitWidth) + (MinStride - 1)
10669                          : APInt::getMinValue(BitWidth) + (MinStride - 1);
10670 
10671   // Although End can be a MIN expression we estimate MinEnd considering only
10672   // the case End = RHS. This is safe because in the other case (Start - End)
10673   // is zero, leading to a zero maximum backedge taken count.
10674   APInt MinEnd =
10675     IsSigned ? APIntOps::smax(getSignedRangeMin(RHS), Limit)
10676              : APIntOps::umax(getUnsignedRangeMin(RHS), Limit);
10677 
10678 
10679   const SCEV *MaxBECount = getCouldNotCompute();
10680   if (isa<SCEVConstant>(BECount))
10681     MaxBECount = BECount;
10682   else
10683     MaxBECount = computeBECount(getConstant(MaxStart - MinEnd),
10684                                 getConstant(MinStride), false);
10685 
10686   if (isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(MaxBECount))
10687     MaxBECount = BECount;
10688 
10689   return ExitLimit(BECount, MaxBECount, false, Predicates);
10690 }
10691 
10692 const SCEV *SCEVAddRecExpr::getNumIterationsInRange(const ConstantRange &Range,
10693                                                     ScalarEvolution &SE) const {
10694   if (Range.isFullSet())  // Infinite loop.
10695     return SE.getCouldNotCompute();
10696 
10697   // If the start is a non-zero constant, shift the range to simplify things.
10698   if (const SCEVConstant *SC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(getStart()))
10699     if (!SC->getValue()->isZero()) {
10700       SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> Operands(op_begin(), op_end());
10701       Operands[0] = SE.getZero(SC->getType());
10702       const SCEV *Shifted = SE.getAddRecExpr(Operands, getLoop(),
10703                                              getNoWrapFlags(FlagNW));
10704       if (const auto *ShiftedAddRec = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Shifted))
10705         return ShiftedAddRec->getNumIterationsInRange(
10706             Range.subtract(SC->getAPInt()), SE);
10707       // This is strange and shouldn't happen.
10708       return SE.getCouldNotCompute();
10709     }
10710 
10711   // The only time we can solve this is when we have all constant indices.
10712   // Otherwise, we cannot determine the overflow conditions.
10713   if (any_of(operands(), [](const SCEV *Op) { return !isa<SCEVConstant>(Op); }))
10714     return SE.getCouldNotCompute();
10715 
10716   // Okay at this point we know that all elements of the chrec are constants and
10717   // that the start element is zero.
10718 
10719   // First check to see if the range contains zero.  If not, the first
10720   // iteration exits.
10721   unsigned BitWidth = SE.getTypeSizeInBits(getType());
10722   if (!Range.contains(APInt(BitWidth, 0)))
10723     return SE.getZero(getType());
10724 
10725   if (isAffine()) {
10726     // If this is an affine expression then we have this situation:
10727     //   Solve {0,+,A} in Range  ===  Ax in Range
10728 
10729     // We know that zero is in the range.  If A is positive then we know that
10730     // the upper value of the range must be the first possible exit value.
10731     // If A is negative then the lower of the range is the last possible loop
10732     // value.  Also note that we already checked for a full range.
10733     APInt A = cast<SCEVConstant>(getOperand(1))->getAPInt();
10734     APInt End = A.sge(1) ? (Range.getUpper() - 1) : Range.getLower();
10735 
10736     // The exit value should be (End+A)/A.
10737     APInt ExitVal = (End + A).udiv(A);
10738     ConstantInt *ExitValue = ConstantInt::get(SE.getContext(), ExitVal);
10739 
10740     // Evaluate at the exit value.  If we really did fall out of the valid
10741     // range, then we computed our trip count, otherwise wrap around or other
10742     // things must have happened.
10743     ConstantInt *Val = EvaluateConstantChrecAtConstant(this, ExitValue, SE);
10744     if (Range.contains(Val->getValue()))
10745       return SE.getCouldNotCompute();  // Something strange happened
10746 
10747     // Ensure that the previous value is in the range.  This is a sanity check.
10748     assert(Range.contains(
10749            EvaluateConstantChrecAtConstant(this,
10750            ConstantInt::get(SE.getContext(), ExitVal - 1), SE)->getValue()) &&
10751            "Linear scev computation is off in a bad way!");
10752     return SE.getConstant(ExitValue);
10753   }
10754 
10755   if (isQuadratic()) {
10756     if (auto S = SolveQuadraticAddRecRange(this, Range, SE))
10757       return SE.getConstant(S.getValue());
10758   }
10759 
10760   return SE.getCouldNotCompute();
10761 }
10762 
10763 const SCEVAddRecExpr *
10764 SCEVAddRecExpr::getPostIncExpr(ScalarEvolution &SE) const {
10765   assert(getNumOperands() > 1 && "AddRec with zero step?");
10766   // There is a temptation to just call getAddExpr(this, getStepRecurrence(SE)),
10767   // but in this case we cannot guarantee that the value returned will be an
10768   // AddRec because SCEV does not have a fixed point where it stops
10769   // simplification: it is legal to return ({rec1} + {rec2}). For example, it
10770   // may happen if we reach arithmetic depth limit while simplifying. So we
10771   // construct the returned value explicitly.
10772   SmallVector<const SCEV *, 3> Ops;
10773   // If this is {A,+,B,+,C,...,+,N}, then its step is {B,+,C,+,...,+,N}, and
10774   // (this + Step) is {A+B,+,B+C,+...,+,N}.
10775   for (unsigned i = 0, e = getNumOperands() - 1; i < e; ++i)
10776     Ops.push_back(SE.getAddExpr(getOperand(i), getOperand(i + 1)));
10777   // We know that the last operand is not a constant zero (otherwise it would
10778   // have been popped out earlier). This guarantees us that if the result has
10779   // the same last operand, then it will also not be popped out, meaning that
10780   // the returned value will be an AddRec.
10781   const SCEV *Last = getOperand(getNumOperands() - 1);
10782   assert(!Last->isZero() && "Recurrency with zero step?");
10783   Ops.push_back(Last);
10784   return cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(SE.getAddRecExpr(Ops, getLoop(),
10785                                                SCEV::FlagAnyWrap));
10786 }
10787 
10788 // Return true when S contains at least an undef value.
10789 static inline bool containsUndefs(const SCEV *S) {
10790   return SCEVExprContains(S, [](const SCEV *S) {
10791     if (const auto *SU = dyn_cast<SCEVUnknown>(S))
10792       return isa<UndefValue>(SU->getValue());
10793     else if (const auto *SC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(S))
10794       return isa<UndefValue>(SC->getValue());
10795     return false;
10796   });
10797 }
10798 
10799 namespace {
10800 
10801 // Collect all steps of SCEV expressions.
10802 struct SCEVCollectStrides {
10803   ScalarEvolution &SE;
10804   SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Strides;
10805 
10806   SCEVCollectStrides(ScalarEvolution &SE, SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &S)
10807       : SE(SE), Strides(S) {}
10808 
10809   bool follow(const SCEV *S) {
10810     if (const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(S))
10811       Strides.push_back(AR->getStepRecurrence(SE));
10812     return true;
10813   }
10814 
10815   bool isDone() const { return false; }
10816 };
10817 
10818 // Collect all SCEVUnknown and SCEVMulExpr expressions.
10819 struct SCEVCollectTerms {
10820   SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Terms;
10821 
10822   SCEVCollectTerms(SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &T) : Terms(T) {}
10823 
10824   bool follow(const SCEV *S) {
10825     if (isa<SCEVUnknown>(S) || isa<SCEVMulExpr>(S) ||
10826         isa<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(S)) {
10827       if (!containsUndefs(S))
10828         Terms.push_back(S);
10829 
10830       // Stop recursion: once we collected a term, do not walk its operands.
10831       return false;
10832     }
10833 
10834     // Keep looking.
10835     return true;
10836   }
10837 
10838   bool isDone() const { return false; }
10839 };
10840 
10841 // Check if a SCEV contains an AddRecExpr.
10842 struct SCEVHasAddRec {
10843   bool &ContainsAddRec;
10844 
10845   SCEVHasAddRec(bool &ContainsAddRec) : ContainsAddRec(ContainsAddRec) {
10846     ContainsAddRec = false;
10847   }
10848 
10849   bool follow(const SCEV *S) {
10850     if (isa<SCEVAddRecExpr>(S)) {
10851       ContainsAddRec = true;
10852 
10853       // Stop recursion: once we collected a term, do not walk its operands.
10854       return false;
10855     }
10856 
10857     // Keep looking.
10858     return true;
10859   }
10860 
10861   bool isDone() const { return false; }
10862 };
10863 
10864 // Find factors that are multiplied with an expression that (possibly as a
10865 // subexpression) contains an AddRecExpr. In the expression:
10866 //
10867 //  8 * (100 +  %p * %q * (%a + {0, +, 1}_loop))
10868 //
10869 // "%p * %q" are factors multiplied by the expression "(%a + {0, +, 1}_loop)"
10870 // that contains the AddRec {0, +, 1}_loop. %p * %q are likely to be array size
10871 // parameters as they form a product with an induction variable.
10872 //
10873 // This collector expects all array size parameters to be in the same MulExpr.
10874 // It might be necessary to later add support for collecting parameters that are
10875 // spread over different nested MulExpr.
10876 struct SCEVCollectAddRecMultiplies {
10877   SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Terms;
10878   ScalarEvolution &SE;
10879 
10880   SCEVCollectAddRecMultiplies(SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &T, ScalarEvolution &SE)
10881       : Terms(T), SE(SE) {}
10882 
10883   bool follow(const SCEV *S) {
10884     if (auto *Mul = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(S)) {
10885       bool HasAddRec = false;
10886       SmallVector<const SCEV *, 0> Operands;
10887       for (auto Op : Mul->operands()) {
10888         const SCEVUnknown *Unknown = dyn_cast<SCEVUnknown>(Op);
10889         if (Unknown && !isa<CallInst>(Unknown->getValue())) {
10890           Operands.push_back(Op);
10891         } else if (Unknown) {
10892           HasAddRec = true;
10893         } else {
10894           bool ContainsAddRec;
10895           SCEVHasAddRec ContiansAddRec(ContainsAddRec);
10896           visitAll(Op, ContiansAddRec);
10897           HasAddRec |= ContainsAddRec;
10898         }
10899       }
10900       if (Operands.size() == 0)
10901         return true;
10902 
10903       if (!HasAddRec)
10904         return false;
10905 
10906       Terms.push_back(SE.getMulExpr(Operands));
10907       // Stop recursion: once we collected a term, do not walk its operands.
10908       return false;
10909     }
10910 
10911     // Keep looking.
10912     return true;
10913   }
10914 
10915   bool isDone() const { return false; }
10916 };
10917 
10918 } // end anonymous namespace
10919 
10920 /// Find parametric terms in this SCEVAddRecExpr. We first for parameters in
10921 /// two places:
10922 ///   1) The strides of AddRec expressions.
10923 ///   2) Unknowns that are multiplied with AddRec expressions.
10924 void ScalarEvolution::collectParametricTerms(const SCEV *Expr,
10925     SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Terms) {
10926   SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> Strides;
10927   SCEVCollectStrides StrideCollector(*this, Strides);
10928   visitAll(Expr, StrideCollector);
10929 
10930   LLVM_DEBUG({
10931     dbgs() << "Strides:\n";
10932     for (const SCEV *S : Strides)
10933       dbgs() << *S << "\n";
10934   });
10935 
10936   for (const SCEV *S : Strides) {
10937     SCEVCollectTerms TermCollector(Terms);
10938     visitAll(S, TermCollector);
10939   }
10940 
10941   LLVM_DEBUG({
10942     dbgs() << "Terms:\n";
10943     for (const SCEV *T : Terms)
10944       dbgs() << *T << "\n";
10945   });
10946 
10947   SCEVCollectAddRecMultiplies MulCollector(Terms, *this);
10948   visitAll(Expr, MulCollector);
10949 }
10950 
10951 static bool findArrayDimensionsRec(ScalarEvolution &SE,
10952                                    SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Terms,
10953                                    SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Sizes) {
10954   int Last = Terms.size() - 1;
10955   const SCEV *Step = Terms[Last];
10956 
10957   // End of recursion.
10958   if (Last == 0) {
10959     if (const SCEVMulExpr *M = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(Step)) {
10960       SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> Qs;
10961       for (const SCEV *Op : M->operands())
10962         if (!isa<SCEVConstant>(Op))
10963           Qs.push_back(Op);
10964 
10965       Step = SE.getMulExpr(Qs);
10966     }
10967 
10968     Sizes.push_back(Step);
10969     return true;
10970   }
10971 
10972   for (const SCEV *&Term : Terms) {
10973     // Normalize the terms before the next call to findArrayDimensionsRec.
10974     const SCEV *Q, *R;
10975     SCEVDivision::divide(SE, Term, Step, &Q, &R);
10976 
10977     // Bail out when GCD does not evenly divide one of the terms.
10978     if (!R->isZero())
10979       return false;
10980 
10981     Term = Q;
10982   }
10983 
10984   // Remove all SCEVConstants.
10985   Terms.erase(
10986       remove_if(Terms, [](const SCEV *E) { return isa<SCEVConstant>(E); }),
10987       Terms.end());
10988 
10989   if (Terms.size() > 0)
10990     if (!findArrayDimensionsRec(SE, Terms, Sizes))
10991       return false;
10992 
10993   Sizes.push_back(Step);
10994   return true;
10995 }
10996 
10997 // Returns true when one of the SCEVs of Terms contains a SCEVUnknown parameter.
10998 static inline bool containsParameters(SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Terms) {
10999   for (const SCEV *T : Terms)
11000     if (SCEVExprContains(T, isa<SCEVUnknown, const SCEV *>))
11001       return true;
11002   return false;
11003 }
11004 
11005 // Return the number of product terms in S.
11006 static inline int numberOfTerms(const SCEV *S) {
11007   if (const SCEVMulExpr *Expr = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(S))
11008     return Expr->getNumOperands();
11009   return 1;
11010 }
11011 
11012 static const SCEV *removeConstantFactors(ScalarEvolution &SE, const SCEV *T) {
11013   if (isa<SCEVConstant>(T))
11014     return nullptr;
11015 
11016   if (isa<SCEVUnknown>(T))
11017     return T;
11018 
11019   if (const SCEVMulExpr *M = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(T)) {
11020     SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> Factors;
11021     for (const SCEV *Op : M->operands())
11022       if (!isa<SCEVConstant>(Op))
11023         Factors.push_back(Op);
11024 
11025     return SE.getMulExpr(Factors);
11026   }
11027 
11028   return T;
11029 }
11030 
11031 /// Return the size of an element read or written by Inst.
11032 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getElementSize(Instruction *Inst) {
11033   Type *Ty;
11034   if (StoreInst *Store = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(Inst))
11035     Ty = Store->getValueOperand()->getType();
11036   else if (LoadInst *Load = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(Inst))
11037     Ty = Load->getType();
11038   else
11039     return nullptr;
11040 
11041   Type *ETy = getEffectiveSCEVType(PointerType::getUnqual(Ty));
11042   return getSizeOfExpr(ETy, Ty);
11043 }
11044 
11045 void ScalarEvolution::findArrayDimensions(SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Terms,
11046                                           SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Sizes,
11047                                           const SCEV *ElementSize) {
11048   if (Terms.size() < 1 || !ElementSize)
11049     return;
11050 
11051   // Early return when Terms do not contain parameters: we do not delinearize
11052   // non parametric SCEVs.
11053   if (!containsParameters(Terms))
11054     return;
11055 
11056   LLVM_DEBUG({
11057     dbgs() << "Terms:\n";
11058     for (const SCEV *T : Terms)
11059       dbgs() << *T << "\n";
11060   });
11061 
11062   // Remove duplicates.
11063   array_pod_sort(Terms.begin(), Terms.end());
11064   Terms.erase(std::unique(Terms.begin(), Terms.end()), Terms.end());
11065 
11066   // Put larger terms first.
11067   llvm::sort(Terms, [](const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS) {
11068     return numberOfTerms(LHS) > numberOfTerms(RHS);
11069   });
11070 
11071   // Try to divide all terms by the element size. If term is not divisible by
11072   // element size, proceed with the original term.
11073   for (const SCEV *&Term : Terms) {
11074     const SCEV *Q, *R;
11075     SCEVDivision::divide(*this, Term, ElementSize, &Q, &R);
11076     if (!Q->isZero())
11077       Term = Q;
11078   }
11079 
11080   SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> NewTerms;
11081 
11082   // Remove constant factors.
11083   for (const SCEV *T : Terms)
11084     if (const SCEV *NewT = removeConstantFactors(*this, T))
11085       NewTerms.push_back(NewT);
11086 
11087   LLVM_DEBUG({
11088     dbgs() << "Terms after sorting:\n";
11089     for (const SCEV *T : NewTerms)
11090       dbgs() << *T << "\n";
11091   });
11092 
11093   if (NewTerms.empty() || !findArrayDimensionsRec(*this, NewTerms, Sizes)) {
11094     Sizes.clear();
11095     return;
11096   }
11097 
11098   // The last element to be pushed into Sizes is the size of an element.
11099   Sizes.push_back(ElementSize);
11100 
11101   LLVM_DEBUG({
11102     dbgs() << "Sizes:\n";
11103     for (const SCEV *S : Sizes)
11104       dbgs() << *S << "\n";
11105   });
11106 }
11107 
11108 void ScalarEvolution::computeAccessFunctions(
11109     const SCEV *Expr, SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Subscripts,
11110     SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Sizes) {
11111   // Early exit in case this SCEV is not an affine multivariate function.
11112   if (Sizes.empty())
11113     return;
11114 
11115   if (auto *AR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Expr))
11116     if (!AR->isAffine())
11117       return;
11118 
11119   const SCEV *Res = Expr;
11120   int Last = Sizes.size() - 1;
11121   for (int i = Last; i >= 0; i--) {
11122     const SCEV *Q, *R;
11123     SCEVDivision::divide(*this, Res, Sizes[i], &Q, &R);
11124 
11125     LLVM_DEBUG({
11126       dbgs() << "Res: " << *Res << "\n";
11127       dbgs() << "Sizes[i]: " << *Sizes[i] << "\n";
11128       dbgs() << "Res divided by Sizes[i]:\n";
11129       dbgs() << "Quotient: " << *Q << "\n";
11130       dbgs() << "Remainder: " << *R << "\n";
11131     });
11132 
11133     Res = Q;
11134 
11135     // Do not record the last subscript corresponding to the size of elements in
11136     // the array.
11137     if (i == Last) {
11138 
11139       // Bail out if the remainder is too complex.
11140       if (isa<SCEVAddRecExpr>(R)) {
11141         Subscripts.clear();
11142         Sizes.clear();
11143         return;
11144       }
11145 
11146       continue;
11147     }
11148 
11149     // Record the access function for the current subscript.
11150     Subscripts.push_back(R);
11151   }
11152 
11153   // Also push in last position the remainder of the last division: it will be
11154   // the access function of the innermost dimension.
11155   Subscripts.push_back(Res);
11156 
11157   std::reverse(Subscripts.begin(), Subscripts.end());
11158 
11159   LLVM_DEBUG({
11160     dbgs() << "Subscripts:\n";
11161     for (const SCEV *S : Subscripts)
11162       dbgs() << *S << "\n";
11163   });
11164 }
11165 
11166 /// Splits the SCEV into two vectors of SCEVs representing the subscripts and
11167 /// sizes of an array access. Returns the remainder of the delinearization that
11168 /// is the offset start of the array.  The SCEV->delinearize algorithm computes
11169 /// the multiples of SCEV coefficients: that is a pattern matching of sub
11170 /// expressions in the stride and base of a SCEV corresponding to the
11171 /// computation of a GCD (greatest common divisor) of base and stride.  When
11172 /// SCEV->delinearize fails, it returns the SCEV unchanged.
11173 ///
11174 /// For example: when analyzing the memory access A[i][j][k] in this loop nest
11175 ///
11176 ///  void foo(long n, long m, long o, double A[n][m][o]) {
11177 ///
11178 ///    for (long i = 0; i < n; i++)
11179 ///      for (long j = 0; j < m; j++)
11180 ///        for (long k = 0; k < o; k++)
11181 ///          A[i][j][k] = 1.0;
11182 ///  }
11183 ///
11184 /// the delinearization input is the following AddRec SCEV:
11185 ///
11186 ///  AddRec: {{{%A,+,(8 * %m * %o)}<%for.i>,+,(8 * %o)}<%for.j>,+,8}<%for.k>
11187 ///
11188 /// From this SCEV, we are able to say that the base offset of the access is %A
11189 /// because it appears as an offset that does not divide any of the strides in
11190 /// the loops:
11191 ///
11192 ///  CHECK: Base offset: %A
11193 ///
11194 /// and then SCEV->delinearize determines the size of some of the dimensions of
11195 /// the array as these are the multiples by which the strides are happening:
11196 ///
11197 ///  CHECK: ArrayDecl[UnknownSize][%m][%o] with elements of sizeof(double) bytes.
11198 ///
11199 /// Note that the outermost dimension remains of UnknownSize because there are
11200 /// no strides that would help identifying the size of the last dimension: when
11201 /// the array has been statically allocated, one could compute the size of that
11202 /// dimension by dividing the overall size of the array by the size of the known
11203 /// dimensions: %m * %o * 8.
11204 ///
11205 /// Finally delinearize provides the access functions for the array reference
11206 /// that does correspond to A[i][j][k] of the above C testcase:
11207 ///
11208 ///  CHECK: ArrayRef[{0,+,1}<%for.i>][{0,+,1}<%for.j>][{0,+,1}<%for.k>]
11209 ///
11210 /// The testcases are checking the output of a function pass:
11211 /// DelinearizationPass that walks through all loads and stores of a function
11212 /// asking for the SCEV of the memory access with respect to all enclosing
11213 /// loops, calling SCEV->delinearize on that and printing the results.
11214 void ScalarEvolution::delinearize(const SCEV *Expr,
11215                                  SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Subscripts,
11216                                  SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Sizes,
11217                                  const SCEV *ElementSize) {
11218   // First step: collect parametric terms.
11219   SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> Terms;
11220   collectParametricTerms(Expr, Terms);
11221 
11222   if (Terms.empty())
11223     return;
11224 
11225   // Second step: find subscript sizes.
11226   findArrayDimensions(Terms, Sizes, ElementSize);
11227 
11228   if (Sizes.empty())
11229     return;
11230 
11231   // Third step: compute the access functions for each subscript.
11232   computeAccessFunctions(Expr, Subscripts, Sizes);
11233 
11234   if (Subscripts.empty())
11235     return;
11236 
11237   LLVM_DEBUG({
11238     dbgs() << "succeeded to delinearize " << *Expr << "\n";
11239     dbgs() << "ArrayDecl[UnknownSize]";
11240     for (const SCEV *S : Sizes)
11241       dbgs() << "[" << *S << "]";
11242 
11243     dbgs() << "\nArrayRef";
11244     for (const SCEV *S : Subscripts)
11245       dbgs() << "[" << *S << "]";
11246     dbgs() << "\n";
11247   });
11248 }
11249 
11250 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
11251 //                   SCEVCallbackVH Class Implementation
11252 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
11253 
11254 void ScalarEvolution::SCEVCallbackVH::deleted() {
11255   assert(SE && "SCEVCallbackVH called with a null ScalarEvolution!");
11256   if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(getValPtr()))
11257     SE->ConstantEvolutionLoopExitValue.erase(PN);
11258   SE->eraseValueFromMap(getValPtr());
11259   // this now dangles!
11260 }
11261 
11262 void ScalarEvolution::SCEVCallbackVH::allUsesReplacedWith(Value *V) {
11263   assert(SE && "SCEVCallbackVH called with a null ScalarEvolution!");
11264 
11265   // Forget all the expressions associated with users of the old value,
11266   // so that future queries will recompute the expressions using the new
11267   // value.
11268   Value *Old = getValPtr();
11269   SmallVector<User *, 16> Worklist(Old->user_begin(), Old->user_end());
11270   SmallPtrSet<User *, 8> Visited;
11271   while (!Worklist.empty()) {
11272     User *U = Worklist.pop_back_val();
11273     // Deleting the Old value will cause this to dangle. Postpone
11274     // that until everything else is done.
11275     if (U == Old)
11276       continue;
11277     if (!Visited.insert(U).second)
11278       continue;
11279     if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(U))
11280       SE->ConstantEvolutionLoopExitValue.erase(PN);
11281     SE->eraseValueFromMap(U);
11282     Worklist.insert(Worklist.end(), U->user_begin(), U->user_end());
11283   }
11284   // Delete the Old value.
11285   if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(Old))
11286     SE->ConstantEvolutionLoopExitValue.erase(PN);
11287   SE->eraseValueFromMap(Old);
11288   // this now dangles!
11289 }
11290 
11291 ScalarEvolution::SCEVCallbackVH::SCEVCallbackVH(Value *V, ScalarEvolution *se)
11292   : CallbackVH(V), SE(se) {}
11293 
11294 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
11295 //                   ScalarEvolution Class Implementation
11296 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
11297 
11298 ScalarEvolution::ScalarEvolution(Function &F, TargetLibraryInfo &TLI,
11299                                  AssumptionCache &AC, DominatorTree &DT,
11300                                  LoopInfo &LI)
11301     : F(F), TLI(TLI), AC(AC), DT(DT), LI(LI),
11302       CouldNotCompute(new SCEVCouldNotCompute()), ValuesAtScopes(64),
11303       LoopDispositions(64), BlockDispositions(64) {
11304   // To use guards for proving predicates, we need to scan every instruction in
11305   // relevant basic blocks, and not just terminators.  Doing this is a waste of
11306   // time if the IR does not actually contain any calls to
11307   // @llvm.experimental.guard, so do a quick check and remember this beforehand.
11308   //
11309   // This pessimizes the case where a pass that preserves ScalarEvolution wants
11310   // to _add_ guards to the module when there weren't any before, and wants
11311   // ScalarEvolution to optimize based on those guards.  For now we prefer to be
11312   // efficient in lieu of being smart in that rather obscure case.
11313 
11314   auto *GuardDecl = F.getParent()->getFunction(
11315       Intrinsic::getName(Intrinsic::experimental_guard));
11316   HasGuards = GuardDecl && !GuardDecl->use_empty();
11317 }
11318 
11319 ScalarEvolution::ScalarEvolution(ScalarEvolution &&Arg)
11320     : F(Arg.F), HasGuards(Arg.HasGuards), TLI(Arg.TLI), AC(Arg.AC), DT(Arg.DT),
11321       LI(Arg.LI), CouldNotCompute(std::move(Arg.CouldNotCompute)),
11322       ValueExprMap(std::move(Arg.ValueExprMap)),
11323       PendingLoopPredicates(std::move(Arg.PendingLoopPredicates)),
11324       PendingPhiRanges(std::move(Arg.PendingPhiRanges)),
11325       PendingMerges(std::move(Arg.PendingMerges)),
11326       MinTrailingZerosCache(std::move(Arg.MinTrailingZerosCache)),
11327       BackedgeTakenCounts(std::move(Arg.BackedgeTakenCounts)),
11328       PredicatedBackedgeTakenCounts(
11329           std::move(Arg.PredicatedBackedgeTakenCounts)),
11330       ConstantEvolutionLoopExitValue(
11331           std::move(Arg.ConstantEvolutionLoopExitValue)),
11332       ValuesAtScopes(std::move(Arg.ValuesAtScopes)),
11333       LoopDispositions(std::move(Arg.LoopDispositions)),
11334       LoopPropertiesCache(std::move(Arg.LoopPropertiesCache)),
11335       BlockDispositions(std::move(Arg.BlockDispositions)),
11336       UnsignedRanges(std::move(Arg.UnsignedRanges)),
11337       SignedRanges(std::move(Arg.SignedRanges)),
11338       UniqueSCEVs(std::move(Arg.UniqueSCEVs)),
11339       UniquePreds(std::move(Arg.UniquePreds)),
11340       SCEVAllocator(std::move(Arg.SCEVAllocator)),
11341       LoopUsers(std::move(Arg.LoopUsers)),
11342       PredicatedSCEVRewrites(std::move(Arg.PredicatedSCEVRewrites)),
11343       FirstUnknown(Arg.FirstUnknown) {
11344   Arg.FirstUnknown = nullptr;
11345 }
11346 
11347 ScalarEvolution::~ScalarEvolution() {
11348   // Iterate through all the SCEVUnknown instances and call their
11349   // destructors, so that they release their references to their values.
11350   for (SCEVUnknown *U = FirstUnknown; U;) {
11351     SCEVUnknown *Tmp = U;
11352     U = U->Next;
11353     Tmp->~SCEVUnknown();
11354   }
11355   FirstUnknown = nullptr;
11356 
11357   ExprValueMap.clear();
11358   ValueExprMap.clear();
11359   HasRecMap.clear();
11360 
11361   // Free any extra memory created for ExitNotTakenInfo in the unlikely event
11362   // that a loop had multiple computable exits.
11363   for (auto &BTCI : BackedgeTakenCounts)
11364     BTCI.second.clear();
11365   for (auto &BTCI : PredicatedBackedgeTakenCounts)
11366     BTCI.second.clear();
11367 
11368   assert(PendingLoopPredicates.empty() && "isImpliedCond garbage");
11369   assert(PendingPhiRanges.empty() && "getRangeRef garbage");
11370   assert(PendingMerges.empty() && "isImpliedViaMerge garbage");
11371   assert(!WalkingBEDominatingConds && "isLoopBackedgeGuardedByCond garbage!");
11372   assert(!ProvingSplitPredicate && "ProvingSplitPredicate garbage!");
11373 }
11374 
11375 bool ScalarEvolution::hasLoopInvariantBackedgeTakenCount(const Loop *L) {
11376   return !isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(getBackedgeTakenCount(L));
11377 }
11378 
11379 static void PrintLoopInfo(raw_ostream &OS, ScalarEvolution *SE,
11380                           const Loop *L) {
11381   // Print all inner loops first
11382   for (Loop *I : *L)
11383     PrintLoopInfo(OS, SE, I);
11384 
11385   OS << "Loop ";
11386   L->getHeader()->printAsOperand(OS, /*PrintType=*/false);
11387   OS << ": ";
11388 
11389   SmallVector<BasicBlock *, 8> ExitBlocks;
11390   L->getExitBlocks(ExitBlocks);
11391   if (ExitBlocks.size() != 1)
11392     OS << "<multiple exits> ";
11393 
11394   if (SE->hasLoopInvariantBackedgeTakenCount(L)) {
11395     OS << "backedge-taken count is " << *SE->getBackedgeTakenCount(L);
11396   } else {
11397     OS << "Unpredictable backedge-taken count. ";
11398   }
11399 
11400   OS << "\n"
11401         "Loop ";
11402   L->getHeader()->printAsOperand(OS, /*PrintType=*/false);
11403   OS << ": ";
11404 
11405   if (!isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(SE->getMaxBackedgeTakenCount(L))) {
11406     OS << "max backedge-taken count is " << *SE->getMaxBackedgeTakenCount(L);
11407     if (SE->isBackedgeTakenCountMaxOrZero(L))
11408       OS << ", actual taken count either this or zero.";
11409   } else {
11410     OS << "Unpredictable max backedge-taken count. ";
11411   }
11412 
11413   OS << "\n"
11414         "Loop ";
11415   L->getHeader()->printAsOperand(OS, /*PrintType=*/false);
11416   OS << ": ";
11417 
11418   SCEVUnionPredicate Pred;
11419   auto PBT = SE->getPredicatedBackedgeTakenCount(L, Pred);
11420   if (!isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(PBT)) {
11421     OS << "Predicated backedge-taken count is " << *PBT << "\n";
11422     OS << " Predicates:\n";
11423     Pred.print(OS, 4);
11424   } else {
11425     OS << "Unpredictable predicated backedge-taken count. ";
11426   }
11427   OS << "\n";
11428 
11429   if (SE->hasLoopInvariantBackedgeTakenCount(L)) {
11430     OS << "Loop ";
11431     L->getHeader()->printAsOperand(OS, /*PrintType=*/false);
11432     OS << ": ";
11433     OS << "Trip multiple is " << SE->getSmallConstantTripMultiple(L) << "\n";
11434   }
11435 }
11436 
11437 static StringRef loopDispositionToStr(ScalarEvolution::LoopDisposition LD) {
11438   switch (LD) {
11439   case ScalarEvolution::LoopVariant:
11440     return "Variant";
11441   case ScalarEvolution::LoopInvariant:
11442     return "Invariant";
11443   case ScalarEvolution::LoopComputable:
11444     return "Computable";
11445   }
11446   llvm_unreachable("Unknown ScalarEvolution::LoopDisposition kind!");
11447 }
11448 
11449 void ScalarEvolution::print(raw_ostream &OS) const {
11450   // ScalarEvolution's implementation of the print method is to print
11451   // out SCEV values of all instructions that are interesting. Doing
11452   // this potentially causes it to create new SCEV objects though,
11453   // which technically conflicts with the const qualifier. This isn't
11454   // observable from outside the class though, so casting away the
11455   // const isn't dangerous.
11456   ScalarEvolution &SE = *const_cast<ScalarEvolution *>(this);
11457 
11458   OS << "Classifying expressions for: ";
11459   F.printAsOperand(OS, /*PrintType=*/false);
11460   OS << "\n";
11461   for (Instruction &I : instructions(F))
11462     if (isSCEVable(I.getType()) && !isa<CmpInst>(I)) {
11463       OS << I << '\n';
11464       OS << "  -->  ";
11465       const SCEV *SV = SE.getSCEV(&I);
11466       SV->print(OS);
11467       if (!isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(SV)) {
11468         OS << " U: ";
11469         SE.getUnsignedRange(SV).print(OS);
11470         OS << " S: ";
11471         SE.getSignedRange(SV).print(OS);
11472       }
11473 
11474       const Loop *L = LI.getLoopFor(I.getParent());
11475 
11476       const SCEV *AtUse = SE.getSCEVAtScope(SV, L);
11477       if (AtUse != SV) {
11478         OS << "  -->  ";
11479         AtUse->print(OS);
11480         if (!isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(AtUse)) {
11481           OS << " U: ";
11482           SE.getUnsignedRange(AtUse).print(OS);
11483           OS << " S: ";
11484           SE.getSignedRange(AtUse).print(OS);
11485         }
11486       }
11487 
11488       if (L) {
11489         OS << "\t\t" "Exits: ";
11490         const SCEV *ExitValue = SE.getSCEVAtScope(SV, L->getParentLoop());
11491         if (!SE.isLoopInvariant(ExitValue, L)) {
11492           OS << "<<Unknown>>";
11493         } else {
11494           OS << *ExitValue;
11495         }
11496 
11497         bool First = true;
11498         for (auto *Iter = L; Iter; Iter = Iter->getParentLoop()) {
11499           if (First) {
11500             OS << "\t\t" "LoopDispositions: { ";
11501             First = false;
11502           } else {
11503             OS << ", ";
11504           }
11505 
11506           Iter->getHeader()->printAsOperand(OS, /*PrintType=*/false);
11507           OS << ": " << loopDispositionToStr(SE.getLoopDisposition(SV, Iter));
11508         }
11509 
11510         for (auto *InnerL : depth_first(L)) {
11511           if (InnerL == L)
11512             continue;
11513           if (First) {
11514             OS << "\t\t" "LoopDispositions: { ";
11515             First = false;
11516           } else {
11517             OS << ", ";
11518           }
11519 
11520           InnerL->getHeader()->printAsOperand(OS, /*PrintType=*/false);
11521           OS << ": " << loopDispositionToStr(SE.getLoopDisposition(SV, InnerL));
11522         }
11523 
11524         OS << " }";
11525       }
11526 
11527       OS << "\n";
11528     }
11529 
11530   OS << "Determining loop execution counts for: ";
11531   F.printAsOperand(OS, /*PrintType=*/false);
11532   OS << "\n";
11533   for (Loop *I : LI)
11534     PrintLoopInfo(OS, &SE, I);
11535 }
11536 
11537 ScalarEvolution::LoopDisposition
11538 ScalarEvolution::getLoopDisposition(const SCEV *S, const Loop *L) {
11539   auto &Values = LoopDispositions[S];
11540   for (auto &V : Values) {
11541     if (V.getPointer() == L)
11542       return V.getInt();
11543   }
11544   Values.emplace_back(L, LoopVariant);
11545   LoopDisposition D = computeLoopDisposition(S, L);
11546   auto &Values2 = LoopDispositions[S];
11547   for (auto &V : make_range(Values2.rbegin(), Values2.rend())) {
11548     if (V.getPointer() == L) {
11549       V.setInt(D);
11550       break;
11551     }
11552   }
11553   return D;
11554 }
11555 
11556 ScalarEvolution::LoopDisposition
11557 ScalarEvolution::computeLoopDisposition(const SCEV *S, const Loop *L) {
11558   switch (static_cast<SCEVTypes>(S->getSCEVType())) {
11559   case scConstant:
11560     return LoopInvariant;
11561   case scTruncate:
11562   case scZeroExtend:
11563   case scSignExtend:
11564     return getLoopDisposition(cast<SCEVCastExpr>(S)->getOperand(), L);
11565   case scAddRecExpr: {
11566     const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR = cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(S);
11567 
11568     // If L is the addrec's loop, it's computable.
11569     if (AR->getLoop() == L)
11570       return LoopComputable;
11571 
11572     // Add recurrences are never invariant in the function-body (null loop).
11573     if (!L)
11574       return LoopVariant;
11575 
11576     // Everything that is not defined at loop entry is variant.
11577     if (DT.dominates(L->getHeader(), AR->getLoop()->getHeader()))
11578       return LoopVariant;
11579     assert(!L->contains(AR->getLoop()) && "Containing loop's header does not"
11580            " dominate the contained loop's header?");
11581 
11582     // This recurrence is invariant w.r.t. L if AR's loop contains L.
11583     if (AR->getLoop()->contains(L))
11584       return LoopInvariant;
11585 
11586     // This recurrence is variant w.r.t. L if any of its operands
11587     // are variant.
11588     for (auto *Op : AR->operands())
11589       if (!isLoopInvariant(Op, L))
11590         return LoopVariant;
11591 
11592     // Otherwise it's loop-invariant.
11593     return LoopInvariant;
11594   }
11595   case scAddExpr:
11596   case scMulExpr:
11597   case scUMaxExpr:
11598   case scSMaxExpr: {
11599     bool HasVarying = false;
11600     for (auto *Op : cast<SCEVNAryExpr>(S)->operands()) {
11601       LoopDisposition D = getLoopDisposition(Op, L);
11602       if (D == LoopVariant)
11603         return LoopVariant;
11604       if (D == LoopComputable)
11605         HasVarying = true;
11606     }
11607     return HasVarying ? LoopComputable : LoopInvariant;
11608   }
11609   case scUDivExpr: {
11610     const SCEVUDivExpr *UDiv = cast<SCEVUDivExpr>(S);
11611     LoopDisposition LD = getLoopDisposition(UDiv->getLHS(), L);
11612     if (LD == LoopVariant)
11613       return LoopVariant;
11614     LoopDisposition RD = getLoopDisposition(UDiv->getRHS(), L);
11615     if (RD == LoopVariant)
11616       return LoopVariant;
11617     return (LD == LoopInvariant && RD == LoopInvariant) ?
11618            LoopInvariant : LoopComputable;
11619   }
11620   case scUnknown:
11621     // All non-instruction values are loop invariant.  All instructions are loop
11622     // invariant if they are not contained in the specified loop.
11623     // Instructions are never considered invariant in the function body
11624     // (null loop) because they are defined within the "loop".
11625     if (auto *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(cast<SCEVUnknown>(S)->getValue()))
11626       return (L && !L->contains(I)) ? LoopInvariant : LoopVariant;
11627     return LoopInvariant;
11628   case scCouldNotCompute:
11629     llvm_unreachable("Attempt to use a SCEVCouldNotCompute object!");
11630   }
11631   llvm_unreachable("Unknown SCEV kind!");
11632 }
11633 
11634 bool ScalarEvolution::isLoopInvariant(const SCEV *S, const Loop *L) {
11635   return getLoopDisposition(S, L) == LoopInvariant;
11636 }
11637 
11638 bool ScalarEvolution::hasComputableLoopEvolution(const SCEV *S, const Loop *L) {
11639   return getLoopDisposition(S, L) == LoopComputable;
11640 }
11641 
11642 ScalarEvolution::BlockDisposition
11643 ScalarEvolution::getBlockDisposition(const SCEV *S, const BasicBlock *BB) {
11644   auto &Values = BlockDispositions[S];
11645   for (auto &V : Values) {
11646     if (V.getPointer() == BB)
11647       return V.getInt();
11648   }
11649   Values.emplace_back(BB, DoesNotDominateBlock);
11650   BlockDisposition D = computeBlockDisposition(S, BB);
11651   auto &Values2 = BlockDispositions[S];
11652   for (auto &V : make_range(Values2.rbegin(), Values2.rend())) {
11653     if (V.getPointer() == BB) {
11654       V.setInt(D);
11655       break;
11656     }
11657   }
11658   return D;
11659 }
11660 
11661 ScalarEvolution::BlockDisposition
11662 ScalarEvolution::computeBlockDisposition(const SCEV *S, const BasicBlock *BB) {
11663   switch (static_cast<SCEVTypes>(S->getSCEVType())) {
11664   case scConstant:
11665     return ProperlyDominatesBlock;
11666   case scTruncate:
11667   case scZeroExtend:
11668   case scSignExtend:
11669     return getBlockDisposition(cast<SCEVCastExpr>(S)->getOperand(), BB);
11670   case scAddRecExpr: {
11671     // This uses a "dominates" query instead of "properly dominates" query
11672     // to test for proper dominance too, because the instruction which
11673     // produces the addrec's value is a PHI, and a PHI effectively properly
11674     // dominates its entire containing block.
11675     const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR = cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(S);
11676     if (!DT.dominates(AR->getLoop()->getHeader(), BB))
11677       return DoesNotDominateBlock;
11678 
11679     // Fall through into SCEVNAryExpr handling.
11680     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
11681   }
11682   case scAddExpr:
11683   case scMulExpr:
11684   case scUMaxExpr:
11685   case scSMaxExpr: {
11686     const SCEVNAryExpr *NAry = cast<SCEVNAryExpr>(S);
11687     bool Proper = true;
11688     for (const SCEV *NAryOp : NAry->operands()) {
11689       BlockDisposition D = getBlockDisposition(NAryOp, BB);
11690       if (D == DoesNotDominateBlock)
11691         return DoesNotDominateBlock;
11692       if (D == DominatesBlock)
11693         Proper = false;
11694     }
11695     return Proper ? ProperlyDominatesBlock : DominatesBlock;
11696   }
11697   case scUDivExpr: {
11698     const SCEVUDivExpr *UDiv = cast<SCEVUDivExpr>(S);
11699     const SCEV *LHS = UDiv->getLHS(), *RHS = UDiv->getRHS();
11700     BlockDisposition LD = getBlockDisposition(LHS, BB);
11701     if (LD == DoesNotDominateBlock)
11702       return DoesNotDominateBlock;
11703     BlockDisposition RD = getBlockDisposition(RHS, BB);
11704     if (RD == DoesNotDominateBlock)
11705       return DoesNotDominateBlock;
11706     return (LD == ProperlyDominatesBlock && RD == ProperlyDominatesBlock) ?
11707       ProperlyDominatesBlock : DominatesBlock;
11708   }
11709   case scUnknown:
11710     if (Instruction *I =
11711           dyn_cast<Instruction>(cast<SCEVUnknown>(S)->getValue())) {
11712       if (I->getParent() == BB)
11713         return DominatesBlock;
11714       if (DT.properlyDominates(I->getParent(), BB))
11715         return ProperlyDominatesBlock;
11716       return DoesNotDominateBlock;
11717     }
11718     return ProperlyDominatesBlock;
11719   case scCouldNotCompute:
11720     llvm_unreachable("Attempt to use a SCEVCouldNotCompute object!");
11721   }
11722   llvm_unreachable("Unknown SCEV kind!");
11723 }
11724 
11725 bool ScalarEvolution::dominates(const SCEV *S, const BasicBlock *BB) {
11726   return getBlockDisposition(S, BB) >= DominatesBlock;
11727 }
11728 
11729 bool ScalarEvolution::properlyDominates(const SCEV *S, const BasicBlock *BB) {
11730   return getBlockDisposition(S, BB) == ProperlyDominatesBlock;
11731 }
11732 
11733 bool ScalarEvolution::hasOperand(const SCEV *S, const SCEV *Op) const {
11734   return SCEVExprContains(S, [&](const SCEV *Expr) { return Expr == Op; });
11735 }
11736 
11737 bool ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit::hasOperand(const SCEV *S) const {
11738   auto IsS = [&](const SCEV *X) { return S == X; };
11739   auto ContainsS = [&](const SCEV *X) {
11740     return !isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(X) && SCEVExprContains(X, IsS);
11741   };
11742   return ContainsS(ExactNotTaken) || ContainsS(MaxNotTaken);
11743 }
11744 
11745 void
11746 ScalarEvolution::forgetMemoizedResults(const SCEV *S) {
11747   ValuesAtScopes.erase(S);
11748   LoopDispositions.erase(S);
11749   BlockDispositions.erase(S);
11750   UnsignedRanges.erase(S);
11751   SignedRanges.erase(S);
11752   ExprValueMap.erase(S);
11753   HasRecMap.erase(S);
11754   MinTrailingZerosCache.erase(S);
11755 
11756   for (auto I = PredicatedSCEVRewrites.begin();
11757        I != PredicatedSCEVRewrites.end();) {
11758     std::pair<const SCEV *, const Loop *> Entry = I->first;
11759     if (Entry.first == S)
11760       PredicatedSCEVRewrites.erase(I++);
11761     else
11762       ++I;
11763   }
11764 
11765   auto RemoveSCEVFromBackedgeMap =
11766       [S, this](DenseMap<const Loop *, BackedgeTakenInfo> &Map) {
11767         for (auto I = Map.begin(), E = Map.end(); I != E;) {
11768           BackedgeTakenInfo &BEInfo = I->second;
11769           if (BEInfo.hasOperand(S, this)) {
11770             BEInfo.clear();
11771             Map.erase(I++);
11772           } else
11773             ++I;
11774         }
11775       };
11776 
11777   RemoveSCEVFromBackedgeMap(BackedgeTakenCounts);
11778   RemoveSCEVFromBackedgeMap(PredicatedBackedgeTakenCounts);
11779 }
11780 
11781 void
11782 ScalarEvolution::getUsedLoops(const SCEV *S,
11783                               SmallPtrSetImpl<const Loop *> &LoopsUsed) {
11784   struct FindUsedLoops {
11785     FindUsedLoops(SmallPtrSetImpl<const Loop *> &LoopsUsed)
11786         : LoopsUsed(LoopsUsed) {}
11787     SmallPtrSetImpl<const Loop *> &LoopsUsed;
11788     bool follow(const SCEV *S) {
11789       if (auto *AR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(S))
11790         LoopsUsed.insert(AR->getLoop());
11791       return true;
11792     }
11793 
11794     bool isDone() const { return false; }
11795   };
11796 
11797   FindUsedLoops F(LoopsUsed);
11798   SCEVTraversal<FindUsedLoops>(F).visitAll(S);
11799 }
11800 
11801 void ScalarEvolution::addToLoopUseLists(const SCEV *S) {
11802   SmallPtrSet<const Loop *, 8> LoopsUsed;
11803   getUsedLoops(S, LoopsUsed);
11804   for (auto *L : LoopsUsed)
11805     LoopUsers[L].push_back(S);
11806 }
11807 
11808 void ScalarEvolution::verify() const {
11809   ScalarEvolution &SE = *const_cast<ScalarEvolution *>(this);
11810   ScalarEvolution SE2(F, TLI, AC, DT, LI);
11811 
11812   SmallVector<Loop *, 8> LoopStack(LI.begin(), LI.end());
11813 
11814   // Map's SCEV expressions from one ScalarEvolution "universe" to another.
11815   struct SCEVMapper : public SCEVRewriteVisitor<SCEVMapper> {
11816     SCEVMapper(ScalarEvolution &SE) : SCEVRewriteVisitor<SCEVMapper>(SE) {}
11817 
11818     const SCEV *visitConstant(const SCEVConstant *Constant) {
11819       return SE.getConstant(Constant->getAPInt());
11820     }
11821 
11822     const SCEV *visitUnknown(const SCEVUnknown *Expr) {
11823       return SE.getUnknown(Expr->getValue());
11824     }
11825 
11826     const SCEV *visitCouldNotCompute(const SCEVCouldNotCompute *Expr) {
11827       return SE.getCouldNotCompute();
11828     }
11829   };
11830 
11831   SCEVMapper SCM(SE2);
11832 
11833   while (!LoopStack.empty()) {
11834     auto *L = LoopStack.pop_back_val();
11835     LoopStack.insert(LoopStack.end(), L->begin(), L->end());
11836 
11837     auto *CurBECount = SCM.visit(
11838         const_cast<ScalarEvolution *>(this)->getBackedgeTakenCount(L));
11839     auto *NewBECount = SE2.getBackedgeTakenCount(L);
11840 
11841     if (CurBECount == SE2.getCouldNotCompute() ||
11842         NewBECount == SE2.getCouldNotCompute()) {
11843       // NB! This situation is legal, but is very suspicious -- whatever pass
11844       // change the loop to make a trip count go from could not compute to
11845       // computable or vice-versa *should have* invalidated SCEV.  However, we
11846       // choose not to assert here (for now) since we don't want false
11847       // positives.
11848       continue;
11849     }
11850 
11851     if (containsUndefs(CurBECount) || containsUndefs(NewBECount)) {
11852       // SCEV treats "undef" as an unknown but consistent value (i.e. it does
11853       // not propagate undef aggressively).  This means we can (and do) fail
11854       // verification in cases where a transform makes the trip count of a loop
11855       // go from "undef" to "undef+1" (say).  The transform is fine, since in
11856       // both cases the loop iterates "undef" times, but SCEV thinks we
11857       // increased the trip count of the loop by 1 incorrectly.
11858       continue;
11859     }
11860 
11861     if (SE.getTypeSizeInBits(CurBECount->getType()) >
11862         SE.getTypeSizeInBits(NewBECount->getType()))
11863       NewBECount = SE2.getZeroExtendExpr(NewBECount, CurBECount->getType());
11864     else if (SE.getTypeSizeInBits(CurBECount->getType()) <
11865              SE.getTypeSizeInBits(NewBECount->getType()))
11866       CurBECount = SE2.getZeroExtendExpr(CurBECount, NewBECount->getType());
11867 
11868     auto *ConstantDelta =
11869         dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(SE2.getMinusSCEV(CurBECount, NewBECount));
11870 
11871     if (ConstantDelta && ConstantDelta->getAPInt() != 0) {
11872       dbgs() << "Trip Count Changed!\n";
11873       dbgs() << "Old: " << *CurBECount << "\n";
11874       dbgs() << "New: " << *NewBECount << "\n";
11875       dbgs() << "Delta: " << *ConstantDelta << "\n";
11876       std::abort();
11877     }
11878   }
11879 }
11880 
11881 bool ScalarEvolution::invalidate(
11882     Function &F, const PreservedAnalyses &PA,
11883     FunctionAnalysisManager::Invalidator &Inv) {
11884   // Invalidate the ScalarEvolution object whenever it isn't preserved or one
11885   // of its dependencies is invalidated.
11886   auto PAC = PA.getChecker<ScalarEvolutionAnalysis>();
11887   return !(PAC.preserved() || PAC.preservedSet<AllAnalysesOn<Function>>()) ||
11888          Inv.invalidate<AssumptionAnalysis>(F, PA) ||
11889          Inv.invalidate<DominatorTreeAnalysis>(F, PA) ||
11890          Inv.invalidate<LoopAnalysis>(F, PA);
11891 }
11892 
11893 AnalysisKey ScalarEvolutionAnalysis::Key;
11894 
11895 ScalarEvolution ScalarEvolutionAnalysis::run(Function &F,
11896                                              FunctionAnalysisManager &AM) {
11897   return ScalarEvolution(F, AM.getResult<TargetLibraryAnalysis>(F),
11898                          AM.getResult<AssumptionAnalysis>(F),
11899                          AM.getResult<DominatorTreeAnalysis>(F),
11900                          AM.getResult<LoopAnalysis>(F));
11901 }
11902 
11903 PreservedAnalyses
11904 ScalarEvolutionPrinterPass::run(Function &F, FunctionAnalysisManager &AM) {
11905   AM.getResult<ScalarEvolutionAnalysis>(F).print(OS);
11906   return PreservedAnalyses::all();
11907 }
11908 
11909 INITIALIZE_PASS_BEGIN(ScalarEvolutionWrapperPass, "scalar-evolution",
11910                       "Scalar Evolution Analysis", false, true)
11911 INITIALIZE_PASS_DEPENDENCY(AssumptionCacheTracker)
11912 INITIALIZE_PASS_DEPENDENCY(LoopInfoWrapperPass)
11913 INITIALIZE_PASS_DEPENDENCY(DominatorTreeWrapperPass)
11914 INITIALIZE_PASS_DEPENDENCY(TargetLibraryInfoWrapperPass)
11915 INITIALIZE_PASS_END(ScalarEvolutionWrapperPass, "scalar-evolution",
11916                     "Scalar Evolution Analysis", false, true)
11917 
11918 char ScalarEvolutionWrapperPass::ID = 0;
11919 
11920 ScalarEvolutionWrapperPass::ScalarEvolutionWrapperPass() : FunctionPass(ID) {
11921   initializeScalarEvolutionWrapperPassPass(*PassRegistry::getPassRegistry());
11922 }
11923 
11924 bool ScalarEvolutionWrapperPass::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
11925   SE.reset(new ScalarEvolution(
11926       F, getAnalysis<TargetLibraryInfoWrapperPass>().getTLI(),
11927       getAnalysis<AssumptionCacheTracker>().getAssumptionCache(F),
11928       getAnalysis<DominatorTreeWrapperPass>().getDomTree(),
11929       getAnalysis<LoopInfoWrapperPass>().getLoopInfo()));
11930   return false;
11931 }
11932 
11933 void ScalarEvolutionWrapperPass::releaseMemory() { SE.reset(); }
11934 
11935 void ScalarEvolutionWrapperPass::print(raw_ostream &OS, const Module *) const {
11936   SE->print(OS);
11937 }
11938 
11939 void ScalarEvolutionWrapperPass::verifyAnalysis() const {
11940   if (!VerifySCEV)
11941     return;
11942 
11943   SE->verify();
11944 }
11945 
11946 void ScalarEvolutionWrapperPass::getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const {
11947   AU.setPreservesAll();
11948   AU.addRequiredTransitive<AssumptionCacheTracker>();
11949   AU.addRequiredTransitive<LoopInfoWrapperPass>();
11950   AU.addRequiredTransitive<DominatorTreeWrapperPass>();
11951   AU.addRequiredTransitive<TargetLibraryInfoWrapperPass>();
11952 }
11953 
11954 const SCEVPredicate *ScalarEvolution::getEqualPredicate(const SCEV *LHS,
11955                                                         const SCEV *RHS) {
11956   FoldingSetNodeID ID;
11957   assert(LHS->getType() == RHS->getType() &&
11958          "Type mismatch between LHS and RHS");
11959   // Unique this node based on the arguments
11960   ID.AddInteger(SCEVPredicate::P_Equal);
11961   ID.AddPointer(LHS);
11962   ID.AddPointer(RHS);
11963   void *IP = nullptr;
11964   if (const auto *S = UniquePreds.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP))
11965     return S;
11966   SCEVEqualPredicate *Eq = new (SCEVAllocator)
11967       SCEVEqualPredicate(ID.Intern(SCEVAllocator), LHS, RHS);
11968   UniquePreds.InsertNode(Eq, IP);
11969   return Eq;
11970 }
11971 
11972 const SCEVPredicate *ScalarEvolution::getWrapPredicate(
11973     const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR,
11974     SCEVWrapPredicate::IncrementWrapFlags AddedFlags) {
11975   FoldingSetNodeID ID;
11976   // Unique this node based on the arguments
11977   ID.AddInteger(SCEVPredicate::P_Wrap);
11978   ID.AddPointer(AR);
11979   ID.AddInteger(AddedFlags);
11980   void *IP = nullptr;
11981   if (const auto *S = UniquePreds.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP))
11982     return S;
11983   auto *OF = new (SCEVAllocator)
11984       SCEVWrapPredicate(ID.Intern(SCEVAllocator), AR, AddedFlags);
11985   UniquePreds.InsertNode(OF, IP);
11986   return OF;
11987 }
11988 
11989 namespace {
11990 
11991 class SCEVPredicateRewriter : public SCEVRewriteVisitor<SCEVPredicateRewriter> {
11992 public:
11993 
11994   /// Rewrites \p S in the context of a loop L and the SCEV predication
11995   /// infrastructure.
11996   ///
11997   /// If \p Pred is non-null, the SCEV expression is rewritten to respect the
11998   /// equivalences present in \p Pred.
11999   ///
12000   /// If \p NewPreds is non-null, rewrite is free to add further predicates to
12001   /// \p NewPreds such that the result will be an AddRecExpr.
12002   static const SCEV *rewrite(const SCEV *S, const Loop *L, ScalarEvolution &SE,
12003                              SmallPtrSetImpl<const SCEVPredicate *> *NewPreds,
12004                              SCEVUnionPredicate *Pred) {
12005     SCEVPredicateRewriter Rewriter(L, SE, NewPreds, Pred);
12006     return Rewriter.visit(S);
12007   }
12008 
12009   const SCEV *visitUnknown(const SCEVUnknown *Expr) {
12010     if (Pred) {
12011       auto ExprPreds = Pred->getPredicatesForExpr(Expr);
12012       for (auto *Pred : ExprPreds)
12013         if (const auto *IPred = dyn_cast<SCEVEqualPredicate>(Pred))
12014           if (IPred->getLHS() == Expr)
12015             return IPred->getRHS();
12016     }
12017     return convertToAddRecWithPreds(Expr);
12018   }
12019 
12020   const SCEV *visitZeroExtendExpr(const SCEVZeroExtendExpr *Expr) {
12021     const SCEV *Operand = visit(Expr->getOperand());
12022     const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Operand);
12023     if (AR && AR->getLoop() == L && AR->isAffine()) {
12024       // This couldn't be folded because the operand didn't have the nuw
12025       // flag. Add the nusw flag as an assumption that we could make.
12026       const SCEV *Step = AR->getStepRecurrence(SE);
12027       Type *Ty = Expr->getType();
12028       if (addOverflowAssumption(AR, SCEVWrapPredicate::IncrementNUSW))
12029         return SE.getAddRecExpr(SE.getZeroExtendExpr(AR->getStart(), Ty),
12030                                 SE.getSignExtendExpr(Step, Ty), L,
12031                                 AR->getNoWrapFlags());
12032     }
12033     return SE.getZeroExtendExpr(Operand, Expr->getType());
12034   }
12035 
12036   const SCEV *visitSignExtendExpr(const SCEVSignExtendExpr *Expr) {
12037     const SCEV *Operand = visit(Expr->getOperand());
12038     const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Operand);
12039     if (AR && AR->getLoop() == L && AR->isAffine()) {
12040       // This couldn't be folded because the operand didn't have the nsw
12041       // flag. Add the nssw flag as an assumption that we could make.
12042       const SCEV *Step = AR->getStepRecurrence(SE);
12043       Type *Ty = Expr->getType();
12044       if (addOverflowAssumption(AR, SCEVWrapPredicate::IncrementNSSW))
12045         return SE.getAddRecExpr(SE.getSignExtendExpr(AR->getStart(), Ty),
12046                                 SE.getSignExtendExpr(Step, Ty), L,
12047                                 AR->getNoWrapFlags());
12048     }
12049     return SE.getSignExtendExpr(Operand, Expr->getType());
12050   }
12051 
12052 private:
12053   explicit SCEVPredicateRewriter(const Loop *L, ScalarEvolution &SE,
12054                         SmallPtrSetImpl<const SCEVPredicate *> *NewPreds,
12055                         SCEVUnionPredicate *Pred)
12056       : SCEVRewriteVisitor(SE), NewPreds(NewPreds), Pred(Pred), L(L) {}
12057 
12058   bool addOverflowAssumption(const SCEVPredicate *P) {
12059     if (!NewPreds) {
12060       // Check if we've already made this assumption.
12061       return Pred && Pred->implies(P);
12062     }
12063     NewPreds->insert(P);
12064     return true;
12065   }
12066 
12067   bool addOverflowAssumption(const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR,
12068                              SCEVWrapPredicate::IncrementWrapFlags AddedFlags) {
12069     auto *A = SE.getWrapPredicate(AR, AddedFlags);
12070     return addOverflowAssumption(A);
12071   }
12072 
12073   // If \p Expr represents a PHINode, we try to see if it can be represented
12074   // as an AddRec, possibly under a predicate (PHISCEVPred). If it is possible
12075   // to add this predicate as a runtime overflow check, we return the AddRec.
12076   // If \p Expr does not meet these conditions (is not a PHI node, or we
12077   // couldn't create an AddRec for it, or couldn't add the predicate), we just
12078   // return \p Expr.
12079   const SCEV *convertToAddRecWithPreds(const SCEVUnknown *Expr) {
12080     if (!isa<PHINode>(Expr->getValue()))
12081       return Expr;
12082     Optional<std::pair<const SCEV *, SmallVector<const SCEVPredicate *, 3>>>
12083     PredicatedRewrite = SE.createAddRecFromPHIWithCasts(Expr);
12084     if (!PredicatedRewrite)
12085       return Expr;
12086     for (auto *P : PredicatedRewrite->second){
12087       // Wrap predicates from outer loops are not supported.
12088       if (auto *WP = dyn_cast<const SCEVWrapPredicate>(P)) {
12089         auto *AR = cast<const SCEVAddRecExpr>(WP->getExpr());
12090         if (L != AR->getLoop())
12091           return Expr;
12092       }
12093       if (!addOverflowAssumption(P))
12094         return Expr;
12095     }
12096     return PredicatedRewrite->first;
12097   }
12098 
12099   SmallPtrSetImpl<const SCEVPredicate *> *NewPreds;
12100   SCEVUnionPredicate *Pred;
12101   const Loop *L;
12102 };
12103 
12104 } // end anonymous namespace
12105 
12106 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::rewriteUsingPredicate(const SCEV *S, const Loop *L,
12107                                                    SCEVUnionPredicate &Preds) {
12108   return SCEVPredicateRewriter::rewrite(S, L, *this, nullptr, &Preds);
12109 }
12110 
12111 const SCEVAddRecExpr *ScalarEvolution::convertSCEVToAddRecWithPredicates(
12112     const SCEV *S, const Loop *L,
12113     SmallPtrSetImpl<const SCEVPredicate *> &Preds) {
12114   SmallPtrSet<const SCEVPredicate *, 4> TransformPreds;
12115   S = SCEVPredicateRewriter::rewrite(S, L, *this, &TransformPreds, nullptr);
12116   auto *AddRec = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(S);
12117 
12118   if (!AddRec)
12119     return nullptr;
12120 
12121   // Since the transformation was successful, we can now transfer the SCEV
12122   // predicates.
12123   for (auto *P : TransformPreds)
12124     Preds.insert(P);
12125 
12126   return AddRec;
12127 }
12128 
12129 /// SCEV predicates
12130 SCEVPredicate::SCEVPredicate(const FoldingSetNodeIDRef ID,
12131                              SCEVPredicateKind Kind)
12132     : FastID(ID), Kind(Kind) {}
12133 
12134 SCEVEqualPredicate::SCEVEqualPredicate(const FoldingSetNodeIDRef ID,
12135                                        const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS)
12136     : SCEVPredicate(ID, P_Equal), LHS(LHS), RHS(RHS) {
12137   assert(LHS->getType() == RHS->getType() && "LHS and RHS types don't match");
12138   assert(LHS != RHS && "LHS and RHS are the same SCEV");
12139 }
12140 
12141 bool SCEVEqualPredicate::implies(const SCEVPredicate *N) const {
12142   const auto *Op = dyn_cast<SCEVEqualPredicate>(N);
12143 
12144   if (!Op)
12145     return false;
12146 
12147   return Op->LHS == LHS && Op->RHS == RHS;
12148 }
12149 
12150 bool SCEVEqualPredicate::isAlwaysTrue() const { return false; }
12151 
12152 const SCEV *SCEVEqualPredicate::getExpr() const { return LHS; }
12153 
12154 void SCEVEqualPredicate::print(raw_ostream &OS, unsigned Depth) const {
12155   OS.indent(Depth) << "Equal predicate: " << *LHS << " == " << *RHS << "\n";
12156 }
12157 
12158 SCEVWrapPredicate::SCEVWrapPredicate(const FoldingSetNodeIDRef ID,
12159                                      const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR,
12160                                      IncrementWrapFlags Flags)
12161     : SCEVPredicate(ID, P_Wrap), AR(AR), Flags(Flags) {}
12162 
12163 const SCEV *SCEVWrapPredicate::getExpr() const { return AR; }
12164 
12165 bool SCEVWrapPredicate::implies(const SCEVPredicate *N) const {
12166   const auto *Op = dyn_cast<SCEVWrapPredicate>(N);
12167 
12168   return Op && Op->AR == AR && setFlags(Flags, Op->Flags) == Flags;
12169 }
12170 
12171 bool SCEVWrapPredicate::isAlwaysTrue() const {
12172   SCEV::NoWrapFlags ScevFlags = AR->getNoWrapFlags();
12173   IncrementWrapFlags IFlags = Flags;
12174 
12175   if (ScalarEvolution::setFlags(ScevFlags, SCEV::FlagNSW) == ScevFlags)
12176     IFlags = clearFlags(IFlags, IncrementNSSW);
12177 
12178   return IFlags == IncrementAnyWrap;
12179 }
12180 
12181 void SCEVWrapPredicate::print(raw_ostream &OS, unsigned Depth) const {
12182   OS.indent(Depth) << *getExpr() << " Added Flags: ";
12183   if (SCEVWrapPredicate::IncrementNUSW & getFlags())
12184     OS << "<nusw>";
12185   if (SCEVWrapPredicate::IncrementNSSW & getFlags())
12186     OS << "<nssw>";
12187   OS << "\n";
12188 }
12189 
12190 SCEVWrapPredicate::IncrementWrapFlags
12191 SCEVWrapPredicate::getImpliedFlags(const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR,
12192                                    ScalarEvolution &SE) {
12193   IncrementWrapFlags ImpliedFlags = IncrementAnyWrap;
12194   SCEV::NoWrapFlags StaticFlags = AR->getNoWrapFlags();
12195 
12196   // We can safely transfer the NSW flag as NSSW.
12197   if (ScalarEvolution::setFlags(StaticFlags, SCEV::FlagNSW) == StaticFlags)
12198     ImpliedFlags = IncrementNSSW;
12199 
12200   if (ScalarEvolution::setFlags(StaticFlags, SCEV::FlagNUW) == StaticFlags) {
12201     // If the increment is positive, the SCEV NUW flag will also imply the
12202     // WrapPredicate NUSW flag.
12203     if (const auto *Step = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(AR->getStepRecurrence(SE)))
12204       if (Step->getValue()->getValue().isNonNegative())
12205         ImpliedFlags = setFlags(ImpliedFlags, IncrementNUSW);
12206   }
12207 
12208   return ImpliedFlags;
12209 }
12210 
12211 /// Union predicates don't get cached so create a dummy set ID for it.
12212 SCEVUnionPredicate::SCEVUnionPredicate()
12213     : SCEVPredicate(FoldingSetNodeIDRef(nullptr, 0), P_Union) {}
12214 
12215 bool SCEVUnionPredicate::isAlwaysTrue() const {
12216   return all_of(Preds,
12217                 [](const SCEVPredicate *I) { return I->isAlwaysTrue(); });
12218 }
12219 
12220 ArrayRef<const SCEVPredicate *>
12221 SCEVUnionPredicate::getPredicatesForExpr(const SCEV *Expr) {
12222   auto I = SCEVToPreds.find(Expr);
12223   if (I == SCEVToPreds.end())
12224     return ArrayRef<const SCEVPredicate *>();
12225   return I->second;
12226 }
12227 
12228 bool SCEVUnionPredicate::implies(const SCEVPredicate *N) const {
12229   if (const auto *Set = dyn_cast<SCEVUnionPredicate>(N))
12230     return all_of(Set->Preds,
12231                   [this](const SCEVPredicate *I) { return this->implies(I); });
12232 
12233   auto ScevPredsIt = SCEVToPreds.find(N->getExpr());
12234   if (ScevPredsIt == SCEVToPreds.end())
12235     return false;
12236   auto &SCEVPreds = ScevPredsIt->second;
12237 
12238   return any_of(SCEVPreds,
12239                 [N](const SCEVPredicate *I) { return I->implies(N); });
12240 }
12241 
12242 const SCEV *SCEVUnionPredicate::getExpr() const { return nullptr; }
12243 
12244 void SCEVUnionPredicate::print(raw_ostream &OS, unsigned Depth) const {
12245   for (auto Pred : Preds)
12246     Pred->print(OS, Depth);
12247 }
12248 
12249 void SCEVUnionPredicate::add(const SCEVPredicate *N) {
12250   if (const auto *Set = dyn_cast<SCEVUnionPredicate>(N)) {
12251     for (auto Pred : Set->Preds)
12252       add(Pred);
12253     return;
12254   }
12255 
12256   if (implies(N))
12257     return;
12258 
12259   const SCEV *Key = N->getExpr();
12260   assert(Key && "Only SCEVUnionPredicate doesn't have an "
12261                 " associated expression!");
12262 
12263   SCEVToPreds[Key].push_back(N);
12264   Preds.push_back(N);
12265 }
12266 
12267 PredicatedScalarEvolution::PredicatedScalarEvolution(ScalarEvolution &SE,
12268                                                      Loop &L)
12269     : SE(SE), L(L) {}
12270 
12271 const SCEV *PredicatedScalarEvolution::getSCEV(Value *V) {
12272   const SCEV *Expr = SE.getSCEV(V);
12273   RewriteEntry &Entry = RewriteMap[Expr];
12274 
12275   // If we already have an entry and the version matches, return it.
12276   if (Entry.second && Generation == Entry.first)
12277     return Entry.second;
12278 
12279   // We found an entry but it's stale. Rewrite the stale entry
12280   // according to the current predicate.
12281   if (Entry.second)
12282     Expr = Entry.second;
12283 
12284   const SCEV *NewSCEV = SE.rewriteUsingPredicate(Expr, &L, Preds);
12285   Entry = {Generation, NewSCEV};
12286 
12287   return NewSCEV;
12288 }
12289 
12290 const SCEV *PredicatedScalarEvolution::getBackedgeTakenCount() {
12291   if (!BackedgeCount) {
12292     SCEVUnionPredicate BackedgePred;
12293     BackedgeCount = SE.getPredicatedBackedgeTakenCount(&L, BackedgePred);
12294     addPredicate(BackedgePred);
12295   }
12296   return BackedgeCount;
12297 }
12298 
12299 void PredicatedScalarEvolution::addPredicate(const SCEVPredicate &Pred) {
12300   if (Preds.implies(&Pred))
12301     return;
12302   Preds.add(&Pred);
12303   updateGeneration();
12304 }
12305 
12306 const SCEVUnionPredicate &PredicatedScalarEvolution::getUnionPredicate() const {
12307   return Preds;
12308 }
12309 
12310 void PredicatedScalarEvolution::updateGeneration() {
12311   // If the generation number wrapped recompute everything.
12312   if (++Generation == 0) {
12313     for (auto &II : RewriteMap) {
12314       const SCEV *Rewritten = II.second.second;
12315       II.second = {Generation, SE.rewriteUsingPredicate(Rewritten, &L, Preds)};
12316     }
12317   }
12318 }
12319 
12320 void PredicatedScalarEvolution::setNoOverflow(
12321     Value *V, SCEVWrapPredicate::IncrementWrapFlags Flags) {
12322   const SCEV *Expr = getSCEV(V);
12323   const auto *AR = cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Expr);
12324 
12325   auto ImpliedFlags = SCEVWrapPredicate::getImpliedFlags(AR, SE);
12326 
12327   // Clear the statically implied flags.
12328   Flags = SCEVWrapPredicate::clearFlags(Flags, ImpliedFlags);
12329   addPredicate(*SE.getWrapPredicate(AR, Flags));
12330 
12331   auto II = FlagsMap.insert({V, Flags});
12332   if (!II.second)
12333     II.first->second = SCEVWrapPredicate::setFlags(Flags, II.first->second);
12334 }
12335 
12336 bool PredicatedScalarEvolution::hasNoOverflow(
12337     Value *V, SCEVWrapPredicate::IncrementWrapFlags Flags) {
12338   const SCEV *Expr = getSCEV(V);
12339   const auto *AR = cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Expr);
12340 
12341   Flags = SCEVWrapPredicate::clearFlags(
12342       Flags, SCEVWrapPredicate::getImpliedFlags(AR, SE));
12343 
12344   auto II = FlagsMap.find(V);
12345 
12346   if (II != FlagsMap.end())
12347     Flags = SCEVWrapPredicate::clearFlags(Flags, II->second);
12348 
12349   return Flags == SCEVWrapPredicate::IncrementAnyWrap;
12350 }
12351 
12352 const SCEVAddRecExpr *PredicatedScalarEvolution::getAsAddRec(Value *V) {
12353   const SCEV *Expr = this->getSCEV(V);
12354   SmallPtrSet<const SCEVPredicate *, 4> NewPreds;
12355   auto *New = SE.convertSCEVToAddRecWithPredicates(Expr, &L, NewPreds);
12356 
12357   if (!New)
12358     return nullptr;
12359 
12360   for (auto *P : NewPreds)
12361     Preds.add(P);
12362 
12363   updateGeneration();
12364   RewriteMap[SE.getSCEV(V)] = {Generation, New};
12365   return New;
12366 }
12367 
12368 PredicatedScalarEvolution::PredicatedScalarEvolution(
12369     const PredicatedScalarEvolution &Init)
12370     : RewriteMap(Init.RewriteMap), SE(Init.SE), L(Init.L), Preds(Init.Preds),
12371       Generation(Init.Generation), BackedgeCount(Init.BackedgeCount) {
12372   for (const auto &I : Init.FlagsMap)
12373     FlagsMap.insert(I);
12374 }
12375 
12376 void PredicatedScalarEvolution::print(raw_ostream &OS, unsigned Depth) const {
12377   // For each block.
12378   for (auto *BB : L.getBlocks())
12379     for (auto &I : *BB) {
12380       if (!SE.isSCEVable(I.getType()))
12381         continue;
12382 
12383       auto *Expr = SE.getSCEV(&I);
12384       auto II = RewriteMap.find(Expr);
12385 
12386       if (II == RewriteMap.end())
12387         continue;
12388 
12389       // Don't print things that are not interesting.
12390       if (II->second.second == Expr)
12391         continue;
12392 
12393       OS.indent(Depth) << "[PSE]" << I << ":\n";
12394       OS.indent(Depth + 2) << *Expr << "\n";
12395       OS.indent(Depth + 2) << "--> " << *II->second.second << "\n";
12396     }
12397 }
12398 
12399 // Match the mathematical pattern A - (A / B) * B, where A and B can be
12400 // arbitrary expressions.
12401 // It's not always easy, as A and B can be folded (imagine A is X / 2, and B is
12402 // 4, A / B becomes X / 8).
12403 bool ScalarEvolution::matchURem(const SCEV *Expr, const SCEV *&LHS,
12404                                 const SCEV *&RHS) {
12405   const auto *Add = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(Expr);
12406   if (Add == nullptr || Add->getNumOperands() != 2)
12407     return false;
12408 
12409   const SCEV *A = Add->getOperand(1);
12410   const auto *Mul = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(Add->getOperand(0));
12411 
12412   if (Mul == nullptr)
12413     return false;
12414 
12415   const auto MatchURemWithDivisor = [&](const SCEV *B) {
12416     // (SomeExpr + (-(SomeExpr / B) * B)).
12417     if (Expr == getURemExpr(A, B)) {
12418       LHS = A;
12419       RHS = B;
12420       return true;
12421     }
12422     return false;
12423   };
12424 
12425   // (SomeExpr + (-1 * (SomeExpr / B) * B)).
12426   if (Mul->getNumOperands() == 3 && isa<SCEVConstant>(Mul->getOperand(0)))
12427     return MatchURemWithDivisor(Mul->getOperand(1)) ||
12428            MatchURemWithDivisor(Mul->getOperand(2));
12429 
12430   // (SomeExpr + ((-SomeExpr / B) * B)) or (SomeExpr + ((SomeExpr / B) * -B)).
12431   if (Mul->getNumOperands() == 2)
12432     return MatchURemWithDivisor(Mul->getOperand(1)) ||
12433            MatchURemWithDivisor(Mul->getOperand(0)) ||
12434            MatchURemWithDivisor(getNegativeSCEV(Mul->getOperand(1))) ||
12435            MatchURemWithDivisor(getNegativeSCEV(Mul->getOperand(0)));
12436   return false;
12437 }
12438